1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- 2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 3@c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 4@c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 5@c 6@c %**start of header 7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use 8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o. 9@setfilename gdb.info 10@c 11@include gdb-cfg.texi 12@c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN} 14@setchapternewpage odd 15@c %**end of header 16 17@iftex 18@c @smallbook 19@c @cropmarks 20@end iftex 21 22@finalout 23@syncodeindex ky cp 24@syncodeindex tp cp 25 26@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable, 27@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex. 28@syncodeindex vr cp 29@syncodeindex fn cp 30 31@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version! 32@c This is updated by GNU Press. 33@set EDITION Tenth 34 35@c !!set GDB edit command default editor 36@set EDITOR /bin/ex 37 38@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER. 39 40@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of 41@c manuals to an info tree. 42@dircategory Software development 43@direntry 44* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger. 45@end direntry 46 47@copying 48Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 491998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 50Free Software Foundation, Inc. 51 52Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document 53under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or 54any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the 55Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs 56Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' 57and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. 58 59(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify 60this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in 61developing GNU and promoting software freedom.'' 62@end copying 63 64@ifnottex 65This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}. 66 67This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with 68@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN} 69@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 70@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 71@end ifset 72Version @value{GDBVN}. 73 74@insertcopying 75@end ifnottex 76 77@titlepage 78@title Debugging with @value{GDBN} 79@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger 80@sp 1 81@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} 82@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 83@sp 1 84@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 85@end ifset 86@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al. 87@page 88@tex 89{\parskip=0pt 90\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par 91\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par 92\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par 93} 94@end tex 95 96@vskip 0pt plus 1filll 97Published by the Free Software Foundation @* 9851 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, 99Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@* 100ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @* 101 102@insertcopying 103@page 104@value{GDBN} version 7.3 is dedicated to the memory of long-standing 105contributor Michael Snyder. 106@end titlepage 107@page 108 109@ifnottex 110@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir) 111 112@top Debugging with @value{GDBN} 113 114This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger. 115 116This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} 117@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 118@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 119@end ifset 120Version @value{GDBVN}. 121 122Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 123 124This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred 125Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free 126software in general. We will miss him. 127 128@menu 129* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN} 130* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session 131 132* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN} 133* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands 134* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN} 135* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing 136* Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward 137* Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it 138* Stack:: Examining the stack 139* Source:: Examining source files 140* Data:: Examining data 141* Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code 142* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros 143* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively 144* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays 145 146* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages 147 148* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table 149* Altering:: Altering execution 150* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files 151* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target 152* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs 153* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information 154* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN} 155* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN} 156* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters 157* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 158* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 159* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface. 160* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface. 161* JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface. 162 163* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 164 165@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 166* Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing 167* Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively 168@end ifset 169@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 170* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing 171* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively 172@end ifclear 173* In Memoriam:: In Memoriam 174* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation 175* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB 176* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands 177* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol 178* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism 179* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to 180 @value{GDBN} 181* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from 182 the operating system 183* Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format 184* Copying:: GNU General Public License says 185 how you can copy and share GDB 186* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation 187* Index:: Index 188@end menu 189 190@end ifnottex 191 192@contents 193 194@node Summary 195@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN} 196 197The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is 198going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another 199program was doing at the moment it crashed. 200 201@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of 202these) to help you catch bugs in the act: 203 204@itemize @bullet 205@item 206Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. 207 208@item 209Make your program stop on specified conditions. 210 211@item 212Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. 213 214@item 215Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the 216effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. 217@end itemize 218 219You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}. 220For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}. 221For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}. 222 223Support for D is partial. For information on D, see 224@ref{D,,D}. 225 226@cindex Modula-2 227Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see 228@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. 229 230Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see 231@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}. 232 233@cindex Pascal 234Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 235nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 236entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 237syntax. 238 239@cindex Fortran 240@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although 241it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing 242underscore. 243 244@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C, 245using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime. 246 247@menu 248* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software 249* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB 250@end menu 251 252@node Free Software 253@unnumberedsec Free Software 254 255@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu} 256General Public License 257(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed 258program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the 259freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to 260the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies. 261Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the 262Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms. 263 264Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that 265you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away 266from anyone else. 267 268@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation 269 270The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in 271the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can 272include with the free software. Many of our most important 273programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory 274texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package; 275when an important free software package does not come with a free 276manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such 277gaps today. 278 279Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people 280normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the 281authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no 282copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude 283them from the free software world. 284 285That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far 286from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a 287manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community, 288only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication 289contract to make it non-free. 290 291Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not 292price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers 293charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free 294Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The 295problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals 296are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and 297modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this. 298 299The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for 300free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of 301commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can 302accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper. 303 304Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too. 305When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they 306are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can 307provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A 308manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document 309a changed version of the program is not really available to our 310community. 311 312Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are 313acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original 314author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of 315authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions 316to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that 317may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal 318with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions 319are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use 320of the manual. 321 322However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical} 323content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual 324media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions 325obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another 326manual to replace it. 327 328Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to 329lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that 330free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps 331the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will 332realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to 333the free software community. 334 335If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under 336the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation 337license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you 338don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers 339will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the 340option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is 341what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please 342try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license 343is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}. 344 345You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted 346manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying 347copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major 348improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation 349at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it, 350and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom. 351Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that 352have paid or pay the authors to work on it. 353 354The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation 355published by other publishers, at 356@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}. 357 358@node Contributors 359@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN} 360 361Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many 362other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its 363development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One 364of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute 365to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The 366file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a 367blow-by-blow account. 368 369Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time. 370 371@quotation 372@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you 373or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly 374omitted from this list, we would like to add your names! 375@end quotation 376 377So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we 378particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major 379releases: 380Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0); 381Jim Blandy (release 4.18); 382Jason Molenda (release 4.17); 383Stan Shebs (release 4.14); 384Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9); 385Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4); 386John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9); 387Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3); 388and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0). 389 390Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris 391Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8. 392 393Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support 394in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per 395Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 396demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did 397much general update work leading to release 3.0). 398 399@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple 400object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V. 401Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore. 402 403David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did 404the original support for encapsulated COFF. 405 406Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support. 407 408Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support. 409Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS 410support. 411Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support. 412Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support. 413Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support. 414David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support. 415Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support. 416Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support. 417Keith Packard contributed NS32K support. 418Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support. 419Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support. 420Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging). 421Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support. 422Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support. 423Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode. 424Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support. 425Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support. 426Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support. 427 428Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support. 429 430Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared 431libraries. 432 433Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree 434about several machine instruction sets. 435 436Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop 437remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM 438contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI, 439and RDI targets, respectively. 440 441Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing 442command-line editing and command history. 443 444Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the 445Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual. 446 447Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4. 448He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded 449symbols. 450 451Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for 452H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors. 453 454NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors. 455 456Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D 457processors. 458 459Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor. 460 461Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors. 462 463Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors. 464 465Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware 466watchpoints. 467 468Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints. 469 470Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver. 471 472Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made 473nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}. 474 475The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed 476support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0 477(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++} 478compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface): 479Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, 480Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase 481provided HP-specific information in this manual. 482 483DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project. 484Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port. 485 486Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its 487development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN} 488fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin 489Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim 490Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler, 491Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek 492Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In 493addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, 494JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug 495Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff 496Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, 497Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin 498Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela 499Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David 500Zuhn have made contributions both large and small. 501 502Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for 503Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 504 505Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red 506Hat. 507 508Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many 509people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick 510Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei 511Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason 512Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped 513with the migration of old architectures to this new framework. 514 515Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s 516unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring 517frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark 518Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the 519libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and 520trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a 521complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by 522Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane 523Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel 524Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei 525Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich 526Weigand. 527 528Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from 529Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others 530who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include 531Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner. 532 533Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the 534Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture. 535 536@node Sample Session 537@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session 538 539You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}. 540However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the 541debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands. 542 543@iftex 544In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input}, 545to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output. 546@end iftex 547 548@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where 549@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use. 550 551One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro 552processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its 553quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro 554definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4} 555session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we 556then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the 557same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to 558@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same 559procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}: 560 561@smallexample 562$ @b{cd gnu/m4} 563$ @b{./m4} 564@b{define(foo,0000)} 565 566@b{foo} 5670000 568@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))} 569 570@b{bar} 5710000 572@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 573 574@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 575@b{baz} 576@b{Ctrl-d} 577m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string 578@end smallexample 579 580@noindent 581Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on. 582 583@smallexample 584$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4} 585@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook 586@c FIXME... format to come out better. 587@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies 588 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see 589 the conditions. 590There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty" 591 for details. 592 593@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc... 594(@value{GDBP}) 595@end smallexample 596 597@noindent 598@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the 599rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly. 600We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so 601that examples fit in this manual. 602 603@smallexample 604(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70} 605@end smallexample 606 607@noindent 608We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works. 609Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is 610@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN} 611@code{break} command. 612 613@smallexample 614(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote} 615Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879. 616@end smallexample 617 618@noindent 619Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN} 620control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote} 621subroutine, the program runs as usual: 622 623@smallexample 624(@value{GDBP}) @b{run} 625Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4 626@b{define(foo,0000)} 627 628@b{foo} 6290000 630@end smallexample 631 632@noindent 633To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN} 634suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the 635context where it stops. 636 637@smallexample 638@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 639 640Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 641 at builtin.c:879 642879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3)) 643@end smallexample 644 645@noindent 646Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to 647the next line of the current function. 648 649@smallexample 650(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 651882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\ 652 : nil, 653@end smallexample 654 655@noindent 656@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it 657by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}. 658@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any} 659subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}. 660 661@smallexample 662(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 663set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 664 at input.c:530 665530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 666@end smallexample 667 668@noindent 669The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now 670suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It 671shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace} 672command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are 673in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a 674stack frame for each active subroutine. 675 676@smallexample 677(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt} 678#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 679 at input.c:530 680#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 681 at builtin.c:882 682#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242 683#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30) 684 at macro.c:71 685#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40 686#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195 687@end smallexample 688 689@noindent 690We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two 691times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid 692falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine. 693 694@smallexample 695(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 6960x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote) 697(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 6980x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \ 699def_lquote : xstrdup(lq); 700(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 701536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 702 : xstrdup(rq); 703(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 704538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 705@end smallexample 706 707@noindent 708The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables 709@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left 710and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p} 711(@code{print}) to see their values. 712 713@smallexample 714(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote} 715$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>" 716(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote} 717$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>" 718@end smallexample 719 720@noindent 721@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes. 722To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source 723surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command. 724 725@smallexample 726(@value{GDBP}) @b{l} 727533 xfree(rquote); 728534 729535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\ 730 : xstrdup (lq); 731536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 732 : xstrdup (rq); 733537 734538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 735539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 736540 @} 737541 738542 void 739@end smallexample 740 741@noindent 742Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and 743@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables. 744 745@smallexample 746(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 747539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 748(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 749540 @} 750(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote} 751$3 = 9 752(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote} 753$4 = 7 754@end smallexample 755 756@noindent 757That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and 758@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and 759@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using 760the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of 761any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and 762assignments. 763 764@smallexample 765(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)} 766$5 = 7 767(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)} 768$6 = 9 769@end smallexample 770 771@noindent 772Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the 773@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue 774executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the 775example that caused trouble initially: 776 777@smallexample 778(@value{GDBP}) @b{c} 779Continuing. 780 781@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 782 783baz 7840000 785@end smallexample 786 787@noindent 788Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The 789problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong 790lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input: 791 792@smallexample 793@b{Ctrl-d} 794Program exited normally. 795@end smallexample 796 797@noindent 798The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it 799indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN} 800session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command. 801 802@smallexample 803(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit} 804@end smallexample 805 806@node Invocation 807@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN} 808 809This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it. 810The essentials are: 811@itemize @bullet 812@item 813type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}. 814@item 815type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit. 816@end itemize 817 818@menu 819* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN} 820* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN} 821* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN} 822* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file 823@end menu 824 825@node Invoking GDB 826@section Invoking @value{GDBN} 827 828Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started, 829@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit. 830 831You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options, 832to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset. 833 834The command-line options described here are designed 835to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these 836options may effectively be unavailable. 837 838The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument, 839specifying an executable program: 840 841@smallexample 842@value{GDBP} @var{program} 843@end smallexample 844 845@noindent 846You can also start with both an executable program and a core file 847specified: 848 849@smallexample 850@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core} 851@end smallexample 852 853You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want 854to debug a running process: 855 856@smallexample 857@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234 858@end smallexample 859 860@noindent 861would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file 862named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first). 863 864Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly 865complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote 866debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of 867``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN} 868will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps. 869 870You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the 871executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops 872option processing. 873@smallexample 874@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c 875@end smallexample 876This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set 877@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}. 878 879You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes 880@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}: 881 882@smallexample 883@value{GDBP} -silent 884@end smallexample 885 886@noindent 887You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line 888options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available. 889 890@noindent 891Type 892 893@smallexample 894@value{GDBP} -help 895@end smallexample 896 897@noindent 898to display all available options and briefly describe their use 899(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent). 900 901All options and command line arguments you give are processed 902in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the 903@samp{-x} option is used. 904 905 906@menu 907* File Options:: Choosing files 908* Mode Options:: Choosing modes 909* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup 910@end menu 911 912@node File Options 913@subsection Choosing Files 914 915When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as 916specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is 917the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and 918@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the 919first argument that does not have an associated option flag as 920equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the 921second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as 922equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.) 923If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will 924first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt 925to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with 926a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by 927prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}. 928 929If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support, 930such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second 931argument and ignore it. 932 933Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the 934following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate 935them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous. 936(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather 937than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.) 938 939@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This 940@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find 941@c it. 942 943@table @code 944@item -symbols @var{file} 945@itemx -s @var{file} 946@cindex @code{--symbols} 947@cindex @code{-s} 948Read symbol table from file @var{file}. 949 950@item -exec @var{file} 951@itemx -e @var{file} 952@cindex @code{--exec} 953@cindex @code{-e} 954Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate, 955and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump. 956 957@item -se @var{file} 958@cindex @code{--se} 959Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable 960file. 961 962@item -core @var{file} 963@itemx -c @var{file} 964@cindex @code{--core} 965@cindex @code{-c} 966Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. 967 968@item -pid @var{number} 969@itemx -p @var{number} 970@cindex @code{--pid} 971@cindex @code{-p} 972Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command. 973 974@item -command @var{file} 975@itemx -x @var{file} 976@cindex @code{--command} 977@cindex @code{-x} 978Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is 979evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would. 980@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 981 982@item -eval-command @var{command} 983@itemx -ex @var{command} 984@cindex @code{--eval-command} 985@cindex @code{-ex} 986Execute a single @value{GDBN} command. 987 988This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may 989also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required. 990 991@smallexample 992@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \ 993 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out 994@end smallexample 995 996@item -directory @var{directory} 997@itemx -d @var{directory} 998@cindex @code{--directory} 999@cindex @code{-d} 1000Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files. 1001 1002@item -r 1003@itemx -readnow 1004@cindex @code{--readnow} 1005@cindex @code{-r} 1006Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than 1007the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed. 1008This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster. 1009 1010@end table 1011 1012@node Mode Options 1013@subsection Choosing Modes 1014 1015You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in 1016batch mode or quiet mode. 1017 1018@table @code 1019@item -nx 1020@itemx -n 1021@cindex @code{--nx} 1022@cindex @code{-n} 1023Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally, 1024@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command 1025options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command 1026Files}. 1027 1028@item -quiet 1029@itemx -silent 1030@itemx -q 1031@cindex @code{--quiet} 1032@cindex @code{--silent} 1033@cindex @code{-q} 1034``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These 1035messages are also suppressed in batch mode. 1036 1037@item -batch 1038@cindex @code{--batch} 1039Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the 1040command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from 1041initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with 1042nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands 1043in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited 1044terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm 1045off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}). 1046 1047Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for 1048example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to 1049make this more useful, the message 1050 1051@smallexample 1052Program exited normally. 1053@end smallexample 1054 1055@noindent 1056(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under 1057@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch 1058mode. 1059 1060@item -batch-silent 1061@cindex @code{--batch-silent} 1062Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All 1063@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is 1064unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless 1065for an interactive session. 1066 1067This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section} 1068messages, for example. 1069 1070Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to 1071writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent. 1072 1073@item -return-child-result 1074@cindex @code{--return-child-result} 1075The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child 1076process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions: 1077 1078@itemize @bullet 1079@item 1080@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an 1081internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been 1082without @samp{-return-child-result}. 1083@item 1084The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}. 1085@item 1086The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case 1087the exit code will be -1. 1088@end itemize 1089 1090This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent}, 1091when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator 1092interface. 1093 1094@item -nowindows 1095@itemx -nw 1096@cindex @code{--nowindows} 1097@cindex @code{-nw} 1098``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface 1099(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line 1100interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect. 1101 1102@item -windows 1103@itemx -w 1104@cindex @code{--windows} 1105@cindex @code{-w} 1106If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be 1107used if possible. 1108 1109@item -cd @var{directory} 1110@cindex @code{--cd} 1111Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory, 1112instead of the current directory. 1113 1114@item -data-directory @var{directory} 1115@cindex @code{--data-directory} 1116Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory. 1117The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its 1118auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}. 1119 1120@item -fullname 1121@itemx -f 1122@cindex @code{--fullname} 1123@cindex @code{-f} 1124@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a 1125subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line 1126number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is 1127displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This 1128recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by 1129the file name, line number and character position separated by colons, 1130and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two 1131@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the 1132frame. 1133 1134@item -epoch 1135@cindex @code{--epoch} 1136The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs 1137@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print 1138routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a 1139separate window. 1140 1141@item -annotate @var{level} 1142@cindex @code{--annotate} 1143This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its 1144effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}} 1145(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much 1146information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of 1147expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the 1148normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of 1149@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs 1150that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated. 1151 1152The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 1153(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 1154 1155@item --args 1156@cindex @code{--args} 1157Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the 1158executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior. 1159This option stops option processing. 1160 1161@item -baud @var{bps} 1162@itemx -b @var{bps} 1163@cindex @code{--baud} 1164@cindex @code{-b} 1165Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial 1166interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging. 1167 1168@item -l @var{timeout} 1169@cindex @code{-l} 1170Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN} 1171for remote debugging. 1172 1173@item -tty @var{device} 1174@itemx -t @var{device} 1175@cindex @code{--tty} 1176@cindex @code{-t} 1177Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. 1178@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate. 1179 1180@c resolve the situation of these eventually 1181@item -tui 1182@cindex @code{--tui} 1183Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User 1184Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing 1185source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs 1186(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the 1187Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program 1188@samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from 1189Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}). 1190 1191@c @item -xdb 1192@c @cindex @code{--xdb} 1193@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands. 1194@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually 1195@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX 1196@c systems. 1197 1198@item -interpreter @var{interp} 1199@cindex @code{--interpreter} 1200Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling 1201program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which 1202communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. 1203@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}. 1204 1205@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes 1206@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , 1207The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The 1208previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and 1209selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier 1210@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported. 1211 1212@item -write 1213@cindex @code{--write} 1214Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This 1215is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN} 1216(@pxref{Patching}). 1217 1218@item -statistics 1219@cindex @code{--statistics} 1220This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and 1221memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt. 1222 1223@item -version 1224@cindex @code{--version} 1225This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and 1226no-warranty blurb, and exit. 1227 1228@end table 1229 1230@node Startup 1231@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup 1232@cindex @value{GDBN} startup 1233 1234Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup: 1235 1236@enumerate 1237@item 1238Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line 1239(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}). 1240 1241@item 1242@cindex init file 1243Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was 1244used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration, 1245 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in 1246that file. 1247 1248@item 1249Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On 1250DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the 1251@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in 1252that file. 1253 1254@item 1255Processes command line options and operands. 1256 1257@item 1258Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current 1259working directory. This is only done if the current directory is 1260different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one 1261init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific 1262to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke 1263@value{GDBN}. 1264 1265@item 1266If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to 1267attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded 1268scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries. 1269@xref{Auto-loading}. 1270 1271If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup, 1272you must do something like the following: 1273 1274@smallexample 1275$ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram" 1276@end smallexample 1277 1278The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late: 1279 1280@smallexample 1281$ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram 1282@end smallexample 1283 1284@item 1285Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command 1286Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files. 1287 1288@item 1289Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}. 1290@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the 1291files where @value{GDBN} records it. 1292@end enumerate 1293 1294Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command 1295Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init 1296file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set 1297complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options 1298and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx} 1299option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}). 1300 1301To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you 1302can use @kbd{gdb --help}. 1303 1304@cindex init file name 1305@cindex @file{.gdbinit} 1306@cindex @file{gdb.ini} 1307The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}. 1308The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to 1309the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows 1310ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a 1311@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename 1312the file to the standard name. 1313 1314 1315@node Quitting GDB 1316@section Quitting @value{GDBN} 1317@cindex exiting @value{GDBN} 1318@cindex leaving @value{GDBN} 1319 1320@table @code 1321@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1322@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})} 1323@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1324@itemx q 1325To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated 1326@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you 1327do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; 1328otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the 1329error code. 1330@end table 1331 1332@cindex interrupt 1333An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather 1334terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and 1335returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt 1336character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect 1337until a time when it is safe. 1338 1339If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or 1340device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command 1341(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 1342 1343@node Shell Commands 1344@section Shell Commands 1345 1346If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your 1347debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can 1348just use the @code{shell} command. 1349 1350@table @code 1351@kindex shell 1352@cindex shell escape 1353@item shell @var{command string} 1354Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}. 1355If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which 1356shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell 1357(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.). 1358@end table 1359 1360The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments. 1361You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in 1362@value{GDBN}: 1363 1364@table @code 1365@kindex make 1366@cindex calling make 1367@item make @var{make-args} 1368Execute the @code{make} program with the specified 1369arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}. 1370@end table 1371 1372@node Logging Output 1373@section Logging Output 1374@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output 1375@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file 1376 1377You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file. 1378There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging. 1379 1380@table @code 1381@kindex set logging 1382@item set logging on 1383Enable logging. 1384@item set logging off 1385Disable logging. 1386@cindex logging file name 1387@item set logging file @var{file} 1388Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}. 1389@item set logging overwrite [on|off] 1390By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if 1391you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead. 1392@item set logging redirect [on|off] 1393By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile. 1394Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file. 1395@kindex show logging 1396@item show logging 1397Show the current values of the logging settings. 1398@end table 1399 1400@node Commands 1401@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands 1402 1403You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command 1404name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain 1405@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB} 1406key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to 1407show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility). 1408 1409@menu 1410* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN} 1411* Completion:: Command completion 1412* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help 1413@end menu 1414 1415@node Command Syntax 1416@section Command Syntax 1417 1418A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on 1419how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by 1420arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the 1421command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to 1422step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command 1423with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments. 1424 1425@cindex abbreviation 1426@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is 1427unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the 1428documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous 1429abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as 1430equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose 1431names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as 1432arguments to the @code{help} command. 1433 1434@cindex repeating commands 1435@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)} 1436A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to 1437repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run}) 1438will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional 1439repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to 1440repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see 1441@ref{Define, dont-repeat}. 1442 1443The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with 1444@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating 1445exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory. 1446 1447@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy 1448output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more} 1449(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one 1450@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command 1451repetition after any command that generates this sort of display. 1452 1453@kindex # @r{(a comment)} 1454@cindex comment 1455Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does 1456nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command 1457Files,,Command Files}). 1458 1459@cindex repeating command sequences 1460@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)} 1461The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of 1462commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and 1463then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history 1464for editing. 1465 1466@node Completion 1467@section Command Completion 1468 1469@cindex completion 1470@cindex word completion 1471@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is 1472only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities 1473are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN} 1474commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program. 1475 1476Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest 1477of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the 1478word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to 1479enter it). For example, if you type 1480 1481@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit 1482@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity. 1483@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to 1484@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following... 1485@smallexample 1486(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB} 1487@end smallexample 1488 1489@noindent 1490@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is 1491the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}: 1492 1493@smallexample 1494(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints 1495@end smallexample 1496 1497@noindent 1498You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info 1499breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if 1500@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you 1501were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you 1502might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre}, 1503to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion). 1504 1505If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press 1506@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more 1507characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time; 1508@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For 1509example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name 1510begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN} 1511just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the 1512function names in your program that begin with those characters, for 1513example: 1514 1515@smallexample 1516(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB} 1517@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see: 1518make_a_section_from_file make_environ 1519make_abs_section make_function_type 1520make_blockvector make_pointer_type 1521make_cleanup make_reference_type 1522make_command make_symbol_completion_list 1523(@value{GDBP}) b make_ 1524@end smallexample 1525 1526@noindent 1527After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your 1528partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the 1529command. 1530 1531If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you 1532can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?} 1533means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a 1534key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is 1535one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}. 1536 1537@cindex quotes in commands 1538@cindex completion of quoted strings 1539Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain 1540parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from 1541its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this 1542situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in 1543@value{GDBN} commands. 1544 1545The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the 1546name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function 1547overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished 1548by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you 1549may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} 1550that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version 1551that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the 1552word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote 1553@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts 1554@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual 1555when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion: 1556 1557@smallexample 1558(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?} 1559bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int) 1560(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1561@end smallexample 1562 1563In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using 1564quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while 1565completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first 1566place: 1567 1568@smallexample 1569(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB} 1570@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell: 1571(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1572@end smallexample 1573 1574@noindent 1575In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if 1576you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for 1577completion on an overloaded symbol. 1578 1579For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus 1580Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set 1581overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution; 1582see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 1583 1584@cindex completion of structure field names 1585@cindex structure field name completion 1586@cindex completion of union field names 1587@cindex union field name completion 1588When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a 1589structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be 1590confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only 1591examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to 1592limit completions to the field names available in the type of the 1593left-hand-side: 1594 1595@smallexample 1596(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?} 1597magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind 1598to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write 1599@end smallexample 1600 1601@noindent 1602This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type 1603@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as 1604follows: 1605 1606@smallexample 1607struct ui_file 1608@{ 1609 int *magic; 1610 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush; 1611 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write; 1612 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs; 1613 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read; 1614 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete; 1615 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty; 1616 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind; 1617 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put; 1618 void *to_data; 1619@} 1620@end smallexample 1621 1622 1623@node Help 1624@section Getting Help 1625@cindex online documentation 1626@kindex help 1627 1628You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands, 1629using the command @code{help}. 1630 1631@table @code 1632@kindex h @r{(@code{help})} 1633@item help 1634@itemx h 1635You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to 1636display a short list of named classes of commands: 1637 1638@smallexample 1639(@value{GDBP}) help 1640List of classes of commands: 1641 1642aliases -- Aliases of other commands 1643breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points 1644data -- Examining data 1645files -- Specifying and examining files 1646internals -- Maintenance commands 1647obscure -- Obscure features 1648running -- Running the program 1649stack -- Examining the stack 1650status -- Status inquiries 1651support -- Support facilities 1652tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without 1653 stopping the program 1654user-defined -- User-defined commands 1655 1656Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of 1657commands in that class. 1658Type "help" followed by command name for full 1659documentation. 1660Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1661(@value{GDBP}) 1662@end smallexample 1663@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull... 1664 1665@item help @var{class} 1666Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a 1667list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the 1668help display for the class @code{status}: 1669 1670@smallexample 1671(@value{GDBP}) help status 1672Status inquiries. 1673 1674List of commands: 1675 1676@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed 1677@c to fit in smallbook page size. 1678info -- Generic command for showing things 1679 about the program being debugged 1680show -- Generic command for showing things 1681 about the debugger 1682 1683Type "help" followed by command name for full 1684documentation. 1685Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1686(@value{GDBP}) 1687@end smallexample 1688 1689@item help @var{command} 1690With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a 1691short paragraph on how to use that command. 1692 1693@kindex apropos 1694@item apropos @var{args} 1695The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN} 1696commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in 1697@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example: 1698 1699@smallexample 1700apropos reload 1701@end smallexample 1702 1703@noindent 1704results in: 1705 1706@smallexample 1707@c @group 1708set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading 1709 multiple times in one run 1710show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading 1711 multiple times in one run 1712@c @end group 1713@end smallexample 1714 1715@kindex complete 1716@item complete @var{args} 1717The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions 1718for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the 1719command you want completed. For example: 1720 1721@smallexample 1722complete i 1723@end smallexample 1724 1725@noindent results in: 1726 1727@smallexample 1728@group 1729if 1730ignore 1731info 1732inspect 1733@end group 1734@end smallexample 1735 1736@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs. 1737@end table 1738 1739In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info} 1740and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state 1741of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this 1742manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings 1743under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to 1744all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}. 1745 1746@c @group 1747@table @code 1748@kindex info 1749@kindex i @r{(@code{info})} 1750@item info 1751This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your 1752program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function 1753with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info 1754registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}. 1755You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with 1756@w{@code{help info}}. 1757 1758@kindex set 1759@item set 1760You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with 1761@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with 1762@code{set prompt $}. 1763 1764@kindex show 1765@item show 1766In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of 1767@value{GDBN} itself. 1768You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the 1769related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number 1770system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire 1771which is currently in use with @code{show radix}. 1772 1773@kindex info set 1774To display all the settable parameters and their current 1775values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use 1776@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display. 1777@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of 1778@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else, 1779@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"? 1780@end table 1781@c @end group 1782 1783Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are 1784exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands: 1785 1786@table @code 1787@kindex show version 1788@cindex @value{GDBN} version number 1789@item show version 1790Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this 1791information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of 1792@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which 1793version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new 1794commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many 1795system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are 1796variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well. 1797The version number is the same as the one announced when you start 1798@value{GDBN}. 1799 1800@kindex show copying 1801@kindex info copying 1802@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright 1803@item show copying 1804@itemx info copying 1805Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}. 1806 1807@kindex show warranty 1808@kindex info warranty 1809@item show warranty 1810@itemx info warranty 1811Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty, 1812if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one. 1813 1814@end table 1815 1816@node Running 1817@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN} 1818 1819When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate 1820debugging information when you compile it. 1821 1822You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment 1823of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect 1824your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or 1825kill a child process. 1826 1827@menu 1828* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging 1829* Starting:: Starting your program 1830* Arguments:: Your program's arguments 1831* Environment:: Your program's environment 1832 1833* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory 1834* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output 1835* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process 1836* Kill Process:: Killing the child process 1837 1838* Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs 1839* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads 1840* Forks:: Debugging forks 1841* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later 1842@end menu 1843 1844@node Compilation 1845@section Compiling for Debugging 1846 1847In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate 1848debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information 1849is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each 1850variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers 1851and addresses in the executable code. 1852 1853To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run 1854the compiler. 1855 1856Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with 1857optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some 1858compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options 1859together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized 1860executables containing debugging information. 1861 1862@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or 1863without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We 1864recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a 1865program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense 1866in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}. 1867 1868Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option 1869@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this 1870format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it. 1871 1872@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their 1873expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information 1874about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify 1875the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large. 1876Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, 1877provides macro information if you specify the options 1878@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests 1879debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests 1880``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact 1881ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with 1882@option{-g} alone. 1883 1884@need 2000 1885@node Starting 1886@section Starting your Program 1887@cindex starting 1888@cindex running 1889 1890@table @code 1891@kindex run 1892@kindex r @r{(@code{run})} 1893@item run 1894@itemx r 1895Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}. 1896You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an 1897argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of 1898@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command 1899(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 1900 1901@end table 1902 1903If you are running your program in an execution environment that 1904supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes 1905that process run your program. In some environments without processes, 1906@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets, 1907like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error 1908message like this one: 1909 1910@smallexample 1911The "remote" target does not support "run". 1912Try "help target" or "continue". 1913@end smallexample 1914 1915@noindent 1916then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load} 1917first (@pxref{load}). 1918 1919The execution of a program is affected by certain information it 1920receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this 1921information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You 1922can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect 1923your program the next time you start it.) This information may be 1924divided into four categories: 1925 1926@table @asis 1927@item The @emph{arguments.} 1928Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the 1929@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell 1930is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions 1931(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing 1932the arguments. 1933In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the 1934@code{SHELL} environment variable. 1935@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}. 1936 1937@item The @emph{environment.} 1938Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can 1939use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset 1940environment} to change parts of the environment that affect 1941your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}. 1942 1943@item The @emph{working directory.} 1944Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set 1945the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}. 1946@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}. 1947 1948@item The @emph{standard input and output.} 1949Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and 1950standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output 1951in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to 1952set a different device for your program. 1953@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}. 1954 1955@cindex pipes 1956@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use 1957pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another 1958program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the 1959wrong program. 1960@end table 1961 1962When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute 1963immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion 1964of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has 1965stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print} 1966or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}. 1967 1968If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last 1969time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol 1970table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain 1971your current breakpoints. 1972 1973@table @code 1974@kindex start 1975@item start 1976@cindex run to main procedure 1977The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language. 1978With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but 1979other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their 1980main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the 1981execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main 1982procedure, depending on the language used. 1983 1984The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary 1985breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking 1986the @samp{run} command. 1987 1988@cindex elaboration phase 1989Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is 1990executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the 1991languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance, 1992constructors for static and global objects are executed before 1993@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops 1994before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint 1995will remain to halt execution. 1996 1997Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the 1998@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the 1999underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be 2000reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to 2001@samp{start} or @samp{run}. 2002 2003It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In 2004these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of 2005your program too late, as the program would have already completed the 2006elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your 2007elaboration code before running your program. 2008 2009@kindex set exec-wrapper 2010@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper} 2011@itemx show exec-wrapper 2012@itemx unset exec-wrapper 2013When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to 2014launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program 2015with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper} 2016@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its 2017arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if 2018appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes 2019your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control. 2020 2021You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 2022its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 2023this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 2024with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 2025 2026For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 2027the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's 2028environment: 2029 2030@smallexample 2031(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so' 2032(@value{GDBP}) run 2033@end smallexample 2034 2035This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding 2036@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino. 2037 2038@kindex set disable-randomization 2039@item set disable-randomization 2040@itemx set disable-randomization on 2041This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native 2042randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option 2043is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better 2044reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions. 2045 2046This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same 2047behavior using 2048 2049@smallexample 2050(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R 2051@end smallexample 2052 2053@item set disable-randomization off 2054Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their 2055ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug 2056disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because 2057@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such 2058as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set 2059disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs. 2060 2061The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. 2062It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these 2063cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable 2064code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing 2065a code at its expected addresses. 2066 2067Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it 2068makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by 2069having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared 2070library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code 2071misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new 2072random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the 2073startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at 2074a randomly chosen address. 2075 2076Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code 2077similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at 2078a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even 2079already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such 2080executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}. 2081 2082Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly 2083(as long as the randomization is enabled). 2084 2085@item show disable-randomization 2086Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of 2087the virtual address space of the started program. 2088 2089@end table 2090 2091@node Arguments 2092@section Your Program's Arguments 2093 2094@cindex arguments (to your program) 2095The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the 2096@code{run} command. 2097They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and 2098performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your 2099@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell 2100@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses 2101the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix). 2102 2103On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by 2104@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system 2105calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of 2106the program, not by the shell. 2107 2108@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous 2109@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command. 2110 2111@table @code 2112@kindex set args 2113@item set args 2114Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If 2115@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program 2116with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments, 2117using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run 2118it again without arguments. 2119 2120@kindex show args 2121@item show args 2122Show the arguments to give your program when it is started. 2123@end table 2124 2125@node Environment 2126@section Your Program's Environment 2127 2128@cindex environment (of your program) 2129The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and 2130their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as 2131your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search 2132path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with 2133the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When 2134debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified 2135environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again. 2136 2137@table @code 2138@kindex path 2139@item path @var{directory} 2140Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable 2141(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program. 2142The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change. 2143You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a 2144system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on 2145MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it 2146is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner. 2147 2148You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current 2149working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you 2150use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the 2151@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the 2152@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding 2153@var{directory} to the search path. 2154@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to 2155@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op. 2156 2157@kindex show paths 2158@item show paths 2159Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH} 2160environment variable). 2161 2162@kindex show environment 2163@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]} 2164Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to 2165your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname}, 2166print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to 2167your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}. 2168 2169@kindex set environment 2170@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]} 2171Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value 2172changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may 2173be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and 2174any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value} 2175parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a 2176null value. 2177@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing 2178@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care? 2179 2180For example, this command: 2181 2182@smallexample 2183set env USER = foo 2184@end smallexample 2185 2186@noindent 2187tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named 2188@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they 2189are not actually required.) 2190 2191@kindex unset environment 2192@item unset environment @var{varname} 2193Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your 2194program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =}; 2195@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment, 2196rather than assigning it an empty value. 2197@end table 2198 2199@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using 2200the shell indicated 2201by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or 2202@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell 2203that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or 2204@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect 2205your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to 2206files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or 2207@file{.profile}. 2208 2209@node Working Directory 2210@section Your Program's Working Directory 2211 2212@cindex working directory (of your program) 2213Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its 2214working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}. 2215The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited 2216from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new 2217working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command. 2218 2219The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands 2220that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2221Specify Files}. 2222 2223@table @code 2224@kindex cd 2225@cindex change working directory 2226@item cd @var{directory} 2227Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. 2228 2229@kindex pwd 2230@item pwd 2231Print the @value{GDBN} working directory. 2232@end table 2233 2234It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of 2235the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory 2236during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is 2237configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info 2238proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the 2239current working directory of the debuggee. 2240 2241@node Input/Output 2242@section Your Program's Input and Output 2243 2244@cindex redirection 2245@cindex i/o 2246@cindex terminal 2247By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to 2248the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal 2249to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal 2250modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue 2251running your program. 2252 2253@table @code 2254@kindex info terminal 2255@item info terminal 2256Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your 2257program is using. 2258@end table 2259 2260You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell 2261redirection with the @code{run} command. For example, 2262 2263@smallexample 2264run > outfile 2265@end smallexample 2266 2267@noindent 2268starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}. 2269 2270@kindex tty 2271@cindex controlling terminal 2272Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is 2273with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as 2274argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run} 2275commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child 2276process, for future @code{run} commands. For example, 2277 2278@smallexample 2279tty /dev/ttyb 2280@end smallexample 2281 2282@noindent 2283directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands 2284default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have 2285that as their controlling terminal. 2286 2287An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's 2288effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling 2289terminal. 2290 2291When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run} 2292command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input 2293for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias 2294for @code{set inferior-tty}. 2295 2296@cindex inferior tty 2297@cindex set inferior controlling terminal 2298You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to 2299display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your 2300program. 2301 2302@table @code 2303@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb 2304@kindex set inferior-tty 2305Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb. 2306 2307@item show inferior-tty 2308@kindex show inferior-tty 2309Show the current tty for the program being debugged. 2310@end table 2311 2312@node Attach 2313@section Debugging an Already-running Process 2314@kindex attach 2315@cindex attach 2316 2317@table @code 2318@item attach @var{process-id} 2319This command attaches to a running process---one that was started 2320outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active 2321targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to 2322find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility, 2323or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command. 2324 2325@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after 2326executing the command. 2327@end table 2328 2329To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment 2330which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for 2331programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must 2332also have permission to send the process a signal. 2333 2334When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in 2335the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if 2336the program is not found) by using the source file search path 2337(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use 2338the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2339Specify Files}. 2340 2341The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified 2342process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process 2343with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when 2344you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you 2345can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the 2346process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after 2347attaching @value{GDBN} to the process. 2348 2349@table @code 2350@kindex detach 2351@item detach 2352When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the 2353@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching 2354the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command, 2355that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you 2356are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}. 2357@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 2358executing the command. 2359@end table 2360 2361If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach 2362that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process. 2363By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these 2364things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the 2365@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 2366Messages}). 2367 2368@node Kill Process 2369@section Killing the Child Process 2370 2371@table @code 2372@kindex kill 2373@item kill 2374Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}. 2375@end table 2376 2377This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a 2378running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program 2379is running. 2380 2381On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN} 2382while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the 2383@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program 2384outside the debugger. 2385 2386The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and 2387relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an 2388executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you 2389next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and 2390reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current 2391breakpoint settings). 2392 2393@node Inferiors and Programs 2394@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs 2395 2396@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single 2397session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run 2398several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one 2399before starting another). In the most general case, you can have 2400multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched 2401from multiple executables. 2402 2403@cindex inferior 2404@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an 2405object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to 2406a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not 2407have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and 2408may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique 2409identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each 2410inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some 2411embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts 2412of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple 2413threads running in it. 2414 2415To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info 2416inferiors}}: 2417 2418@table @code 2419@kindex info inferiors 2420@item info inferiors 2421Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}. 2422 2423@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order): 2424 2425@enumerate 2426@item 2427the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2428 2429@item 2430the target system's inferior identifier 2431 2432@item 2433the name of the executable the inferior is running. 2434 2435@end enumerate 2436 2437@noindent 2438An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number 2439indicates the current inferior. 2440 2441For example, 2442@end table 2443@c end table here to get a little more width for example 2444 2445@smallexample 2446(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2447 Num Description Executable 2448 2 process 2307 hello 2449* 1 process 3401 goodbye 2450@end smallexample 2451 2452To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command: 2453 2454@table @code 2455@kindex inferior @var{infno} 2456@item inferior @var{infno} 2457Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument 2458@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown 2459in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display. 2460@end table 2461 2462 2463You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the 2464@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some 2465systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session 2466automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To 2467remove inferiors from the debugging session use the 2468@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command. 2469 2470@table @code 2471@kindex add-inferior 2472@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ] 2473Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the 2474executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified, 2475the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or 2476change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the 2477@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument. 2478 2479@kindex clone-inferior 2480@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ] 2481Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior 2482@var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the 2483number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you 2484want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging. 2485 2486@smallexample 2487(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2488 Num Description Executable 2489* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2490(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior 2491Added inferior 2. 24921 inferiors added. 2493(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2494 Num Description Executable 2495 2 <null> helloworld 2496* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2497@end smallexample 2498 2499You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it. 2500 2501@kindex remove-inferiors 2502@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2503Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not 2504possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For 2505those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first. 2506 2507@end table 2508 2509To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current 2510inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach 2511inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it 2512using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command: 2513 2514@table @code 2515@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2516@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{} 2517Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} 2518inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry 2519still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, 2520but its Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2521 2522@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2523@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2524Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior 2525number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still 2526stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its 2527Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2528@end table 2529 2530After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach}, 2531@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after 2532a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with 2533@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted. 2534 2535 2536To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s 2537control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}: 2538 2539@table @code 2540@kindex set print inferior-events 2541@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit 2542@item set print inferior-events 2543@itemx set print inferior-events on 2544@itemx set print inferior-events off 2545The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or 2546disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new 2547inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been 2548detached. By default, these messages will not be printed. 2549 2550@kindex show print inferior-events 2551@item show print inferior-events 2552Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that 2553inferiors have started, exited or have been detached. 2554@end table 2555 2556Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a 2557single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the 2558value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior. 2559 2560 2561Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to 2562get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address 2563spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint 2564info program-spaces}} command. 2565 2566@table @code 2567@kindex maint info program-spaces 2568@item maint info program-spaces 2569Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by 2570@value{GDBN}. 2571 2572@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order): 2573 2574@enumerate 2575@item 2576the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2577 2578@item 2579the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g., 2580the @code{file} command. 2581 2582@end enumerate 2583 2584@noindent 2585An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number 2586indicates the current program space. 2587 2588In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra 2589information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For 2590example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space. 2591 2592@smallexample 2593(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2594 Id Executable 2595 2 goodbye 2596 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561) 2597* 1 hello 2598@end smallexample 2599 2600Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello}, 2601while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On 2602some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the 2603same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both 2604the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example, 2605 2606@smallexample 2607(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2608 Id Executable 2609* 1 vfork-test 2610 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045) 2611@end smallexample 2612 2613Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program 2614space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call. 2615@end table 2616 2617@node Threads 2618@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads 2619 2620@cindex threads of execution 2621@cindex multiple threads 2622@cindex switching threads 2623In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program 2624may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics 2625of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general 2626the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except 2627that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and 2628modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own 2629registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory. 2630 2631@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread 2632programs: 2633 2634@itemize @bullet 2635@item automatic notification of new threads 2636@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads 2637@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads 2638@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}}, 2639a command to apply a command to a list of threads 2640@item thread-specific breakpoints 2641@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of 2642messages on thread start and exit. 2643@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets 2644the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice 2645isn't compatible with the program. 2646@end itemize 2647 2648@quotation 2649@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every 2650@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads. 2651If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no 2652effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output 2653from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command, 2654like this: 2655 2656@smallexample 2657(@value{GDBP}) info threads 2658(@value{GDBP}) thread 1 2659Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to 2660see the IDs of currently known threads. 2661@end smallexample 2662@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB 2663@c doesn't support threads"? 2664@end quotation 2665 2666@cindex focus of debugging 2667@cindex current thread 2668The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all 2669threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes 2670control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging. 2671This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show 2672program information from the perspective of the current thread. 2673 2674@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message 2675@cindex thread identifier (system) 2676@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message 2677@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that 2678@c thread without first checking `info threads'. 2679Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays 2680the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the 2681form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier 2682whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on 2683@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see 2684 2685@smallexample 2686[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)] 2687@end smallexample 2688 2689@noindent 2690when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system, 2691the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no 2692further qualifier. 2693 2694@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first 2695@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the 2696@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread 2697@c program? 2698@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some 2699@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple 2700@c threads ab initio? 2701 2702@cindex thread number 2703@cindex thread identifier (GDB) 2704For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread 2705number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program. 2706 2707@table @code 2708@kindex info threads 2709@item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]} 2710Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional 2711argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and 2712means to print information only about the specified thread or threads. 2713@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order): 2714 2715@enumerate 2716@item 2717the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2718 2719@item 2720the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag}) 2721 2722@item 2723the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by 2724the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the 2725program itself. 2726 2727@item 2728the current stack frame summary for that thread 2729@end enumerate 2730 2731@noindent 2732An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number 2733indicates the current thread. 2734 2735For example, 2736@end table 2737@c end table here to get a little more width for example 2738 2739@smallexample 2740(@value{GDBP}) info threads 2741 Id Target Id Frame 2742 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause () 2743 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause () 2744* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 2745 at threadtest.c:68 2746@end smallexample 2747 2748On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a 2749Solaris-specific command: 2750 2751@table @code 2752@item maint info sol-threads 2753@kindex maint info sol-threads 2754@cindex thread info (Solaris) 2755Display info on Solaris user threads. 2756@end table 2757 2758@table @code 2759@kindex thread @var{threadno} 2760@item thread @var{threadno} 2761Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command 2762argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as 2763shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display. 2764@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread 2765you selected, and its current stack frame summary: 2766 2767@smallexample 2768(@value{GDBP}) thread 2 2769[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))] 2770#0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8 27718 printf ("hello\n"); 2772@end smallexample 2773 2774@noindent 2775As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after 2776@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying 2777threads. 2778 2779@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable} 2780The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number 2781of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint 2782conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See 2783@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general 2784information on convenience variables. 2785 2786@kindex thread apply 2787@cindex apply command to several threads 2788@item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command} 2789The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named 2790@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the 2791threads that you want affected with the command argument 2792@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers 2793shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it 2794could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a 2795command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}. 2796 2797@kindex thread name 2798@cindex name a thread 2799@item thread name [@var{name}] 2800This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is 2801given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name 2802appears in the @samp{info threads} display. 2803 2804On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to 2805determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these 2806systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the 2807system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause 2808@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name. 2809 2810@kindex thread find 2811@cindex search for a thread 2812@item thread find [@var{regexp}] 2813Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag} 2814matches the supplied regular expression. 2815 2816As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command, 2817this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target 2818@var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag} 2819is the LWP id. 2820 2821@smallexample 2822(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688 2823Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)' 2824(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4 2825 Id Target Id Frame 2826 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select () 2827@end smallexample 2828 2829@kindex set print thread-events 2830@cindex print messages on thread start and exit 2831@item set print thread-events 2832@itemx set print thread-events on 2833@itemx set print thread-events off 2834The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or 2835disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have 2836started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will 2837be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target. 2838Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets. 2839 2840@kindex show print thread-events 2841@item show print thread-events 2842Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads 2843have started and exited. 2844@end table 2845 2846@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for 2847more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start 2848programs with multiple threads. 2849 2850@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about 2851watchpoints in programs with multiple threads. 2852 2853@table @code 2854@kindex set libthread-db-search-path 2855@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db} 2856@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]} 2857If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 2858directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}. 2859If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to 2860an empty list. 2861 2862On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper'' 2863@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the 2864inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 2865to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue 2866with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory 2867from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process. 2868 2869For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories, 2870@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process. 2871If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version 2872mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN} 2873will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory. 2874If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully, 2875@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled. 2876 2877Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented 2878only on some platforms. 2879 2880@kindex show libthread-db-search-path 2881@item show libthread-db-search-path 2882Display current libthread_db search path. 2883 2884@kindex set debug libthread-db 2885@kindex show debug libthread-db 2886@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db} 2887@item set debug libthread-db 2888@itemx show debug libthread-db 2889Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events. 2890Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable. 2891@end table 2892 2893@node Forks 2894@section Debugging Forks 2895 2896@cindex fork, debugging programs which call 2897@cindex multiple processes 2898@cindex processes, multiple 2899On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging 2900programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork} 2901function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the 2902parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have 2903set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child 2904will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal) 2905will cause it to terminate. 2906 2907However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround 2908which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which 2909the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep 2910only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists, 2911so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN} 2912on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to 2913get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of 2914@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to 2915the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug 2916the child process just like any other process which you attached to. 2917 2918On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that 2919create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions. 2920Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later 2921only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later). 2922 2923By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug 2924the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. 2925 2926If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process, 2927use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}. 2928 2929@table @code 2930@kindex set follow-fork-mode 2931@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode} 2932Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or 2933@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new 2934process. The @var{mode} argument can be: 2935 2936@table @code 2937@item parent 2938The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs 2939unimpeded. This is the default. 2940 2941@item child 2942The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs 2943unimpeded. 2944 2945@end table 2946 2947@kindex show follow-fork-mode 2948@item show follow-fork-mode 2949Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call. 2950@end table 2951 2952@cindex debugging multiple processes 2953On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the 2954command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}. 2955 2956@table @code 2957@kindex set detach-on-fork 2958@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode} 2959Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or 2960retain debugger control over them both. 2961 2962@table @code 2963@item on 2964The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of 2965@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run 2966independently. This is the default. 2967 2968@item off 2969Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}. 2970One process (child or parent, depending on the value of 2971@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other 2972is held suspended. 2973 2974@end table 2975 2976@kindex show detach-on-fork 2977@item show detach-on-fork 2978Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off. 2979@end table 2980 2981If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN} 2982will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks). 2983You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by 2984using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork 2985to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and 2986Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}). 2987 2988To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach 2989from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it 2990to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} 2991command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors 2992and Programs}. 2993 2994If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an 2995@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first 2996breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on 2997@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on 2998the child process's @code{main}. 2999 3000On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you 3001cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes. 3002 3003If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec} 3004call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent 3005process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name 3006as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes, 3007@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image. 3008You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}} 3009command. 3010 3011@table @code 3012@kindex set follow-exec-mode 3013@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode} 3014 3015Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An 3016@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process. 3017 3018@code{follow-exec-mode} can be: 3019 3020@table @code 3021@item new 3022@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this 3023new inferior. The program the process was running before the 3024@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the 3025original inferior. 3026 3027For example: 3028 3029@smallexample 3030(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3031(gdb) info inferior 3032 Id Description Executable 3033* 1 <null> prog1 3034(@value{GDBP}) run 3035process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3036Program exited normally. 3037(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3038 Id Description Executable 3039* 2 <null> prog2 3040 1 <null> prog1 3041@end smallexample 3042 3043@item same 3044@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new 3045executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the 3046inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with 3047e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was 3048running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode. 3049 3050For example: 3051 3052@smallexample 3053(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3054 Id Description Executable 3055* 1 <null> prog1 3056(@value{GDBP}) run 3057process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3058Program exited normally. 3059(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3060 Id Description Executable 3061* 1 <null> prog2 3062@end smallexample 3063 3064@end table 3065@end table 3066 3067You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever 3068a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set 3069Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}. 3070 3071@node Checkpoint/Restart 3072@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later 3073 3074@cindex checkpoint 3075@cindex restart 3076@cindex bookmark 3077@cindex snapshot of a process 3078@cindex rewind program state 3079 3080On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only 3081@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a 3082program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it 3083later. 3084 3085Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has 3086happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This 3087includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits) 3088system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the 3089moment when the checkpoint was saved. 3090 3091Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're 3092getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save 3093a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss 3094the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program 3095from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and 3096start again from there. 3097 3098This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or 3099steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs. 3100 3101To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging: 3102 3103@table @code 3104@kindex checkpoint 3105@item checkpoint 3106Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state. 3107The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint 3108is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id. 3109 3110@kindex info checkpoints 3111@item info checkpoints 3112List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging 3113session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be 3114listed: 3115 3116@table @code 3117@item Checkpoint ID 3118@item Process ID 3119@item Code Address 3120@item Source line, or label 3121@end table 3122 3123@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3124@item restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3125Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number 3126@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames 3127etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint 3128was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point 3129in time when the checkpoint was saved. 3130 3131Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc. 3132are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint 3133only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in 3134the debugger. 3135 3136@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3137@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3138Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}. 3139 3140@end table 3141 3142Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state 3143of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system 3144(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from 3145a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location, 3146so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files 3147opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the 3148previously read data can be read again. 3149 3150Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other 3151external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received 3152from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers, 3153but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to 3154be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have 3155been changed cannot be restored (at this time). 3156 3157However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your 3158program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it 3159again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a 3160different execution path this time. 3161 3162@cindex checkpoints and process id 3163Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be 3164different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process 3165id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}), 3166and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}. 3167If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could 3168potentially pose a problem. 3169 3170@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints 3171 3172On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization 3173is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it 3174difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an 3175absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the 3176absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the 3177next. 3178 3179A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process. 3180Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main, 3181and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the 3182process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and 3183your symbols will all stay in the same place. 3184 3185@node Stopping 3186@chapter Stopping and Continuing 3187 3188The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your 3189program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into 3190trouble, you can investigate and find out why. 3191 3192Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons, 3193such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a 3194@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and 3195change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then 3196continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide 3197ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also 3198explicitly request this information at any time. 3199 3200@table @code 3201@kindex info program 3202@item info program 3203Display information about the status of your program: whether it is 3204running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped. 3205@end table 3206 3207@menu 3208* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints 3209* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution 3210* Signals:: Signals 3211* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs 3212@end menu 3213 3214@node Breakpoints 3215@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints 3216 3217@cindex breakpoints 3218A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in 3219the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to 3220control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set 3221breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set 3222Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program 3223should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the 3224program. 3225 3226On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before 3227the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: 3228you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints 3229in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program 3230(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create} 3231call). 3232 3233@cindex watchpoints 3234@cindex data breakpoints 3235@cindex memory tracing 3236@cindex breakpoint on memory address 3237@cindex breakpoint on variable modification 3238A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program 3239when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value 3240of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables 3241combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called 3242@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set 3243watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside 3244from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you 3245enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the 3246same commands. 3247 3248You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically 3249whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,, 3250Automatic Display}. 3251 3252@cindex catchpoints 3253@cindex breakpoint on events 3254A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program 3255when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++} 3256exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a 3257different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting 3258Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any 3259other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the 3260@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.) 3261 3262@cindex breakpoint numbers 3263@cindex numbers for breakpoints 3264@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or 3265catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers 3266starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various 3267features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which 3268breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or 3269@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you 3270enable it again. 3271 3272@cindex breakpoint ranges 3273@cindex ranges of breakpoints 3274Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to 3275operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like 3276@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a 3277hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command, 3278all breakpoints in that range are operated on. 3279 3280@menu 3281* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints 3282* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints 3283* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints 3284* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints 3285* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints 3286* Conditions:: Break conditions 3287* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists 3288* Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file 3289* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 3290* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 3291@end menu 3292 3293@node Set Breaks 3294@subsection Setting Breakpoints 3295 3296@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt? 3297@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization. 3298@c 3299@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init? 3300 3301@kindex break 3302@kindex b @r{(@code{break})} 3303@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable} 3304@cindex latest breakpoint 3305Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated 3306@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the 3307number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience 3308Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with 3309convenience variables. 3310 3311@table @code 3312@item break @var{location} 3313Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a 3314function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction. 3315(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to 3316specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just 3317before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}. 3318 3319When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as 3320C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break. 3321@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of 3322that situation. 3323 3324It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program 3325only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints}) 3326or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint. 3327 3328@item break 3329When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at 3330the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame 3331(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the 3332innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control 3333returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a 3334@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except 3335that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use 3336@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops 3337the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful 3338inside loops. 3339 3340@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at 3341least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you 3342would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the 3343breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already 3344existed when your program stopped. 3345 3346@item break @dots{} if @var{cond} 3347Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 3348@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the 3349value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 3350@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described 3351above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions, 3352,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions. 3353 3354@kindex tbreak 3355@item tbreak @var{args} 3356Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the 3357same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same 3358way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your 3359program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3360 3361@kindex hbreak 3362@cindex hardware breakpoints 3363@item hbreak @var{args} 3364Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the 3365@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the 3366breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not 3367have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code 3368debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without 3369changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation 3370provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets 3371will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction 3372address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware 3373breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For 3374example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and 3375@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete 3376or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones 3377(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}). 3378@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3379For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 3380breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 3381hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 3382 3383@kindex thbreak 3384@item thbreak @var{args} 3385Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} 3386are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in 3387the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command, 3388the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the 3389first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak} 3390command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware 3391may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3392See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3393 3394@kindex rbreak 3395@cindex regular expression 3396@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp 3397@cindex set breakpoints in many functions 3398@item rbreak @var{regex} 3399Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression 3400@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all 3401matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these 3402breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with 3403the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make 3404them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint. 3405 3406The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools 3407like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by 3408shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include 3409an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit 3410@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to 3411match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}. 3412 3413@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in 3414When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting 3415breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 3416classes. 3417 3418@cindex set breakpoints on all functions 3419The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in 3420@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this: 3421 3422@smallexample 3423(@value{GDBP}) rbreak . 3424@end smallexample 3425 3426@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex} 3427If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits 3428the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the 3429specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on 3430every function in a given file: 3431 3432@smallexample 3433(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:. 3434@end smallexample 3435 3436The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may 3437optionally be surrounded by spaces. 3438 3439@kindex info breakpoints 3440@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints} 3441@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3442@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3443Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and 3444not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only 3445about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)). 3446For each breakpoint, following columns are printed: 3447 3448@table @emph 3449@item Breakpoint Numbers 3450@item Type 3451Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint. 3452@item Disposition 3453Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit. 3454@item Enabled or Disabled 3455Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints 3456that are not enabled. 3457@item Address 3458Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a 3459pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will 3460contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared 3461library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded. 3462See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will 3463have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details. 3464@item What 3465Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and 3466line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to 3467the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until 3468the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future. 3469@end table 3470 3471@noindent 3472If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on 3473the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any, 3474are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition 3475specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared 3476library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a 3477valid location. 3478 3479@noindent 3480@code{info break} with a breakpoint 3481number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The 3482convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for 3483the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint 3484listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). 3485 3486@noindent 3487@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint 3488has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the 3489@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint 3490hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint 3491was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This 3492will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint. 3493@end table 3494 3495@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in 3496your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When 3497the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful 3498(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 3499 3500@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints 3501@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations 3502It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations 3503in your program. Examples of this situation are: 3504 3505@itemize @bullet 3506@item 3507For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several 3508instances of the function body, used in different cases. 3509 3510@item 3511For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can 3512correspond to any number of instantiations. 3513 3514@item 3515For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to 3516several places where that function is inlined. 3517@end itemize 3518 3519In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all 3520the relevant locations@footnote{ 3521As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's 3522line number information for all the locations. This means that they 3523will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug 3524info with line numbers for them.}. 3525 3526A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint 3527table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for 3528each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the 3529address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual 3530addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those 3531locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form 3532@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}. 3533 3534For example: 3535 3536@smallexample 3537Num Type Disp Enb Address What 35381 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE> 3539 stop only if i==1 3540 breakpoint already hit 1 time 35411.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8 35421.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8 3543@end smallexample 3544 3545Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing 3546@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the 3547@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot 3548delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the 3549entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with 3550the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of 3551the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling 3552the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations 3553that belong to that breakpoint. 3554 3555@cindex pending breakpoints 3556It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library. 3557Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly, 3558and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support 3559this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever 3560any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would 3561set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your 3562debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the 3563symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set 3564breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set 3565a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address 3566is not yet resolved. 3567 3568After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded, 3569@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded 3570shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some 3571pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an 3572ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints 3573that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again. 3574 3575This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For 3576example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and 3577a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template, 3578a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint. 3579 3580Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not 3581differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands, 3582enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations. 3583 3584@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what 3585happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint 3586address specification to an address: 3587 3588@kindex set breakpoint pending 3589@kindex show breakpoint pending 3590@table @code 3591@item set breakpoint pending auto 3592This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint 3593location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created. 3594 3595@item set breakpoint pending on 3596This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically 3597result in a pending breakpoint being created. 3598 3599@item set breakpoint pending off 3600This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any 3601unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does 3602not affect any pending breakpoints previously created. 3603 3604@item show breakpoint pending 3605Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints. 3606@end table 3607 3608The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its 3609variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated 3610as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded. 3611 3612@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints 3613For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or 3614software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the 3615breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to 3616breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal 3617breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For 3618breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware 3619breakpoints. 3620 3621You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:: 3622 3623@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw 3624@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw 3625@table @code 3626@item set breakpoint auto-hw on 3627This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it 3628will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware 3629breakpoint must be used. 3630 3631@item set breakpoint auto-hw off 3632This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint 3633type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when 3634trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address. 3635@end table 3636 3637@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code 3638at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when 3639executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program 3640code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as 3641the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This 3642behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the 3643target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote 3644targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance. 3645This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:: 3646 3647@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted 3648@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted 3649@table @code 3650@item set breakpoint always-inserted off 3651All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in 3652the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are 3653removed from the target when it stops. 3654 3655@item set breakpoint always-inserted on 3656Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If 3657the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the 3658breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is 3659removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed. 3660 3661@cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted} 3662@item set breakpoint always-inserted auto 3663This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior 3664in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if 3665@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is 3666controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if 3667@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off. 3668@end table 3669 3670@cindex negative breakpoint numbers 3671@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints 3672@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for 3673special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C 3674programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, 3675starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them. 3676You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command 3677@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}). 3678 3679 3680@node Set Watchpoints 3681@subsection Setting Watchpoints 3682 3683@cindex setting watchpoints 3684You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an 3685expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where 3686this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.) 3687The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or 3688as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include: 3689 3690@itemize @bullet 3691@item 3692A reference to the value of a single variable. 3693 3694@item 3695An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example, 3696@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified 3697address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes). 3698 3699@item 3700An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The 3701expression can use any operators valid in the program's native 3702language (@pxref{Languages}). 3703@end itemize 3704 3705You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can 3706not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on 3707@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized. 3708@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and 3709the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes 3710valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory 3711pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a 3712@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time 3713the expression changes. 3714 3715@cindex software watchpoints 3716@cindex hardware watchpoints 3717Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or 3718hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your 3719program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of 3720times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to 3721catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the 3722culprit.) 3723 3724On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other 3725x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware 3726watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program. 3727 3728@table @code 3729@kindex watch 3730@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} 3731Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the 3732expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value 3733changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is 3734to watch the value of a single variable: 3735 3736@smallexample 3737(@value{GDBP}) watch foo 3738@end smallexample 3739 3740If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}} 3741clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by 3742@var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads 3743change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note 3744that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work 3745with Hardware Watchpoints. 3746 3747Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr} 3748(see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to 3749instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case, 3750@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result, 3751and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used 3752to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's 3753result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an 3754error. 3755 3756@kindex rwatch 3757@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} 3758Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read 3759by the program. 3760 3761@kindex awatch 3762@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} 3763Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from 3764or written into by the program. 3765 3766@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3767@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3768This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as 3769@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}). 3770@end table 3771 3772If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to 3773dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will 3774never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches 3775a never-changing value: 3776 3777@smallexample 3778(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850 3779Cannot watch constant value 0x600850. 3780(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850 3781Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584 3782@end smallexample 3783 3784@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware 3785watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in 3786value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN} 3787cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which 3788executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next 3789@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs. 3790 3791@cindex use only software watchpoints 3792You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the 3793@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to 3794zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if 3795the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted 3796watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting 3797@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware 3798mechanism of watching expression values.) 3799 3800@table @code 3801@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints 3802@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints 3803Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints. 3804 3805@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints 3806@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints 3807Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints. 3808@end table 3809 3810For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 3811watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 3812hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 3813 3814When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports 3815 3816@smallexample 3817Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr} 3818@end smallexample 3819 3820@noindent 3821if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint. 3822 3823Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set 3824hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the 3825value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining 3826every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do 3827that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a 3828hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it 3829will print a message like this: 3830 3831@smallexample 3832Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint. 3833@end smallexample 3834 3835Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the 3836data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware 3837watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems 3838can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you 3839cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a 3840double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes 3841wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region 3842into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints. 3843 3844If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable 3845to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program. 3846Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such 3847time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be 3848able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the 3849warning will be printed only when the program is resumed: 3850 3851@smallexample 3852Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint 3853@end smallexample 3854 3855@noindent 3856If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints. 3857 3858Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also 3859exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints. 3860That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the 3861expression with separately allocated resources. 3862 3863If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call}, 3864any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another 3865kind of breakpoint or the call completes. 3866 3867@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local 3868(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when 3869they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in 3870which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program 3871being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope, 3872and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you 3873rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One 3874way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the 3875@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints. 3876 3877@cindex watchpoints and threads 3878@cindex threads and watchpoints 3879In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the 3880watched expression from every thread. 3881 3882@quotation 3883@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints 3884have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software 3885watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a 3886single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only 3887change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also 3888confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use 3889software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice 3890when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware 3891watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.) 3892@end quotation 3893 3894@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}. 3895 3896@node Set Catchpoints 3897@subsection Setting Catchpoints 3898@cindex catchpoints, setting 3899@cindex exception handlers 3900@cindex event handling 3901 3902You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain 3903kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a 3904shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint. 3905 3906@table @code 3907@kindex catch 3908@item catch @var{event} 3909Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following: 3910@table @code 3911@item throw 3912@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions 3913The throwing of a C@t{++} exception. 3914 3915@item catch 3916The catching of a C@t{++} exception. 3917 3918@item exception 3919@cindex Ada exception catching 3920@cindex catch Ada exceptions 3921An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified 3922at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}), 3923the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised. 3924Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised. 3925 3926When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose 3927name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the 3928fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise, 3929@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception 3930rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception 3931called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then 3932the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception 3933Pck.Constraint_Error}. 3934 3935@item exception unhandled 3936An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. 3937 3938@item assert 3939A failed Ada assertion. 3940 3941@item exec 3942@cindex break on fork/exec 3943A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX 3944and @sc{gnu}/Linux. 3945 3946@item syscall 3947@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{} 3948@cindex break on a system call. 3949A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A 3950syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service 3951from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services. 3952@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the 3953debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no 3954argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls 3955will be caught. 3956 3957@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the 3958underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On 3959GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall 3960names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}. 3961 3962@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers 3963@c can be found, e.g., on this URL: 3964@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html 3965@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet. 3966 3967Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for 3968each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion 3969facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the 3970available choices. 3971 3972You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's 3973number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to 3974identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its 3975name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name 3976into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly 3977may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete 3978list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags 3979behind the OS upgrades). 3980 3981The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide 3982arguments to it: 3983 3984@smallexample 3985(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 3986Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 3987(@value{GDBP}) r 3988Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 3989 3990Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \ 3991 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 3992(@value{GDBP}) c 3993Continuing. 3994 3995Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \ 3996 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 3997(@value{GDBP}) 3998@end smallexample 3999 4000Here is an example of catching a system call by name: 4001 4002@smallexample 4003(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot 4004Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61]) 4005(@value{GDBP}) r 4006Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4007 4008Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \ 4009 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4010(@value{GDBP}) c 4011Continuing. 4012 4013Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \ 4014 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4015(@value{GDBP}) 4016@end smallexample 4017 4018An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case 4019below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML 4020file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it: 4021 4022@smallexample 4023(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4024Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group') 4025(@value{GDBP}) r 4026Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4027 4028Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \ 4029 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4030(@value{GDBP}) c 4031Continuing. 4032 4033Program exited normally. 4034(@value{GDBP}) 4035@end smallexample 4036 4037However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name 4038in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints 4039a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name, 4040but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below: 4041 4042@smallexample 4043(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764 4044warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall. 4045Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764) 4046(@value{GDBP}) 4047@end smallexample 4048 4049If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option, 4050it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your 4051architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls, 4052you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to 4053notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall 4054name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this: 4055 4056@smallexample 4057(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 4058warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml" 4059warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'. 4060GDB will not be able to display syscall names. 4061Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 4062(@value{GDBP}) 4063@end smallexample 4064 4065Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system. 4066 4067Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its 4068number. In this case, you would see something like: 4069 4070@smallexample 4071(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4072Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252) 4073@end smallexample 4074 4075Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names. 4076 4077@item fork 4078A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX 4079and @sc{gnu}/Linux. 4080 4081@item vfork 4082A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX 4083and @sc{gnu}/Linux. 4084 4085@end table 4086 4087@item tcatch @var{event} 4088Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is 4089automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught. 4090 4091@end table 4092 4093Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints. 4094 4095There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling 4096(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}: 4097 4098@itemize @bullet 4099@item 4100If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns 4101control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call 4102raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that 4103returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to 4104simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal 4105that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if 4106you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are 4107disabled within interactive calls. 4108 4109@item 4110You cannot raise an exception interactively. 4111 4112@item 4113You cannot install an exception handler interactively. 4114@end itemize 4115 4116@cindex raise exceptions 4117Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling: 4118if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to 4119stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you 4120can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a 4121breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find 4122out where the exception was raised. 4123 4124To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some 4125knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are 4126raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception} 4127which has the following ANSI C interface: 4128 4129@smallexample 4130 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored. 4131 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */ 4132 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id); 4133@end smallexample 4134 4135@noindent 4136To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack 4137unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception} 4138(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}). 4139 4140With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}) 4141that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when 4142a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional 4143breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are 4144raised. 4145 4146 4147@node Delete Breaks 4148@subsection Deleting Breakpoints 4149 4150@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4151@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4152It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or 4153catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program 4154to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A 4155breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten. 4156 4157With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to 4158where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can 4159delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying 4160their breakpoint numbers. 4161 4162It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN} 4163automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed 4164when you continue execution without changing the execution address. 4165 4166@table @code 4167@kindex clear 4168@item clear 4169Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the 4170selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When 4171the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a 4172breakpoint where your program just stopped. 4173 4174@item clear @var{location} 4175Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}. 4176@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the 4177most useful ones are listed below: 4178 4179@table @code 4180@item clear @var{function} 4181@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function} 4182Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}. 4183 4184@item clear @var{linenum} 4185@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 4186Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified 4187@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}. 4188@end table 4189 4190@cindex delete breakpoints 4191@kindex delete 4192@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})} 4193@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4194Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint 4195ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all 4196breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set 4197confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}. 4198@end table 4199 4200@node Disabling 4201@subsection Disabling Breakpoints 4202 4203@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint 4204Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might 4205prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if 4206it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so 4207that you can @dfn{enable} it again later. 4208 4209You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with 4210the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying 4211one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to 4212print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you 4213do not know which numbers to use. 4214 4215Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations 4216affects all of its locations. 4217 4218A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different 4219states of enablement: 4220 4221@itemize @bullet 4222@item 4223Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set 4224with the @code{break} command starts out in this state. 4225@item 4226Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program. 4227@item 4228Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes 4229disabled. 4230@item 4231Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but 4232immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint 4233set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state. 4234@end itemize 4235 4236You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints, 4237watchpoints, and catchpoints: 4238 4239@table @code 4240@kindex disable 4241@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})} 4242@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4243Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are 4244listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All 4245options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in 4246case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate 4247@code{disable} as @code{dis}. 4248 4249@kindex enable 4250@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4251Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They 4252become effective once again in stopping your program. 4253 4254@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{} 4255Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any 4256of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program. 4257 4258@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{} 4259Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN} 4260deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there. 4261Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state. 4262@end table 4263 4264@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is 4265@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled. 4266Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks, 4267,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled; 4268subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of 4269the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a 4270breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other 4271breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and 4272Stepping}.) 4273 4274@node Conditions 4275@subsection Break Conditions 4276@cindex conditional breakpoints 4277@cindex breakpoint conditions 4278 4279@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted? 4280@c in particular for a watchpoint? 4281The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a 4282specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a 4283breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 4284programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with 4285a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it, 4286and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}. 4287 4288This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that 4289situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is, 4290when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed 4291by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition 4292@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint. 4293 4294Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them, 4295since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but 4296it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name, 4297and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting 4298one. 4299 4300Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in 4301your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions 4302that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to 4303format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable 4304unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In 4305that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your 4306program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that 4307breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break 4308conditions for the 4309purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached 4310(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}). 4311 4312Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using 4313@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set 4314Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time 4315with the @code{condition} command. 4316 4317You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command. 4318The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword; 4319@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a 4320catchpoint. 4321 4322@table @code 4323@kindex condition 4324@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression} 4325Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint, 4326watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition, 4327breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of 4328@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use 4329@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for 4330syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have 4331referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses 4332symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN} 4333prints an error message: 4334 4335@smallexample 4336No symbol "foo" in current context. 4337@end smallexample 4338 4339@noindent 4340@value{GDBN} does 4341not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition} 4342command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like 4343@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 4344 4345@item condition @var{bnum} 4346Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes 4347an ordinary unconditional breakpoint. 4348@end table 4349 4350@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint) 4351A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the 4352breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so 4353useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore 4354count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which 4355is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and 4356therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose 4357ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements 4358the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count 4359value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times 4360your program reaches it. 4361 4362@table @code 4363@kindex ignore 4364@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count} 4365Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}. 4366The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's 4367execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN} 4368takes no action. 4369 4370To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify 4371a count of zero. 4372 4373When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a 4374breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to 4375@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and 4376Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}. 4377 4378If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the 4379condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero, 4380@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition. 4381 4382You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such 4383as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that 4384is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 4385Variables}. 4386@end table 4387 4388Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints. 4389 4390 4391@node Break Commands 4392@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists 4393 4394@cindex breakpoint commands 4395You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of 4396commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For 4397example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or 4398enable other breakpoints. 4399 4400@table @code 4401@kindex commands 4402@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)} 4403@item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4404@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{} 4405@itemx end 4406Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands 4407themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just 4408@code{end} to terminate the commands. 4409 4410To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and 4411follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands. 4412 4413With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint, 4414watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently 4415encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single 4416command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints 4417set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by 4418@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command 4419creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous 4420Expressions}). 4421@end table 4422 4423Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is 4424disabled within a @var{command-list}. 4425 4426You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply 4427use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command 4428that resumes execution. 4429 4430Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes 4431execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution 4432(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter 4433another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to 4434ambiguities about which list to execute. 4435 4436@kindex silent 4437If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the 4438usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may 4439be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and 4440then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you 4441see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is 4442meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list. 4443 4444The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to 4445print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent 4446breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}. 4447 4448For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the 4449value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive. 4450 4451@smallexample 4452break foo if x>0 4453commands 4454silent 4455printf "x is %d\n",x 4456cont 4457end 4458@end smallexample 4459 4460One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so 4461you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line 4462of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something 4463erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values 4464to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command 4465so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent} 4466command so that no output is produced. Here is an example: 4467 4468@smallexample 4469break 403 4470commands 4471silent 4472set x = y + 4 4473cont 4474end 4475@end smallexample 4476 4477@node Save Breakpoints 4478@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file 4479 4480To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save 4481breakpoints}} command. 4482 4483@table @code 4484@kindex save breakpoints 4485@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions 4486@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}] 4487This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with 4488their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 4489suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all 4490types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints, 4491tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the 4492@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints 4493with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated 4494because it may not be possible to access the context where the 4495watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions 4496are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the 4497breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program, 4498and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or 4499that can no longer be recreated. 4500@end table 4501 4502@c @ifclear BARETARGET 4503@node Error in Breakpoints 4504@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 4505 4506If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and 4507watchpoints, you will see this error message: 4508 4509@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant 4510@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999). 4511@smallexample 4512Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints. 4513You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints. 4514@end smallexample 4515 4516@noindent 4517This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since 4518only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and 4519watchpoints it needs to insert. 4520 4521When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the 4522hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue. 4523 4524@node Breakpoint-related Warnings 4525@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 4526@cindex breakpoint address adjusted 4527 4528Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at 4529which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained, 4530@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply 4531with the constraints dictated by the architecture. 4532 4533One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is 4534a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be 4535bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture 4536constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a 4537bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN} 4538honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the 4539first in the bundle. 4540 4541It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain 4542instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that 4543a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to 4544another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s 4545breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is 4546printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint 4547is hit. 4548 4549A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint 4550that's been subject to address adjustment: 4551 4552@smallexample 4553warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410. 4554@end smallexample 4555 4556Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s 4557internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should 4558verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the 4559desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and 4560other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior. 4561E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later 4562instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some 4563cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often. 4564 4565@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these 4566adjusted breakpoints: 4567 4568@smallexample 4569warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414 4570to 0x00010410. 4571@end smallexample 4572 4573When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial 4574action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more 4575frequently than expected. 4576 4577@node Continuing and Stepping 4578@section Continuing and Stepping 4579 4580@cindex stepping 4581@cindex continuing 4582@cindex resuming execution 4583@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program 4584completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just 4585one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one 4586line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what 4587particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping, 4588your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If 4589it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use 4590@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.) 4591 4592@table @code 4593@kindex continue 4594@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})} 4595@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)} 4596@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 4597@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 4598@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 4599Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped; 4600any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument 4601@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to 4602ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of 4603@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 4604 4605The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program 4606stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to 4607@code{continue} is ignored. 4608 4609The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the 4610debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided 4611purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as 4612@code{continue}. 4613@end table 4614 4615To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return} 4616(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the 4617calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a 4618Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program. 4619 4620A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint 4621(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the 4622beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem 4623is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint, 4624and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are 4625interesting, until you see the problem happen. 4626 4627@table @code 4628@kindex step 4629@kindex s @r{(@code{step})} 4630@item step 4631Continue running your program until control reaches a different source 4632line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is 4633abbreviated @code{s}. 4634 4635@quotation 4636@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line 4637@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but 4638@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that 4639@c distinction here. 4640@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is 4641within a function that was compiled without debugging information, 4642execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have 4643debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which 4644is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions 4645without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described 4646below. 4647@end quotation 4648 4649The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source 4650line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 4651@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues 4652to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within 4653the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions 4654called within the line. 4655 4656Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line 4657number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the 4658@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl} 4659on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there 4660was any debugging information about the routine. 4661 4662@item step @var{count} 4663Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a 4664breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before 4665@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away. 4666 4667@kindex next 4668@kindex n @r{(@code{next})} 4669@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 4670Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame. 4671This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within 4672the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when 4673control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level 4674that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command 4675is abbreviated @code{n}. 4676 4677An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}. 4678 4679 4680@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with 4681@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria 4682@c 4683@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like 4684@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the 4685@c function are executed without stopping. 4686 4687The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a 4688source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 4689@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. 4690 4691@kindex set step-mode 4692@item set step-mode 4693@cindex functions without line info, and stepping 4694@cindex stepping into functions with no line info 4695@itemx set step-mode on 4696The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to 4697stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line 4698information rather than stepping over it. 4699 4700This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the 4701machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not 4702want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function. 4703 4704@item set step-mode off 4705Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no 4706debug information. This is the default. 4707 4708@item show step-mode 4709Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without 4710source line debug information. 4711 4712@kindex finish 4713@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})} 4714@item finish 4715Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame 4716returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be 4717abbreviated as @code{fin}. 4718 4719Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning, 4720,Returning from a Function}). 4721 4722@kindex until 4723@kindex u @r{(@code{until})} 4724@cindex run until specified location 4725@item until 4726@itemx u 4727Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the 4728current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single 4729stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next} 4730command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it 4731automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater 4732than the address of the jump. 4733 4734This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping 4735though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it 4736exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop 4737simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step 4738through the next iteration. 4739 4740@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current 4741stack frame. 4742 4743@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order 4744of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For 4745example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f} 4746(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line 4747@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}: 4748 4749@smallexample 4750(@value{GDBP}) f 4751#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206 4752206 expand_input(); 4753(@value{GDBP}) until 4754195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{ 4755@end smallexample 4756 4757This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had 4758generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the 4759start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is 4760written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared 4761to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this 4762expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier 4763statement---not in terms of the actual machine code. 4764 4765@code{until} with no argument works by means of single 4766instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an 4767argument. 4768 4769@item until @var{location} 4770@itemx u @var{location} 4771Continue running your program until either the specified location is 4772reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of 4773the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}. 4774This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and 4775hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified 4776location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This 4777implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function 4778invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is 4779line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to 4780line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner 4781invocations have returned. 4782 4783@smallexample 478494 int factorial (int value) 478595 @{ 478696 if (value > 1) @{ 478797 value *= factorial (value - 1); 478898 @} 478999 return (value); 4790100 @} 4791@end smallexample 4792 4793 4794@kindex advance @var{location} 4795@itemx advance @var{location} 4796Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is 4797required, which should be of one of the forms described in 4798@ref{Specify Location}. 4799Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack 4800frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will 4801not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't 4802have to be in the same frame as the current one. 4803 4804 4805@kindex stepi 4806@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})} 4807@item stepi 4808@itemx stepi @var{arg} 4809@itemx si 4810Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger. 4811 4812It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine 4813instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next 4814instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto 4815Display,, Automatic Display}. 4816 4817An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}. 4818 4819@need 750 4820@kindex nexti 4821@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})} 4822@item nexti 4823@itemx nexti @var{arg} 4824@itemx ni 4825Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call, 4826proceed until the function returns. 4827 4828An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}. 4829@end table 4830 4831@node Signals 4832@section Signals 4833@cindex signals 4834 4835A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The 4836operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each 4837kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the 4838signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}); 4839@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in 4840memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when 4841the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has 4842requested an alarm). 4843 4844@cindex fatal signals 4845Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the 4846functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate 4847errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the 4848program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal. 4849@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally 4850fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program. 4851 4852@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your 4853program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of 4854signal. 4855 4856@cindex handling signals 4857Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like 4858@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program 4859(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning) 4860but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens. 4861You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command. 4862 4863@table @code 4864@kindex info signals 4865@kindex info handle 4866@item info signals 4867@itemx info handle 4868Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to 4869handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all 4870the defined types of signals. 4871 4872@item info signals @var{sig} 4873Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number. 4874 4875@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}. 4876 4877@kindex handle 4878@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]} 4879Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} 4880can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the 4881@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form 4882@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the 4883known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below, 4884say what change to make. 4885@end table 4886 4887@c @group 4888The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated. 4889Their full names are: 4890 4891@table @code 4892@item nostop 4893@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may 4894still print a message telling you that the signal has come in. 4895 4896@item stop 4897@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies 4898the @code{print} keyword as well. 4899 4900@item print 4901@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens. 4902 4903@item noprint 4904@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This 4905implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well. 4906 4907@item pass 4908@itemx noignore 4909@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program 4910can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal 4911and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms. 4912 4913@item nopass 4914@itemx ignore 4915@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal. 4916@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms. 4917@end table 4918@c @end group 4919 4920When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the 4921program until you 4922continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in 4923effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words, 4924after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle} 4925command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your 4926program sees that signal when you continue. 4927 4928The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for 4929non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and 4930@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the 4931erroneous signals. 4932 4933You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from 4934seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see, 4935or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped 4936due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct 4937values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more 4938execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as 4939a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this, 4940you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your 4941Program a Signal}. 4942 4943@cindex extra signal information 4944@anchor{extra signal information} 4945 4946On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information 4947associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually 4948delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported 4949by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data 4950that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the 4951receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is 4952target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype 4953$_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the 4954standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h} 4955system header. 4956 4957Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray 4958referenced address that raised a segmentation fault. 4959 4960@smallexample 4961@group 4962(@value{GDBP}) continue 4963Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault. 49640x0000000000400766 in main () 496569 *(int *)p = 0; 4966(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo 4967type = struct @{ 4968 int si_signo; 4969 int si_errno; 4970 int si_code; 4971 union @{ 4972 int _pad[28]; 4973 struct @{...@} _kill; 4974 struct @{...@} _timer; 4975 struct @{...@} _rt; 4976 struct @{...@} _sigchld; 4977 struct @{...@} _sigfault; 4978 struct @{...@} _sigpoll; 4979 @} _sifields; 4980@} 4981(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault 4982type = struct @{ 4983 void *si_addr; 4984@} 4985(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr 4986$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000 4987@end group 4988@end smallexample 4989 4990Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable. 4991 4992@node Thread Stops 4993@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs 4994 4995@cindex stopped threads 4996@cindex threads, stopped 4997 4998@cindex continuing threads 4999@cindex threads, continuing 5000 5001@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads 5002(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There 5003are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the 5004debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode}, 5005when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint 5006or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by 5007@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports 5008@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while 5009you examine the stopped thread in the debugger. 5010 5011@menu 5012* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control 5013* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute 5014* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously 5015* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints 5016* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls 5017* Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior 5018@end menu 5019 5020@node All-Stop Mode 5021@subsection All-Stop Mode 5022 5023@cindex all-stop mode 5024 5025In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason, 5026@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This 5027allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including 5028switching between threads, without worrying that things may change 5029underfoot. 5030 5031Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start 5032executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands 5033like @code{step} or @code{next}. 5034 5035In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep. 5036Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating 5037system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may 5038execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a 5039single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a 5040statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program 5041stops. 5042 5043You might even find your program stopped in another thread after 5044continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other 5045thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the 5046first thread completes whatever you requested. 5047 5048@cindex automatic thread selection 5049@cindex switching threads automatically 5050@cindex threads, automatic switching 5051Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a 5052signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or 5053signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a 5054message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the 5055thread. 5056 5057On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by 5058locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run. 5059 5060@table @code 5061@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode} 5062@cindex scheduler locking mode 5063@cindex lock scheduler 5064Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no 5065locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the 5066current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step} 5067mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads 5068from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that 5069the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. 5070Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run 5071when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a 5072function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands 5073like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another 5074thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change 5075the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. 5076 5077@item show scheduler-locking 5078Display the current scheduler locking mode. 5079@end table 5080 5081@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously 5082By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as 5083@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only 5084threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN} 5085is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the 5086@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current 5087inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that 5088forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance, 5089it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other 5090situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state 5091of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want 5092to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case, 5093you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the 5094inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command. 5095 5096@table @code 5097@kindex set schedule-multiple 5098@item set schedule-multiple 5099Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed 5100when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of 5101all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads 5102of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The 5103@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on}, 5104or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}. 5105 5106@item show schedule-multiple 5107Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of 5108multiple processes. 5109@end table 5110 5111@node Non-Stop Mode 5112@subsection Non-Stop Mode 5113 5114@cindex non-stop mode 5115 5116@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded 5117@c with more details. 5118 5119For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional 5120mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in 5121the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This 5122minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs 5123where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to 5124respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode. 5125 5126In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event, 5127@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other 5128threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally, 5129execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default 5130only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as 5131in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in 5132ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping 5133one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping 5134one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads 5135independently and simultaneously. 5136 5137To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run 5138or attach to your program: 5139 5140@smallexample 5141# Enable the async interface. 5142set target-async 1 5143 5144# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop. 5145set pagination off 5146 5147# Finally, turn it on! 5148set non-stop on 5149@end smallexample 5150 5151You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting: 5152 5153@table @code 5154@kindex set non-stop 5155@item set non-stop on 5156Enable selection of non-stop mode. 5157@item set non-stop off 5158Disable selection of non-stop mode. 5159@kindex show non-stop 5160@item show non-stop 5161Show the current non-stop enablement setting. 5162@end table 5163 5164Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled, 5165not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode. 5166In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when 5167@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally 5168not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore, 5169since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled 5170non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by 5171default. 5172 5173In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread 5174by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread. 5175To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}. 5176 5177You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands 5178(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background 5179while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}. 5180The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are 5181always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode. 5182 5183Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when 5184running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution. 5185In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process; 5186but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread. 5187To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}. 5188 5189Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option. 5190 5191In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make 5192that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the 5193thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s 5194command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly 5195changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the 5196previously current thread. 5197 5198@node Background Execution 5199@subsection Background Execution 5200 5201@cindex foreground execution 5202@cindex background execution 5203@cindex asynchronous execution 5204@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous 5205 5206@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal 5207foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background 5208(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for 5209the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for 5210another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives 5211a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs. 5212 5213You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use 5214background execution commands. You can use these commands to 5215manipulate the asynchronous mode setting: 5216 5217@table @code 5218@kindex set target-async 5219@item set target-async on 5220Enable asynchronous mode. 5221@item set target-async off 5222Disable asynchronous mode. 5223@kindex show target-async 5224@item show target-async 5225Show the current target-async setting. 5226@end table 5227 5228If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error 5229message if you attempt to use the background execution commands. 5230 5231To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example, 5232the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or 5233just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution 5234are: 5235 5236@table @code 5237@kindex run& 5238@item run 5239@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}. 5240 5241@item attach 5242@kindex attach& 5243@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}. 5244 5245@item step 5246@kindex step& 5247@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}. 5248 5249@item stepi 5250@kindex stepi& 5251@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}. 5252 5253@item next 5254@kindex next& 5255@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}. 5256 5257@item nexti 5258@kindex nexti& 5259@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}. 5260 5261@item continue 5262@kindex continue& 5263@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}. 5264 5265@item finish 5266@kindex finish& 5267@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}. 5268 5269@item until 5270@kindex until& 5271@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}. 5272 5273@end table 5274 5275Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop 5276mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. 5277However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with 5278the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the 5279previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop 5280mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}. 5281 5282You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by 5283using the @code{interrupt} command. 5284 5285@table @code 5286@kindex interrupt 5287@item interrupt 5288@itemx interrupt -a 5289 5290Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode, 5291@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops 5292only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode, 5293use @code{interrupt -a}. 5294@end table 5295 5296@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints 5297@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints 5298 5299When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging 5300Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set 5301breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread. 5302 5303@table @code 5304@cindex breakpoints and threads 5305@cindex thread breakpoints 5306@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno} 5307@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} 5308@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{} 5309@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of 5310writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to 5311specify some source line. 5312 5313Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command 5314to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 5315particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the 5316numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first 5317column of the @samp{info threads} display. 5318 5319If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a 5320breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your 5321program. 5322 5323You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 5324well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or 5325after the breakpoint condition, like this: 5326 5327@smallexample 5328(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim 5329@end smallexample 5330 5331@end table 5332 5333@node Interrupted System Calls 5334@subsection Interrupted System Calls 5335 5336@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls 5337@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints 5338@cindex premature return from system calls 5339There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug 5340multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a 5341breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a 5342system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a 5343consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals 5344that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that 5345stop execution. 5346 5347To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of 5348each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming 5349style anyways. 5350 5351For example, do not write code like this: 5352 5353@smallexample 5354 sleep (10); 5355@end smallexample 5356 5357The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops 5358at a breakpoint or for some other reason. 5359 5360Instead, write this: 5361 5362@smallexample 5363 int unslept = 10; 5364 while (unslept > 0) 5365 unslept = sleep (unslept); 5366@end smallexample 5367 5368A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still 5369conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your 5370multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without 5371@value{GDBN}. 5372 5373Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to 5374monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction. 5375When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return 5376prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop. 5377 5378@node Observer Mode 5379@subsection Observer Mode 5380 5381If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior 5382without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set 5383variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state, 5384whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate 5385at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands. 5386 5387When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to 5388be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable 5389@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop 5390mode. 5391 5392Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical 5393combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled 5394@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory}, 5395then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code 5396stream will still not be able to be placed. 5397 5398@table @code 5399 5400@kindex observer 5401@item set observer on 5402@itemx set observer off 5403When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables 5404below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables 5405non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to 5406normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode. 5407 5408@item show observer 5409Show whether observer mode is on or off. 5410 5411@kindex may-write-registers 5412@item set may-write-registers on 5413@itemx set may-write-registers off 5414This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of 5415registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the 5416@code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}. 5417 5418@item show may-write-registers 5419Show the current permission to write registers. 5420 5421@kindex may-write-memory 5422@item set may-write-memory on 5423@itemx set may-write-memory off 5424This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents 5425of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It 5426defaults to @code{on}. 5427 5428@item show may-write-memory 5429Show the current permission to write memory. 5430 5431@kindex may-insert-breakpoints 5432@item set may-insert-breakpoints on 5433@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off 5434This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints. 5435This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined 5436by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}. 5437 5438@item show may-insert-breakpoints 5439Show the current permission to insert breakpoints. 5440 5441@kindex may-insert-tracepoints 5442@item set may-insert-tracepoints on 5443@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off 5444This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular) 5445tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 5446non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of 5447@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 5448 5449@item show may-insert-tracepoints 5450Show the current permission to insert tracepoints. 5451 5452@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints 5453@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on 5454@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off 5455This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast 5456tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 5457fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the 5458control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 5459 5460@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints 5461Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints. 5462 5463@kindex may-interrupt 5464@item set may-interrupt on 5465@itemx set may-interrupt off 5466This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop 5467program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the 5468@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will 5469@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}. 5470 5471@item show may-interrupt 5472Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program. 5473 5474@end table 5475 5476@node Reverse Execution 5477@chapter Running programs backward 5478@cindex reverse execution 5479@cindex running programs backward 5480 5481When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that 5482you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened. 5483If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to 5484``rewind'' the program by running it backward. 5485 5486A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able 5487to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the 5488program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should 5489revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great 5490deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not 5491all target environments can support reverse execution. 5492 5493When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that 5494have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse 5495order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous 5496thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'', 5497the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that 5498instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing 5499a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code 5500should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their 5501prior values@footnote{ 5502Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance, 5503memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some 5504targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not. 5505 5506The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target 5507requires only that the target do something reasonable when 5508@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the 5509results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to 5510@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN} 5511assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a 5512consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given. 5513}. 5514 5515If you are debugging in a target environment that supports 5516reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands. 5517 5518@table @code 5519@kindex reverse-continue 5520@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})} 5521@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5522@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5523Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing 5524in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous 5525exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of 5526asynchronous signals depends on the target environment. 5527 5528@kindex reverse-step 5529@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})} 5530@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5531Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a 5532different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}. 5533 5534Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop 5535at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously 5536executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to 5537debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into 5538the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last} 5539statement in the called function (typically a return statement). 5540 5541Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are 5542called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping. 5543 5544@kindex reverse-stepi 5545@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})} 5546@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5547Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction 5548to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program 5549counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance, 5550if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you 5551back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself. 5552 5553@kindex reverse-next 5554@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})} 5555@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5556Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in 5557the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function 5558calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from 5559the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back 5560to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called, 5561just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last 5562line of a function back to its return to its caller 5563@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}. 5564 5565@kindex reverse-nexti 5566@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})} 5567@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5568Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction 5569in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically. 5570That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from 5571another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute 5572in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack 5573frame) is reached. 5574 5575@kindex reverse-finish 5576@item reverse-finish 5577Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the 5578current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point 5579where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current 5580function invocation, you end up at the beginning. 5581 5582@kindex set exec-direction 5583@item set exec-direction 5584Set the direction of target execution. 5585@itemx set exec-direction reverse 5586@cindex execute forward or backward in time 5587@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the 5588exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include 5589@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return} 5590command cannot be used in reverse mode. 5591@item set exec-direction forward 5592@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion. 5593This is the default. 5594@end table 5595 5596 5597@node Process Record and Replay 5598@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It 5599@cindex process record and replay 5600@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it 5601 5602On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record 5603and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and 5604replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands. 5605 5606@cindex replay mode 5607When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record 5608for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay 5609mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code 5610instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during 5611code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not 5612really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the 5613program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still 5614changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the 5615execution log. 5616 5617@cindex record mode 5618If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log, 5619@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the 5620inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log 5621for future replay. 5622 5623The process record and replay target supports reverse execution 5624(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the 5625inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in 5626this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution 5627log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't 5628support it directly can only be done in the replay mode. 5629 5630When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in 5631replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the 5632previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the 5633platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not. 5634 5635For architecture environments that support process record and replay, 5636@value{GDBN} provides the following commands: 5637 5638@table @code 5639@kindex target record 5640@kindex record 5641@kindex rec 5642@item target record 5643This command starts the process record and replay target. The process 5644record and replay target can only debug a process that is already 5645running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the 5646@kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with 5647the @kbd{target record} command. 5648 5649Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}. 5650 5651@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay 5652Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping}) 5653will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target 5654is started. That's because the process record and replay target 5655doesn't support displaced stepping. 5656 5657@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay 5658@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay 5659If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in 5660the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the 5661process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't 5662support these two modes. 5663 5664@kindex record stop 5665@kindex rec s 5666@item record stop 5667Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and 5668replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the 5669inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state. 5670 5671When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at 5672the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the 5673next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if 5674you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process 5675will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened. 5676 5677On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped 5678while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log, 5679but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live'' 5680at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the 5681usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state. 5682 5683When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it, 5684process record and replay target will automatically stop itself. 5685 5686@kindex record save 5687@item record save @var{filename} 5688Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}. 5689Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where 5690@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior. 5691 5692@kindex record restore 5693@item record restore @var{filename} 5694Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}. 5695File must have been created with @code{record save}. 5696 5697@kindex set record insn-number-max 5698@item set record insn-number-max @var{limit} 5699Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000. 5700 5701If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start 5702deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record 5703instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded 5704instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded 5705instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit. 5706(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN} 5707lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of 5708the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.) 5709 5710If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded 5711instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded 5712instructions is unlimited in this case. 5713 5714@kindex show record insn-number-max 5715@item show record insn-number-max 5716Show the limit of instructions to be recorded. 5717 5718@kindex set record stop-at-limit 5719@item set record stop-at-limit 5720Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches 5721the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit 5722is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the 5723inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If 5724you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will 5725cause the oldest one to be deleted. 5726 5727If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the 5728oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking. 5729 5730@kindex show record stop-at-limit 5731@item show record stop-at-limit 5732Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}. 5733 5734@kindex set record memory-query 5735@item set record memory-query 5736Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory 5737changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query 5738whether to stop the inferior in that case. 5739 5740If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically 5741ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when 5742@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this 5743instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay 5744results. 5745 5746@kindex show record memory-query 5747@item show record memory-query 5748Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}. 5749 5750@kindex info record 5751@item info record 5752Show various statistics about the state of process record and its 5753in-memory execution log buffer, including: 5754 5755@itemize @bullet 5756@item 5757Whether in record mode or replay mode. 5758@item 5759Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions). 5760@item 5761Highest recorded instruction number. 5762@item 5763Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode). 5764@item 5765Number of instructions contained in the execution log. 5766@item 5767Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log. 5768@end itemize 5769 5770@kindex record delete 5771@kindex rec del 5772@item record delete 5773When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the 5774subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting 5775from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously 5776recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''. 5777@end table 5778 5779 5780@node Stack 5781@chapter Examining the Stack 5782 5783When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it 5784stopped and how it got there. 5785 5786@cindex call stack 5787Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call 5788is generated. 5789That information includes the location of the call in your program, 5790the arguments of the call, 5791and the local variables of the function being called. 5792The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}. 5793The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call 5794stack}. 5795 5796When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the 5797stack allow you to see all of this information. 5798 5799@cindex selected frame 5800One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many 5801@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In 5802particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in 5803your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are 5804special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are 5805interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 5806 5807When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the 5808currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the 5809@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}). 5810 5811@menu 5812* Frames:: Stack frames 5813* Backtrace:: Backtraces 5814* Selection:: Selecting a frame 5815* Frame Info:: Information on a frame 5816 5817@end menu 5818 5819@node Frames 5820@section Stack Frames 5821 5822@cindex frame, definition 5823@cindex stack frame 5824The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack 5825frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated 5826with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given 5827to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at 5828which the function is executing. 5829 5830@cindex initial frame 5831@cindex outermost frame 5832@cindex innermost frame 5833When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the 5834function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the 5835@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is 5836made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation 5837is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for 5838the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is 5839actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most 5840recently created of all the stack frames that still exist. 5841 5842@cindex frame pointer 5843Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A 5844stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each 5845kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose 5846address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept 5847in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} 5848(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame. 5849 5850@cindex frame number 5851@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with 5852zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it, 5853and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program; 5854they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack 5855frames in @value{GDBN} commands. 5856 5857@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow 5858@c underflow problems. 5859@cindex frameless execution 5860Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate 5861without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option 5862@smallexample 5863@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} 5864@end smallexample 5865generates functions without a frame.) 5866This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save 5867the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing 5868with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation 5869has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though 5870it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing 5871correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has 5872no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack. 5873 5874@table @code 5875@kindex frame@r{, command} 5876@cindex current stack frame 5877@item frame @var{args} 5878The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another, 5879and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the 5880address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument, 5881@code{frame} prints the current stack frame. 5882 5883@kindex select-frame 5884@cindex selecting frame silently 5885@item select-frame 5886The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame 5887to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of 5888@code{frame}. 5889@end table 5890 5891@node Backtrace 5892@section Backtraces 5893 5894@cindex traceback 5895@cindex call stack traces 5896A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one 5897line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing 5898frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the 5899stack. 5900 5901@table @code 5902@kindex backtrace 5903@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})} 5904@item backtrace 5905@itemx bt 5906Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all 5907frames in the stack. 5908 5909You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt 5910character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}. 5911 5912@item backtrace @var{n} 5913@itemx bt @var{n} 5914Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames. 5915 5916@item backtrace -@var{n} 5917@itemx bt -@var{n} 5918Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames. 5919 5920@item backtrace full 5921@itemx bt full 5922@itemx bt full @var{n} 5923@itemx bt full -@var{n} 5924Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the 5925number of frames to print, as described above. 5926@end table 5927 5928@kindex where 5929@kindex info stack 5930The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s}) 5931are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}. 5932 5933@cindex multiple threads, backtrace 5934In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the 5935backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for 5936several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply} 5937(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread 5938apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all 5939the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a 5940multi-threaded program. 5941 5942Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name. 5943The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set 5944print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and 5945line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program 5946counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that 5947line number. 5948 5949Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command 5950@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames. 5951 5952@smallexample 5953@group 5954#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 5955 at builtin.c:993 5956#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242 5957#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08) 5958 at macro.c:71 5959(More stack frames follow...) 5960@end group 5961@end smallexample 5962 5963@noindent 5964The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter 5965value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the 5966code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}. 5967 5968@noindent 5969The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by 5970@code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter 5971only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command 5972@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details 5973on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed. 5974 5975@cindex optimized out, in backtrace 5976@cindex function call arguments, optimized out 5977If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will 5978optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are 5979never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that 5980passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments 5981in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such 5982arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what 5983such a backtrace might look like: 5984 5985@smallexample 5986@group 5987#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 5988 at builtin.c:993 5989#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242 5990#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08) 5991 at macro.c:71 5992(More stack frames follow...) 5993@end group 5994@end smallexample 5995 5996@noindent 5997The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are 5998shown as @samp{<optimized out>}. 5999 6000If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments, 6001either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one 6002you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations. 6003 6004@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function 6005@cindex program entry point 6006@cindex startup code, and backtrace 6007Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system 6008libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is 6009@code{main}@footnote{ 6010Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing'' 6011environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the 6012entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}. 6013When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace 6014it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly 6015system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code. 6016 6017If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels 6018in a backtrace, you can change this behavior: 6019 6020@table @code 6021@item set backtrace past-main 6022@itemx set backtrace past-main on 6023@kindex set backtrace 6024Backtraces will continue past the user entry point. 6025 6026@item set backtrace past-main off 6027Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the 6028default. 6029 6030@item show backtrace past-main 6031@kindex show backtrace 6032Display the current user entry point backtrace policy. 6033 6034@item set backtrace past-entry 6035@itemx set backtrace past-entry on 6036Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application. 6037This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built, 6038and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called. 6039 6040@item set backtrace past-entry off 6041Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an 6042application. This is the default. 6043 6044@item show backtrace past-entry 6045Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy. 6046 6047@item set backtrace limit @var{n} 6048@itemx set backtrace limit 0 6049@cindex backtrace limit 6050Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means 6051unlimited. 6052 6053@item show backtrace limit 6054Display the current limit on backtrace levels. 6055@end table 6056 6057@node Selection 6058@section Selecting a Frame 6059 6060Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on 6061whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for 6062selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description 6063of the stack frame just selected. 6064 6065@table @code 6066@kindex frame@r{, selecting} 6067@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})} 6068@item frame @var{n} 6069@itemx f @var{n} 6070Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost 6071(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the 6072innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for 6073@code{main}. 6074 6075@item frame @var{addr} 6076@itemx f @var{addr} 6077Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the 6078chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it 6079impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In 6080addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and 6081switches between them. 6082 6083On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to 6084select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer. 6085 6086On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack 6087pointer and a program counter. 6088 6089On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack 6090pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer. 6091 6092@kindex up 6093@item up @var{n} 6094Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this 6095advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames 6096that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one. 6097 6098@kindex down 6099@kindex do @r{(@code{down})} 6100@item down @var{n} 6101Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this 6102advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames 6103that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may 6104abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}. 6105@end table 6106 6107All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the 6108frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the 6109arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that 6110frame. The second line shows the text of that source line. 6111 6112@need 1000 6113For example: 6114 6115@smallexample 6116@group 6117(@value{GDBP}) up 6118#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc) 6119 at env.c:10 612010 read_input_file (argv[i]); 6121@end group 6122@end smallexample 6123 6124After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments 6125prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame. 6126You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite 6127editing program by typing @code{edit}. 6128@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines}, 6129for details. 6130 6131@table @code 6132@kindex down-silently 6133@kindex up-silently 6134@item up-silently @var{n} 6135@itemx down-silently @var{n} 6136These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down}, 6137respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without 6138causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use 6139in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and 6140distracting. 6141@end table 6142 6143@node Frame Info 6144@section Information About a Frame 6145 6146There are several other commands to print information about the selected 6147stack frame. 6148 6149@table @code 6150@item frame 6151@itemx f 6152When used without any argument, this command does not change which 6153frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently 6154selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an 6155argument, this command is used to select a stack frame. 6156@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 6157 6158@kindex info frame 6159@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})} 6160@item info frame 6161@itemx info f 6162This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame, 6163including: 6164 6165@itemize @bullet 6166@item 6167the address of the frame 6168@item 6169the address of the next frame down (called by this frame) 6170@item 6171the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame) 6172@item 6173the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written 6174@item 6175the address of the frame's arguments 6176@item 6177the address of the frame's local variables 6178@item 6179the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame) 6180@item 6181which registers were saved in the frame 6182@end itemize 6183 6184@noindent The verbose description is useful when 6185something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit 6186the usual conventions. 6187 6188@item info frame @var{addr} 6189@itemx info f @var{addr} 6190Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without 6191selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this 6192command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some 6193architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command. 6194@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 6195 6196@kindex info args 6197@item info args 6198Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line. 6199 6200@item info locals 6201@kindex info locals 6202Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate 6203line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic) 6204accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame. 6205 6206@kindex info catch 6207@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers 6208@cindex exception handlers, how to list 6209@item info catch 6210Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the 6211current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other 6212exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up}, 6213@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}. 6214@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}. 6215 6216@end table 6217 6218 6219@node Source 6220@chapter Examining Source Files 6221 6222@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging 6223information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were 6224used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints 6225the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame 6226(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where 6227execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of 6228source files by explicit command. 6229 6230If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may 6231prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using 6232@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}. 6233 6234@menu 6235* List:: Printing source lines 6236* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations 6237* Edit:: Editing source files 6238* Search:: Searching source files 6239* Source Path:: Specifying source directories 6240* Machine Code:: Source and machine code 6241@end menu 6242 6243@node List 6244@section Printing Source Lines 6245 6246@kindex list 6247@kindex l @r{(@code{list})} 6248To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command 6249(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed. 6250There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to 6251print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list. 6252 6253Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used: 6254 6255@table @code 6256@item list @var{linenum} 6257Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the 6258current source file. 6259 6260@item list @var{function} 6261Print lines centered around the beginning of function 6262@var{function}. 6263 6264@item list 6265Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a 6266@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines 6267printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed 6268as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the 6269Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line. 6270 6271@item list - 6272Print lines just before the lines last printed. 6273@end table 6274 6275@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display 6276By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of 6277the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}: 6278 6279@table @code 6280@kindex set listsize 6281@item set listsize @var{count} 6282Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless 6283the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number). 6284 6285@kindex show listsize 6286@item show listsize 6287Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints. 6288@end table 6289 6290Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument, 6291so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful 6292than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an 6293argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that 6294each repetition moves up in the source file. 6295 6296In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two 6297@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways 6298of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always 6299to specify some source line. 6300 6301Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}: 6302 6303@table @code 6304@item list @var{linespec} 6305Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}. 6306 6307@item list @var{first},@var{last} 6308Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are 6309linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the 6310source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to 6311the same source file as the first linespec. 6312 6313@item list ,@var{last} 6314Print lines ending with @var{last}. 6315 6316@item list @var{first}, 6317Print lines starting with @var{first}. 6318 6319@item list + 6320Print lines just after the lines last printed. 6321 6322@item list - 6323Print lines just before the lines last printed. 6324 6325@item list 6326As described in the preceding table. 6327@end table 6328 6329@node Specify Location 6330@section Specifying a Location 6331@cindex specifying location 6332@cindex linespec 6333 6334Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location 6335of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level 6336debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code; 6337for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}. 6338 6339Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that 6340@value{GDBN} understands: 6341 6342@table @code 6343@item @var{linenum} 6344Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file. 6345 6346@item -@var{offset} 6347@itemx +@var{offset} 6348Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current 6349line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one 6350printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which 6351execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame} 6352(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When 6353used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command, 6354this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first 6355linespec. 6356 6357@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 6358Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}. 6359 6360@item @var{function} 6361Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}. 6362For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace. 6363 6364@item @var{function}:@var{label} 6365Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}. 6366 6367@item @var{filename}:@var{function} 6368Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function} 6369in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a 6370function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named 6371functions in different source files. 6372 6373@item @var{label} 6374Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears. 6375@value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to 6376the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected 6377stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then 6378@value{GDBN} will not search for a label. 6379 6380@item *@var{address} 6381Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented 6382commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source 6383line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other 6384breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in 6385parts of your program which do not have debugging information or 6386source files. 6387 6388Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working 6389language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code 6390address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the 6391semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations 6392that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms 6393of @var{address}: 6394 6395@table @code 6396@item @var{expression} 6397Any expression valid in the current working language. 6398 6399@item @var{funcaddr} 6400An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C, 6401C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is 6402simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case 6403of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is 6404@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address} 6405(although the Pascal form also works). 6406 6407This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction, 6408before the stack frame and arguments have been set up. 6409 6410@item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr} 6411Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source 6412file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not 6413specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several 6414functions with identical names in different source files. 6415@end table 6416 6417@end table 6418 6419 6420@node Edit 6421@section Editing Source Files 6422@cindex editing source files 6423 6424@kindex edit 6425@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})} 6426To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command. 6427The editing program of your choice 6428is invoked with the current line set to 6429the active line in the program. 6430Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you 6431want to print if you want to see other parts of the program: 6432 6433@table @code 6434@item edit @var{location} 6435Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at 6436that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the 6437specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms 6438of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit} 6439command most commonly used: 6440 6441@table @code 6442@item edit @var{number} 6443Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number. 6444 6445@item edit @var{function} 6446Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition. 6447@end table 6448 6449@end table 6450 6451@subsection Choosing your Editor 6452You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want 6453@footnote{ 6454The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the 6455following command-line syntax: 6456@smallexample 6457ex +@var{number} file 6458@end smallexample 6459The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in 6460the file where to start editing.}. 6461By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this 6462by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using 6463@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the 6464@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell: 6465@smallexample 6466EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi 6467export EDITOR 6468gdb @dots{} 6469@end smallexample 6470or in the @code{csh} shell, 6471@smallexample 6472setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi 6473gdb @dots{} 6474@end smallexample 6475 6476@node Search 6477@section Searching Source Files 6478@cindex searching source files 6479 6480There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a 6481regular expression. 6482 6483@table @code 6484@kindex search 6485@kindex forward-search 6486@item forward-search @var{regexp} 6487@itemx search @var{regexp} 6488The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, 6489starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for 6490@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the 6491synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as 6492@code{fo}. 6493 6494@kindex reverse-search 6495@item reverse-search @var{regexp} 6496The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting 6497with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match 6498for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate 6499this command as @code{rev}. 6500@end table 6501 6502@node Source Path 6503@section Specifying Source Directories 6504 6505@cindex source path 6506@cindex directories for source files 6507Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source 6508files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do, 6509the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging 6510session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files; 6511this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file, 6512it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present 6513in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. 6514 6515For example, suppose an executable references the file 6516@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is 6517@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this 6518fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this 6519fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error 6520message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the 6521source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. 6522Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if 6523the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to 6524@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under 6525@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}. 6526 6527Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file 6528names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for 6529instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file 6530is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try 6531@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after 6532that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}. 6533 6534Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the 6535source files. 6536 6537Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out 6538any information it has cached about where source files are found and where 6539each line is in the file. 6540 6541@kindex directory 6542@kindex dir 6543When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir} 6544and @samp{cwd}, in that order. 6545To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command. 6546 6547The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN} 6548script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command). 6549 6550In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands 6551that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution 6552rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's 6553debug information in case the sources were moved to a different 6554directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of 6555two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in 6556the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten. 6557In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and 6558@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement 6559of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the 6560source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file 6561name to look up the sources. 6562 6563Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been 6564moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell 6565@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with 6566@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be 6567@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location 6568of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path 6569substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command 6570(@pxref{set substitute-path}). 6571 6572To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the 6573@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator. 6574For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into 6575@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but 6576not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution 6577is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will 6578not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either. 6579 6580In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory} 6581command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in 6582the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple 6583subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each 6584subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while 6585preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path} 6586allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single 6587command. 6588 6589@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command. 6590The source path is only used if the file at the original location no 6591longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies 6592the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if 6593for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is 6594located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only 6595method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location. 6596 6597@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources} 6598@cindex default source path substitution 6599You can configure a default source path substitution rule by 6600configuring @value{GDBN} with the 6601@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir} 6602should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured 6603prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and 6604directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted 6605automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 6606location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables 6607with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved 6608together. 6609 6610@table @code 6611@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{} 6612@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{} 6613Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several 6614directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:} 6615(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as 6616part of absolute file names) or 6617whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source 6618path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner. 6619 6620@kindex cdir 6621@kindex cwd 6622@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable} 6623@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable} 6624@cindex compilation directory 6625@cindex current directory 6626@cindex working directory 6627@cindex directory, current 6628@cindex directory, compilation 6629You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation 6630directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current 6631working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former 6632tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN} 6633session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current 6634directory at the time you add an entry to the source path. 6635 6636@item directory 6637Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation. 6638 6639@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since 6640@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS) 6641 6642@item set directories @var{path-list} 6643@kindex set directories 6644Set the source path to @var{path-list}. 6645@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing. 6646 6647@item show directories 6648@kindex show directories 6649Print the source path: show which directories it contains. 6650 6651@anchor{set substitute-path} 6652@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to} 6653@kindex set substitute-path 6654Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the 6655current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same 6656@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted. 6657 6658For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to 6659@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command 6660 6661@smallexample 6662(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross 6663@end smallexample 6664 6665@noindent 6666will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with 6667@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file 6668@file{baz.c} even though it was moved. 6669 6670In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined, 6671the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been 6672defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform 6673the substitution. 6674 6675For instance, if we had entered the following commands: 6676 6677@smallexample 6678(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include 6679(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src 6680@end smallexample 6681 6682@noindent 6683@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into 6684@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would 6685use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into 6686@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}. 6687 6688 6689@item unset substitute-path [path] 6690@kindex unset substitute-path 6691If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules 6692for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found. 6693A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found. 6694 6695If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted. 6696 6697@item show substitute-path [path] 6698@kindex show substitute-path 6699If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule 6700which would rewrite that path, if any. 6701 6702If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution 6703rules. 6704 6705@end table 6706 6707If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of 6708interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong 6709versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows: 6710 6711@enumerate 6712@item 6713Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value. 6714 6715@item 6716Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the 6717directories you want in the source path. You can add all the 6718directories in one command. 6719@end enumerate 6720 6721@node Machine Code 6722@section Source and Machine Code 6723@cindex source line and its code address 6724 6725You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program 6726addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display 6727a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command 6728@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next 6729source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs 6730mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the 6731line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as 6732well as hex. 6733 6734@table @code 6735@kindex info line 6736@item info line @var{linespec} 6737Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for 6738source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of 6739the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. 6740@end table 6741 6742For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of 6743the object code for the first line of function 6744@code{m4_changequote}: 6745 6746@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in 6747@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed. 6748@smallexample 6749(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote 6750Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350. 6751@end smallexample 6752 6753@noindent 6754@cindex code address and its source line 6755We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for 6756@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address: 6757@smallexample 6758(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff 6759Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404. 6760@end smallexample 6761 6762@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line} 6763@cindex @code{x} command, default address 6764@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line 6765After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command 6766is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is 6767sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory, 6768,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the 6769convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 6770Variables}). 6771 6772@table @code 6773@kindex disassemble 6774@cindex assembly instructions 6775@cindex instructions, assembly 6776@cindex machine instructions 6777@cindex listing machine instructions 6778@item disassemble 6779@itemx disassemble /m 6780@itemx disassemble /r 6781This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine 6782instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying 6783the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as 6784in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}. 6785The default memory range is the function surrounding the 6786program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this 6787command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function 6788surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should 6789be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The 6790arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms: 6791 6792@table @code 6793@item @var{start},@var{end} 6794the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive) 6795@item @var{start},+@var{length} 6796the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to 6797@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive). 6798@end table 6799 6800@noindent 6801When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also 6802printed (since there could be several functions in the given range). 6803 6804The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as 6805@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}. 6806 6807If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter, 6808the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker. 6809@end table 6810 6811The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of 6812HP PA-RISC 2.0 code: 6813 6814@smallexample 6815(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4 6816Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4: 6817 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp 6818 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26 6819 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31 6820 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31) 6821 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp 6822 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp 6823 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26 6824 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31 6825End of assembler dump. 6826@end smallexample 6827 6828Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the 6829program is stopped just after function prologue: 6830 6831@smallexample 6832(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main 6833Dump of assembler code for function main: 68345 @{ 6835 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp 6836 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp 6837 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp 6838 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp 6839 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp 6840 68416 printf ("Hello.\n"); 6842=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp) 6843 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt> 6844 68457 return 0; 68468 @} 6847 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax 6848 0x0804834d <+29>: leave 6849 0x0804834e <+30>: ret 6850 6851End of assembler dump. 6852@end smallexample 6853 6854Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64, 6855 6856@smallexample 6857(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10 6858Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b: 6859 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi) 6860 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax 6861 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx) 6862 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al 6863End of assembler dump. 6864@end smallexample 6865 6866Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction 6867mnemonics or other syntax. 6868 6869For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries, 6870instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared 6871libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a 6872location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN} 6873might be able to resolve these to actual function names. 6874 6875@table @code 6876@kindex set disassembly-flavor 6877@cindex Intel disassembly flavor 6878@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor 6879@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set} 6880Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the 6881program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands. 6882 6883Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You 6884can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}. 6885The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix 6886assemblers for x86-based targets. 6887 6888@kindex show disassembly-flavor 6889@item show disassembly-flavor 6890Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor. 6891@end table 6892 6893@table @code 6894@kindex set disassemble-next-line 6895@kindex show disassemble-next-line 6896@item set disassemble-next-line 6897@itemx show disassemble-next-line 6898Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source 6899line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will 6900display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the 6901program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to 6902displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if 6903possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason 6904(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line 6905info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the 6906next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If 6907AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only 6908if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes 6909@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function 6910with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is 6911OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or 6912instruction. 6913@end table 6914 6915 6916@node Data 6917@chapter Examining Data 6918 6919@cindex printing data 6920@cindex examining data 6921@kindex print 6922@kindex inspect 6923@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not 6924@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a 6925@c different window or something like that. 6926The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print} 6927command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It 6928evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your 6929program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with 6930Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a 6931Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). 6932 6933@table @code 6934@item print @var{expr} 6935@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr} 6936@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the 6937value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type; 6938you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where 6939@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output 6940Formats}. 6941 6942@item print 6943@itemx print /@var{f} 6944@cindex reprint the last value 6945If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the 6946@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to 6947conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format. 6948@end table 6949 6950A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command. 6951It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a 6952specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 6953 6954If you are interested in information about types, or about how the 6955fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}} 6956command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol 6957Table}. 6958 6959@menu 6960* Expressions:: Expressions 6961* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions 6962* Variables:: Program variables 6963* Arrays:: Artificial arrays 6964* Output Formats:: Output formats 6965* Memory:: Examining memory 6966* Auto Display:: Automatic display 6967* Print Settings:: Print settings 6968* Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing 6969* Value History:: Value history 6970* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables 6971* Registers:: Registers 6972* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware 6973* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit 6974* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system 6975* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes 6976* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file 6977* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core 6978* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different 6979 character set than GDB does 6980* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets 6981* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes 6982@end menu 6983 6984@node Expressions 6985@section Expressions 6986 6987@cindex expressions 6988@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and 6989compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined 6990by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in 6991@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, 6992casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if 6993you compiled your program to include this information; see 6994@ref{Compilation}. 6995 6996@cindex arrays in expressions 6997@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by 6998the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example, 6999you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array 7000of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it 7001to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that 7002is @code{malloc}ed in the target program. 7003 7004Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in 7005this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different 7006Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other 7007languages. 7008 7009In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN} 7010expressions regardless of your programming language. 7011 7012@cindex casts, in expressions 7013Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so 7014useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure 7015at that address in memory. 7016@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true? 7017 7018@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common 7019to programming languages: 7020 7021@table @code 7022@item @@ 7023@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays. 7024@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information. 7025 7026@item :: 7027@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or 7028function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}. 7029 7030@cindex @{@var{type}@} 7031@cindex type casting memory 7032@cindex memory, viewing as typed object 7033@cindex casts, to view memory 7034@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr} 7035Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in 7036memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or 7037pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in 7038a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is 7039normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}. 7040@end table 7041 7042@node Ambiguous Expressions 7043@section Ambiguous Expressions 7044@cindex ambiguous expressions 7045 7046Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance, 7047some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit 7048a single function name to be defined several times, for application in 7049different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example 7050involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++} 7051templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in 7052the same function name being defined in different contexts. 7053 7054In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust 7055the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you 7056can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in 7057@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully 7058qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous 7059as well. 7060 7061When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger 7062has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each 7063possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}. 7064The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}} 7065aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was 7066used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the 7067menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible 7068choices. 7069 7070For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a 7071breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}. 7072We choose three particular definitions of that function name: 7073 7074@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least 7075@smallexample 7076@group 7077(@value{GDBP}) b String::after 7078[0] cancel 7079[1] all 7080[2] file:String.cc; line number:867 7081[3] file:String.cc; line number:860 7082[4] file:String.cc; line number:875 7083[5] file:String.cc; line number:853 7084[6] file:String.cc; line number:846 7085[7] file:String.cc; line number:735 7086> 2 4 6 7087Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867. 7088Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875. 7089Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846. 7090Multiple breakpoints were set. 7091Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted 7092 breakpoints. 7093(@value{GDBP}) 7094@end group 7095@end smallexample 7096 7097@table @code 7098@kindex set multiple-symbols 7099@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode} 7100@cindex multiple-symbols menu 7101 7102This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression 7103is ambiguous. 7104 7105By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which 7106the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN} 7107automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting 7108a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint 7109inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made, 7110then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression. 7111For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result 7112in the use of the menu. 7113 7114When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu 7115when an ambiguity is detected. 7116 7117Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports 7118an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted. 7119 7120@kindex show multiple-symbols 7121@item show multiple-symbols 7122Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting. 7123@end table 7124 7125@node Variables 7126@section Program Variables 7127 7128The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable 7129in your program. 7130 7131Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame 7132(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either: 7133 7134@itemize @bullet 7135@item 7136global (or file-static) 7137@end itemize 7138 7139@noindent or 7140 7141@itemize @bullet 7142@item 7143visible according to the scope rules of the 7144programming language from the point of execution in that frame 7145@end itemize 7146 7147@noindent This means that in the function 7148 7149@smallexample 7150foo (a) 7151 int a; 7152@{ 7153 bar (a); 7154 @{ 7155 int b = test (); 7156 bar (b); 7157 @} 7158@} 7159@end smallexample 7160 7161@noindent 7162you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is 7163executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or 7164examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside 7165the block where @code{b} is declared. 7166 7167@cindex variable name conflict 7168There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose 7169scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not 7170in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or 7171function with the same name (in different source files). If that 7172happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish, 7173you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file, 7174using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation: 7175 7176@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions 7177@ifnotinfo 7178@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers? 7179@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions 7180@end ifnotinfo 7181@smallexample 7182@var{file}::@var{variable} 7183@var{function}::@var{variable} 7184@end smallexample 7185 7186@noindent 7187Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the 7188static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to 7189make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example, 7190to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}: 7191 7192@smallexample 7193(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x 7194@end smallexample 7195 7196@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution 7197This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar 7198use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++} 7199scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions. 7200@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in 7201@c conflict?? --mew 7202 7203@cindex wrong values 7204@cindex variable values, wrong 7205@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables 7206@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables 7207@quotation 7208@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the 7209wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new 7210scope, and just before exit. 7211@end quotation 7212You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions. 7213This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to 7214set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are 7215stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong 7216values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually 7217also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame; 7218after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local 7219variable definitions may be gone. 7220 7221This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations. 7222To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization 7223when compiling. 7224 7225@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context'' 7226Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize 7227unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as 7228opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases 7229offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN} 7230might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that 7231happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this: 7232 7233@smallexample 7234No symbol "foo" in current context. 7235@end smallexample 7236 7237To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a 7238different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such 7239formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, 7240usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+} 7241produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as 7242COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also 7243an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options 7244for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} 7245Compiler Collection (GCC)}. 7246@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats 7247that are best suited to C@t{++} programs. 7248 7249If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to 7250@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified 7251by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete 7252type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this. 7253 7254Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified 7255signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get 7256printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or 7257@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN} 7258defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign. 7259For program code 7260 7261@smallexample 7262char var0[] = "A"; 7263signed char var1[] = "A"; 7264@end smallexample 7265 7266You get during debugging 7267@smallexample 7268(gdb) print var0 7269$1 = "A" 7270(gdb) print var1 7271$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@} 7272@end smallexample 7273 7274@node Arrays 7275@section Artificial Arrays 7276 7277@cindex artificial array 7278@cindex arrays 7279@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array} 7280It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the 7281same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of 7282dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the 7283program. 7284 7285You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an 7286@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left 7287operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array 7288and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length 7289of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of 7290the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left 7291argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately 7292following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an 7293example. If a program says 7294 7295@smallexample 7296int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int)); 7297@end smallexample 7298 7299@noindent 7300you can print the contents of @code{array} with 7301 7302@smallexample 7303p *array@@len 7304@end smallexample 7305 7306The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made 7307with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of 7308subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions. 7309Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history 7310(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out. 7311 7312Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast. 7313This re-interprets a value as if it were an array. 7314The value need not be in memory: 7315@smallexample 7316(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678 7317$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 7318@end smallexample 7319 7320As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in 7321@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill 7322the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}: 7323@smallexample 7324(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678 7325$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 7326@end smallexample 7327 7328Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in 7329moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not 7330actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values 7331of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is 7332to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 7333Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first 7334interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For 7335instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to 7336structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv} 7337in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type: 7338 7339@smallexample 7340set $i = 0 7341p dtab[$i++]->fv 7342@key{RET} 7343@key{RET} 7344@dots{} 7345@end smallexample 7346 7347@node Output Formats 7348@section Output Formats 7349 7350@cindex formatted output 7351@cindex output formats 7352By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes 7353this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number 7354in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory 7355at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do 7356these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value. 7357 7358The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value 7359already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the 7360@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format 7361letters supported are: 7362 7363@table @code 7364@item x 7365Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in 7366hexadecimal. 7367 7368@item d 7369Print as integer in signed decimal. 7370 7371@item u 7372Print as integer in unsigned decimal. 7373 7374@item o 7375Print as integer in octal. 7376 7377@item t 7378Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''. 7379@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also 7380used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte''; 7381see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.} 7382 7383@item a 7384@cindex unknown address, locating 7385@cindex locate address 7386Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from 7387the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover 7388where (in what function) an unknown address is located: 7389 7390@smallexample 7391(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320 7392$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396> 7393@end smallexample 7394 7395@noindent 7396The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results. 7397@xref{Symbols, info symbol}. 7398 7399@item c 7400Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This 7401prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The 7402character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn} 7403for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range. 7404 7405Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char}, 7406@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character 7407constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer 7408data. 7409 7410@item f 7411Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print 7412using typical floating point syntax. 7413 7414@item s 7415@cindex printing strings 7416@cindex printing byte arrays 7417Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte 7418data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data 7419are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their 7420natural types. 7421 7422Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of 7423@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as 7424strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer 7425array. 7426 7427@item r 7428@cindex raw printing 7429Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will 7430use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty 7431Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the 7432value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python 7433pretty-printer which might exist. 7434@end table 7435 7436For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type 7437 7438@smallexample 7439p/x $pc 7440@end smallexample 7441 7442@noindent 7443Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command 7444names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash. 7445 7446To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format, 7447you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no 7448expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex. 7449 7450@node Memory 7451@section Examining Memory 7452 7453You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in 7454any of several formats, independently of your program's data types. 7455 7456@cindex examining memory 7457@table @code 7458@kindex x @r{(examine memory)} 7459@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr} 7460@itemx x @var{addr} 7461@itemx x 7462Use the @code{x} command to examine memory. 7463@end table 7464 7465@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how 7466much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an 7467expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory. 7468If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}. 7469Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}. 7470 7471@table @r 7472@item @var{n}, the repeat count 7473The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies 7474how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. 7475@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB 7476@c 4.1.2. 7477 7478@item @var{f}, the display format 7479The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print} 7480(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c}, 7481@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions). 7482The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes 7483each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}. 7484 7485@item @var{u}, the unit size 7486The unit size is any of 7487 7488@table @code 7489@item b 7490Bytes. 7491@item h 7492Halfwords (two bytes). 7493@item w 7494Words (four bytes). This is the initial default. 7495@item g 7496Giant words (eight bytes). 7497@end table 7498 7499Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the 7500default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format, 7501the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format, 7502the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given. 7503Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display 750432-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings. 7505Note that the results depend on the programming language of the 7506current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s} 7507modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use 7508UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot 7509be altered. 7510 7511@item @var{addr}, starting display address 7512@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying 7513memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may); 7514it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory. 7515@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for 7516@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several 7517other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to 7518the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the 7519starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display 7520a value from memory). 7521@end table 7522 7523For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords 7524(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}), 7525starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four 7526words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp}; 7527@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}). 7528 7529Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the 7530letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether 7531unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output 7532specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing. 7533(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.) 7534 7535Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s} 7536and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example, 7537@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions, 7538including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with 7539the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay 7540slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately 7541follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command 7542@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine 7543instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}. 7544 7545All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it 7546easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time 7547you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine 7548instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven 7549with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command, 7550the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as 7551for successive uses of @code{x}. 7552 7553When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program 7554counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example: 7555 7556@smallexample 7557(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6 7558 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp 7559 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx 7560 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp 7561=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp) 7562 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt> 7563@end smallexample 7564 7565@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history 7566The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved 7567in the value history because there is often too much of them and they 7568would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for 7569subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables 7570@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address 7571examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable 7572@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in 7573the convenience variable @code{$__}. 7574 7575If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved 7576are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last 7577address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output. 7578 7579@cindex remote memory comparison 7580@cindex verify remote memory image 7581When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine 7582(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the 7583remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to 7584the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such 7585situations. 7586 7587@table @code 7588@kindex compare-sections 7589@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]} 7590Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the 7591executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in 7592the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no 7593arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's 7594availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"} 7595remote request. 7596@end table 7597 7598@node Auto Display 7599@section Automatic Display 7600@cindex automatic display 7601@cindex display of expressions 7602 7603If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently 7604(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic 7605display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops. 7606Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it; 7607to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number. 7608The automatic display looks like this: 7609 7610@smallexample 76112: foo = 38 76123: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804 7613@end smallexample 7614 7615@noindent 7616This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with 7617displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can 7618specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides 7619whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format 7620specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i} 7621or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}. 7622 7623@table @code 7624@kindex display 7625@item display @var{expr} 7626Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display 7627each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 7628 7629@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 7630 7631@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr} 7632For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or 7633count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but 7634arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}. 7635@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}. 7636 7637@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr} 7638For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a 7639number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to 7640be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect 7641doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 7642@end table 7643 7644For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine 7645instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc} 7646is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 7647 7648@table @code 7649@kindex delete display 7650@kindex undisplay 7651@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{} 7652@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{} 7653Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the 7654numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command 7655argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the 7656numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display; 7657or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 7658 7659@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 7660(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.) 7661 7662@kindex disable display 7663@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 7664Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display 7665item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be 7666enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you 7667want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a 7668single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of 7669the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display 7670numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 7671 7672@kindex enable display 7673@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 7674Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once 7675again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise. 7676Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the 7677command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one 7678of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} 7679display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 7680 7681@item display 7682Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is 7683done when your program stops. 7684 7685@kindex info display 7686@item info display 7687Print the list of expressions previously set up to display 7688automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the 7689values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such. 7690It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now 7691because they refer to automatic variables not currently available. 7692@end table 7693 7694@cindex display disabled out of scope 7695If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make 7696sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an 7697expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its 7698variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command 7699@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument 7700@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program 7701continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where 7702there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled 7703automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char} 7704is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again. 7705 7706@node Print Settings 7707@section Print Settings 7708 7709@cindex format options 7710@cindex print settings 7711@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures, 7712and symbols are printed. 7713 7714@noindent 7715These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language: 7716 7717@table @code 7718@kindex set print 7719@item set print address 7720@itemx set print address on 7721@cindex print/don't print memory addresses 7722@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack 7723traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth, 7724even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default 7725is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with 7726@code{set print address on}: 7727 7728@smallexample 7729@group 7730(@value{GDBP}) f 7731#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>") 7732 at input.c:530 7733530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 7734@end group 7735@end smallexample 7736 7737@item set print address off 7738Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example, 7739this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}: 7740 7741@smallexample 7742@group 7743(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off 7744(@value{GDBP}) f 7745#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530 7746530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 7747@end group 7748@end smallexample 7749 7750You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine 7751dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with 7752@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on 7753all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments. 7754 7755@kindex show print 7756@item show print address 7757Show whether or not addresses are to be printed. 7758@end table 7759 7760When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the 7761closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely 7762identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single 7763source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with 7764@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately, 7765you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when 7766it prints a symbolic address: 7767 7768@table @code 7769@item set print symbol-filename on 7770@cindex source file and line of a symbol 7771@cindex symbol, source file and line 7772Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a 7773symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 7774 7775@item set print symbol-filename off 7776Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the 7777default. 7778 7779@item show print symbol-filename 7780Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and 7781line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 7782@end table 7783 7784Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line 7785numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line 7786number and source file that corresponds to each instruction. 7787 7788Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being 7789printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol: 7790 7791@table @code 7792@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset} 7793@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol 7794Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the 7795offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than 7796@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN} 7797to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it. 7798 7799@item show print max-symbolic-offset 7800Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a 7801symbolic address. 7802@end table 7803 7804@cindex wild pointer, interpreting 7805@cindex pointer, finding referent 7806If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try 7807@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name 7808and source file location of the variable where it points, using 7809@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form. 7810For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points 7811at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}: 7812 7813@smallexample 7814(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on 7815(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt 7816$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c> 7817@end smallexample 7818 7819@quotation 7820@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a} 7821does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with 7822the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on. 7823@end quotation 7824 7825Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed: 7826 7827@table @code 7828@item set print array 7829@itemx set print array on 7830@cindex pretty print arrays 7831Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read, 7832but uses more space. The default is off. 7833 7834@item set print array off 7835Return to compressed format for arrays. 7836 7837@item show print array 7838Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying 7839arrays. 7840 7841@cindex print array indexes 7842@item set print array-indexes 7843@itemx set print array-indexes on 7844Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more 7845convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the 7846index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off. 7847 7848@item set print array-indexes off 7849Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays. 7850 7851@item show print array-indexes 7852Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying 7853arrays. 7854 7855@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements} 7856@cindex number of array elements to print 7857@cindex limit on number of printed array elements 7858Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print. 7859If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has 7860printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command. 7861This limit also applies to the display of strings. 7862When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200. 7863Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited. 7864 7865@item show print elements 7866Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print. 7867If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited. 7868 7869@item set print frame-arguments @var{value} 7870@kindex set print frame-arguments 7871@cindex printing frame argument values 7872@cindex print all frame argument values 7873@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only 7874@cindex do not print frame argument values 7875This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed 7876when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible 7877values are: 7878 7879@table @code 7880@item all 7881The values of all arguments are printed. 7882 7883@item scalars 7884Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more 7885complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced 7886by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where 7887only scalar arguments are shown: 7888 7889@smallexample 7890#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green) 7891 at frame-args.c:23 7892@end smallexample 7893 7894@item none 7895None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument 7896is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes: 7897 7898@smallexample 7899#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{}) 7900 at frame-args.c:23 7901@end smallexample 7902@end table 7903 7904By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used 7905to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless 7906of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value 7907of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of 7908information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable. 7909Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because 7910the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive, 7911especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments} 7912to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation, 7913thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame. 7914 7915@item show print frame-arguments 7916Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame. 7917 7918@item set print repeats 7919@cindex repeated array elements 7920Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array 7921elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an 7922array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string 7923@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of 7924identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements 7925themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to 7926be individually printed. The default threshold is 10. 7927 7928@item show print repeats 7929Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical 7930elements. 7931 7932@item set print null-stop 7933@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays 7934Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first 7935@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually 7936contain only short strings. 7937The default is off. 7938 7939@item show print null-stop 7940Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first 7941@sc{null} character. 7942 7943@item set print pretty on 7944@cindex print structures in indented form 7945@cindex indentation in structure display 7946Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member 7947per line, like this: 7948 7949@smallexample 7950@group 7951$1 = @{ 7952 next = 0x0, 7953 flags = @{ 7954 sweet = 1, 7955 sour = 1 7956 @}, 7957 meat = 0x54 "Pork" 7958@} 7959@end group 7960@end smallexample 7961 7962@item set print pretty off 7963Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this: 7964 7965@smallexample 7966@group 7967$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \ 7968meat = 0x54 "Pork"@} 7969@end group 7970@end smallexample 7971 7972@noindent 7973This is the default format. 7974 7975@item show print pretty 7976Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures. 7977 7978@item set print sevenbit-strings on 7979@cindex eight-bit characters in strings 7980@cindex octal escapes in strings 7981Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set, 7982@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or 7983character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is 7984best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the 7985high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit. 7986 7987@item set print sevenbit-strings off 7988Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more 7989international character sets, and is the default. 7990 7991@item show print sevenbit-strings 7992Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters. 7993 7994@item set print union on 7995@cindex unions in structures, printing 7996Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures 7997and other unions. This is the default setting. 7998 7999@item set print union off 8000Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in 8001structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"} 8002instead. 8003 8004@item show print union 8005Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in 8006structures and other unions. 8007 8008For example, given the declarations 8009 8010@smallexample 8011typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species; 8012typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms; 8013typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@} 8014 Bug_forms; 8015 8016struct thing @{ 8017 Species it; 8018 union @{ 8019 Tree_forms tree; 8020 Bug_forms bug; 8021 @} form; 8022@}; 8023 8024struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@}; 8025@end smallexample 8026 8027@noindent 8028with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print 8029 8030@smallexample 8031$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@} 8032@end smallexample 8033 8034@noindent 8035and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print 8036 8037@smallexample 8038$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@} 8039@end smallexample 8040 8041@noindent 8042@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages 8043and in Pascal. 8044@end table 8045 8046@need 1000 8047@noindent 8048These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs: 8049 8050@table @code 8051@cindex demangling C@t{++} names 8052@item set print demangle 8053@itemx set print demangle on 8054Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded 8055(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe 8056linkage. The default is on. 8057 8058@item show print demangle 8059Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form. 8060 8061@item set print asm-demangle 8062@itemx set print asm-demangle on 8063Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even 8064in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies. 8065The default is off. 8066 8067@item show print asm-demangle 8068Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled 8069or demangled form. 8070 8071@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style 8072@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++} 8073@kindex set demangle-style 8074@item set demangle-style @var{style} 8075Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to 8076represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently: 8077 8078@table @code 8079@item auto 8080Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program. 8081 8082@item gnu 8083Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm. 8084This is the default. 8085 8086@item hp 8087Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm. 8088 8089@item lucid 8090Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm. 8091 8092@item arm 8093Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}. 8094@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow 8095debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would 8096require further enhancement to permit that. 8097 8098@end table 8099If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats. 8100 8101@item show demangle-style 8102Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols. 8103 8104@item set print object 8105@itemx set print object on 8106@cindex derived type of an object, printing 8107@cindex display derived types 8108When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual} 8109(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using 8110the virtual function table. 8111 8112@item set print object off 8113Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the 8114virtual function table. This is the default setting. 8115 8116@item show print object 8117Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed. 8118 8119@item set print static-members 8120@itemx set print static-members on 8121@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects 8122Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on. 8123 8124@item set print static-members off 8125Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. 8126 8127@item show print static-members 8128Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not. 8129 8130@item set print pascal_static-members 8131@itemx set print pascal_static-members on 8132@cindex static members of Pascal objects 8133@cindex Pascal objects, static members display 8134Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on. 8135 8136@item set print pascal_static-members off 8137Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object. 8138 8139@item show print pascal_static-members 8140Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not. 8141 8142@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet. 8143@item set print vtbl 8144@itemx set print vtbl on 8145@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables 8146@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display 8147@cindex VTBL display 8148Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off. 8149(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 8150ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 8151 8152@item set print vtbl off 8153Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. 8154 8155@item show print vtbl 8156Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not. 8157@end table 8158 8159@node Pretty Printing 8160@section Pretty Printing 8161 8162@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using 8163Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This 8164mechanism works for both MI and the CLI. 8165 8166@menu 8167* Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers 8168* Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer 8169* Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands 8170@end menu 8171 8172@node Pretty-Printer Introduction 8173@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction 8174 8175When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer 8176registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the 8177pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally. 8178 8179Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage. 8180The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed 8181pretty-printers with their names. 8182If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its 8183@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types. 8184Each such subprinter has its own name. 8185The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}. 8186 8187Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}. 8188Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding 8189debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to 8190do anything special. 8191 8192There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered. 8193 8194@itemize @bullet 8195@item 8196Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging 8197all inferiors. 8198 8199@item 8200Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only 8201when debugging that program. 8202@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python. 8203 8204@item 8205Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded 8206with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library). 8207@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python. 8208@end itemize 8209 8210@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how 8211pretty-printers are selected, 8212 8213@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers 8214for new types. 8215 8216@node Pretty-Printer Example 8217@subsection Pretty-Printer Example 8218 8219Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer: 8220 8221@smallexample 8222(@value{GDBP}) print s 8223$1 = @{ 8224 static npos = 4294967295, 8225 _M_dataplus = @{ 8226 <std::allocator<char>> = @{ 8227 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{ 8228 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields> 8229 @}, 8230 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, 8231 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider: 8232 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd" 8233 @} 8234@} 8235@end smallexample 8236 8237With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed: 8238 8239@smallexample 8240(@value{GDBP}) print s 8241$2 = "abcd" 8242@end smallexample 8243 8244@node Pretty-Printer Commands 8245@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands 8246@cindex pretty-printer commands 8247 8248@table @code 8249@kindex info pretty-printer 8250@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 8251Print the list of installed pretty-printers. 8252This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such. 8253 8254@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects 8255whose pretty-printers to list. 8256Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file 8257(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}), 8258and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). 8259@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN} 8260looks up a printer from these three objects. 8261 8262@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers 8263to list. 8264 8265@kindex disable pretty-printer 8266@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 8267Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 8268A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later. 8269 8270@kindex enable pretty-printer 8271@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 8272Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 8273@end table 8274 8275Example: 8276 8277Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so 8278named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and 8279another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects, 8280@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}. 8281 8282@smallexample 8283(gdb) info pretty-printer 8284library1.so: 8285 foo 8286library2.so: 8287 bar 8288 bar1 8289 bar2 8290(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 8291library2.so: 8292 bar 8293 bar1 8294 bar2 8295(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1 82961 printer disabled 82972 of 3 printers enabled 8298(gdb) info pretty-printer 8299library1.so: 8300 foo [disabled] 8301library2.so: 8302 bar 8303 bar1 8304 bar2 8305(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1 83061 printer disabled 83071 of 3 printers enabled 8308(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 8309library1.so: 8310 foo [disabled] 8311library2.so: 8312 bar 8313 bar1 [disabled] 8314 bar2 8315(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar 83161 printer disabled 83170 of 3 printers enabled 8318(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 8319library1.so: 8320 foo [disabled] 8321library2.so: 8322 bar [disabled] 8323 bar1 [disabled] 8324 bar2 8325@end smallexample 8326 8327Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled, 8328as can each individual subprinter. 8329 8330@node Value History 8331@section Value History 8332 8333@cindex value history 8334@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN} 8335Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN} 8336@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions. 8337Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded 8338(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands). 8339When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded, 8340since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the 8341symbol table. 8342 8343@cindex @code{$} 8344@cindex @code{$$} 8345@cindex history number 8346The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can 8347refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one. 8348@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by 8349printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the 8350history number. 8351 8352To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's 8353history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to 8354remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in 8355the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that. 8356@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2} 8357is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to 8358@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}. 8359 8360For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and 8361want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type 8362 8363@smallexample 8364p *$ 8365@end smallexample 8366 8367If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points 8368to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this: 8369 8370@smallexample 8371p *$.next 8372@end smallexample 8373 8374@noindent 8375You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this 8376command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}. 8377 8378Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of 8379@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands: 8380 8381@smallexample 8382print x 8383set x=5 8384@end smallexample 8385 8386@noindent 8387then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command 8388remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed. 8389 8390@table @code 8391@kindex show values 8392@item show values 8393Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers. 8394This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show 8395values} does not change the history. 8396 8397@item show values @var{n} 8398Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}. 8399 8400@item show values + 8401Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more 8402values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display. 8403@end table 8404 8405Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the 8406same effect as @samp{show values +}. 8407 8408@node Convenience Vars 8409@section Convenience Variables 8410 8411@cindex convenience variables 8412@cindex user-defined variables 8413@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within 8414@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables 8415exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and 8416setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution 8417of your program. That is why you can use them freely. 8418 8419Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by 8420@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of 8421the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 8422(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded 8423by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.) 8424 8425You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment 8426expression, just as you would set a variable in your program. 8427For example: 8428 8429@smallexample 8430set $foo = *object_ptr 8431@end smallexample 8432 8433@noindent 8434would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by 8435@code{object_ptr}. 8436 8437Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its 8438value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the 8439value with another assignment at any time. 8440 8441Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience 8442variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if 8443that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience 8444variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value. 8445 8446@table @code 8447@kindex show convenience 8448@cindex show all user variables 8449@item show convenience 8450Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values. 8451Abbreviated @code{show conv}. 8452 8453@kindex init-if-undefined 8454@cindex convenience variables, initializing 8455@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression} 8456Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful 8457for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept, 8458to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that 8459convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to 8460override default values used in a command script. 8461 8462If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so 8463any side-effects do not occur. 8464@end table 8465 8466One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be 8467incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print 8468a field from successive elements of an array of structures: 8469 8470@smallexample 8471set $i = 0 8472print bar[$i++]->contents 8473@end smallexample 8474 8475@noindent 8476Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}. 8477 8478Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given 8479values likely to be useful. 8480 8481@table @code 8482@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable} 8483@item $_ 8484The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to 8485the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other 8486commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also 8487set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line} 8488and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *} 8489except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer 8490to the type of @code{$__}. 8491 8492@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable} 8493@item $__ 8494The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command 8495to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen 8496to match the format in which the data was printed. 8497 8498@item $_exitcode 8499@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable} 8500The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when 8501the program being debugged terminates. 8502 8503@item $_sdata 8504@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable} 8505The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint 8506data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that 8507@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or 8508if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected. 8509 8510@item $_siginfo 8511@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable} 8512The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information 8513(@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo} 8514could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals. 8515For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command. 8516 8517@item $_tlb 8518@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable} 8519The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging 8520applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to 8521gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request. 8522@xref{General Query Packets}. 8523This variable contains the address of the thread information block. 8524 8525@end table 8526 8527On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that 8528begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system 8529name first, before it searches for a convenience variable. 8530 8531@cindex convenience functions 8532@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These 8533have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience 8534function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function; 8535however, a convenience function is implemented internally to 8536@value{GDBN}. 8537 8538@table @code 8539@item help function 8540@kindex help function 8541@cindex show all convenience functions 8542Print a list of all convenience functions. 8543@end table 8544 8545@node Registers 8546@section Registers 8547 8548@cindex registers 8549You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables 8550with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different 8551for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on 8552your machine. 8553 8554@table @code 8555@kindex info registers 8556@item info registers 8557Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point 8558and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 8559 8560@kindex info all-registers 8561@cindex floating point registers 8562@item info all-registers 8563Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point 8564and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 8565 8566@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{} 8567Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}. 8568As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to 8569the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on 8570the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}. 8571@end table 8572 8573@cindex stack pointer register 8574@cindex program counter register 8575@cindex process status register 8576@cindex frame pointer register 8577@cindex standard registers 8578@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in 8579expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an 8580architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names 8581@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and 8582the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a 8583pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a 8584register that contains the processor status. For example, 8585you could print the program counter in hex with 8586 8587@smallexample 8588p/x $pc 8589@end smallexample 8590 8591@noindent 8592or print the instruction to be executed next with 8593 8594@smallexample 8595x/i $pc 8596@end smallexample 8597 8598@noindent 8599or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing 8600one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in 8601memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost 8602stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other 8603stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack, 8604regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return}; 8605see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with 8606 8607@smallexample 8608set $sp += 4 8609@end smallexample 8610 8611Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on 8612your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics, 8613so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command 8614shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info 8615registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you 8616can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps} 8617is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register. 8618 8619@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an 8620integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have 8621special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these 8622registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way 8623to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value 8624(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with 8625@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}). 8626 8627Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This 8628means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by 8629the operating system is not the same one that your program normally 8630sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point 8631coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C 8632programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such 8633cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format 8634that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command 8635prints the data in both formats. 8636 8637@cindex SSE registers (x86) 8638@cindex MMX registers (x86) 8639Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted 8640in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines 8641have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed 8642together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such 8643registers in @code{struct} notation: 8644 8645@smallexample 8646(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1 8647$1 = @{ 8648 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@}, 8649 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@}, 8650 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000", 8651 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@}, 8652 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@}, 8653 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@}, 8654 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000 8655@} 8656@end smallexample 8657 8658@noindent 8659To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which 8660view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning 8661value to a @code{struct} member: 8662 8663@smallexample 8664 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF 8665@end smallexample 8666 8667Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame 8668(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the 8669value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in 8670were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the 8671true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost 8672frame (with @samp{frame 0}). 8673 8674However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine 8675code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if 8676@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack 8677frame makes no difference. 8678 8679@node Floating Point Hardware 8680@section Floating Point Hardware 8681@cindex floating point 8682 8683Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give 8684you more information about the status of the floating point hardware. 8685 8686@table @code 8687@kindex info float 8688@item info float 8689Display hardware-dependent information about the floating 8690point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the 8691floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on 8692the ARM and x86 machines. 8693@end table 8694 8695@node Vector Unit 8696@section Vector Unit 8697@cindex vector unit 8698 8699Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you 8700more information about the status of the vector unit. 8701 8702@table @code 8703@kindex info vector 8704@item info vector 8705Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and 8706layout vary depending on the hardware. 8707@end table 8708 8709@node OS Information 8710@section Operating System Auxiliary Information 8711@cindex OS information 8712 8713@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help 8714you debug your program. 8715 8716@cindex @code{ptrace} system call 8717@cindex @code{struct user} contents 8718When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix 8719machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace} 8720system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure, 8721called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the 8722command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data 8723structure. 8724 8725@table @code 8726@item info udot 8727@kindex info udot 8728Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS 8729kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the 8730contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to 8731the @code{examine} command. 8732@end table 8733 8734@cindex auxiliary vector 8735@cindex vector, auxiliary 8736Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at 8737startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you 8738specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of 8739binary values that tell system libraries important details about the 8740hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is 8741identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific. 8742Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities, 8743@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote 8744targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's 8745support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see 8746@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}. 8747 8748@table @code 8749@kindex info auxv 8750@item info auxv 8751Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a 8752live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value 8753numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized 8754tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some 8755pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the 8756most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for 8757an unrecognized tag. 8758@end table 8759 8760On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information 8761and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets, 8762this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the 8763@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}. 8764 8765@table @code 8766@kindex info os 8767@item info os 8768List the types of OS information available for the target. If the 8769target does not return a list of possible types, this command will 8770report an error. 8771 8772@kindex info os processes 8773@item info os processes 8774Display the list of processes on the target. For each process, 8775@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and 8776the command corresponding to the process. 8777@end table 8778 8779@node Memory Region Attributes 8780@section Memory Region Attributes 8781@cindex memory region attributes 8782 8783@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling 8784required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses 8785attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory 8786accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache 8787target memory. By default the description of memory regions is 8788fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the 8789user can override the fetched regions. 8790 8791Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a 8792memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when 8793accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have 8794been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing 8795all memory. 8796 8797When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it; 8798to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number. 8799 8800@table @code 8801@kindex mem 8802@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{} 8803Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with 8804attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions 8805monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special 8806case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address. 8807(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.) 8808 8809@item mem auto 8810Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied 8811regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support. 8812 8813@kindex delete mem 8814@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{} 8815Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions 8816monitored by @value{GDBN}. 8817 8818@kindex disable mem 8819@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 8820Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 8821A disabled memory region is not forgotten. 8822It may be enabled again later. 8823 8824@kindex enable mem 8825@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 8826Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 8827 8828@kindex info mem 8829@item info mem 8830Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns 8831for each region: 8832 8833@table @emph 8834@item Memory Region Number 8835@item Enabled or Disabled. 8836Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}. 8837Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}. 8838 8839@item Lo Address 8840The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region. 8841 8842@item Hi Address 8843The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region. 8844 8845@item Attributes 8846The list of attributes set for this memory region. 8847@end table 8848@end table 8849 8850 8851@subsection Attributes 8852 8853@subsubsection Memory Access Mode 8854The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or 8855write accesses to a memory region. 8856 8857While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid 8858memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA, 8859etc.@: from accessing memory. 8860 8861@table @code 8862@item ro 8863Memory is read only. 8864@item wo 8865Memory is write only. 8866@item rw 8867Memory is read/write. This is the default. 8868@end table 8869 8870@subsubsection Memory Access Size 8871The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized 8872accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers 8873require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is 8874specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size. 8875 8876@table @code 8877@item 8 8878Use 8 bit memory accesses. 8879@item 16 8880Use 16 bit memory accesses. 8881@item 32 8882Use 32 bit memory accesses. 8883@item 64 8884Use 64 bit memory accesses. 8885@end table 8886 8887@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints 8888@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 8889@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints 8890@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands. 8891@c 8892@c @table @code 8893@c @item hwbreak 8894@c Always use hardware breakpoints 8895@c @item swbreak (default) 8896@c @end table 8897 8898@subsubsection Data Cache 8899The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target 8900memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug 8901protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN} 8902does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device 8903registers. 8904 8905@table @code 8906@item cache 8907Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory. 8908@item nocache 8909Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default. 8910@end table 8911 8912@subsection Memory Access Checking 8913@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is 8914not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such 8915regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide 8916better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour. 8917 8918@table @code 8919@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default 8920@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off] 8921If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not 8922explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses 8923to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one 8924memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN} 8925treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM. 8926The default value is @code{on}. 8927@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default 8928@item show mem inaccessible-by-default 8929Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory. 8930@end table 8931 8932 8933@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification 8934@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 8935@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful. 8936@c 8937@c @table @code 8938@c @item verify 8939@c @item noverify (default) 8940@c @end table 8941 8942@node Dump/Restore Files 8943@section Copy Between Memory and a File 8944@cindex dump/restore files 8945@cindex append data to a file 8946@cindex dump data to a file 8947@cindex restore data from a file 8948 8949You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and 8950@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The 8951@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the 8952@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's 8953memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or 8954Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary 8955files. 8956 8957@table @code 8958 8959@kindex dump 8960@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 8961@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 8962Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 8963or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format. 8964 8965The @var{format} parameter may be any one of: 8966@table @code 8967@item binary 8968Raw binary form. 8969@item ihex 8970Intel hex format. 8971@item srec 8972Motorola S-record format. 8973@item tekhex 8974Tektronix Hex format. 8975@end table 8976 8977@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the 8978@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If 8979@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary 8980form. 8981 8982@kindex append 8983@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 8984@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 8985Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 8986or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form. 8987(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.) 8988 8989@kindex restore 8990@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end} 8991Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The 8992@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd} 8993file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you 8994must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename. 8995 8996If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses 8997contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so 8998they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have 8999a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias} 9000from that location. 9001 9002If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between 9003file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored. 9004These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before 9005the @var{bias} argument is applied. 9006 9007@end table 9008 9009@node Core File Generation 9010@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program 9011@cindex dump core from inferior 9012 9013A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory 9014image of a running process and its process status (register values 9015etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that 9016crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes 9017automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by 9018the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in 9019the post-mortem debugging mode. 9020 9021Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you 9022are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state. 9023@value{GDBN} has a special command for that. 9024 9025@table @code 9026@kindex gcore 9027@kindex generate-core-file 9028@item generate-core-file [@var{file}] 9029@itemx gcore [@var{file}] 9030Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument 9031@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not 9032specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where 9033@var{pid} is the inferior process ID. 9034 9035Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of 9036this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390). 9037@end table 9038 9039@node Character Sets 9040@section Character Sets 9041@cindex character sets 9042@cindex charset 9043@cindex translating between character sets 9044@cindex host character set 9045@cindex target character set 9046 9047If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to 9048represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself, 9049@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for 9050you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host 9051character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the 9052@dfn{target character set}. 9053 9054For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which 9055uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s 9056remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program 9057running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set, 9058then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is 9059@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set 9060target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between 9061@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use 9062character and string literals in expressions. 9063 9064@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set 9065the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set 9066target-charset} command, described below. 9067 9068Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set 9069support: 9070 9071@table @code 9072@item set target-charset @var{charset} 9073@kindex set target-charset 9074Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the 9075list of supported target character sets, type 9076@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 9077 9078@item set host-charset @var{charset} 9079@kindex set host-charset 9080Set the current host character set to @var{charset}. 9081 9082By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the 9083system it is running on; you can override that default using the 9084@code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot 9085automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this 9086case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}. 9087 9088@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character 9089set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 9090@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports. 9091 9092@item set charset @var{charset} 9093@kindex set charset 9094Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As 9095above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 9096@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used 9097for both host and target. 9098 9099@item show charset 9100@kindex show charset 9101Show the names of the current host and target character sets. 9102 9103@item show host-charset 9104@kindex show host-charset 9105Show the name of the current host character set. 9106 9107@item show target-charset 9108@kindex show target-charset 9109Show the name of the current target character set. 9110 9111@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset} 9112@kindex set target-wide-charset 9113Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is 9114the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To 9115display the list of supported wide character sets, type 9116@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 9117 9118@item show target-wide-charset 9119@kindex show target-wide-charset 9120Show the name of the current target's wide character set. 9121@end table 9122 9123Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action. 9124Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file 9125@file{charset-test.c}: 9126 9127@smallexample 9128#include <stdio.h> 9129 9130char ascii_hello[] 9131 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119, 9132 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@}; 9133char ibm1047_hello[] 9134 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166, 9135 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@}; 9136 9137main () 9138@{ 9139 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 9140@} 9141@end smallexample 9142 9143In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays 9144containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline, 9145encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets. 9146 9147We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it: 9148 9149@smallexample 9150$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test 9151$ gdb -nw charset-test 9152GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs 9153Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 9154@dots{} 9155(@value{GDBP}) 9156@end smallexample 9157 9158We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets 9159@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and 9160strings: 9161 9162@smallexample 9163(@value{GDBP}) show charset 9164The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'. 9165(@value{GDBP}) 9166@end smallexample 9167 9168For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our 9169initial character set: 9170@smallexample 9171(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII 9172(@value{GDBP}) show charset 9173The current host and target character set is `ASCII'. 9174(@value{GDBP}) 9175@end smallexample 9176 9177Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our 9178host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints 9179characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display 9180them properly. Since our current target character set is also 9181@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly: 9182 9183@smallexample 9184(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 9185$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n" 9186(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 9187$2 = 72 'H' 9188(@value{GDBP}) 9189@end smallexample 9190 9191@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string 9192literals you use in expressions: 9193 9194@smallexample 9195(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 9196$3 = 43 '+' 9197(@value{GDBP}) 9198@end smallexample 9199 9200The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+} 9201character. 9202 9203@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the 9204target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target 9205character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish: 9206 9207@smallexample 9208(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 9209$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%" 9210(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 9211$5 = 200 '\310' 9212(@value{GDBP}) 9213@end smallexample 9214 9215If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, 9216@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports: 9217 9218@smallexample 9219(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 9220ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1 9221(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 9222@end smallexample 9223 9224We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the 9225program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but 9226@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the 9227target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set, 9228@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly: 9229 9230@smallexample 9231(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047 9232(@value{GDBP}) show charset 9233The current host character set is `ASCII'. 9234The current target character set is `IBM1047'. 9235(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 9236$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012" 9237(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 9238$7 = 72 '\110' 9239(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 9240$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n" 9241(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 9242$9 = 200 'H' 9243(@value{GDBP}) 9244@end smallexample 9245 9246As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and 9247string literals you use in expressions: 9248 9249@smallexample 9250(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 9251$10 = 78 '+' 9252(@value{GDBP}) 9253@end smallexample 9254 9255The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+} 9256character. 9257 9258@node Caching Remote Data 9259@section Caching Data of Remote Targets 9260@cindex caching data of remote targets 9261 9262@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a 9263remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves 9264performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by 9265bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply 9266caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN} 9267does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O 9268addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) 9269memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing. 9270Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data 9271known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately 9272rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread 9273in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of 9274stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}. 9275Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as 9276cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}. 9277 9278@table @code 9279@kindex set remotecache 9280@item set remotecache on 9281@itemx set remotecache off 9282This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility 9283with old scripts. 9284 9285@kindex show remotecache 9286@item show remotecache 9287Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag. 9288 9289@kindex set stack-cache 9290@item set stack-cache on 9291@itemx set stack-cache off 9292Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use 9293caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}. 9294 9295@kindex show stack-cache 9296@item show stack-cache 9297Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses. 9298 9299@kindex info dcache 9300@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]} 9301Print the information about the data cache performance. The 9302information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for 9303each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was 9304referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache 9305operation. 9306 9307If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be 9308printed in hex. 9309@end table 9310 9311@node Searching Memory 9312@section Search Memory 9313@cindex searching memory 9314 9315Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the 9316@code{find} command. 9317 9318@table @code 9319@kindex find 9320@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 9321@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 9322Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2}, 9323etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either 9324@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive. 9325@end table 9326 9327@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters. 9328They may be specified in either order, apart or together. 9329 9330@table @r 9331@item @var{s}, search query size 9332The size of each search query value. 9333 9334@table @code 9335@item b 9336bytes 9337@item h 9338halfwords (two bytes) 9339@item w 9340words (four bytes) 9341@item g 9342giant words (eight bytes) 9343@end table 9344 9345All values are interpreted in the current language. 9346This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++} 9347then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'. 9348 9349If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the 9350value's type in the current language. 9351This is useful when one wants to specify the search 9352pattern as a mixture of types. 9353Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages 9354a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42} 9355which is typically four bytes. 9356 9357@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds 9358The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds. 9359@end table 9360 9361You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes 9362 (@code{"}). 9363The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte, 9364regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification. 9365 9366The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the 9367number of matches found. 9368 9369The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable 9370@samp{$_}. 9371A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}. 9372 9373For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function: 9374 9375@smallexample 9376void 9377hello () 9378@{ 9379 static char hello[] = "hello-hello"; 9380 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @} 9381 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed 9382 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @}; 9383 printf ("%s\n", hello); 9384@} 9385@end smallexample 9386 9387@noindent 9388you get during debugging: 9389 9390@smallexample 9391(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello" 93920x804956d <hello.1620+6> 93931 pattern found 9394(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o' 93950x8049567 <hello.1620> 93960x804956d <hello.1620+6> 93972 patterns found 9398(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l' 93990x8049567 <hello.1620> 94001 pattern found 9401(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321 94020x8049560 <mixed.1625> 94031 pattern found 9404(gdb) print $numfound 9405$1 = 1 9406(gdb) print $_ 9407$2 = (void *) 0x8049560 9408@end smallexample 9409 9410@node Optimized Code 9411@chapter Debugging Optimized Code 9412@cindex optimized code, debugging 9413@cindex debugging optimized code 9414 9415Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization 9416disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds 9417directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler 9418applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code 9419diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging 9420information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from 9421the running program back to constructs from your original source. 9422 9423@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you 9424can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the 9425progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases 9426where you may need to debug an optimized version. 9427 9428When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the 9429optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is 9430really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not 9431exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a 9432variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that 9433variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence. 9434 9435Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just 9436@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in 9437doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem, 9438please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!). 9439@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code. 9440 9441@menu 9442* Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining 9443@end menu 9444 9445@node Inline Functions 9446@section Inline Functions 9447@cindex inline functions, debugging 9448 9449@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function 9450body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared 9451routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like 9452non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their 9453arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip 9454them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}. 9455You can check whether a function was inlined by using the 9456@code{info frame} command. 9457 9458For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must 9459record information about inlining in the debug information --- 9460@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several 9461other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions 9462when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1 9463do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and 9464@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined 9465function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead 9466displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as 9467local variables in the caller. 9468 9469The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site; 9470unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to 9471the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the 9472start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to 9473the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows 9474the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional 9475instructions are executed. 9476 9477This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the 9478context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by 9479a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do 9480this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body. 9481 9482There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined 9483function calls are the same as normal calls: 9484 9485@itemize @bullet 9486@item 9487You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN} 9488either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the 9489breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation 9490will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then, 9491set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined 9492function instead. 9493 9494@item 9495Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not 9496work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN} 9497may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing 9498function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future 9499version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line 9500or inside the inlined function instead. 9501 9502@item 9503@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after 9504using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated 9505debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line 9506and print a variable where your program stored the return value. 9507 9508@end itemize 9509 9510 9511@node Macros 9512@chapter C Preprocessor Macros 9513 9514Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke 9515``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens. 9516@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show 9517the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including 9518where it was defined. 9519 9520You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN} 9521with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not 9522include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile 9523with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}. 9524 9525A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later, 9526and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different 9527points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have 9528no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN} 9529uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise, 9530@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location; 9531see @ref{List}. 9532 9533Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any 9534macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides 9535the following commands for working with macros explicitly. 9536 9537@table @code 9538 9539@kindex macro expand 9540@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor 9541@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of 9542@cindex expanding preprocessor macros 9543@item macro expand @var{expression} 9544@itemx macro exp @var{expression} 9545Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in 9546@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does 9547not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; 9548it can be any string of tokens. 9549 9550@kindex macro exp1 9551@item macro expand-once @var{expression} 9552@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression} 9553@cindex expand macro once 9554@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of 9555expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in 9556@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are 9557left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a 9558particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further 9559expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not 9560parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it 9561can be any string of tokens. 9562 9563@kindex info macro 9564@cindex macro definition, showing 9565@cindex definition, showing a macro's 9566@item info macro @var{macro} 9567Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the 9568source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established. 9569 9570@kindex macro define 9571@cindex user-defined macros 9572@cindex defining macros interactively 9573@cindex macros, user-defined 9574@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list} 9575@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list} 9576Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, 9577invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in 9578@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an 9579``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form 9580defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in 9581@var{arglist}. 9582 9583A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every 9584expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the 9585@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides 9586all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, 9587as well as any previous user-supplied definition. 9588 9589@kindex macro undef 9590@item macro undef @var{macro} 9591Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}. 9592This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro 9593define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present 9594in the program being debugged. 9595 9596@kindex macro list 9597@item macro list 9598List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command. 9599@end table 9600 9601@cindex macros, example of debugging with 9602Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we 9603show our source files: 9604 9605@smallexample 9606$ cat sample.c 9607#include <stdio.h> 9608#include "sample.h" 9609 9610#define M 42 9611#define ADD(x) (M + x) 9612 9613main () 9614@{ 9615#define N 28 9616 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 9617#undef N 9618 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 9619#define N 1729 9620 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 9621@} 9622$ cat sample.h 9623#define Q < 9624$ 9625@end smallexample 9626 9627Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}. 9628We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the 9629compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging 9630information. 9631 9632@smallexample 9633$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample 9634$ 9635@end smallexample 9636 9637Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program: 9638 9639@smallexample 9640$ gdb -nw sample 9641GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs 9642Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 9643GDB is free software, @dots{} 9644(@value{GDBP}) 9645@end smallexample 9646 9647We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the 9648program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position 9649to decide which macro definitions are in scope: 9650 9651@smallexample 9652(@value{GDBP}) list main 96533 96544 #define M 42 96555 #define ADD(x) (M + x) 96566 96577 main () 96588 @{ 96599 #define N 28 966010 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 966111 #undef N 966212 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 9663(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD 9664Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5 9665#define ADD(x) (M + x) 9666(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q 9667Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1 9668 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2 9669#define Q < 9670(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1) 9671expands to: (42 + 1) 9672(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1) 9673expands to: once (M + 1) 9674(@value{GDBP}) 9675@end smallexample 9676 9677In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only 9678the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of 9679@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M}, 9680which was introduced by @code{ADD}. 9681 9682Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in 9683force at the source line of the current stack frame: 9684 9685@smallexample 9686(@value{GDBP}) break main 9687Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10. 9688(@value{GDBP}) run 9689Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample 9690 9691Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10 969210 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 9693(@value{GDBP}) 9694@end smallexample 9695 9696At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force: 9697 9698@smallexample 9699(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 9700Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9 9701#define N 28 9702(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 9703expands to: 28 < 42 9704(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 9705$1 = 1 9706(@value{GDBP}) 9707@end smallexample 9708 9709As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then 9710give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack 9711thereof) in force at each point: 9712 9713@smallexample 9714(@value{GDBP}) next 9715Hello, world! 971612 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 9717(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 9718The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro 9719at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12 9720(@value{GDBP}) next 9721We're so creative. 972214 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 9723(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 9724Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13 9725#define N 1729 9726(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 9727expands to: 1729 < 42 9728(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 9729$2 = 0 9730(@value{GDBP}) 9731@end smallexample 9732 9733In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command 9734line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in 9735such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero 9736of the source file submitted to the compiler. 9737 9738@smallexample 9739(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__ 9740Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0 9741-D__STDC__=1 9742(@value{GDBP}) 9743@end smallexample 9744 9745 9746@node Tracepoints 9747@chapter Tracepoints 9748@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael 9749@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni. 9750 9751@cindex tracepoints 9752In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt 9753the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn 9754anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness 9755depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger 9756might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps 9757fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able 9758to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it. 9759 9760Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can 9761specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and 9762arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached. 9763Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values 9764those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The 9765expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays, 9766for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting 9767a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were 9768in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these 9769values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and 9770unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior. 9771 9772The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote 9773targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know 9774how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the 9775remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} 9776support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote 9777packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint 9778Packets}. 9779 9780It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent 9781of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search 9782through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details. 9783 9784This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features. 9785 9786@menu 9787* Set Tracepoints:: 9788* Analyze Collected Data:: 9789* Tracepoint Variables:: 9790* Trace Files:: 9791@end menu 9792 9793@node Set Tracepoints 9794@section Commands to Set Tracepoints 9795 9796Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of 9797tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of 9798breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using 9799standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints, 9800tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many 9801of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number 9802as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on. 9803 9804For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set 9805of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when 9806it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers, 9807local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN} 9808commands to examine the values these data had at the time the 9809tracepoint was hit. 9810 9811Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on 9812tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} 9813commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific 9814either. 9815 9816@cindex fast tracepoints 9817Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in 9818a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is 9819faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed. 9820 9821@cindex static tracepoints 9822@cindex markers, static tracepoints 9823@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints 9824Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning 9825that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location 9826in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static 9827tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of 9828instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in 9829the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or 9830address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate 9831investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s 9832support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation 9833points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level 9834tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of 9835@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting 9836registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation 9837point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables. 9838The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an 9839instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a 9840static tracepoint marker. 9841 9842@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems. 9843@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}. 9844 9845This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated 9846conditions and actions. 9847 9848@menu 9849* Create and Delete Tracepoints:: 9850* Enable and Disable Tracepoints:: 9851* Tracepoint Passcounts:: 9852* Tracepoint Conditions:: 9853* Trace State Variables:: 9854* Tracepoint Actions:: 9855* Listing Tracepoints:: 9856* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers:: 9857* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments:: 9858* Tracepoint Restrictions:: 9859@end menu 9860 9861@node Create and Delete Tracepoints 9862@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints 9863 9864@table @code 9865@cindex set tracepoint 9866@kindex trace 9867@item trace @var{location} 9868The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command. 9869Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or 9870an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The 9871@code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the 9872target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some 9873data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or 9874changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} 9875command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will 9876not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. 9877 9878Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command: 9879 9880@smallexample 9881(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number 9882 9883(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward 9884 9885(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function 9886 9887(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function 9888 9889(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address 9890@end smallexample 9891 9892@noindent 9893You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}. 9894 9895@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond} 9896Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 9897@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only 9898if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 9899@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more 9900information on tracepoint conditions. 9901 9902@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 9903@cindex set fast tracepoint 9904@cindex fast tracepoints, setting 9905@kindex ftrace 9906The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that 9907support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly 9908less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump 9909instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It 9910may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired 9911location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory 9912message. 9913 9914@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for 9915@code{trace}. 9916 9917@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 9918@cindex set static tracepoint 9919@cindex static tracepoints, setting 9920@cindex probe static tracepoint marker 9921@kindex strace 9922The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that 9923support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static 9924instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not 9925be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in 9926which case the command will exit with an explanatory message. 9927 9928@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for 9929@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify 9930@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker 9931identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier 9932depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is 9933using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field 9934of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output. 9935@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint 9936Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST 9937tracing engine: 9938 9939@smallexample 9940main () 9941@{ 9942 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ"); 9943@} 9944@end smallexample 9945 9946@noindent 9947the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the 9948@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to: 9949 9950@smallexample 9951(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 9952Cnt Enb ID Address What 99531 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22 9954 Data: "str %s" 9955[etc...] 9956@end smallexample 9957 9958@noindent 9959so you may probe the marker above with: 9960 9961@smallexample 9962(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33 9963@end smallexample 9964 9965Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect 9966$_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point 9967call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see 9968that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format 9969string. The user data is then the result of running that formating 9970string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info 9971static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in 9972the @samp{Data:} field. 9973 9974You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing 9975the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to 9976@value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. 9977 9978@vindex $tpnum 9979@cindex last tracepoint number 9980@cindex recent tracepoint number 9981@cindex tracepoint number 9982The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number 9983of the most recently set tracepoint. 9984 9985@kindex delete tracepoint 9986@cindex tracepoint deletion 9987@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 9988Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the 9989default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular 9990@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also. 9991 9992Examples: 9993 9994@smallexample 9995(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints 9996 9997(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints 9998@end smallexample 9999 10000@noindent 10001You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}. 10002@end table 10003 10004@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints 10005@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints 10006 10007These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}. 10008 10009@table @code 10010@kindex disable tracepoint 10011@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 10012Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument 10013@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during 10014the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable 10015a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command. 10016 10017@kindex enable tracepoint 10018@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 10019Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled 10020tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is 10021run. 10022@end table 10023 10024@node Tracepoint Passcounts 10025@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts 10026 10027@table @code 10028@kindex passcount 10029@cindex tracepoint pass count 10030@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]} 10031Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to 10032automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is 10033@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on 10034the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number 10035@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the 10036passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is 10037given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the 10038user. 10039 10040Examples: 10041 10042@smallexample 10043(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of 10044@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2} 10045 10046(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the 10047@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.} 10048(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 10049(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3} 10050(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar} 10051(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2} 10052(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz} 10053(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been 10054@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has} 10055@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times} 10056@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.} 10057@end smallexample 10058@end table 10059 10060@node Tracepoint Conditions 10061@subsection Tracepoint Conditions 10062@cindex conditional tracepoints 10063@cindex tracepoint conditions 10064 10065The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program 10066reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for 10067a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 10068programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A 10069tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your 10070program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition 10071is true. 10072 10073Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by 10074using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command. 10075@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can 10076also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command, 10077just as with breakpoints. 10078 10079Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate 10080the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the 10081expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) 10082suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}. 10083Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack 10084accesses, and so forth. 10085 10086For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called 10087frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You 10088could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls 10089of that function that happen while the error code is propagating 10090through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up 10091collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to 10092search through. 10093 10094@smallexample 10095(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0} 10096@end smallexample 10097 10098@node Trace State Variables 10099@subsection Trace State Variables 10100@cindex trace state variables 10101 10102A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is 10103created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as 10104that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''), 10105but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly, 10106using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed 10107integers. 10108 10109Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded 10110to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace 10111experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of 10112trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target. 10113 10114@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables 10115Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use 10116them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience 10117variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target 10118while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share 10119the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you 10120cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or 10121@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience 10122variable with the same name. 10123 10124@table @code 10125 10126@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ] 10127@kindex tvariable 10128The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named 10129@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of 10130@var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is 10131entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible, 10132otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent 10133@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a 10134variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the 10135existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial 10136value. The default initial value is 0. 10137 10138@item info tvariables 10139@kindex info tvariables 10140List all the trace state variables along with their initial values. 10141Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is 10142currently running. 10143 10144@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]} 10145@kindex delete tvariable 10146Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments 10147are specified. 10148 10149@end table 10150 10151@node Tracepoint Actions 10152@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists 10153 10154@table @code 10155@kindex actions 10156@cindex tracepoint actions 10157@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 10158This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the 10159tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not 10160specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most 10161recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say 10162@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the 10163actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and 10164terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So 10165far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and 10166@code{while-stepping}. 10167 10168@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break 10169Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined 10170actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected. 10171 10172@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint 10173To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}} 10174and follow it immediately with @samp{end}. 10175 10176@smallexample 10177(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data 10178 10179(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data 10180 10181(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions. 10182@end smallexample 10183 10184In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect} 10185commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is 10186hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data 10187following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used, 10188followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a 10189sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is 10190terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action 10191list is terminated by an @code{end} command. 10192 10193@smallexample 10194(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 10195(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 10196Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line: 10197> collect bar,baz 10198> collect $regs 10199> while-stepping 12 10200 > collect $pc, arr[i] 10201 > end 10202end 10203@end smallexample 10204 10205@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)} 10206@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 10207Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. 10208This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions. 10209In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following 10210special arguments are supported: 10211 10212@table @code 10213@item $regs 10214Collect all registers. 10215 10216@item $args 10217Collect all function arguments. 10218 10219@item $locals 10220Collect all local variables. 10221 10222@item $_sdata 10223@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect} 10224Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for 10225static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action 10226Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an 10227instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The 10228tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a 10229character string using the format provided by the programmer that 10230instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms. 10231Here's an example of a UST marker call: 10232 10233@smallexample 10234 const char master_name[] = "$your_name"; 10235 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name) 10236@end smallexample 10237 10238In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string 10239@samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can 10240inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to 10241@value{GDBN}. 10242@end table 10243 10244You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one 10245with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several 10246arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same. 10247 10248The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is 10249particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect. 10250 10251@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)} 10252@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 10253Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This 10254command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results 10255are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace 10256state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those 10257values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect} 10258action were used. 10259 10260@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)} 10261@item while-stepping @var{n} 10262Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint, 10263collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping} 10264command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping 10265(followed by its own @code{end} command): 10266 10267@smallexample 10268> while-stepping 12 10269 > collect $regs, myglobal 10270 > end 10271> 10272@end smallexample 10273 10274@noindent 10275Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by 10276@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if 10277you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or 10278@code{stepping}. 10279 10280@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 10281@kindex set default-collect 10282@cindex default collection action 10283This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint 10284hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended 10285to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed 10286individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named 10287@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a 10288local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location. 10289 10290@item show default-collect 10291@kindex show default-collect 10292Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each 10293tracepoint hit. 10294 10295@end table 10296 10297@node Listing Tracepoints 10298@subsection Listing Tracepoints 10299 10300@table @code 10301@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 10302@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 10303@cindex information about tracepoints 10304@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]} 10305Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't 10306specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the 10307tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for 10308@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same 10309command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints. 10310 10311A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to 10312tracing: 10313 10314@itemize @bullet 10315@item 10316its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command 10317@end itemize 10318 10319@smallexample 10320(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace} 10321Num Type Disp Enb Address What 103221 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7 10323 while-stepping 20 10324 collect globfoo, $regs 10325 end 10326 collect globfoo2 10327 end 10328 pass count 1200 10329(@value{GDBP}) 10330@end smallexample 10331 10332@noindent 10333This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}. 10334@end table 10335 10336@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 10337@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 10338 10339@table @code 10340@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers 10341@cindex information about static tracepoint markers 10342@item info static-tracepoint-markers 10343Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the 10344program. 10345 10346For each marker, the following columns are printed: 10347 10348@table @emph 10349@item Count 10350An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a 10351stable identifier. 10352@item ID 10353The marker ID, as reported by the target. 10354@item Enabled or Disabled 10355Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks 10356that are not enabled. 10357@item Address 10358Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address. 10359@item What 10360Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line 10361number. If the debug information included in the program does not 10362allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column 10363will be left blank. 10364@end table 10365 10366@noindent 10367In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker: 10368 10369@table @emph 10370@item Data 10371User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the 10372UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the 10373marker call. 10374@item Static tracepoints probing the marker 10375The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker. 10376@end table 10377 10378@smallexample 10379(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 10380Cnt ID Enb Address What 103811 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25 10382 Data: number1 %d number2 %d 10383 Probed by static tracepoints: #2 103842 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24 10385 Data: str %s 10386(@value{GDBP}) 10387@end smallexample 10388@end table 10389 10390@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 10391@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 10392 10393@table @code 10394@kindex tstart 10395@cindex start a new trace experiment 10396@cindex collected data discarded 10397@item tstart 10398This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and 10399begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all 10400the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace 10401experiment. 10402 10403@kindex tstop 10404@cindex stop a running trace experiment 10405@item tstop 10406This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and 10407stops collecting data. 10408 10409@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop 10410automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached 10411(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full. 10412 10413@kindex tstatus 10414@cindex status of trace data collection 10415@cindex trace experiment, status of 10416@item tstatus 10417This command displays the status of the current trace data 10418collection. 10419@end table 10420 10421Here is an example of the commands we described so far: 10422 10423@smallexample 10424(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test} 10425(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 10426Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line. 10427> collect $regs,$locals,$args 10428> while-stepping 11 10429 > collect $regs 10430 > end 10431> end 10432(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 10433 [time passes @dots{}] 10434(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop} 10435@end smallexample 10436 10437@cindex disconnected tracing 10438You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if 10439@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or 10440involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will 10441ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected 10442terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be 10443unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable 10444@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should 10445continue running without @value{GDBN}. 10446 10447@table @code 10448@item set disconnected-tracing on 10449@itemx set disconnected-tracing off 10450@kindex set disconnected-tracing 10451Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN} 10452has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or 10453@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no 10454matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful 10455for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network. 10456 10457@item show disconnected-tracing 10458@kindex show disconnected-tracing 10459Show the current choice for disconnected tracing. 10460 10461@end table 10462 10463When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not 10464still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the 10465meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running, 10466it will continue after reconnection. 10467 10468Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the 10469tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that 10470information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt 10471to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may 10472have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of 10473the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the 10474debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with 10475which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is 10476necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being 10477created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use. 10478 10479@cindex circular trace buffer 10480If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you 10481can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace 10482buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace 10483frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue 10484collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being 10485hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the 10486buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set 10487@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time, 10488including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change 10489buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until 10490the next run. 10491 10492@table @code 10493@item set circular-trace-buffer on 10494@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off 10495@kindex set circular-trace-buffer 10496Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer 10497for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may 10498fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace 10499data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits. 10500 10501@item show circular-trace-buffer 10502@kindex show circular-trace-buffer 10503Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not 10504match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to 10505match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run, 10506for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file. 10507 10508@end table 10509 10510@node Tracepoint Restrictions 10511@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions 10512 10513@cindex tracepoint restrictions 10514There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As 10515described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target 10516without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of 10517the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data 10518examination time, you will be limited by only having what was 10519collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it 10520is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not 10521mentioned here. 10522 10523@itemize @bullet 10524 10525@item 10526Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus 10527the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available. 10528You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access 10529convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace 10530state variables). Some language features may implicitly call 10531functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore 10532cannot be collected either. 10533 10534@item 10535Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with 10536@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may 10537behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for 10538instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable 10539may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The 10540tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the 10541variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the 10542tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine 10543where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the 10544program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped. 10545 10546@item 10547Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object 10548may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays 10549in a misleading way. 10550 10551@item 10552When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically 10553dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string 10554being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does 10555not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly 10556dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to 10557collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example, 10558@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to 10559by @code{ptr}. 10560 10561@item 10562It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a 10563tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred 10564bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300} 10565(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your 10566target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture). 10567Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when 10568using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined 10569depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that 10570if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the 10571stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an 10572invalid address. 10573 10574@item 10575If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can 10576infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of 10577the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame 10578for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has 10579multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was 10580inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases 10581@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default 10582it to zero. 10583 10584@end itemize 10585 10586@node Analyze Collected Data 10587@section Using the Collected Data 10588 10589After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands 10590for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint 10591collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another 10592snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are 10593consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can 10594examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a 10595specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace 10596snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and 10597registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot, 10598rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being 10599debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands 10600(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will 10601behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was 10602when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in 10603the buffer will fail. 10604 10605@menu 10606* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot 10607* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot 10608* save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run 10609@end menu 10610 10611@node tfind 10612@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}} 10613 10614@kindex tfind 10615@cindex select trace snapshot 10616@cindex find trace snapshot 10617The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is 10618@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n}, 10619counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next 10620snapshot is selected. 10621 10622Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command. 10623 10624@table @code 10625@item tfind start 10626Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for 10627@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot). 10628 10629@item tfind none 10630Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging. 10631 10632@item tfind end 10633Same as @samp{tfind none}. 10634 10635@item tfind 10636No argument means find the next trace snapshot. 10637 10638@item tfind - 10639Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits 10640retracing earlier steps. 10641 10642@item tfind tracepoint @var{num} 10643Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search 10644proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no 10645argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected 10646for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot. 10647 10648@item tfind pc @var{addr} 10649Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the 10650program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace 10651snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next 10652snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot. 10653 10654@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 10655Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of 10656addresses (exclusive). 10657 10658@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 10659Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and 10660@var{addr2} (inclusive). 10661 10662@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n} 10663Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If 10664the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in 10665that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined 10666trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the 10667next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying 10668@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as 10669stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session. 10670@end table 10671 10672The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically 10673designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For 10674instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace 10675snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous 10676trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then 10677simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace 10678snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting 10679@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order. 10680The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot 10681for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with 10682no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter 10683(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with 10684no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same 10685tracepoint as the current one. 10686 10687In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually, 10688these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that 10689scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data 10690you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP 10691registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this: 10692 10693@smallexample 10694(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 10695(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 10696> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \ 10697 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp 10698> tfind 10699> end 10700 10701Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44 10702Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44 10703Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44 10704Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44 10705Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44 10706Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44 10707Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44 10708Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44 10709Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44 10710Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44 10711Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14 10712@end smallexample 10713 10714Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in 10715the buffer: 10716 10717@smallexample 10718(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 10719(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 10720> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X 10721> tfind line 10722> end 10723 10724Frame 0, X = 1 10725Frame 7, X = 2 10726Frame 13, X = 255 10727@end smallexample 10728 10729@node tdump 10730@subsection @code{tdump} 10731@kindex tdump 10732@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint 10733@cindex tracepoint data, display 10734 10735This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at 10736the current trace snapshot. 10737 10738@smallexample 10739(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444} 10740(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 10741Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line: 10742> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test 10743> end 10744 10745(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 10746 10747(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444} 10748#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66) 10749at gdb_test.c:444 10750444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", ) 10751 10752(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump} 10753Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1: 10754d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707 10755d1 0x18 24 10756d2 0x80 128 10757d3 0x33 51 10758d4 0x71aea3d 119204413 10759d5 0x22 34 10760d6 0xe0 224 10761d7 0x380035 3670069 10762a0 0x19e24a 1696330 10763a1 0x3000668 50333288 10764a2 0x100 256 10765a3 0x322000 3284992 10766a4 0x3000698 50333336 10767a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156 10768fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c 10769sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34 10770ps 0x0 0 10771pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8 10772fpcontrol 0x0 0 10773fpstatus 0x0 0 10774fpiaddr 0x0 0 10775p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test" 10776p1 = (void *) 0x11 10777p2 = (void *) 0x22 10778p3 = (void *) 0x33 10779p4 = (void *) 0x44 10780p5 = (void *) 0x55 10781p6 = (void *) 0x66 10782gdb_long_test = 17 '\021' 10783 10784(@value{GDBP}) 10785@end smallexample 10786 10787@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection 10788actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So 10789@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's 10790actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run. 10791 10792Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump} 10793uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace 10794frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were 10795collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether 10796to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the 10797body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected, 10798then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection 10799list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the 10800same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit. 10801@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good. 10802 10803@node save tracepoints 10804@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}} 10805@kindex save tracepoints 10806@kindex save-tracepoints 10807@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions 10808 10809This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with 10810their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 10811suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved 10812tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command 10813Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated 10814alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}} 10815 10816@node Tracepoint Variables 10817@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints 10818@cindex tracepoint variables 10819@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints 10820 10821@table @code 10822@vindex $trace_frame 10823@item (int) $trace_frame 10824The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no 10825snapshot is selected. 10826 10827@vindex $tracepoint 10828@item (int) $tracepoint 10829The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot. 10830 10831@vindex $trace_line 10832@item (int) $trace_line 10833The line number for the current trace snapshot. 10834 10835@vindex $trace_file 10836@item (char []) $trace_file 10837The source file for the current trace snapshot. 10838 10839@vindex $trace_func 10840@item (char []) $trace_func 10841The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}. 10842@end table 10843 10844Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf}, 10845use @code{output} instead. 10846 10847Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for 10848stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their 10849data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables, 10850which are managed by the target. 10851 10852@smallexample 10853(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 10854 10855(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1} 10856> output $trace_file 10857> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint 10858> tfind 10859> end 10860@end smallexample 10861 10862@node Trace Files 10863@section Using Trace Files 10864@cindex trace files 10865 10866In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no 10867longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed 10868for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to 10869dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source 10870of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command. 10871 10872@table @code 10873 10874@kindex tsave 10875@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename} 10876Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command 10877assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if 10878necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and 10879then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the 10880optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save 10881the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be 10882more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that 10883@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.) 10884 10885@kindex target tfile 10886@kindex tfile 10887@item target tfile @var{filename} 10888Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands 10889that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not 10890possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report 10891the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well 10892as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be 10893on a filesystem accessible to the host. 10894 10895@end table 10896 10897@node Overlays 10898@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays 10899@cindex overlays 10900 10901If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's 10902memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this 10903problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that 10904use overlays. 10905 10906@menu 10907* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays. 10908* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}. 10909* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are 10910 mapped by asking the inferior. 10911* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays. 10912@end menu 10913 10914@node How Overlays Work 10915@section How Overlays Work 10916@cindex mapped overlays 10917@cindex unmapped overlays 10918@cindex load address, overlay's 10919@cindex mapped address 10920@cindex overlay area 10921 10922Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64 10923kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by 10924other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory 10925management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to 10926adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system. 10927 10928One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively 10929independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules 10930@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place 10931their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in 10932instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the 10933largest overlay as well. 10934 10935Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that 10936overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside 10937for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point 10938there. 10939 10940@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the 10941@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer 10942@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size. 10943 10944@smallexample 10945@group 10946 Data Instruction Larger 10947Address Space Address Space Address Space 10948+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+ 10949| | | | | | 10950+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1 10951| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address 10952| variables | | program | | +-----------+ 10953| and heap | | | | | | 10954+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2 10955| | +-----------+ | | | load address 10956+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 | 10957 | | | | | | 10958 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+ 10959 address | | | | | | 10960 | overlay | <-' | | | 10961 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3 10962 | | <---. | | load address 10963 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 | 10964 | | | | 10965 +-----------+ | | 10966 +-----------+ 10967 | | 10968 +-----------+ 10969 10970 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay 10971@end group 10972@end smallexample 10973 10974The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data 10975and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies 10976its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space. 10977Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one 10978may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for 10979data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the 10980program variables and heap would share an address space with the main 10981program and the overlay area. 10982 10983An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a 10984@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the 10985instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present) 10986in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address} 10987is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called 10988the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also 10989called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}. 10990 10991Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a 10992program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of 10993global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program: 10994 10995@itemize @bullet 10996 10997@item 10998Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program 10999must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or 11000return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong 11001overlay, and your program will probably crash. 11002 11003@item 11004If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you 11005will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on 11006your program's performance. 11007 11008@item 11009The executable file you load onto your system must contain each 11010overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its 11011mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated 11012and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address. 11013You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation 11014addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,, 11015ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}. 11016 11017@item 11018The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able 11019to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the 11020instruction and data spaces. 11021 11022@end itemize 11023 11024The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be 11025improved in many ways: 11026 11027@itemize @bullet 11028 11029@item 11030If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management 11031hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area 11032contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space. 11033This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped 11034area in the usual way. 11035 11036@item 11037If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one 11038overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time. 11039 11040@item 11041You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In 11042general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than 11043code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or 11044return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access 11045the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you 11046must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a 11047different data overlay into the same mapped area. 11048 11049@end itemize 11050 11051 11052@node Overlay Commands 11053@section Overlay Commands 11054 11055To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must 11056correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's 11057virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's 11058mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows 11059@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or 11060variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not. 11061 11062@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay}; 11063you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are: 11064 11065@table @code 11066@item overlay off 11067@kindex overlay 11068Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is 11069disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are 11070always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s 11071overlay support is disabled. 11072 11073@item overlay manual 11074@cindex manual overlay debugging 11075Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 11076relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not, 11077using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay} 11078commands described below. 11079 11080@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay} 11081@itemx overlay map @var{overlay} 11082@cindex map an overlay 11083Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must 11084be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an 11085overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's 11086functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes 11087that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of 11088@var{overlay} are now unmapped. 11089 11090@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay} 11091@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay} 11092@cindex unmap an overlay 11093Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay} 11094must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. 11095When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the 11096overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses. 11097 11098@item overlay auto 11099Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 11100consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior 11101to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic 11102Overlay Debugging}. 11103 11104@item overlay load-target 11105@itemx overlay load 11106@cindex reloading the overlay table 11107Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN} 11108re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior 11109stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the 11110overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only 11111useful when using automatic overlay debugging. 11112 11113@item overlay list-overlays 11114@itemx overlay list 11115@cindex listing mapped overlays 11116Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped 11117addresses, load addresses, and sizes. 11118 11119@end table 11120 11121Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name 11122of the function the address falls in: 11123 11124@smallexample 11125(@value{GDBP}) print main 11126$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main> 11127@end smallexample 11128@noindent 11129When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in 11130unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with 11131asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an 11132unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way: 11133 11134@smallexample 11135(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 11136No sections are mapped. 11137(@value{GDBP}) print foo 11138$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*> 11139@end smallexample 11140@noindent 11141When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's 11142name normally: 11143 11144@smallexample 11145(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 11146Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034, 11147 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a 11148(@value{GDBP}) print foo 11149$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo> 11150@end smallexample 11151 11152When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct 11153address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the 11154overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like 11155@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped 11156code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations: 11157 11158@itemize @bullet 11159@item 11160@cindex breakpoints in overlays 11161@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in 11162You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as 11163@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address. 11164@item 11165@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in 11166unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your 11167overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if 11168you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its 11169breakpoints properly. 11170@end itemize 11171 11172 11173@node Automatic Overlay Debugging 11174@section Automatic Overlay Debugging 11175@cindex automatic overlay debugging 11176 11177@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which 11178are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the 11179inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the 11180@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN} 11181looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the 11182current state of the overlays. 11183 11184Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support 11185@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging: 11186 11187@table @asis 11188 11189@item @code{_ovly_table}: 11190This variable must be an array of the following structures: 11191 11192@smallexample 11193struct 11194@{ 11195 /* The overlay's mapped address. */ 11196 unsigned long vma; 11197 11198 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */ 11199 unsigned long size; 11200 11201 /* The overlay's load address. */ 11202 unsigned long lma; 11203 11204 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped; 11205 zero otherwise. */ 11206 unsigned long mapped; 11207@} 11208@end smallexample 11209 11210@item @code{_novlys}: 11211This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total 11212number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}. 11213 11214@end table 11215 11216To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN} 11217looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and 11218@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the 11219executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults 11220the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is 11221currently mapped. 11222 11223In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called 11224@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN} 11225will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then 11226calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this 11227will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays 11228are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set 11229in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the 11230overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they 11231are not being executed. 11232 11233@node Overlay Sample Program 11234@section Overlay Sample Program 11235@cindex overlay example program 11236 11237When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays 11238at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped 11239addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay 11240Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately, 11241since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target 11242architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide 11243portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. 11244 11245However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid 11246program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test 11247suite. The program consists of the following files from 11248@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}: 11249 11250@table @file 11251@item overlays.c 11252The main program file. 11253@item ovlymgr.c 11254A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}. 11255@item foo.c 11256@itemx bar.c 11257@itemx baz.c 11258@itemx grbx.c 11259Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}. 11260@item d10v.ld 11261@itemx m32r.ld 11262Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf} 11263and @code{m32r-elf} targets. 11264@end table 11265 11266You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC 11267cross-compiler like this: 11268 11269@smallexample 11270$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c 11271$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c 11272$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c 11273$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c 11274$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c 11275$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c 11276$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \ 11277 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays 11278@end smallexample 11279 11280The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that 11281you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the 11282target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}. 11283 11284 11285@node Languages 11286@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages 11287@cindex languages 11288 11289Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are 11290rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C, 11291dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in 11292Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be 11293represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as 11294@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}. 11295 11296@cindex working language 11297Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages, 11298allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's 11299native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner 11300consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The 11301language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working 11302language}. 11303 11304@menu 11305* Setting:: Switching between source languages 11306* Show:: Displaying the language 11307* Checks:: Type and range checks 11308* Supported Languages:: Supported languages 11309* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages 11310@end menu 11311 11312@node Setting 11313@section Switching Between Source Languages 11314 11315There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN} 11316set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the 11317@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN} 11318defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is 11319used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values 11320are printed, etc. 11321 11322In addition to the working language, every source file that 11323@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object 11324file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular 11325source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the 11326language from the name of the file. The language of a source file 11327controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can 11328show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to 11329set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can 11330set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, , 11331Displaying the Language}. 11332 11333This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such 11334as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in 11335another language. In that case, make the 11336program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way 11337@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original 11338program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code. 11339 11340@menu 11341* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages. 11342* Manually:: Setting the working language manually 11343* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language 11344@end menu 11345 11346@node Filenames 11347@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages 11348 11349If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then 11350@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated. 11351 11352@table @file 11353@item .ada 11354@itemx .ads 11355@itemx .adb 11356@itemx .a 11357Ada source file. 11358 11359@item .c 11360C source file 11361 11362@item .C 11363@itemx .cc 11364@itemx .cp 11365@itemx .cpp 11366@itemx .cxx 11367@itemx .c++ 11368C@t{++} source file 11369 11370@item .d 11371D source file 11372 11373@item .m 11374Objective-C source file 11375 11376@item .f 11377@itemx .F 11378Fortran source file 11379 11380@item .mod 11381Modula-2 source file 11382 11383@item .s 11384@itemx .S 11385Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but 11386@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping. 11387@end table 11388 11389In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename 11390extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}. 11391 11392@node Manually 11393@subsection Setting the Working Language 11394 11395If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, 11396expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and 11397your program. 11398 11399@kindex set language 11400If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the 11401command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of 11402a language, such as 11403@code{c} or @code{modula-2}. 11404For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}. 11405 11406Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working 11407language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try 11408to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the 11409source language, when an expression is acceptable to both 11410languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current 11411source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a 11412command such as: 11413 11414@smallexample 11415print a = b + c 11416@end smallexample 11417 11418@noindent 11419might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add 11420@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result 11421printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare 11422@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value. 11423 11424@node Automatically 11425@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language 11426 11427To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use 11428@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN} 11429then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a 11430frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the 11431working language to the language recorded for the function in that 11432frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function 11433or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that 11434does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is 11435not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning. 11436 11437This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written 11438entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries 11439written in one source language can be used by a main program written in 11440a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this 11441case frees you from having to set the working language manually. 11442 11443@node Show 11444@section Displaying the Language 11445 11446The following commands help you find out which language is the 11447working language, and also what language source files were written in. 11448 11449@table @code 11450@item show language 11451@kindex show language 11452Display the current working language. This is the 11453language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to 11454build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program. 11455 11456@item info frame 11457@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language} 11458Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the 11459working language if you use an identifier from this frame. 11460@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other 11461information listed here. 11462 11463@item info source 11464@kindex info source@r{, show the source language} 11465Display the source language of this source file. 11466@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other 11467information listed here. 11468@end table 11469 11470In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions 11471not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated 11472with a language explicitly: 11473 11474@table @code 11475@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language} 11476@kindex set extension-language 11477Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be 11478assumed as written in the source language @var{language}. 11479 11480@item info extensions 11481@kindex info extensions 11482List all the filename extensions and the associated languages. 11483@end table 11484 11485@node Checks 11486@section Type and Range Checking 11487 11488@quotation 11489@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range 11490checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This 11491section documents the intended facilities. 11492@end quotation 11493@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added 11494 11495Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common 11496errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include 11497checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making 11498sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as 11499these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled 11500by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range 11501errors when your program is running. 11502 11503@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish. 11504Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, 11505it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for 11506evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the 11507working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check 11508automatically based on your program's source language. 11509@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default 11510settings of supported languages. 11511 11512@menu 11513* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking 11514* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking 11515@end menu 11516 11517@cindex type checking 11518@cindex checks, type 11519@node Type Checking 11520@subsection An Overview of Type Checking 11521 11522Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the 11523arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type, 11524otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch 11525errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example, 11526 11527@smallexample 115281 + 2 @result{} 3 11529@exdent but 11530@error{} 1 + 2.3 11531@end smallexample 11532 11533The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not 11534type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3. 11535 11536For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the 11537@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking; 11538to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression; 11539or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur, 11540but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of 11541these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but 11542also issues a warning. 11543 11544Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons 11545related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression. 11546For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and 11547a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do 11548with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as 11549the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway. 11550 11551Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For 11552instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical 11553operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be 11554represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical 11555operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further 11556details on specific languages. 11557 11558@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker: 11559 11560@kindex set check type 11561@kindex show check type 11562@table @code 11563@item set check type auto 11564Set type checking on or off based on the current working language. 11565@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for 11566each language. 11567 11568@item set check type on 11569@itemx set check type off 11570Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the 11571current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not 11572match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in 11573evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a 11574message and aborts evaluation of the expression. 11575 11576@item set check type warn 11577Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to 11578evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still 11579be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add 11580numbers and structures. 11581 11582@item show type 11583Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN} 11584is setting it automatically. 11585@end table 11586 11587@cindex range checking 11588@cindex checks, range 11589@node Range Checking 11590@subsection An Overview of Range Checking 11591 11592In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the 11593bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range 11594checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure 11595computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do 11596not exceed the bounds of the array. 11597 11598For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell 11599@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them, 11600always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue 11601warnings but evaluate the expression anyway. 11602 11603A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an 11604array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member 11605of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an 11606error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the 11607result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is 11608the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then 11609 11610@smallexample 11611@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s} 11612@end smallexample 11613 11614This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases 11615specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, , 11616Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages. 11617 11618@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker: 11619 11620@kindex set check range 11621@kindex show check range 11622@table @code 11623@item set check range auto 11624Set range checking on or off based on the current working language. 11625@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for 11626each language. 11627 11628@item set check range on 11629@itemx set check range off 11630Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the 11631current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not 11632match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on, 11633then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted. 11634 11635@item set check range warn 11636Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error, 11637but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the 11638expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing 11639memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix 11640systems). 11641 11642@item show range 11643Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is 11644being set automatically by @value{GDBN}. 11645@end table 11646 11647@node Supported Languages 11648@section Supported Languages 11649 11650@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal, 11651assembly, Modula-2, and Ada. 11652@c This is false ... 11653Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the 11654language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators, 11655and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions, 11656,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported 11657language. 11658 11659The following sections detail to what degree each source language is 11660supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language 11661tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the 11662@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output 11663formats should look like for different languages. There are many good 11664books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a 11665language reference or tutorial. 11666 11667@menu 11668* C:: C and C@t{++} 11669* D:: D 11670* Objective-C:: Objective-C 11671* OpenCL C:: OpenCL C 11672* Fortran:: Fortran 11673* Pascal:: Pascal 11674* Modula-2:: Modula-2 11675* Ada:: Ada 11676@end menu 11677 11678@node C 11679@subsection C and C@t{++} 11680 11681@cindex C and C@t{++} 11682@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++} 11683 11684Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply 11685to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages 11686together. 11687 11688@cindex C@t{++} 11689@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler 11690@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 11691The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++} 11692compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code 11693effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported 11694C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++} 11695compiler (@code{aCC}). 11696 11697For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging 11698format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging 11699format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++} 11700command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}. 11701@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC, 11702gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}. 11703 11704@menu 11705* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators 11706* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants 11707* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions 11708* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++} 11709* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks 11710* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C 11711* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++} 11712* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format 11713@end menu 11714 11715@node C Operators 11716@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators 11717 11718@cindex C and C@t{++} operators 11719 11720Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 11721@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 11722often defined on groups of types. 11723 11724For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold: 11725 11726@itemize @bullet 11727 11728@item 11729@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class 11730specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}. 11731 11732@item 11733@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and 11734@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform). 11735 11736@item 11737@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}. 11738 11739@item 11740@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above. 11741 11742@end itemize 11743 11744@noindent 11745The following operators are supported. They are listed here 11746in order of increasing precedence: 11747 11748@table @code 11749@item , 11750The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list 11751are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire 11752expression being the last expression evaluated. 11753 11754@item = 11755Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value 11756assigned. Defined on scalar types. 11757 11758@item @var{op}= 11759Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}}, 11760and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}. 11761@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. 11762@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&}, 11763@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}. 11764 11765@item ?: 11766The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought 11767of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an 11768integral type. 11769 11770@item || 11771Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 11772 11773@item && 11774Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 11775 11776@item | 11777Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 11778 11779@item ^ 11780Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 11781 11782@item & 11783Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 11784 11785@item ==@r{, }!= 11786Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these 11787expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true. 11788 11789@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>= 11790Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal. 11791Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false 11792and non-zero for true. 11793 11794@item <<@r{, }>> 11795left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types. 11796 11797@item @@ 11798The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 11799 11800@item +@r{, }- 11801Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and 11802pointer types. 11803 11804@item *@r{, }/@r{, }% 11805Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are 11806defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on 11807integral types. 11808 11809@item ++@r{, }-- 11810Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the 11811operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression; 11812when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the 11813operation takes place. 11814 11815@item * 11816Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as 11817@code{++}. 11818 11819@item & 11820Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}. 11821 11822For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is 11823allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})} 11824to examine the address 11825where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is 11826stored. 11827 11828@item - 11829Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same 11830precedence as @code{++}. 11831 11832@item ! 11833Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 11834@code{++}. 11835 11836@item ~ 11837Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 11838@code{++}. 11839 11840 11841@item .@r{, }-> 11842Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience, 11843@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a 11844pointer based on the stored type information. 11845Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data. 11846 11847@item .*@r{, }->* 11848Dereferences of pointers to members. 11849 11850@item [] 11851Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as 11852@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}. 11853 11854@item () 11855Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}. 11856 11857@item :: 11858C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union}, 11859and @code{class} types. 11860 11861@item :: 11862Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator 11863(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::}, 11864above. 11865@end table 11866 11867If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually 11868attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's 11869predefined meaning. 11870 11871@node C Constants 11872@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants 11873 11874@cindex C and C@t{++} constants 11875 11876@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the 11877following ways: 11878 11879@itemize @bullet 11880@item 11881Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are 11882specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants 11883by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter 11884@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a 11885@code{long} value. 11886 11887@item 11888Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal 11889point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an 11890exponent. An exponent is of the form: 11891@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another 11892sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents. 11893A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or 11894@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of 11895the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with 11896a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double} 11897constant. 11898 11899@item 11900Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their 11901integral equivalents. 11902 11903@item 11904Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes 11905(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character 11906(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may 11907be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of 11908the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation 11909of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where 11910@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example, 11911@samp{\n} for newline. 11912 11913@item 11914String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by 11915double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described 11916above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by 11917a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five 11918characters. 11919 11920@item 11921Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers 11922to constants using the C operator @samp{&}. 11923 11924@item 11925Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{} 11926and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of 11927integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array, 11928and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers. 11929@end itemize 11930 11931@node C Plus Plus Expressions 11932@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions 11933 11934@cindex expressions in C@t{++} 11935@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions. 11936 11937@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs 11938@cindex C@t{++} compilers 11939@cindex debug formats and C@t{++} 11940@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++} 11941@quotation 11942@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the 11943proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN} 11944works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with 11945@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options 11946@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over 11947stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or 11948stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to 11949specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats 11950are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug 11951C@t{++} code. 11952@end quotation 11953 11954@enumerate 11955 11956@cindex member functions 11957@item 11958Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like 11959 11960@smallexample 11961count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y) 11962@end smallexample 11963 11964@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions} 11965@cindex namespace in C@t{++} 11966@item 11967While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your 11968expressions have the same namespace available as the member function; 11969that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance 11970pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. 11971 11972@cindex call overloaded functions 11973@cindex overloaded functions, calling 11974@cindex type conversions in C@t{++} 11975@item 11976You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function 11977call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not 11978perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions, 11979calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist 11980in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or 11981default arguments. 11982 11983It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point 11984promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of 11985class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of 11986functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the 11987number of function arguments. 11988 11989Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified 11990@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus, 11991,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 11992 11993You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an 11994explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in 11995@smallexample 11996p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13) 11997@end smallexample 11998 11999The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this; 12000see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}. 12001 12002@cindex reference declarations 12003@item 12004@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use 12005them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically 12006dereferenced. 12007 12008In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of 12009reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this 12010avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures. 12011The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless 12012you have specified @samp{set print address off}. 12013 12014@item 12015@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your 12016expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since 12017one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if 12018necessary, for example in an expression like 12019@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows 12020resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++} 12021debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}). 12022@end enumerate 12023 12024In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports 12025calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of 12026objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and 12027invoking user-defined operators. 12028 12029@node C Defaults 12030@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults 12031 12032@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults 12033 12034If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they 12035both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to 12036C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 12037selects the working language. 12038 12039If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it 12040recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or 12041@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of 12042these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}. 12043@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language}, 12044for further details. 12045 12046@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b) 12047@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node 12048@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93. 12049 12050@node C Checks 12051@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks 12052 12053@cindex C and C@t{++} checks 12054 12055By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking 12056is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN} 12057considers two variables type equivalent if: 12058 12059@itemize @bullet 12060@item 12061The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or 12062enumerated tag. 12063 12064@item 12065The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been 12066declared equivalent through @code{typedef}. 12067 12068@ignore 12069@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it. 12070@c FIXME--beers? 12071@item 12072The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are 12073declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C 12074compilers.) 12075@end ignore 12076@end itemize 12077 12078Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array 12079indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer 12080that is not itself an array. 12081 12082@node Debugging C 12083@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C 12084 12085The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to 12086the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is 12087inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it 12088appears as @samp{@{...@}}. 12089 12090The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed 12091with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions, 12092,Expressions}. 12093 12094@node Debugging C Plus Plus 12095@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++} 12096 12097@cindex commands for C@t{++} 12098 12099Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are 12100designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary: 12101 12102@table @code 12103@cindex break in overloaded functions 12104@item @r{breakpoint menus} 12105When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded, 12106@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint 12107locations to help you specify which function definition you want. 12108@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}. 12109 12110@cindex overloading in C@t{++} 12111@item rbreak @var{regex} 12112Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting 12113breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 12114classes. 12115@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 12116 12117@cindex C@t{++} exception handling 12118@item catch throw 12119@itemx catch catch 12120Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set 12121Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}. 12122 12123@cindex inheritance 12124@item ptype @var{typename} 12125Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type 12126@var{typename}. 12127@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}. 12128 12129@cindex C@t{++} symbol display 12130@item set print demangle 12131@itemx show print demangle 12132@itemx set print asm-demangle 12133@itemx show print asm-demangle 12134Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when 12135displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies. 12136@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 12137 12138@item set print object 12139@itemx show print object 12140Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects. 12141@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 12142 12143@item set print vtbl 12144@itemx show print vtbl 12145Control the format for printing virtual function tables. 12146@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 12147(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 12148ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 12149 12150@kindex set overload-resolution 12151@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution 12152@item set overload-resolution on 12153Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default 12154is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments 12155and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types, 12156using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus 12157Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details). 12158If it cannot find a match, it emits a message. 12159 12160@item set overload-resolution off 12161Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For 12162overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN} 12163chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the 12164symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For 12165overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN} 12166searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the 12167argument types. 12168 12169@kindex show overload-resolution 12170@item show overload-resolution 12171Show the current setting of overload resolution. 12172 12173@item @r{Overloaded symbol names} 12174You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using 12175the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type 12176@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can 12177also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the 12178available choices, or to finish the type list for you. 12179@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this. 12180@end table 12181 12182@node Decimal Floating Point 12183@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format 12184@cindex decimal floating point format 12185 12186@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in 12187decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the 12188@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as 12189specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic. 12190 12191There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary 12192Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for 12193PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured 12194target. 12195 12196Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN} 12197to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert 12198(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float. 12199 12200In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating 12201point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores 12202underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions. 12203 12204In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers 12205to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. 12206See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details. 12207 12208@node D 12209@subsection D 12210 12211@cindex D 12212@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with 12213GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D 12214specific feature --- dynamic arrays. 12215 12216@node Objective-C 12217@subsection Objective-C 12218 12219@cindex Objective-C 12220This section provides information about some commands and command 12221options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also 12222@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a 12223few more commands specific to Objective-C support. 12224 12225@menu 12226* Method Names in Commands:: 12227* The Print Command with Objective-C:: 12228@end menu 12229 12230@node Method Names in Commands 12231@subsubsection Method Names in Commands 12232 12233The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method 12234names as line specifications: 12235 12236@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C} 12237@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C} 12238@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C} 12239@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C} 12240@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C} 12241@itemize 12242@item @code{clear} 12243@item @code{break} 12244@item @code{info line} 12245@item @code{jump} 12246@item @code{list} 12247@end itemize 12248 12249A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as 12250 12251@smallexample 12252-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}] 12253@end smallexample 12254 12255where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a 12256plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class 12257name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in 12258brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C 12259source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} 12260instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being 12261debugged, enter: 12262 12263@smallexample 12264break -[Fruit create] 12265@end smallexample 12266 12267To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method, 12268enter: 12269 12270@smallexample 12271list +[NSText initialize] 12272@end smallexample 12273 12274In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is 12275required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus 12276sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It 12277is also possible to specify just a method name: 12278 12279@smallexample 12280break create 12281@end smallexample 12282 12283You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If 12284your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method, 12285you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that 12286method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if 12287none apply. 12288 12289As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the 12290@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter: 12291 12292@smallexample 12293clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:] 12294@end smallexample 12295 12296@node The Print Command with Objective-C 12297@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C 12298@cindex Objective-C, print objects 12299@kindex print-object 12300@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})} 12301 12302The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example: 12303 12304@smallexample 12305print -[@var{object} hash] 12306@end smallexample 12307 12308@cindex print an Objective-C object description 12309@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects 12310@noindent 12311will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object} 12312and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added, 12313@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print 12314the description of an object. However, this command may only work 12315with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook 12316function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined. 12317 12318@node OpenCL C 12319@subsection OpenCL C 12320 12321@cindex OpenCL C 12322This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support. 12323 12324@menu 12325* OpenCL C Datatypes:: 12326* OpenCL C Expressions:: 12327* OpenCL C Operators:: 12328@end menu 12329 12330@node OpenCL C Datatypes 12331@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes 12332 12333@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes 12334@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified 12335by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point 12336data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL 12337extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}. 12338 12339@node OpenCL C Expressions 12340@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions 12341 12342@cindex OpenCL C Expressions 12343@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as 12344lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions 12345supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well. 12346 12347@node OpenCL C Operators 12348@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators 12349 12350@cindex OpenCL C Operators 12351@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and 12352vector data types. 12353 12354@node Fortran 12355@subsection Fortran 12356@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN} 12357 12358@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it 12359currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language. 12360 12361@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols 12362Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers 12363among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and 12364functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you 12365will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing 12366underscore. 12367 12368@menu 12369* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions 12370* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran 12371* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran 12372@end menu 12373 12374@node Fortran Operators 12375@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions 12376 12377@cindex Fortran operators and expressions 12378 12379Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 12380@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non- 12381arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types. 12382 12383@table @code 12384@item ** 12385The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power 12386of the second one. 12387 12388@item : 12389The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to 12390represent a section of array. 12391 12392@item % 12393The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived 12394types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran, 12395this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined 12396union type. 12397@end table 12398 12399@node Fortran Defaults 12400@subsubsection Fortran Defaults 12401 12402@cindex Fortran Defaults 12403 12404Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by 12405default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can 12406change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see 12407@ref{Symbols}, for the details. 12408 12409@node Special Fortran Commands 12410@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands 12411 12412@cindex Special Fortran commands 12413 12414@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features, 12415such as displaying common blocks. 12416 12417@table @code 12418@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran 12419@kindex info common 12420@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]} 12421This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON} 12422block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of 12423all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are 12424printed. 12425@end table 12426 12427@node Pascal 12428@subsection Pascal 12429 12430@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations 12431Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 12432nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 12433entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 12434syntax. 12435 12436The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members} 12437controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed. 12438@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}. 12439 12440@node Modula-2 12441@subsection Modula-2 12442 12443@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support 12444 12445The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support 12446output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being 12447developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and 12448attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 12449to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol 12450table. 12451 12452@cindex expressions in Modula-2 12453@menu 12454* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators 12455* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures 12456* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants 12457* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types 12458* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2 12459* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2 12460* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks 12461* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} 12462* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 12463@end menu 12464 12465@node M2 Operators 12466@subsubsection Operators 12467@cindex Modula-2 operators 12468 12469Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 12470@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 12471often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the 12472following definitions hold: 12473 12474@itemize @bullet 12475 12476@item 12477@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and 12478their subranges. 12479 12480@item 12481@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges. 12482 12483@item 12484@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}. 12485 12486@item 12487@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO 12488@var{type}}. 12489 12490@item 12491@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above. 12492 12493@item 12494@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types. 12495 12496@item 12497@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}. 12498@end itemize 12499 12500@noindent 12501The following operators are supported, and appear in order of 12502increasing precedence: 12503 12504@table @code 12505@item , 12506Function argument or array index separator. 12507 12508@item := 12509Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is 12510@var{value}. 12511 12512@item <@r{, }> 12513Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated 12514types. 12515 12516@item <=@r{, }>= 12517Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to 12518on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on 12519set types. Same precedence as @code{<}. 12520 12521@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }# 12522Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types. 12523Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is 12524available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script 12525comment character. 12526 12527@item IN 12528Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members. 12529Same precedence as @code{<}. 12530 12531@item OR 12532Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types. 12533 12534@item AND@r{, }& 12535Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types. 12536 12537@item @@ 12538The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 12539 12540@item +@r{, }- 12541Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union 12542and difference on set types. 12543 12544@item * 12545Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection 12546on set types. 12547 12548@item / 12549Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set 12550types. Same precedence as @code{*}. 12551 12552@item DIV@r{, }MOD 12553Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same 12554precedence as @code{*}. 12555 12556@item - 12557Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data. 12558 12559@item ^ 12560Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. 12561 12562@item NOT 12563Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as 12564@code{^}. 12565 12566@item . 12567@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same 12568precedence as @code{^}. 12569 12570@item [] 12571Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}. 12572 12573@item () 12574Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence 12575as @code{^}. 12576 12577@item ::@r{, }. 12578@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators. 12579@end table 12580 12581@quotation 12582@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN} 12583treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators 12584@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#}, 12585@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error. 12586@end quotation 12587 12588 12589@node Built-In Func/Proc 12590@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures 12591@cindex Modula-2 built-ins 12592 12593Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions. 12594In describing these, the following metavariables are used: 12595 12596@table @var 12597 12598@item a 12599represents an @code{ARRAY} variable. 12600 12601@item c 12602represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable. 12603 12604@item i 12605represents a variable or constant of integral type. 12606 12607@item m 12608represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the 12609same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should 12610be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}). 12611 12612@item n 12613represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type. 12614 12615@item r 12616represents a variable or constant of floating-point type. 12617 12618@item t 12619represents a type. 12620 12621@item v 12622represents a variable. 12623 12624@item x 12625represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the 12626explanation of the function for details. 12627@end table 12628 12629All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below. 12630 12631@table @code 12632@item ABS(@var{n}) 12633Returns the absolute value of @var{n}. 12634 12635@item CAP(@var{c}) 12636If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case 12637equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument. 12638 12639@item CHR(@var{i}) 12640Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 12641 12642@item DEC(@var{v}) 12643Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 12644 12645@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i}) 12646Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 12647new value. 12648 12649@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 12650Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new 12651set. 12652 12653@item FLOAT(@var{i}) 12654Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}. 12655 12656@item HIGH(@var{a}) 12657Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}. 12658 12659@item INC(@var{v}) 12660Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 12661 12662@item INC(@var{v},@var{i}) 12663Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 12664new value. 12665 12666@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 12667Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already 12668there. Returns the new set. 12669 12670@item MAX(@var{t}) 12671Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}. 12672 12673@item MIN(@var{t}) 12674Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}. 12675 12676@item ODD(@var{i}) 12677Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number. 12678 12679@item ORD(@var{x}) 12680Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal 12681value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the 12682@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include 12683integral, character and enumerated types. 12684 12685@item SIZE(@var{x}) 12686Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type. 12687 12688@item TRUNC(@var{r}) 12689Returns the integral part of @var{r}. 12690 12691@item TSIZE(@var{x}) 12692Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type. 12693 12694@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i}) 12695Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 12696@end table 12697 12698@quotation 12699@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so 12700@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as 12701an error. 12702@end quotation 12703 12704@cindex Modula-2 constants 12705@node M2 Constants 12706@subsubsection Constants 12707 12708@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following 12709ways: 12710 12711@itemize @bullet 12712 12713@item 12714Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an 12715expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the 12716rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a 12717trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}. 12718 12719@item 12720Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a 12721decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can 12722then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where 12723@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the 12724digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10) 12725digits. 12726 12727@item 12728Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of 12729like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may 12730also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually) 12731followed by a @samp{C}. 12732 12733@item 12734String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a 12735pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). 12736Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C 12737Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape 12738sequences. 12739 12740@item 12741Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier. 12742 12743@item 12744Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and 12745@code{FALSE}. 12746 12747@item 12748Pointer constants consist of integral values only. 12749 12750@item 12751Set constants are not yet supported. 12752@end itemize 12753 12754@node M2 Types 12755@subsubsection Modula-2 Types 12756@cindex Modula-2 types 12757 12758Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2 12759syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure 12760types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also 12761print the contents of variables declared using these type. 12762This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with 12763sample @value{GDBN} sessions. 12764 12765The first example contains the following section of code: 12766 12767@smallexample 12768VAR 12769 s: SET OF CHAR ; 12770 r: [20..40] ; 12771@end smallexample 12772 12773@noindent 12774and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of 12775@code{r} and @code{s}. 12776 12777@smallexample 12778(@value{GDBP}) print s 12779@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@} 12780(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12781SET OF CHAR 12782(@value{GDBP}) print r 1278321 12784(@value{GDBP}) ptype r 12785[20..40] 12786@end smallexample 12787 12788@noindent 12789Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as: 12790 12791@smallexample 12792VAR 12793 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ; 12794@end smallexample 12795 12796@noindent 12797then you may query the type of @code{s} by: 12798 12799@smallexample 12800(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12801type = SET ['A'..'Z'] 12802@end smallexample 12803 12804@noindent 12805Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set 12806expressions using the debugger. 12807 12808The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2 12809and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents: 12810 12811@smallexample 12812VAR 12813 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ; 12814@end smallexample 12815 12816@smallexample 12817(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12818ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR 12819@end smallexample 12820 12821Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type 12822is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all 12823arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example 12824above. 12825 12826Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples: 12827 12828@smallexample 12829TYPE 12830 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ; 12831 t = [blue..yellow] ; 12832VAR 12833 s: t ; 12834BEGIN 12835 s := blue ; 12836@end smallexample 12837 12838@noindent 12839The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type 12840and value of a variable. 12841 12842@smallexample 12843(@value{GDBP}) print s 12844$1 = blue 12845(@value{GDBP}) ptype t 12846type = [blue..yellow] 12847@end smallexample 12848 12849@noindent 12850In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents 12851displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as 12852their @code{C} counterparts. 12853 12854@smallexample 12855VAR 12856 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 12857BEGIN 12858 s[1] := 1 ; 12859@end smallexample 12860 12861@smallexample 12862(@value{GDBP}) print s 12863$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@} 12864(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12865type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 12866@end smallexample 12867 12868The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands 12869pointer types as shown in this example: 12870 12871@smallexample 12872VAR 12873 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 12874BEGIN 12875 NEW(s) ; 12876 s^[1] := 1 ; 12877@end smallexample 12878 12879@noindent 12880and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}. 12881 12882@smallexample 12883(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12884type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 12885@end smallexample 12886 12887@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example. 12888Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange 12889types: 12890 12891@smallexample 12892TYPE 12893 foo = RECORD 12894 f1: CARDINAL ; 12895 f2: CHAR ; 12896 f3: myarray ; 12897 END ; 12898 12899 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ; 12900 myrange = [-2..2] ; 12901VAR 12902 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ; 12903@end smallexample 12904 12905@noindent 12906and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown 12907below. 12908 12909@smallexample 12910(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 12911type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD 12912 f1 : CARDINAL; 12913 f2 : CHAR; 12914 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL; 12915END 12916@end smallexample 12917 12918@node M2 Defaults 12919@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults 12920@cindex Modula-2 defaults 12921 12922If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they 12923both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to 12924Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 12925selected the working language. 12926 12927If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering 12928code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the 12929working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} 12930Infer the Source Language}, for further details. 12931 12932@node Deviations 12933@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2 12934@cindex Modula-2, deviations from 12935 12936A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug. 12937This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness: 12938 12939@itemize @bullet 12940@item 12941Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by 12942integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during 12943debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a 12944pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified 12945through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that 12946returned a pointer.) 12947 12948@item 12949C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent 12950non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these 12951escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are 12952printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format. 12953 12954@item 12955The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand 12956argument. 12957 12958@item 12959All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument. 12960@end itemize 12961 12962@node M2 Checks 12963@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks 12964@cindex Modula-2 checks 12965 12966@quotation 12967@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or 12968range checking. 12969@end quotation 12970@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added 12971 12972@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if: 12973 12974@itemize @bullet 12975@item 12976They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE 12977@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement 12978 12979@item 12980They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the 12981@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.) 12982@end itemize 12983 12984As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables 12985whose types are not equivalent is an error. 12986 12987Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array 12988index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures. 12989 12990@node M2 Scope 12991@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.} 12992@cindex scope 12993@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator 12994@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator 12995@ifinfo 12996@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2} 12997@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can. 12998@end ifinfo 12999@ifnotinfo 13000@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2} 13001@end ifnotinfo 13002 13003There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator 13004(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have 13005similar syntax: 13006 13007@smallexample 13008 13009@var{module} . @var{id} 13010@var{scope} :: @var{id} 13011@end smallexample 13012 13013@noindent 13014where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure, 13015@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared 13016identifier within your program, except another module. 13017 13018Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope 13019specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not 13020found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes 13021enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}. 13022 13023Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for 13024the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the 13025definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is 13026an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition 13027module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in 13028@var{module}. 13029 13030@node GDB/M2 13031@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 13032 13033Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs. 13034Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply 13035specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle}, 13036@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four 13037apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct 13038analogue in Modula-2. 13039 13040The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available 13041with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its 13042intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be 13043created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an 13044address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct 13045@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful. 13046 13047@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2 13048In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is 13049interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead. 13050 13051@node Ada 13052@subsection Ada 13053@cindex Ada 13054 13055The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support 13056output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler. 13057Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and 13058attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 13059to be difficult. 13060 13061 13062@cindex expressions in Ada 13063@menu 13064* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax 13065 and semantics supported by Ada mode 13066 in @value{GDBN}. 13067* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax. 13068* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax. 13069* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration. 13070* Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks. 13071* Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 13072* Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar 13073 Profile 13074* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode. 13075@end menu 13076 13077@node Ada Mode Intro 13078@subsubsection Introduction 13079@cindex Ada mode, general 13080 13081The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression 13082syntax, with some extensions. 13083The philosophy behind the design of this subset is 13084 13085@itemize @bullet 13086@item 13087That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for 13088arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls, 13089leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the 13090program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}). 13091 13092@item 13093That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions 13094are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user. 13095 13096@item 13097That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user. 13098@end itemize 13099 13100Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in 13101user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible 13102according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most 13103names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes 13104ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent. 13105 13106The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program. 13107As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that 13108was translated from an Ada source file. 13109 13110While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful 13111mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment 13112(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the 13113middle (to allow based literals). 13114 13115The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which 13116the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of 13117actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow 13118the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring 13119procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and 13120functions to procedures elsewhere. 13121 13122@node Omissions from Ada 13123@subsubsection Omissions from Ada 13124@cindex Ada, omissions from 13125 13126Here are the notable omissions from the subset: 13127 13128@itemize @bullet 13129@item 13130Only a subset of the attributes are supported: 13131 13132@itemize @minus 13133@item 13134@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length} 13135 on array objects (not on types and subtypes). 13136 13137@item 13138@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}. 13139 13140@item 13141@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}. 13142 13143@item 13144@t{'Tag}. 13145 13146@item 13147@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right 13148operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator. 13149 13150@item 13151@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and 13152@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension). 13153 13154@item 13155@t{'Address}. 13156@end itemize 13157 13158@item 13159The names in 13160@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and 13161concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are 13162not currently available. 13163 13164@item 13165Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise 13166equality of representations. They will generally work correctly 13167for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types. 13168They may not work correctly for arrays whose element 13169types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values 13170(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative 13171zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with 13172indeterminate values. 13173 13174@item 13175The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or}, 13176@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality) 13177are not implemented. 13178 13179@item 13180@cindex array aggregates (Ada) 13181@cindex record aggregates (Ada) 13182@cindex aggregates (Ada) 13183There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are 13184permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples: 13185 13186@smallexample 13187(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6) 13188(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0) 13189(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6) 13190(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9)) 13191(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True); 13192(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True) 13193@end smallexample 13194 13195Changing a 13196discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an 13197undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record. 13198However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to 13199them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an 13200aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec} 13201declared to have a type such as: 13202 13203@smallexample 13204type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record 13205 Id : Integer; 13206 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len); 13207end record; 13208@end smallexample 13209 13210you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two 13211assignments: 13212 13213@smallexample 13214(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4 13215(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4)) 13216@end smallexample 13217 13218As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual 13219rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the 13220components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len} 13221component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their 13222original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as 13223indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or 13224redundant component associations, although which component values are 13225assigned in such cases is not defined. 13226 13227@item 13228Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented. 13229 13230@item 13231The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective) 13232than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in 13233which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much 13234looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some 13235function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose 13236the proper resolution. 13237 13238@item 13239The @code{new} operator is not implemented. 13240 13241@item 13242Entry calls are not implemented. 13243 13244@item 13245Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point 13246formats are not supported. 13247 13248@item 13249It is not possible to slice a packed array. 13250 13251@item 13252The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name, 13253are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of 13254context. 13255Should your program 13256redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice), 13257you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions. 13258@end itemize 13259 13260@node Additions to Ada 13261@subsubsection Additions to Ada 13262@cindex Ada, deviations from 13263 13264As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic 13265extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}): 13266 13267@itemize @bullet 13268@item 13269If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically 13270a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer, 13271then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the 13272@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In 13273Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is 13274in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in 13275Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in 13276which certain debugging information has been optimized away. 13277 13278@item 13279@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that 13280appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, 13281you must typically surround it in single quotes. 13282 13283@item 13284The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type 13285@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.'' 13286 13287@item 13288A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable 13289(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}). 13290@end itemize 13291 13292In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright 13293additions specific to Ada: 13294 13295@itemize @bullet 13296@item 13297The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning 13298its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter 13299 13300@smallexample 13301(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3 13302(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1) 13303@end smallexample 13304 13305@item 13306The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value 13307the value of its right-hand operand. 13308This allows, for example, 13309complex conditional breaks: 13310 13311@smallexample 13312(@value{GDBP}) break f 13313(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100) 13314@end smallexample 13315 13316@item 13317Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special 13318characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation, 13319which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form 13320@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the 13321(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The 13322sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark 13323in strings. For example, 13324@smallexample 13325 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]" 13326@end smallexample 13327@noindent 13328contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) 13329after each period. 13330 13331@item 13332The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and 13333@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid 13334to write 13335 13336@smallexample 13337(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y) 13338@end smallexample 13339 13340@item 13341When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the 13342array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise. 13343For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound 13344of 3 might print as 13345 13346@smallexample 13347(3 => 10, 17, 1) 13348@end smallexample 13349 13350@noindent 13351That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>} 13352clause. 13353 13354@item 13355You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique, 13356multi-character subsequence of 13357their names (an exact match gets preference). 13358For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh} 13359in place of @t{a'length}. 13360 13361@item 13362@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers 13363Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type 13364to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for 13365some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users. 13366For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them, 13367enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping. 13368For example, 13369@smallexample 13370(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0] 13371@end smallexample 13372 13373@item 13374Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an 13375access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's 13376specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component 13377selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the 13378object. 13379 13380@end itemize 13381 13382@node Stopping Before Main Program 13383@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning 13384 13385@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code 13386It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and 13387before reaching the main procedure. 13388As defined in the Ada Reference 13389Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called 13390@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of 13391elaboration, simply use the following two commands: 13392@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}. 13393 13394@node Ada Tasks 13395@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks 13396@cindex Ada, tasking 13397 13398Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}). 13399@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands: 13400 13401@table @code 13402@kindex info tasks 13403@item info tasks 13404This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example: 13405 13406 13407@smallexample 13408@iftex 13409@leftskip=0.5cm 13410@end iftex 13411(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13412 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13413 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13414 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b 13415 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a 13416* 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c 13417 13418@end smallexample 13419 13420@noindent 13421In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the 13422task currently being inspected. 13423 13424@table @asis 13425@item ID 13426Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number. 13427 13428@item TID 13429The Ada task ID. 13430 13431@item P-ID 13432The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number). 13433 13434@item Pri 13435The base priority of the task. 13436 13437@item State 13438Current state of the task. 13439 13440@table @code 13441@item Unactivated 13442The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be 13443executing. 13444 13445@item Runnable 13446The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting 13447for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode. 13448 13449@item Terminated 13450The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents 13451that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have 13452terminated themselves. 13453 13454@item Child Activation Wait 13455The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation. 13456 13457@item Accept Statement 13458The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement. 13459 13460@item Waiting on entry call 13461The task is waiting on an entry call. 13462 13463@item Async Select Wait 13464The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous 13465select statement. 13466 13467@item Delay Sleep 13468The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay 13469alternative open. 13470 13471@item Child Termination Wait 13472The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is 13473waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or 13474waiting on a terminate Phase. 13475 13476@item Wait Child in Term Alt 13477The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to 13478finish terminating. 13479 13480@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno} 13481The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}. 13482@end table 13483 13484@item Name 13485Name of the task in the program. 13486 13487@end table 13488 13489@kindex info task @var{taskno} 13490@item info task @var{taskno} 13491This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in 13492the following example: 13493@smallexample 13494@iftex 13495@leftskip=0.5cm 13496@end iftex 13497(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13498 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13499 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13500* 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1 13501(@value{GDBP}) info task 2 13502Ada Task: 0x807c468 13503Name: task_1 13504Thread: 0x807f378 13505Parent: 1 (main_task) 13506Base Priority: 15 13507State: Runnable 13508@end smallexample 13509 13510@item task 13511@kindex task@r{ (Ada)} 13512@cindex current Ada task ID 13513This command prints the ID of the current task. 13514 13515@smallexample 13516@iftex 13517@leftskip=0.5cm 13518@end iftex 13519(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13520 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13521 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13522* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 13523(@value{GDBP}) task 13524[Current task is 2] 13525@end smallexample 13526 13527@item task @var{taskno} 13528@cindex Ada task switching 13529This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}} 13530command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging 13531from the current task to the given task. 13532 13533@smallexample 13534@iftex 13535@leftskip=0.5cm 13536@end iftex 13537(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13538 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13539 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13540* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 13541(@value{GDBP}) task 1 13542[Switching to task 1] 13543#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 13544(@value{GDBP}) bt 13545#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 13546#1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait () 13547#2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep () 13548#3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks () 13549#4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5 13550@end smallexample 13551 13552@item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} 13553@itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{} 13554@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada 13555@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada 13556@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)} 13557These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}} 13558command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). 13559@var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described 13560in @ref{Specify Location}. 13561 13562Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command 13563to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 13564particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the 13565numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first 13566column of the @samp{info tasks} display. 13567 13568If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a 13569breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your 13570program. 13571 13572You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 13573well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the 13574breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}). 13575 13576For example, 13577 13578@smallexample 13579@iftex 13580@leftskip=0.5cm 13581@end iftex 13582(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13583 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13584 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13585 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2 13586 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 13587* 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3 13588(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2 13589Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15. 13590(@value{GDBP}) cont 13591Continuing. 13592task # 1 running 13593task # 2 running 13594 13595Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15 1359615 flush; 13597(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 13598 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 13599 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 13600* 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2 13601 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 13602 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3 13603@end smallexample 13604@end table 13605 13606@node Ada Tasks and Core Files 13607@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 13608@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging 13609 13610When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program, 13611tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on 13612the platform being used. 13613For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task 13614switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work 13615as usual. 13616 13617On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some 13618memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting 13619a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write 13620privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}). 13621Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core 13622file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}. 13623 13624@node Ravenscar Profile 13625@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile 13626@cindex Ravenscar Profile 13627 13628The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features, 13629specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time 13630requirements. 13631 13632@table @code 13633@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on 13634@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile 13635@item set ravenscar task-switching on 13636Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 13637Profile. This is the default. 13638 13639@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off 13640@item set ravenscar task-switching off 13641Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 13642Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support 13643for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in 13644the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly. 13645To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started. 13646 13647@kindex show ravenscar task-switching 13648@item show ravenscar task-switching 13649Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program 13650using the Ravenscar Profile. 13651 13652@end table 13653 13654@node Ada Glitches 13655@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode 13656@cindex Ada, problems 13657 13658Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}), 13659we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in 13660@value{GDBN}, 13661some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger 13662and the GNU Ada compiler. 13663 13664@itemize @bullet 13665@item 13666Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in 13667storage are invisible to the debugger. 13668 13669@item 13670Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the 13671argument lists are treated as positional). 13672 13673@item 13674Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger. 13675 13676@item 13677Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using 13678floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on 13679the host machine. 13680 13681@item 13682The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of 13683the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about 13684this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never 13685look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against 13686symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have 13687defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and 13688local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard}, 13689GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens, 13690you can usually resolve the confusion 13691by qualifying the problematic names with package 13692@code{Standard} explicitly. 13693@end itemize 13694 13695Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging 13696information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value 13697of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work 13698around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able 13699to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically 13700enabled. 13701 13702@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 13703@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 13704@table @code 13705 13706@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on 13707Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the 13708value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS} 13709types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for 13710a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler). 13711This is the default. 13712 13713@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off 13714This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN} 13715sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada 13716trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix 13717the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to 13718@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is 13719recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary. 13720 13721@end table 13722 13723@node Unsupported Languages 13724@section Unsupported Languages 13725 13726@cindex unsupported languages 13727@cindex minimal language 13728In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages, 13729@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}. 13730It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set 13731of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide. 13732This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging 13733an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}. 13734 13735If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically 13736select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported 13737language. 13738 13739@node Symbols 13740@chapter Examining the Symbol Table 13741 13742The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the 13743symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your 13744program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and 13745does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your 13746program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN} 13747(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the 13748file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 13749 13750@cindex symbol names 13751@cindex names of symbols 13752@cindex quoting names 13753Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual 13754characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The 13755most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other 13756source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names 13757are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would 13758ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words 13759@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize 13760@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example, 13761 13762@smallexample 13763p 'foo.c'::x 13764@end smallexample 13765 13766@noindent 13767looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}. 13768 13769@table @code 13770@cindex case-insensitive symbol names 13771@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names 13772@kindex set case-sensitive 13773@item set case-sensitive on 13774@itemx set case-sensitive off 13775@itemx set case-sensitive auto 13776Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names 13777with case sensitivity determined by the current source language. 13778Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set 13779case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for 13780case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If 13781you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default 13782suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive 13783matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is 13784case-insensitive matches. 13785 13786@kindex show case-sensitive 13787@item show case-sensitive 13788This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols 13789lookups. 13790 13791@kindex info address 13792@cindex address of a symbol 13793@item info address @var{symbol} 13794Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register 13795variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register 13796local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable 13797is always stored. 13798 13799Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work 13800at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints 13801the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable. 13802 13803@kindex info symbol 13804@cindex symbol from address 13805@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address 13806@item info symbol @var{addr} 13807Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}. 13808If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the 13809nearest symbol and an offset from it: 13810 13811@smallexample 13812(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320 13813_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text 13814@end smallexample 13815 13816@noindent 13817This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use 13818it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address. 13819 13820For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared 13821library containing the symbol is also printed: 13822 13823@smallexample 13824(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225 13825_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out 13826(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf 13827__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6 13828@end smallexample 13829 13830@kindex whatis 13831@item whatis [@var{arg}] 13832Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or 13833a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the 13834last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is 13835not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as 13836assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If 13837@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or 13838for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}}, 13839@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or 13840@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}. 13841@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 13842 13843@kindex ptype 13844@item ptype [@var{arg}] 13845@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a 13846detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type. 13847@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 13848 13849For example, for this variable declaration: 13850 13851@smallexample 13852struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v; 13853@end smallexample 13854 13855@noindent 13856the two commands give this output: 13857 13858@smallexample 13859@group 13860(@value{GDBP}) whatis v 13861type = struct complex 13862(@value{GDBP}) ptype v 13863type = struct complex @{ 13864 double real; 13865 double imag; 13866@} 13867@end group 13868@end smallexample 13869 13870@noindent 13871As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to 13872the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history. 13873 13874@cindex incomplete type 13875Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications 13876of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the 13877program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of 13878the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example, 13879given these declarations: 13880 13881@smallexample 13882 struct foo; 13883 struct foo *fooptr; 13884@end smallexample 13885 13886@noindent 13887but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say: 13888 13889@smallexample 13890 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo 13891 $1 = <incomplete type> 13892@end smallexample 13893 13894@noindent 13895``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not 13896completely specified. 13897 13898@kindex info types 13899@item info types @var{regexp} 13900@itemx info types 13901Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular 13902expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply 13903no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a 13904complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all 13905types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but 13906@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete 13907name is @code{value}. 13908 13909This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like 13910@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it 13911lists all source files where a type is defined. 13912 13913@kindex info scope 13914@cindex local variables 13915@item info scope @var{location} 13916List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command 13917accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or 13918an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local 13919to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for 13920details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example: 13921 13922@smallexample 13923(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler} 13924Scope for command_line_handler: 13925Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4. 13926Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4. 13927Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4. 13928Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4. 13929Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4. 13930Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4. 13931Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4. 13932@end smallexample 13933 13934@noindent 13935This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect 13936during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions, 13937collect}. 13938 13939@kindex info source 13940@item info source 13941Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for 13942the function containing the current point of execution: 13943@itemize @bullet 13944@item 13945the name of the source file, and the directory containing it, 13946@item 13947the directory it was compiled in, 13948@item 13949its length, in lines, 13950@item 13951which programming language it is written in, 13952@item 13953whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and 13954if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and 13955@item 13956whether the debugging information includes information about 13957preprocessor macros. 13958@end itemize 13959 13960 13961@kindex info sources 13962@item info sources 13963Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is 13964debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols 13965have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed. 13966 13967@kindex info functions 13968@item info functions 13969Print the names and data types of all defined functions. 13970 13971@item info functions @var{regexp} 13972Print the names and data types of all defined functions 13973whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}. 13974Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names 13975include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names 13976start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters 13977that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@: 13978@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash. 13979 13980@kindex info variables 13981@item info variables 13982Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined 13983outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables). 13984 13985@item info variables @var{regexp} 13986Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local 13987variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression 13988@var{regexp}. 13989 13990@kindex info classes 13991@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors 13992@item info classes 13993@itemx info classes @var{regexp} 13994Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or 13995(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 13996expression. 13997 13998@kindex info selectors 13999@item info selectors 14000@itemx info selectors @var{regexp} 14001Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or 14002(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 14003expression. 14004 14005@ignore 14006This was never implemented. 14007@kindex info methods 14008@item info methods 14009@itemx info methods @var{regexp} 14010The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined 14011methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a 14012specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many 14013C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output 14014from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The 14015@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those 14016which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}. 14017@end ignore 14018 14019@cindex reloading symbols 14020Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to 14021be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example, 14022in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on 14023running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow 14024@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules: 14025 14026@table @code 14027@kindex set symbol-reloading 14028@item set symbol-reloading on 14029Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an 14030object file with a particular name is seen again. 14031 14032@item set symbol-reloading off 14033Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the 14034same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not 14035running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you 14036should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} 14037may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain 14038several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same 14039name. 14040 14041@kindex show symbol-reloading 14042@item show symbol-reloading 14043Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting. 14044@end table 14045 14046@cindex opaque data types 14047@kindex set opaque-type-resolution 14048@item set opaque-type-resolution on 14049Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type 14050declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or 14051@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one 14052source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in 14053another source file. The default is on. 14054 14055A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until 14056the next time symbols for a file are loaded. 14057 14058@item set opaque-type-resolution off 14059Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type 14060is printed as follows: 14061@smallexample 14062@{<no data fields>@} 14063@end smallexample 14064 14065@kindex show opaque-type-resolution 14066@item show opaque-type-resolution 14067Show whether opaque types are resolved or not. 14068 14069@kindex maint print symbols 14070@cindex symbol dump 14071@kindex maint print psymbols 14072@cindex partial symbol dump 14073@item maint print symbols @var{filename} 14074@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename} 14075@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename} 14076Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}. 14077These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only 14078symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print 14079symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already 14080collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for 14081only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the 14082command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you 14083use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about 14084symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in 14085files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally, 14086@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information 14087required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols. 14088@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how 14089@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}). 14090 14091@kindex maint info symtabs 14092@kindex maint info psymtabs 14093@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables 14094@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 14095@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 14096@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 14097@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 14098@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 14099 14100List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab} 14101structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not 14102given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can 14103copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular 14104structure in more detail. For example: 14105 14106@smallexample 14107(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read 14108@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 14109 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 14110 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 14111 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10) 14112 readin no 14113 fullname (null) 14114 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074 14115 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9) 14116 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882) 14117 dependencies (none) 14118 @} 14119@} 14120(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 14121(@value{GDBP}) 14122@end smallexample 14123@noindent 14124We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains 14125the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable; 14126and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all. 14127If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to 14128read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function: 14129 14130@smallexample 14131(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab 14132Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c, 14133line 1574. 14134(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 14135@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 14136 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 14137 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 14138 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38) 14139 dirname (null) 14140 fullname (null) 14141 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary) 14142 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0) 14143 debugformat DWARF 2 14144 @} 14145@} 14146(@value{GDBP}) 14147@end smallexample 14148@end table 14149 14150 14151@node Altering 14152@chapter Altering Execution 14153 14154Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to 14155find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to 14156correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by 14157experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the 14158program. 14159 14160For example, you can store new values into variables or memory 14161locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different 14162address, or even return prematurely from a function. 14163 14164@menu 14165* Assignment:: Assignment to variables 14166* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address 14167* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal 14168* Returning:: Returning from a function 14169* Calling:: Calling your program's functions 14170* Patching:: Patching your program 14171@end menu 14172 14173@node Assignment 14174@section Assignment to Variables 14175 14176@cindex assignment 14177@cindex setting variables 14178To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression. 14179@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example, 14180 14181@smallexample 14182print x=4 14183@end smallexample 14184 14185@noindent 14186stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the 14187value of the assignment expression (which is 4). 14188@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more 14189information on operators in supported languages. 14190 14191@kindex set variable 14192@cindex variables, setting 14193If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the 14194@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is 14195really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is 14196not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History, 14197,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects. 14198 14199If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command 14200appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set 14201variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical 14202to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your 14203program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set 14204a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the 14205command @code{set width}: 14206 14207@smallexample 14208(@value{GDBP}) whatis width 14209type = double 14210(@value{GDBP}) p width 14211$4 = 13 14212(@value{GDBP}) set width=47 14213Invalid syntax in expression. 14214@end smallexample 14215 14216@noindent 14217The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In 14218order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use 14219 14220@smallexample 14221(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47 14222@end smallexample 14223 14224Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict 14225with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the 14226@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if 14227your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try 14228to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has 14229the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}: 14230 14231@smallexample 14232@group 14233(@value{GDBP}) whatis g 14234type = double 14235(@value{GDBP}) p g 14236$1 = 1 14237(@value{GDBP}) set g=4 14238(@value{GDBP}) p g 14239$2 = 1 14240(@value{GDBP}) r 14241The program being debugged has been started already. 14242Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y 14243Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out 14244"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: 14245 Invalid bfd target. 14246(@value{GDBP}) show g 14247The current BFD target is "=4". 14248@end group 14249@end smallexample 14250 14251@noindent 14252The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the 14253@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable 14254@code{g}, use 14255 14256@smallexample 14257(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4 14258@end smallexample 14259 14260@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can 14261freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa, 14262and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the 14263same length or shorter. 14264@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions? 14265@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990 14266 14267To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}} 14268construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address 14269(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers 14270to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size 14271and representation in memory), and 14272 14273@smallexample 14274set @{int@}0x83040 = 4 14275@end smallexample 14276 14277@noindent 14278stores the value 4 into that memory location. 14279 14280@node Jumping 14281@section Continuing at a Different Address 14282 14283Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where 14284it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at 14285an address of your own choosing, with the following commands: 14286 14287@table @code 14288@kindex jump 14289@item jump @var{linespec} 14290@itemx jump @var{location} 14291Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by 14292@var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a 14293breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the 14294different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common 14295practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with 14296@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 14297 14298The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or 14299the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any 14300register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in 14301a different function from the one currently executing, the results may 14302be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or 14303of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests 14304confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently 14305executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are 14306well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program. 14307@end table 14308 14309@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt. 14310On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump} 14311command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The 14312difference is that this does not start your program running; it only 14313changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For 14314example, 14315 14316@smallexample 14317set $pc = 0x485 14318@end smallexample 14319 14320@noindent 14321makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at 14322address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped. 14323@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}. 14324 14325The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back 14326up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program 14327that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more 14328detail. 14329 14330@c @group 14331@node Signaling 14332@section Giving your Program a Signal 14333@cindex deliver a signal to a program 14334 14335@table @code 14336@kindex signal 14337@item signal @var{signal} 14338Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the 14339signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a 14340signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal 14341SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal. 14342 14343Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without 14344giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of 14345a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the 14346@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a 14347signal. 14348 14349@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time 14350after executing the command. 14351@end table 14352@c @end group 14353 14354Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the 14355@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill} 14356causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on 14357the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command 14358passes the signal directly to your program. 14359 14360 14361@node Returning 14362@section Returning from a Function 14363 14364@table @code 14365@cindex returning from a function 14366@kindex return 14367@item return 14368@itemx return @var{expression} 14369You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return} 14370command. If you give an 14371@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return 14372value. 14373@end table 14374 14375When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame 14376(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the 14377discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to 14378be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}. 14379 14380This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a 14381Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the 14382innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The 14383specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values 14384of functions. 14385 14386The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the 14387program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just 14388returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing 14389and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the 14390selected stack frame returns naturally. 14391 14392@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for 14393the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the 14394type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for 14395OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in 14396CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU 14397registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have 14398specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its 14399current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the 14400assignment into the right register(s). 14401 14402Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always 14403use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the 14404debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the 14405function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long 14406int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1 14407into a @code{long long int}: 14408 14409@smallexample 14410Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29 1441129 return 31; 14412(@value{GDBP}) return -1 14413Make func return now? (y or n) y 14414#0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43 1441543 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ()); 14416(@value{GDBP}) 14417@end smallexample 14418 14419However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the 14420function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type 14421to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value 14422in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example, 14423typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part 14424of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit 14425architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by 14426an appropriate cast explicitly: 14427 14428@smallexample 14429Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func () 14430(@value{GDBP}) return -1 14431Return value type not available for selected stack frame. 14432Please use an explicit cast of the value to return. 14433(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1 14434Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y 14435#0 0x00400526 in main () 14436(@value{GDBP}) 14437@end smallexample 14438 14439@node Calling 14440@section Calling Program Functions 14441 14442@table @code 14443@cindex calling functions 14444@cindex inferior functions, calling 14445@item print @var{expr} 14446Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value. 14447@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being 14448debugged. 14449 14450@kindex call 14451@item call @var{expr} 14452Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void} 14453returned values. 14454 14455You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to 14456execute a function from your program that does not return anything 14457(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output 14458with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise 14459print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the 14460value history. 14461@end table 14462 14463It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or 14464@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in 14465the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens 14466in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command. 14467 14468Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you 14469call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an 14470exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy 14471frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has 14472an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a 14473dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot 14474seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens 14475in that case is controlled by the 14476@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command. 14477 14478@table @code 14479@item set unwindonsignal 14480@kindex set unwindonsignal 14481@cindex unwind stack in called functions 14482@cindex call dummy stack unwinding 14483Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function 14484that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on, 14485@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores 14486the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the 14487default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was 14488received. 14489 14490@item show unwindonsignal 14491@kindex show unwindonsignal 14492Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 14493@value{GDBN}. 14494 14495@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception 14496@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception 14497@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions 14498@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception. 14499Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left 14500unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being 14501debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack 14502it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before 14503the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to 14504the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated. 14505 14506@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception 14507@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception 14508Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 14509@value{GDBN}. 14510 14511@end table 14512 14513@cindex weak alias functions 14514Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias} 14515for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up 14516the type information, including the types of the function arguments, 14517which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly. 14518As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may 14519even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased 14520function instead. 14521 14522@node Patching 14523@section Patching Programs 14524 14525@cindex patching binaries 14526@cindex writing into executables 14527@cindex writing into corefiles 14528 14529By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's 14530executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental 14531alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally 14532patching your program's binary. 14533 14534If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that 14535explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might 14536want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency 14537repairs. 14538 14539@table @code 14540@kindex set write 14541@item set write on 14542@itemx set write off 14543If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and 14544core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write 14545off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only. 14546 14547If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the 14548@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set 14549write}, for your new setting to take effect. 14550 14551@item show write 14552@kindex show write 14553Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing 14554as well as reading. 14555@end table 14556 14557@node GDB Files 14558@chapter @value{GDBN} Files 14559 14560@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged, 14561both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your 14562program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell 14563@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file. 14564 14565@menu 14566* Files:: Commands to specify files 14567* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files 14568* Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB 14569* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files 14570* Data Files:: GDB data files 14571@end menu 14572 14573@node Files 14574@section Commands to Specify Files 14575 14576@cindex symbol table 14577@cindex core dump file 14578 14579You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual 14580way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to 14581@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and 14582Out of @value{GDBN}}). 14583 14584Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a 14585@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to 14586specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target 14587via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver} 14588Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify 14589new files are useful. 14590 14591@table @code 14592@cindex executable file 14593@kindex file 14594@item file @var{filename} 14595Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its 14596symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program 14597executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a 14598directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory, 14599@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of 14600directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program 14601to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN} 14602and your program, using the @code{path} command. 14603 14604@cindex unlinked object files 14605@cindex patching object files 14606You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using 14607the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object 14608file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also, 14609if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use 14610@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note 14611that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this 14612case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to 14613the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time. 14614 14615@item file 14616@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it 14617has on both executable file and the symbol table. 14618 14619@kindex exec-file 14620@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 14621Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found 14622in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH} 14623if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to 14624discard information on the executable file. 14625 14626@kindex symbol-file 14627@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 14628Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is 14629searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol 14630table and program to run from the same file. 14631 14632@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your 14633program's symbol table. 14634 14635The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of 14636some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may 14637contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types, 14638which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside 14639@value{GDBN}. 14640 14641@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 14642executing it once. 14643 14644When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it 14645understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard 14646generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or 14647other compilers that adhere to the local conventions. 14648Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example, 14649using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for 14650optimized code. 14651 14652For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems 14653using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the 14654symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table 14655quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The 14656details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed. 14657 14658The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN} 14659start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for 14660occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source 14661file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these 14662pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional 14663Warnings and Messages}.) 14664 14665We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the 14666symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the 14667symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF'' 14668still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually 14669in stabs format. 14670 14671@kindex readnow 14672@cindex reading symbols immediately 14673@cindex symbols, reading immediately 14674@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 14675@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 14676You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol 14677tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that 14678load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the 14679entire symbol table available. 14680 14681@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in 14682@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in 14683@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing 14684@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now 14685@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy 14686@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol 14687@c files. 14688 14689@kindex core-file 14690@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 14691@itemx core 14692Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents 14693of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the 14694address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the 14695executable file itself for other parts. 14696 14697@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is 14698to be used. 14699 14700Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running 14701under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you 14702wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which 14703the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command 14704(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}). 14705 14706@kindex add-symbol-file 14707@cindex dynamic linking 14708@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} 14709@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} 14710@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{} 14711The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table 14712information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command 14713when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) 14714into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory 14715address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure 14716this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number 14717of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit 14718section name and base address for that section. You can specify any 14719@var{address} as an expression. 14720 14721The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table 14722originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the 14723@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data 14724thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data 14725instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments. 14726 14727@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from 14728@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from 14729@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files 14730@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files 14731@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from 14732Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an 14733executable file, or some other object file which has been fully 14734relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic 14735information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as: 14736 14737@itemize @bullet 14738@item 14739the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in 14740that file, not to symbols defined by other object files, 14741@item 14742every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually 14743been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and 14744@item 14745you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and 14746provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 14747@end itemize 14748 14749@noindent 14750Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load 14751relocatable files into an already running program; such systems 14752typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's 14753important to recognize that many native systems use complex link 14754procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table 14755assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In 14756general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a 14757relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect 14758as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal 14759way. 14760 14761@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 14762 14763@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory 14764@cindex @code{syscall DSO} 14765@cindex load symbols from memory 14766@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address} 14767Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded 14768object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory. 14769For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each 14770process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for 14771some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose 14772evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header. 14773For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or 14774@code{exec-file} commands in advance. 14775 14776@kindex add-shared-symbol-files 14777@kindex assf 14778@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file} 14779@itemx assf @var{library-file} 14780The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only 14781in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an 14782alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}). 14783@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if 14784@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke 14785@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared 14786library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for 14787@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. 14788 14789@kindex section 14790@item section @var{section} @var{addr} 14791The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named 14792@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the 14793exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the 14794@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file 14795itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The 14796@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and 14797their addresses. 14798 14799@kindex info files 14800@kindex info target 14801@item info files 14802@itemx info target 14803@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the 14804current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}), 14805including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in 14806use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The 14807command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than 14808current ones. 14809 14810@kindex maint info sections 14811@item maint info sections 14812Another command that can give you extra information about program sections 14813is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information 14814displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file 14815offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition, 14816@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which 14817may be arbitrarily combined): 14818 14819@table @code 14820@item ALLOBJ 14821Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries. 14822@item @var{sections} 14823Display info only for named @var{sections}. 14824@item @var{section-flags} 14825Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true. 14826The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are: 14827@table @code 14828@item ALLOC 14829Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded. 14830Set for all sections except those containing debug information. 14831@item LOAD 14832Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory. 14833Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections. 14834@item RELOC 14835Section needs to be relocated before loading. 14836@item READONLY 14837Section cannot be modified by the child process. 14838@item CODE 14839Section contains executable code only. 14840@item DATA 14841Section contains data only (no executable code). 14842@item ROM 14843Section will reside in ROM. 14844@item CONSTRUCTOR 14845Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists. 14846@item HAS_CONTENTS 14847Section is not empty. 14848@item NEVER_LOAD 14849An instruction to the linker to not output the section. 14850@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY 14851A notification to the linker that the section contains 14852COFF shared library information. 14853@item IS_COMMON 14854Section contains common symbols. 14855@end table 14856@end table 14857@kindex set trust-readonly-sections 14858@cindex read-only sections 14859@item set trust-readonly-sections on 14860Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file 14861really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change). 14862In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections 14863out of the object file, rather than from the target program. 14864For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant 14865enhancement to debugging performance. 14866 14867The default is off. 14868 14869@item set trust-readonly-sections off 14870Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that 14871the contents of the section might change while the program is running, 14872and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed. 14873 14874@item show trust-readonly-sections 14875Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections. 14876@end table 14877 14878All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names 14879as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file 14880name and remembers it that way. 14881 14882@cindex shared libraries 14883@anchor{Shared Libraries} 14884@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix, 14885and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries. 14886 14887On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support 14888shared libraries. @xref{Expat}. 14889 14890@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries 14891when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file. 14892(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand 14893references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are 14894debugging a core file). 14895 14896On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN} 14897automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call. 14898 14899@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef 14900@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared 14901@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual 14902 14903There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load 14904symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are 14905particularly large or there are many of them. 14906 14907To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the 14908commands: 14909 14910@table @code 14911@kindex set auto-solib-add 14912@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode} 14913If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries 14914will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you 14915attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker 14916informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode} 14917is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the 14918@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}. 14919 14920@cindex memory used for symbol tables 14921If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that 14922takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN} 14923memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the 14924symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set 14925auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each 14926library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary 14927@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches 14928the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded. 14929 14930@kindex show auto-solib-add 14931@item show auto-solib-add 14932Display the current autoloading mode. 14933@end table 14934 14935@cindex load shared library 14936To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary} 14937command: 14938 14939@table @code 14940@kindex info sharedlibrary 14941@kindex info share 14942@item info share @var{regex} 14943@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex} 14944Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded 14945that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print 14946all shared libraries that are loaded. 14947 14948@kindex sharedlibrary 14949@kindex share 14950@item sharedlibrary @var{regex} 14951@itemx share @var{regex} 14952Load shared object library symbols for files matching a 14953Unix regular expression. 14954As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries 14955required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If 14956@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are 14957loaded. 14958 14959@item nosharedlibrary 14960@kindex nosharedlibrary 14961@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries 14962Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols 14963that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared 14964libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not 14965discarded. 14966@end table 14967 14968Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control 14969when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set 14970stop-on-solib-events} command for this: 14971 14972@table @code 14973@item set stop-on-solib-events 14974@kindex set stop-on-solib-events 14975This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control 14976when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event. 14977The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new 14978shared library. 14979 14980@item show stop-on-solib-events 14981@kindex show stop-on-solib-events 14982Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared 14983library events happen. 14984@end table 14985 14986Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging 14987configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries; 14988this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries 14989on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the 14990libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are 14991provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the 14992copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are 14993not. 14994 14995@cindex where to look for shared libraries 14996For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target 14997libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it 14998may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables 14999to specify the search directories for target libraries. 15000 15001@table @code 15002@cindex prefix for shared library file names 15003@cindex system root, alternate 15004@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix 15005@kindex set sysroot 15006@item set sysroot @var{path} 15007Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any 15008absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many 15009runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the 15010target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared 15011libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on 15012the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy 15013under @var{path}. 15014 15015If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will 15016retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only 15017supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get} 15018command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). 15019The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:} 15020(if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system. 15021@footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory 15022that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent 15023variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.} 15024 15025For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and 15026SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target 15027absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts, 15028@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward 15029slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix: 15030 15031@smallexample 15032 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll 15033@end smallexample 15034 15035Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with 15036@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file 15037system: 15038 15039@smallexample 15040 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll 15041@end smallexample 15042 15043If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing 15044the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and, 15045for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with 15046colons: 15047 15048@smallexample 15049 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll 15050@end smallexample 15051 15052This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target 15053with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local 15054copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs 15055@samp{z}): 15056 15057@smallexample 15058 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll} 15059 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll} 15060 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll} 15061@end smallexample 15062 15063@noindent 15064and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that 15065@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both 15066@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}. 15067 15068If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries 15069removing the whole drive spec from the target file name: 15070 15071@smallexample 15072 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll 15073@end smallexample 15074 15075This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name, 15076if you don't want or need to. 15077 15078The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set 15079sysroot}. 15080 15081@cindex default system root 15082@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot} 15083You can set the default system root by using the configure-time 15084@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside 15085@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 15086@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated 15087automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 15088location. 15089 15090@kindex show sysroot 15091@item show sysroot 15092Display the current shared library prefix. 15093 15094@kindex set solib-search-path 15095@item set solib-search-path @var{path} 15096If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 15097directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} 15098is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the 15099path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to 15100use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set 15101@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from 15102finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting 15103it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading 15104of shared library symbols. 15105 15106@kindex show solib-search-path 15107@item show solib-search-path 15108Display the current shared library search path. 15109 15110@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names. 15111@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto) 15112@kindex show target-file-system-kind 15113@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind} 15114Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names. 15115 15116Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not 15117make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For 15118example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file 15119system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to 15120@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as 15121@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of 15122drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as 15123indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash 15124normally considered a directory separator character. In that case, 15125the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name 15126as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make 15127it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's 15128shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical 15129with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting 15130@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN} 15131to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to 15132map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system 15133semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition 15134to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN} 15135tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the 15136current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the 15137Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are: 15138 15139@table @code 15140@item unix 15141Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix 15142kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character 15143are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also 15144the forward slash. 15145 15146@item dos-based 15147Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based. 15148File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter 15149followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and 15150both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are 15151considered directory separators. 15152 15153@item auto 15154Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the 15155target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 15156This is the default. 15157@end table 15158@end table 15159 15160 15161@node Separate Debug Files 15162@section Debugging Information in Separate Files 15163@cindex separate debugging information files 15164@cindex debugging information in separate files 15165@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories 15166@cindex debugging information directory, global 15167@cindex global debugging information directory 15168@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files 15169@cindex @file{.build-id} directory 15170 15171@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a 15172file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows 15173@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically. 15174Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger 15175than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging 15176information for their executables in separate files, which users can 15177install only when they need to debug a problem. 15178 15179@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info 15180file: 15181 15182@itemize @bullet 15183@item 15184The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of 15185the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is 15186usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the 15187name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories 15188(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the 15189debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC) 15190checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that 15191the executable and the debug file came from the same build. 15192 15193@item 15194The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is 15195also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported 15196only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format 15197for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about 15198this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id} 15199command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info, 15200The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified 15201explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see 15202below. 15203@end itemize 15204 15205Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN} 15206uses two different methods of looking for the debug file: 15207 15208@itemize @bullet 15209@item 15210For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in 15211the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that 15212directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug 15213directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading 15214directories of the executable's absolute file name. 15215 15216@item 15217For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the 15218@file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file 15219named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the 15220first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn} 15221are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more 15222hex characters, not 10.) 15223@end itemize 15224 15225So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug 15226@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the 15227file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is 15228@code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is 15229@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following 15230debug information files, in the indicated order: 15231 15232@itemize @minus 15233@item 15234@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug} 15235@item 15236@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug} 15237@item 15238@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug} 15239@item 15240@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}. 15241@end itemize 15242 15243You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the 15244name @value{GDBN} is currently using. 15245 15246@table @code 15247 15248@kindex set debug-file-directory 15249@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories} 15250Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 15251information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set 15252concatenating them by a directory separator. 15253 15254@kindex show debug-file-directory 15255@item show debug-file-directory 15256Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 15257information files. 15258 15259@end table 15260 15261@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections 15262@cindex debug link sections 15263A debug link is a special section of the executable file named 15264@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain: 15265 15266@itemize 15267@item 15268A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by 15269a zero byte, 15270@item 15271zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte 15272boundary within the section, and 15273@item 15274a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the 15275executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging 15276information file's full contents by the function given below, passing 15277zero as the @var{crc} argument. 15278@end itemize 15279 15280Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can 15281contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents 15282described above. 15283 15284@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections 15285@cindex build ID sections 15286The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other 15287ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is 15288often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory. 15289It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains 15290the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default 15291algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the 15292content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical 15293value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its 15294stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file. 15295 15296The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary 15297executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and 15298debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file 15299should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file, 15300but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section 15301in an ordinary executable. 15302 15303The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the 15304@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce 15305the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the 15306following commands: 15307 15308@smallexample 15309@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug} 15310@kbd{strip -g foo} 15311@end smallexample 15312 15313@noindent 15314These commands remove the debugging 15315information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file 15316@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the 15317two files: 15318 15319@itemize @bullet 15320@item 15321The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave 15322behind a debug link in @file{foo}: 15323 15324@smallexample 15325@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo} 15326@end smallexample 15327 15328Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains 15329a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f 15330foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and 15331the @code{ln -s} command above, together. 15332 15333@item 15334Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or 15335the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus 15336compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary 15337utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18. 15338@end itemize 15339 15340@noindent 15341 15342@cindex CRC algorithm definition 15343The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in 15344IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial: 15345 15346@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex 15347@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using 15348@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2 15349@c different ways! 15350@ifhtml 15351@display 15352@html 15353 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup> 15354 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1 15355@end html 15356@end display 15357@end ifhtml 15358@ifnothtml 15359@display 15360 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}} 15361 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1} 15362@end display 15363@end ifnothtml 15364 15365The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least 15366significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern 15367@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and 15368the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the 15369CRC. 15370 15371@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the 15372@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol, 15373, @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the 15374case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most} 15375significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing 15376zeros have no effect on the CRC value. 15377 15378To complete the description, we show below the code of the function 15379which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the 15380initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to 15381this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using 15382@code{0xffffffff}. 15383 15384@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32 15385@smallexample 15386unsigned long 15387gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc, 15388 unsigned char *buf, size_t len) 15389@{ 15390 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] = 15391 @{ 15392 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419, 15393 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4, 15394 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07, 15395 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de, 15396 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856, 15397 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9, 15398 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4, 15399 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b, 15400 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3, 15401 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a, 15402 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599, 15403 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924, 15404 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190, 15405 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f, 15406 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e, 15407 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01, 15408 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed, 15409 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950, 15410 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3, 15411 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2, 15412 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a, 15413 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5, 15414 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010, 15415 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f, 15416 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17, 15417 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6, 15418 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615, 15419 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8, 15420 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344, 15421 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb, 15422 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a, 15423 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5, 15424 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1, 15425 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c, 15426 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef, 15427 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236, 15428 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe, 15429 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31, 15430 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c, 15431 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713, 15432 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b, 15433 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242, 15434 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1, 15435 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c, 15436 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278, 15437 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7, 15438 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66, 15439 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9, 15440 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605, 15441 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8, 15442 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b, 15443 0x2d02ef8d 15444 @}; 15445 unsigned char *end; 15446 15447 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff; 15448 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf) 15449 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8); 15450 return ~crc & 0xffffffff; 15451@} 15452@end smallexample 15453 15454@noindent 15455This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method. 15456 15457 15458@node Index Files 15459@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN} 15460@cindex index files 15461@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section 15462 15463When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the 15464file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most 15465@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early 15466on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so 15467@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up 15468startup. 15469 15470The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can 15471write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file 15472using @command{objcopy}. 15473 15474To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command: 15475 15476@table @code 15477@item save gdb-index @var{directory} 15478@kindex save gdb-index 15479Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by 15480@value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file, 15481with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given 15482@var{directory}. 15483@end table 15484 15485Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol 15486file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}: 15487 15488@smallexample 15489$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \ 15490 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile 15491@end smallexample 15492 15493There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when 15494for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not 15495currently work for programs using Ada. 15496 15497@node Symbol Errors 15498@section Errors Reading Symbol Files 15499 15500While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems, 15501such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler 15502output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since 15503they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people 15504debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information 15505about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print 15506only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many 15507times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages, 15508to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set 15509complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 15510Messages}). 15511 15512The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include: 15513 15514@table @code 15515@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol} 15516 15517The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end 15518(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This 15519error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained 15520in its outer scope blocks. 15521 15522@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had 15523the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol} 15524may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a 15525function. 15526 15527@item block at @var{address} out of order 15528 15529The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in 15530order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not 15531do so. 15532 15533@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble 15534locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You 15535can often determine what source file is affected by specifying 15536@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 15537Messages}.) 15538 15539@item bad block start address patched 15540 15541The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address 15542smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known 15543to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler. 15544 15545@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as 15546starting on the previous source line. 15547 15548@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n} 15549 15550@cindex foo 15551Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is 15552larger than the size of the string table. 15553 15554@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the 15555name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up 15556with this name. 15557 15558@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}} 15559 15560The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does 15561not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the 15562uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal. 15563 15564@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information. 15565This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols 15566are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like 15567debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint 15568on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab} 15569and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol. 15570 15571@item stub type has NULL name 15572 15573@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class. 15574 15575@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{} 15576The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some 15577information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for 15578it. 15579 15580@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger 15581 15582@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler. 15583 15584@end table 15585 15586@node Data Files 15587@section GDB Data Files 15588 15589@cindex prefix for data files 15590@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files 15591are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}. 15592 15593You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN} 15594is currently using. 15595 15596@table @code 15597@kindex set data-directory 15598@item set data-directory @var{directory} 15599Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files 15600to @var{directory}. 15601 15602@kindex show data-directory 15603@item show data-directory 15604Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files. 15605@end table 15606 15607@cindex default data directory 15608@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} 15609You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time 15610@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside 15611@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 15612@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated 15613automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 15614location. 15615 15616The data directory may also be specified with the 15617@code{--data-directory} command line option. 15618@xref{Mode Options}. 15619 15620@node Targets 15621@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target 15622 15623@cindex debugging target 15624A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program. 15625 15626Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program; 15627in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when 15628you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more 15629flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate 15630host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a 15631realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target} 15632command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN} 15633(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}). 15634 15635@cindex target architecture 15636It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target 15637architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose 15638one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture} 15639command. 15640 15641@table @code 15642@kindex set architecture 15643@kindex show architecture 15644@item set architecture @var{arch} 15645This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The 15646value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the 15647supported architectures. 15648 15649@item show architecture 15650Show the current target architecture. 15651 15652@item set processor 15653@itemx processor 15654@kindex set processor 15655@kindex show processor 15656These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture} 15657and @code{show architecture}. 15658@end table 15659 15660@menu 15661* Active Targets:: Active targets 15662* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets 15663* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order 15664@end menu 15665 15666@node Active Targets 15667@section Active Targets 15668 15669@cindex stacking targets 15670@cindex active targets 15671@cindex multiple targets 15672 15673There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or 15674recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file 15675and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently 15676on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for 15677example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to 15678the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process 15679recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are 15680presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target 15681remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution. 15682 15683Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core 15684file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To 15685specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach} 15686command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 15687 15688@node Target Commands 15689@section Commands for Managing Targets 15690 15691@table @code 15692@item target @var{type} @var{parameters} 15693Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or 15694process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging 15695facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or 15696protocol of the target machine. 15697 15698Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but 15699typically include things like device names or host names to connect 15700with, process numbers, and baud rates. 15701 15702The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again 15703after executing the command. 15704 15705@kindex help target 15706@item help target 15707Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets 15708currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files} 15709(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 15710 15711@item help target @var{name} 15712Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to 15713select it. 15714 15715@kindex set gnutarget 15716@item set gnutarget @var{args} 15717@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN} 15718knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable}, 15719a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format 15720with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands, 15721with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine. 15722 15723@quotation 15724@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget}, 15725you must know the actual BFD name. 15726@end quotation 15727 15728@noindent 15729@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}. 15730 15731@kindex show gnutarget 15732@item show gnutarget 15733Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format 15734@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget}, 15735@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically, 15736and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}. 15737@end table 15738 15739@cindex common targets 15740Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB 15741configuration): 15742 15743@table @code 15744@kindex target 15745@item target exec @var{program} 15746@cindex executable file target 15747An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as 15748@samp{exec-file @var{program}}. 15749 15750@item target core @var{filename} 15751@cindex core dump file target 15752A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as 15753@samp{core-file @var{filename}}. 15754 15755@item target remote @var{medium} 15756@cindex remote target 15757A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network 15758connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote 15759protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}. 15760 15761For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the 15762machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say: 15763 15764@smallexample 15765target remote /dev/ttya 15766@end smallexample 15767 15768@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only 15769useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target 15770system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get 15771clobbered by the download. 15772 15773@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 15774@cindex built-in simulator target 15775Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures. 15776In general, 15777@smallexample 15778 target sim 15779 load 15780 run 15781@end smallexample 15782@noindent 15783works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device 15784drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do 15785provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details, 15786see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded 15787Processors}. 15788 15789@end table 15790 15791Some configurations may include these targets as well: 15792 15793@table @code 15794 15795@item target nrom @var{dev} 15796@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target 15797NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading. 15798 15799@end table 15800 15801Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN}; 15802your configuration may have more or fewer targets. 15803 15804Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once 15805you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control 15806various aspects of this process. 15807 15808@table @code 15809 15810@item set hash 15811@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors} 15812@cindex hash mark while downloading 15813This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while 15814downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is 15815displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the 15816monitor. 15817 15818@item show hash 15819@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors} 15820Show the current status of displaying the hash mark. 15821 15822@item set debug monitor 15823@kindex set debug monitor 15824@cindex display remote monitor communications 15825Enable or disable display of communications messages between 15826@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 15827 15828@item show debug monitor 15829@kindex show debug monitor 15830Show the current status of displaying communications between 15831@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 15832@end table 15833 15834@table @code 15835 15836@kindex load @var{filename} 15837@item load @var{filename} 15838@anchor{load} 15839Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into 15840@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it 15841is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging 15842on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example. 15843@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like 15844the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 15845 15846If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to 15847execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your 15848target is @dots{}}'' 15849 15850The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable. 15851For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you 15852link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format 15853specifies a fixed address. 15854@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc. 15855 15856Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to 15857load programs into flash memory. 15858 15859@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 15860@end table 15861 15862@node Byte Order 15863@section Choosing Target Byte Order 15864 15865@cindex choosing target byte order 15866@cindex target byte order 15867 15868Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH, 15869offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte 15870orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to 15871designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about 15872which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust 15873@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually. 15874 15875@table @code 15876@kindex set endian 15877@item set endian big 15878Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian. 15879 15880@item set endian little 15881Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian. 15882 15883@item set endian auto 15884Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the 15885executable. 15886 15887@item show endian 15888Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order. 15889 15890@end table 15891 15892Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic 15893data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the 15894target system. 15895 15896 15897@node Remote Debugging 15898@chapter Debugging Remote Programs 15899@cindex remote debugging 15900 15901If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run 15902@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging. 15903For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel, 15904or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system 15905powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger. 15906 15907Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces 15908to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition, 15909@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN}, 15910but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you 15911write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to 15912communicate with @value{GDBN}. 15913 15914Other remote targets may be available in your 15915configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them. 15916 15917@menu 15918* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target 15919* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system 15920* Server:: Using the gdbserver program 15921* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration 15922* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub 15923@end menu 15924 15925@node Connecting 15926@section Connecting to a Remote Target 15927 15928On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of 15929your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information. 15930Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your 15931program as the first argument. 15932 15933@cindex @code{target remote} 15934@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or 15935over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In 15936each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your 15937program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The 15938@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target. 15939Its arguments indicate which medium to use: 15940 15941@table @code 15942 15943@item target remote @var{serial-device} 15944@cindex serial line, @code{target remote} 15945Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example, 15946to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}: 15947 15948@smallexample 15949target remote /dev/ttyb 15950@end smallexample 15951 15952If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the 15953@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command 15954(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the 15955@code{target} command. 15956 15957@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} 15958@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 15959@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote} 15960Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}. 15961The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP} 15962address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be 15963the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or 15964it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the 15965target. 15966 15967For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named 15968@code{manyfarms}: 15969 15970@smallexample 15971target remote manyfarms:2828 15972@end smallexample 15973 15974If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your 15975debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the 15976same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to 15977port 1234 on your local machine: 15978 15979@smallexample 15980target remote :1234 15981@end smallexample 15982@noindent 15983 15984Note that the colon is still required here. 15985 15986@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 15987@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote} 15988Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to 15989connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}: 15990 15991@smallexample 15992target remote udp:manyfarms:2828 15993@end smallexample 15994 15995When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should 15996keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP} 15997can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will 15998cause havoc with your debugging session. 15999 16000@item target remote | @var{command} 16001@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to 16002Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a 16003pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded 16004by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote 16005protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its 16006standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator 16007that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections 16008using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks. 16009 16010If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting), 16011@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the 16012program has already exited, this will have no effect.) 16013 16014@end table 16015 16016Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual 16017commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already 16018running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not 16019need to use @kbd{run}. 16020 16021@cindex interrupting remote programs 16022@cindex remote programs, interrupting 16023Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the 16024interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the 16025program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware 16026and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the 16027interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt: 16028 16029@smallexample 16030Interrupted while waiting for the program. 16031Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n) 16032@end smallexample 16033 16034If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session. 16035(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target 16036remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} 16037goes back to waiting. 16038 16039@table @code 16040@kindex detach (remote) 16041@item detach 16042When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the 16043@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. 16044Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results 16045will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach} 16046command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target. 16047 16048@kindex disconnect 16049@item disconnect 16050The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that 16051the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN} 16052(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After 16053the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to 16054another target. 16055 16056@cindex send command to remote monitor 16057@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets 16058@cindex add new commands for external monitor 16059@kindex monitor 16060@item monitor @var{cmd} 16061This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the 16062remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it 16063sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you 16064can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand 16065and implement. 16066@end table 16067 16068@node File Transfer 16069@section Sending files to a remote system 16070@cindex remote target, file transfer 16071@cindex file transfer 16072@cindex sending files to remote systems 16073 16074Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same 16075connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient 16076for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems 16077running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets, 16078e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be 16079the only way to upload or download files. 16080 16081Not all remote targets support these commands. 16082 16083@table @code 16084@kindex remote put 16085@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 16086Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 16087@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 16088 16089@kindex remote get 16090@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 16091Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 16092on the host system. 16093 16094@kindex remote delete 16095@item remote delete @var{targetfile} 16096Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 16097 16098@end table 16099 16100@node Server 16101@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program 16102 16103@kindex gdbserver 16104@cindex remote connection without stubs 16105@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which 16106allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via 16107@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub. 16108 16109@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs, 16110because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities 16111that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run 16112@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run 16113@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless, 16114because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is 16115also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get 16116started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}. 16117Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that 16118the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to 16119do as much development work as possible on another system, for example 16120by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar 16121choice for debugging. 16122 16123@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line 16124or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial 16125protocol. 16126 16127@quotation 16128@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security. 16129Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a 16130@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the 16131target system with the same privileges as the user running 16132@code{gdbserver}. 16133@end quotation 16134 16135@subsection Running @code{gdbserver} 16136@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver} 16137 16138Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the 16139program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires. 16140@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can 16141strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host 16142system does all the symbol handling. 16143 16144To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN}; 16145the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual 16146syntax is: 16147 16148@smallexample 16149target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ] 16150@end smallexample 16151 16152@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP 16153hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument 16154@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port 16155@file{/dev/com1}: 16156 16157@smallexample 16158target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt 16159@end smallexample 16160 16161@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate 16162with it. 16163 16164To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line: 16165 16166@smallexample 16167target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt 16168@end smallexample 16169 16170The only difference from the previous example is the first argument, 16171specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via 16172TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to 16173expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345. 16174(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number 16175you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any 16176TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is 16177reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that 16178conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message 16179and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN} 16180@code{target remote} command. 16181 16182@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program 16183 16184On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs. 16185This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is: 16186 16187@smallexample 16188target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 16189@end smallexample 16190 16191@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary 16192to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 16193 16194@pindex pidof 16195@cindex attach to a program by name 16196You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the 16197@code{pidof} utility: 16198 16199@smallexample 16200target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}` 16201@end smallexample 16202 16203In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program} 16204has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the 16205@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID. 16206 16207@subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver} 16208@cindex gdbserver, multiple processes 16209@cindex multiple processes with gdbserver 16210 16211When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote}, 16212@code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the 16213program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection 16214and @code{gdbserver} exits. 16215 16216If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} 16217enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you 16218detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even 16219though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach} 16220commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program. 16221The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set 16222remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line 16223arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O 16224redirection (@pxref{Arguments}). 16225 16226To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 16227or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option. 16228Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start 16229the program you want to debug. 16230 16231@code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode. 16232You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit} 16233(@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). 16234 16235@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver} 16236 16237The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra 16238status information about the debugging process. The 16239@option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display 16240remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for 16241@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers. 16242 16243The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs 16244for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the 16245wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then 16246@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments. 16247 16248@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined 16249command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the 16250program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper 16251runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control. 16252 16253You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 16254its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 16255this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 16256with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 16257 16258For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 16259the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s 16260environment: 16261 16262@smallexample 16263$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog 16264@end smallexample 16265 16266@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver} 16267 16268Run @value{GDBN} on the host system. 16269 16270First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for 16271your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use 16272@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} 16273was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). 16274 16275The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable 16276and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host 16277system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system 16278are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results 16279during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing 16280files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded 16281programs. 16282 16283Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 16284For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using 16285the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose 16286text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like 16287@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load} 16288command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is 16289already on the target. 16290 16291@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver} 16292@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver} 16293@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver} 16294 16295During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the 16296@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}. 16297Here are the available commands. 16298 16299@table @code 16300@item monitor help 16301List the available monitor commands. 16302 16303@item monitor set debug 0 16304@itemx monitor set debug 1 16305Disable or enable general debugging messages. 16306 16307@item monitor set remote-debug 0 16308@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1 16309Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote 16310protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}). 16311 16312@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH] 16313@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db} 16314When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 16315directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set 16316libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path}, 16317@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list. 16318 16319@item monitor exit 16320Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by 16321@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will 16322detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created. 16323Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end 16324of a multi-process mode debug session. 16325 16326@end table 16327 16328@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 16329@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 16330 16331On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast 16332tracepoints and static tracepoints. 16333 16334For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the 16335@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process. 16336This library is built and distributed as an integral part of 16337@code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints 16338requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints 16339support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer, 16340@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support 16341is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the 16342standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if 16343@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust} 16344to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support 16345using @option{--with-ust=no}. 16346 16347There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program: 16348 16349@table @code 16350@item Specifying it as dependency at link time 16351 16352You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent 16353library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding 16354@code{-linproctrace} to the link command. 16355 16356@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms 16357 16358You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using 16359your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes 16360support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most 16361cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so} 16362in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s 16363@option{--wrapper} command line option. 16364 16365@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time 16366 16367On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library, 16368by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care 16369of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix 16370systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call} 16371command for that. For example: 16372 16373@smallexample 16374(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...) 16375@end smallexample 16376 16377Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be 16378available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}. 16379@end table 16380 16381On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix 16382systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target 16383remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic 16384loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the 16385program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that 16386case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints 16387features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared 16388libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the 16389main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start 16390@code{gdbserver} like so: 16391 16392@smallexample 16393$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram 16394@end smallexample 16395 16396Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main: 16397 16398@smallexample 16399$ gdb myprogram 16400(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999 164010x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2 16402(@value{GDBP}) b main 16403(@value{GDBP}) continue 16404@end smallexample 16405 16406The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the 16407process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary} 16408command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the 16409process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static 16410tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start 16411tracing. 16412 16413@node Remote Configuration 16414@section Remote Configuration 16415 16416@kindex set remote 16417@kindex show remote 16418This section documents the configuration options available when 16419debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O 16420extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system, 16421system-call-allowed}. 16422 16423@table @code 16424@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits} 16425@cindex address size for remote targets 16426@cindex bits in remote address 16427Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified 16428number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above 16429that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The 16430default value is the number of bits in the target's address. 16431 16432@item show remoteaddresssize 16433Show the current value of remote address size in bits. 16434 16435@item set remotebaud @var{n} 16436@cindex baud rate for remote targets 16437Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The 16438value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging 16439remote targets. 16440 16441@item show remotebaud 16442Show the current speed of the remote connection. 16443 16444@item set remotebreak 16445@cindex interrupt remote programs 16446@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C 16447@anchor{set remotebreak} 16448If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote 16449when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running 16450on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C} 16451character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems 16452expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal. 16453 16454@item show remotebreak 16455Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to 16456interrupt the remote program. 16457 16458@item set remoteflow on 16459@itemx set remoteflow off 16460@kindex set remoteflow 16461Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS}) 16462on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target. 16463 16464@item show remoteflow 16465@kindex show remoteflow 16466Show the current setting of hardware flow control. 16467 16468@item set remotelogbase @var{base} 16469Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol 16470communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are: 16471@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is 16472@code{ascii}. 16473 16474@item show remotelogbase 16475Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial 16476protocol. 16477 16478@item set remotelogfile @var{file} 16479@cindex record serial communications on file 16480Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The 16481default is not to record at all. 16482 16483@item show remotelogfile. 16484Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the 16485serial communications. 16486 16487@item set remotetimeout @var{num} 16488@cindex timeout for serial communications 16489@cindex remote timeout 16490Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to 16491@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds. 16492 16493@item show remotetimeout 16494Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target 16495responses. 16496 16497@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints 16498@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints 16499@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit} 16500@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit} 16501@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit} 16502@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit} 16503Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or 16504watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited. 16505 16506@item set remote exec-file @var{filename} 16507@itemx show remote exec-file 16508@anchor{set remote exec-file} 16509@cindex executable file, for remote target 16510Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target 16511extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the 16512target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default 16513filename (e.g.@: the last program run). 16514 16515@item set remote interrupt-sequence 16516@cindex interrupt remote programs 16517@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g 16518Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or 16519@samp{BREAK-g} as the 16520sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution. 16521@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which 16522is high level of serial line for some certain time. 16523Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g. 16524It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}. 16525 16526@item show interrupt-sequence 16527Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g} 16528is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program. 16529@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and 16530also known as Magic SysRq g. 16531 16532@item set remote interrupt-on-connect 16533@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start 16534Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when 16535@value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug 16536Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} 16537which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}. 16538 16539@item show interrupt-on-connect 16540Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent 16541to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it. 16542 16543@kindex set tcp 16544@kindex show tcp 16545@item set tcp auto-retry on 16546@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target 16547Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote 16548debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race 16549condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection 16550before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is 16551enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts 16552to establish the connection using the timeout specified by 16553@code{set tcp connect-timeout}. 16554 16555@item set tcp auto-retry off 16556Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections. 16557 16558@item show tcp auto-retry 16559Show the current auto-retry setting. 16560 16561@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds} 16562@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target 16563@cindex timeout, for remote target connection 16564Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to 16565@var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections 16566(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections 16567that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative 16568value. 16569 16570@item show tcp connect-timeout 16571Show the current connection timeout setting. 16572@end table 16573 16574@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling 16575The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by 16576your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you 16577can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each 16578packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this 16579packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet), 16580or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They 16581all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet, 16582see @ref{Remote Protocol}. 16583 16584During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands. 16585If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug 16586in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the 16587@value{GDBN} developers. 16588 16589For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the 16590packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings 16591are: 16592 16593@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25 16594@item Command Name 16595@tab Remote Packet 16596@tab Related Features 16597 16598@item @code{fetch-register} 16599@tab @code{p} 16600@tab @code{info registers} 16601 16602@item @code{set-register} 16603@tab @code{P} 16604@tab @code{set} 16605 16606@item @code{binary-download} 16607@tab @code{X} 16608@tab @code{load}, @code{set} 16609 16610@item @code{read-aux-vector} 16611@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read} 16612@tab @code{info auxv} 16613 16614@item @code{symbol-lookup} 16615@tab @code{qSymbol} 16616@tab Detecting multiple threads 16617 16618@item @code{attach} 16619@tab @code{vAttach} 16620@tab @code{attach} 16621 16622@item @code{verbose-resume} 16623@tab @code{vCont} 16624@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads 16625 16626@item @code{run} 16627@tab @code{vRun} 16628@tab @code{run} 16629 16630@item @code{software-breakpoint} 16631@tab @code{Z0} 16632@tab @code{break} 16633 16634@item @code{hardware-breakpoint} 16635@tab @code{Z1} 16636@tab @code{hbreak} 16637 16638@item @code{write-watchpoint} 16639@tab @code{Z2} 16640@tab @code{watch} 16641 16642@item @code{read-watchpoint} 16643@tab @code{Z3} 16644@tab @code{rwatch} 16645 16646@item @code{access-watchpoint} 16647@tab @code{Z4} 16648@tab @code{awatch} 16649 16650@item @code{target-features} 16651@tab @code{qXfer:features:read} 16652@tab @code{set architecture} 16653 16654@item @code{library-info} 16655@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read} 16656@tab @code{info sharedlibrary} 16657 16658@item @code{memory-map} 16659@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read} 16660@tab @code{info mem} 16661 16662@item @code{read-sdata-object} 16663@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read} 16664@tab @code{print $_sdata} 16665 16666@item @code{read-spu-object} 16667@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read} 16668@tab @code{info spu} 16669 16670@item @code{write-spu-object} 16671@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write} 16672@tab @code{info spu} 16673 16674@item @code{read-siginfo-object} 16675@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read} 16676@tab @code{print $_siginfo} 16677 16678@item @code{write-siginfo-object} 16679@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write} 16680@tab @code{set $_siginfo} 16681 16682@item @code{threads} 16683@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read} 16684@tab @code{info threads} 16685 16686@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address} 16687@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr} 16688@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables 16689 16690@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address} 16691@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr} 16692@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block. 16693 16694@item @code{search-memory} 16695@tab @code{qSearch:memory} 16696@tab @code{find} 16697 16698@item @code{supported-packets} 16699@tab @code{qSupported} 16700@tab Remote communications parameters 16701 16702@item @code{pass-signals} 16703@tab @code{QPassSignals} 16704@tab @code{handle @var{signal}} 16705 16706@item @code{hostio-close-packet} 16707@tab @code{vFile:close} 16708@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 16709 16710@item @code{hostio-open-packet} 16711@tab @code{vFile:open} 16712@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 16713 16714@item @code{hostio-pread-packet} 16715@tab @code{vFile:pread} 16716@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 16717 16718@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet} 16719@tab @code{vFile:pwrite} 16720@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 16721 16722@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet} 16723@tab @code{vFile:unlink} 16724@tab @code{remote delete} 16725 16726@item @code{noack-packet} 16727@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode} 16728@tab Packet acknowledgment 16729 16730@item @code{osdata} 16731@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read} 16732@tab @code{info os} 16733 16734@item @code{query-attached} 16735@tab @code{qAttached} 16736@tab Querying remote process attach state. 16737 16738@item @code{traceframe-info} 16739@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 16740@tab Traceframe info 16741@end multitable 16742 16743@node Remote Stub 16744@section Implementing a Remote Stub 16745 16746@cindex debugging stub, example 16747@cindex remote stub, example 16748@cindex stub example, remote debugging 16749The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the 16750communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the 16751@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow 16752these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're 16753implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start 16754with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best 16755organized, and therefore the easiest to read.) 16756 16757@cindex remote serial debugging, overview 16758To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging 16759@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual 16760prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C 16761program, you need: 16762 16763@enumerate 16764@item 16765A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually 16766have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by 16767your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own. 16768 16769@item 16770A C subroutine library to support your program's 16771subroutine calls, notably managing input and output. 16772 16773@item 16774A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a 16775download program. These are often supplied by the hardware 16776manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware 16777documentation. 16778@end enumerate 16779 16780The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to 16781communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host} 16782machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this: 16783 16784@table @emph 16785@item On the host, 16786@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything 16787else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command 16788(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 16789 16790@item On the target, 16791you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that 16792implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these 16793subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}. 16794 16795On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program 16796@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program. 16797@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details. 16798@end table 16799 16800The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote 16801machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on 16802@sc{sparc} boards. 16803 16804@cindex remote serial stub list 16805These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}: 16806 16807@table @code 16808 16809@item i386-stub.c 16810@cindex @file{i386-stub.c} 16811@cindex Intel 16812@cindex i386 16813For Intel 386 and compatible architectures. 16814 16815@item m68k-stub.c 16816@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c} 16817@cindex Motorola 680x0 16818@cindex m680x0 16819For Motorola 680x0 architectures. 16820 16821@item sh-stub.c 16822@cindex @file{sh-stub.c} 16823@cindex Renesas 16824@cindex SH 16825For Renesas SH architectures. 16826 16827@item sparc-stub.c 16828@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c} 16829@cindex Sparc 16830For @sc{sparc} architectures. 16831 16832@item sparcl-stub.c 16833@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c} 16834@cindex Fujitsu 16835@cindex SparcLite 16836For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures. 16837 16838@end table 16839 16840The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other 16841recently added stubs. 16842 16843@menu 16844* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you 16845* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub 16846* Debug Session:: Putting it all together 16847@end menu 16848 16849@node Stub Contents 16850@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You 16851 16852@cindex remote serial stub 16853The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three 16854subroutines: 16855 16856@table @code 16857@item set_debug_traps 16858@findex set_debug_traps 16859@cindex remote serial stub, initialization 16860This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your 16861program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the 16862beginning of your program. 16863 16864@item handle_exception 16865@findex handle_exception 16866@cindex remote serial stub, main routine 16867This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it 16868explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to 16869run when a trap is triggered. 16870 16871@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during 16872execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications 16873with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications 16874protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN} 16875representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary 16876information on the state of your program, then continues to execute, 16877retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you 16878execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point, 16879@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target 16880machine. 16881 16882@item breakpoint 16883@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote 16884Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a 16885breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only 16886way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target 16887machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this; 16888pressing the interrupt button transfers control to 16889@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines, 16890simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap; 16891again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from 16892your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host 16893@value{GDBN} session gets control. 16894 16895Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want 16896to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the 16897start of your debugging session. 16898@end table 16899 16900@node Bootstrapping 16901@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub 16902 16903@cindex remote stub, support routines 16904The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular 16905chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your 16906debugging target machine. 16907 16908First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the 16909serial port. 16910 16911@table @code 16912@item int getDebugChar() 16913@findex getDebugChar 16914Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port. 16915It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a 16916different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 16917 16918@item void putDebugChar(int) 16919@findex putDebugChar 16920Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port. 16921It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a 16922different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 16923@end table 16924 16925@cindex control C, and remote debugging 16926@cindex interrupting remote targets 16927If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is 16928running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange 16929for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C 16930character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the 16931remote system to stop. 16932 16933Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN} 16934probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way 16935is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that 16936@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}). 16937 16938Other routines you need to supply are: 16939 16940@table @code 16941@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address}) 16942@findex exceptionHandler 16943Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception 16944handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any 16945way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system 16946are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom}, 16947containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}). 16948@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed; 16949its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers 16950might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this 16951exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to 16952@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers, 16953and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if 16954you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it 16955should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine. 16956 16957For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt 16958gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate 16959should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The 16960@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without 16961help from @code{exceptionHandler}. 16962 16963@item void flush_i_cache() 16964@findex flush_i_cache 16965On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the 16966instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no 16967instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op. 16968 16969On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this 16970function to make certain that the state of your program is stable. 16971@end table 16972 16973@noindent 16974You must also make sure this library routine is available: 16975 16976@table @code 16977@item void *memset(void *, int, int) 16978@findex memset 16979This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of 16980memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of 16981@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must 16982either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own. 16983@end table 16984 16985If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard 16986library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another, 16987but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library 16988subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code. 16989 16990 16991@node Debug Session 16992@subsection Putting it All Together 16993 16994@cindex remote serial debugging summary 16995In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these 16996steps. 16997 16998@enumerate 16999@item 17000Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines 17001(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}): 17002@display 17003@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar}, 17004@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}. 17005@end display 17006 17007@item 17008Insert these lines near the top of your program: 17009 17010@smallexample 17011set_debug_traps(); 17012breakpoint(); 17013@end smallexample 17014 17015@item 17016For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called 17017@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use: 17018 17019@smallexample 17020void (*exceptionHook)() = 0; 17021@end smallexample 17022 17023@noindent 17024but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a 17025function in your program, that function is called when 17026@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus 17027error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with 17028one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number. 17029 17030@item 17031Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for 17032your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines. 17033 17034@item 17035Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and 17036the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host. 17037 17038@item 17039@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should 17040@c document that. FIXME. 17041Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by 17042whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it. 17043 17044@item 17045Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target 17046(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 17047 17048@end enumerate 17049 17050@node Configurations 17051@chapter Configuration-Specific Information 17052 17053While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and 17054cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter 17055describes things that are only available in certain configurations. 17056 17057There are three major categories of configurations: native 17058configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded 17059operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several 17060different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which 17061are quite different from each other. 17062 17063@menu 17064* Native:: 17065* Embedded OS:: 17066* Embedded Processors:: 17067* Architectures:: 17068@end menu 17069 17070@node Native 17071@section Native 17072 17073This section describes details specific to particular native 17074configurations. 17075 17076@menu 17077* HP-UX:: HP-UX 17078* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images 17079* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information 17080* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port 17081* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port 17082* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd 17083* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino 17084* Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin 17085@end menu 17086 17087@node HP-UX 17088@subsection HP-UX 17089 17090On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that 17091begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system 17092name first, before it searches for a convenience variable. 17093 17094 17095@node BSD libkvm Interface 17096@subsection BSD libkvm Interface 17097 17098@cindex libkvm 17099@cindex kernel memory image 17100@cindex kernel crash dump 17101 17102BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory 17103interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual 17104memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN} 17105uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash 17106dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a 17107special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load 17108the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the 17109@code{kvm} target: 17110 17111@smallexample 17112(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm} 17113@end smallexample 17114 17115For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an 17116argument: 17117 17118@smallexample 17119(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0} 17120@end smallexample 17121 17122Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are 17123available: 17124 17125@table @code 17126@kindex kvm 17127@item kvm pcb 17128Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address. 17129 17130@item kvm proc 17131Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on 17132modern FreeBSD systems. 17133@end table 17134 17135@node SVR4 Process Information 17136@subsection SVR4 Process Information 17137@cindex /proc 17138@cindex examine process image 17139@cindex process info via @file{/proc} 17140 17141Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called 17142@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running 17143process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured 17144for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info 17145proc} is available to report information about the process running 17146your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info 17147proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code. 17148This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital 17149Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example. 17150 17151@table @code 17152@kindex info proc 17153@cindex process ID 17154@item info proc 17155@itemx info proc @var{process-id} 17156Summarize available information about any running process. If a 17157process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about 17158that process; otherwise display information about the program being 17159debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command 17160line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its 17161executable file's absolute file name. 17162 17163On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form 17164@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID 17165within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means 17166a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still 17167needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as 17168a process ID rather than a thread ID). 17169 17170@item info proc mappings 17171@cindex memory address space mappings 17172Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with 17173information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access 17174rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range 17175includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the 17176memory access rights to that range. 17177 17178@item info proc stat 17179@itemx info proc status 17180@cindex process detailed status information 17181These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show 17182the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID; 17183how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage; 17184the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its 17185consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice} 17186value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page 17187(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt). 17188 17189@item info proc all 17190Show all the information about the process described under all of the 17191above @code{info proc} subcommands. 17192 17193@ignore 17194@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when 17195@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around 17196@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in. 17197@kindex info proc times 17198@item info proc times 17199Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and 17200its children. 17201 17202@kindex info proc id 17203@item info proc id 17204Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID, 17205the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID. 17206@end ignore 17207 17208@item set procfs-trace 17209@kindex set procfs-trace 17210@cindex @code{procfs} API calls 17211This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls. 17212 17213@item show procfs-trace 17214@kindex show procfs-trace 17215Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing. 17216 17217@item set procfs-file @var{file} 17218@kindex set procfs-file 17219Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named 17220@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous 17221contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the 17222standard output. 17223 17224@item show procfs-file 17225@kindex show procfs-file 17226Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written. 17227 17228@item proc-trace-entry 17229@itemx proc-trace-exit 17230@itemx proc-untrace-entry 17231@itemx proc-untrace-exit 17232@kindex proc-trace-entry 17233@kindex proc-trace-exit 17234@kindex proc-untrace-entry 17235@kindex proc-untrace-exit 17236These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits 17237from the @code{syscall} interface. 17238 17239@item info pidlist 17240@kindex info pidlist 17241@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino 17242For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the 17243processes and all the threads within each process. 17244 17245@item info meminfo 17246@kindex info meminfo 17247@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino 17248For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos. 17249@end table 17250 17251@node DJGPP Native 17252@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs 17253@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging 17254@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging 17255@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands 17256 17257@cindex DPMI 17258@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and 17259MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs 17260that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on 17261top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations. 17262 17263@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and 17264defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This 17265subsection describes those commands. 17266 17267@table @code 17268@kindex info dos 17269@item info dos 17270This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print 17271information about the target system and important OS structures. 17272 17273@kindex sysinfo 17274@cindex MS-DOS system info 17275@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS) 17276@item info dos sysinfo 17277This command displays assorted information about the underlying 17278platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the 17279DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory. 17280 17281@cindex GDT 17282@cindex LDT 17283@cindex IDT 17284@cindex segment descriptor tables 17285@cindex descriptor tables display 17286@item info dos gdt 17287@itemx info dos ldt 17288@itemx info dos idt 17289These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local, 17290and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor 17291tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment 17292that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a 17293descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the 17294descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access 17295rights. 17296 17297A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data 17298segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which 17299allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in 17300conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define 17301additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment. 17302 17303@cindex garbled pointers 17304These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables. 17305Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are 17306displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means 17307display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For 17308example, here's a convenient way to display information about the 17309debugged program's data segment: 17310 17311@smallexample 17312@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds} 17313@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)} 17314@end smallexample 17315 17316@noindent 17317This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside 17318the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}). 17319 17320@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS) 17321@item info dos pde 17322@itemx info dos pte 17323These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page 17324Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are 17325data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped 17326into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every 17327page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there 17328may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A 17329Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table 17330that is currently in use. 17331 17332Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page 17333Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of 17334the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the 17335@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page 17336Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command 17337means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by 17338the specified entry in the Page Directory. 17339 17340@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS 17341These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct 17342Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA 17343controller. 17344 17345These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers. 17346 17347@cindex physical address from linear address 17348@item info dos address-pte @var{addr} 17349This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear 17350address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should 17351already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it, 17352because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} 17353segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for 17354the page where a variable @code{i} is stored: 17355 17356@smallexample 17357@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i} 17358@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:} 17359@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30} 17360@end smallexample 17361 17362@noindent 17363This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page 17364whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the 17365attributes of that page. 17366 17367Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *}, 17368since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base 17369address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will 17370be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is 17371declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of 17372@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}. 17373 17374Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the 17375transfer buffer: 17376 17377@smallexample 17378@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)} 17379@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:} 17380@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110} 17381@end smallexample 17382 17383@noindent 17384(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the 173853rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output 17386clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional 17387memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and 17388linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical. 17389 17390This command is supported only with some DPMI servers. 17391@end table 17392 17393@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging 17394In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote 17395debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific 17396to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}. 17397 17398@table @code 17399@kindex set com1base 17400@kindex set com1irq 17401@kindex set com2base 17402@kindex set com2irq 17403@kindex set com3base 17404@kindex set com3irq 17405@kindex set com4base 17406@kindex set com4irq 17407@item set com1base @var{addr} 17408This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial 17409port. 17410 17411@item set com1irq @var{irq} 17412This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use 17413for the @file{COM1} serial port. 17414 17415There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq}, 17416etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the 17417other 3 COM ports. 17418 17419@kindex show com1base 17420@kindex show com1irq 17421@kindex show com2base 17422@kindex show com2irq 17423@kindex show com3base 17424@kindex show com3irq 17425@kindex show com4base 17426@kindex show com4irq 17427The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@: 17428display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ} 17429lines used by the COM ports. 17430 17431@item info serial 17432@kindex info serial 17433@cindex DOS serial port status 17434This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each 17435port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and 17436IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the 17437counts of various errors encountered so far. 17438@end table 17439 17440 17441@node Cygwin Native 17442@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables 17443@cindex MS Windows debugging 17444@cindex native Cygwin debugging 17445@cindex Cygwin-specific commands 17446 17447@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including 17448DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. 17449 17450@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows 17451@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows 17452MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the 17453special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted 17454by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows 17455supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key 17456sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it 17457ignores @kbd{C-c}. 17458 17459There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in 17460this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is 17461described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}. 17462 17463@table @code 17464@kindex info w32 17465@item info w32 17466This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print 17467information about the target system and important OS structures. 17468 17469@item info w32 selector 17470This command displays information returned by 17471the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function. 17472It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to 17473a long value to give the information about this given selector. 17474Without argument, this command displays information 17475about the six segment registers. 17476 17477@item info w32 thread-information-block 17478This command displays thread specific information stored in the 17479Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs} 17480selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs). 17481 17482@kindex info dll 17483@item info dll 17484This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}. 17485 17486@kindex dll-symbols 17487@item dll-symbols 17488This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to 17489add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address. 17490 17491@kindex set cygwin-exceptions 17492@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL 17493@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging 17494@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode} 17495If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that 17496happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off}, 17497@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some 17498exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL 17499``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the 17500Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying 17501@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals. 17502 17503@kindex show cygwin-exceptions 17504@item show cygwin-exceptions 17505Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen 17506inside the Cygwin DLL itself. 17507 17508@kindex set new-console 17509@item set new-console @var{mode} 17510If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will 17511be started in a new console on next start. 17512If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will 17513be started in the same console as the debugger. 17514 17515@kindex show new-console 17516@item show new-console 17517Displays whether a new console is used 17518when the debuggee is started. 17519 17520@kindex set new-group 17521@item set new-group @var{mode} 17522This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should 17523start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger. 17524This affects the way the Windows OS handles 17525@samp{Ctrl-C}. 17526 17527@kindex show new-group 17528@item show new-group 17529Displays current value of new-group boolean. 17530 17531@kindex set debugevents 17532@item set debugevents 17533This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related 17534to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that 17535signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and 17536unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the 17537Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call. 17538 17539@kindex set debugexec 17540@item set debugexec 17541This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events 17542(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger. 17543 17544@kindex set debugexceptions 17545@item set debugexceptions 17546This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the 17547debuggee seen by the debugger. 17548 17549@kindex set debugmemory 17550@item set debugmemory 17551This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads 17552and writes by the debugger. 17553 17554@kindex set shell 17555@item set shell 17556This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called 17557via a shell or directly (default value is on). 17558 17559@kindex show shell 17560@item show shell 17561Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell. 17562 17563@end table 17564 17565@menu 17566* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols 17567@end menu 17568 17569@node Non-debug DLL Symbols 17570@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols 17571@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols 17572@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs 17573 17574Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do 17575not include symbolic debugging information (for example, 17576@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging 17577symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic 17578information contained in the DLL's export table. This section 17579describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as 17580``minimal symbols''. 17581 17582Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs 17583will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to 17584start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the 17585program run once to completion. It is also possible to force 17586@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable --- 17587see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the 17588@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently, 17589explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will 17590cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table, 17591which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance. 17592 17593@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes 17594 17595In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging 17596tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the 17597DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is 17598also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often 17599sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program 17600(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols) 17601necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the 17602contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the 17603exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator. 17604 17605Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even 17606though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since 17607symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause 17608some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and 17609@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} 17610(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example: 17611 17612@smallexample 17613(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA 17614All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA": 17615 17616Non-debugging symbols: 176170x77e885f4 CreateFileA 176180x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA 17619@end smallexample 17620 17621@smallexample 17622(@value{GDBP}) info function ! 17623All functions matching regular expression "!": 17624 17625Non-debugging symbols: 176260x6100114c cygwin1!__assert 176270x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0 176280x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *) 17629[etc...] 17630@end smallexample 17631 17632@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols 17633 17634Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much 17635type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol 17636refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that 17637contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory 17638contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This 17639means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble 17640a function within a DLL without a running program. 17641 17642Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced 17643automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a 17644variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit 17645type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of 17646problem: 17647 17648@smallexample 17649(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv' 17650$1 = 268572168 17651@end smallexample 17652 17653@smallexample 17654(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv' 176550x10021610: "\230y\"" 17656@end smallexample 17657 17658And two possible solutions: 17659 17660@smallexample 17661(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0] 17662$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 17663@end smallexample 17664 17665@smallexample 17666(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv' 176670x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000 17668(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608 176690x10021608: 0x0022fd98 17670(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98 176710x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 17672@end smallexample 17673 17674Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program 17675starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't 17676examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the 17677function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&'' 17678to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address: 17679 17680@smallexample 17681(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline' 17682Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0 17683@end smallexample 17684 17685The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a 17686break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely 17687safe. 17688 17689@node Hurd Native 17690@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems 17691@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging 17692 17693This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the 17694@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging. 17695 17696@table @code 17697@item set signals 17698@itemx set sigs 17699@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command} 17700@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command} 17701This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by 17702@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not 17703affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for 17704@code{signals}. 17705 17706@item show signals 17707@itemx show sigs 17708@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command} 17709@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command} 17710Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals. 17711 17712@item set signal-thread 17713@itemx set sigthread 17714@kindex set signal-thread 17715@kindex set sigthread 17716This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal 17717thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running 17718process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set 17719signal-thread}. 17720 17721@item show signal-thread 17722@itemx show sigthread 17723@kindex show signal-thread 17724@kindex show sigthread 17725These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is 17726delivered a signal. 17727 17728@item set stopped 17729@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command} 17730This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped, 17731as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be 17732continued by delivering a signal to it. 17733 17734@item show stopped 17735@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command} 17736This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is 17737stopped. 17738 17739@item set exceptions 17740@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 17741Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior. 17742When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor 17743single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception 17744trapping on. 17745 17746@item show exceptions 17747@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 17748Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior. 17749 17750@item set task pause 17751@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands} 17752@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 17753@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 17754This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control. 17755Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended 17756whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take 17757effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set 17758to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set 17759thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads. 17760 17761@item show task pause 17762@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands} 17763Show the current state of task suspension. 17764 17765@item set task detach-suspend-count 17766@cindex task suspend count 17767@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17768This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when 17769@value{GDBN} detaches from it. 17770 17771@item show task detach-suspend-count 17772Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching. 17773 17774@item set task exception-port 17775@itemx set task excp 17776@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17777This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will 17778forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send 17779rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias. 17780 17781@item set noninvasive 17782@cindex noninvasive task options 17783This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least 17784invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This 17785is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and 17786@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults. 17787 17788@item info send-rights 17789@itemx info receive-rights 17790@itemx info port-rights 17791@itemx info port-sets 17792@itemx info dead-names 17793@itemx info ports 17794@itemx info psets 17795@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17796@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17797@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17798@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17799@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17800These commands display information about, respectively, send rights, 17801receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task. 17802There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info 17803port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}. 17804 17805@item set thread pause 17806@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command} 17807@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17808@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 17809This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has 17810control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current 17811thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to 17812off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued. 17813Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has 17814control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set 17815task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend 17816only the current thread. 17817 17818@item show thread pause 17819@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command} 17820This command shows the state of current thread suspension. 17821 17822@item set thread run 17823This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run. 17824 17825@item show thread run 17826Show whether the current thread is allowed to run. 17827 17828@item set thread detach-suspend-count 17829@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17830@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17831This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a 17832thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count 17833found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread 17834takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value. 17835 17836@item show thread detach-suspend-count 17837Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when 17838detaching. 17839 17840@item set thread exception-port 17841@itemx set thread excp 17842Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This 17843overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above). 17844@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias. 17845 17846@item set thread takeover-suspend-count 17847Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the 17848value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command 17849changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead. 17850 17851@item set thread default 17852@itemx show thread default 17853@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd 17854Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread 17855default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set 17856thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default} 17857variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all 17858threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with 17859the non-default commands. 17860@end table 17861 17862 17863@node Neutrino 17864@subsection QNX Neutrino 17865@cindex QNX Neutrino 17866 17867@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX 17868Neutrino target: 17869 17870@table @code 17871@item set debug nto-debug 17872@kindex set debug nto-debug 17873When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX 17874Neutrino support. 17875 17876@item show debug nto-debug 17877@kindex show debug nto-debug 17878Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages. 17879@end table 17880 17881@node Darwin 17882@subsection Darwin 17883@cindex Darwin 17884 17885@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target: 17886 17887@table @code 17888@item set debug darwin @var{num} 17889@kindex set debug darwin 17890When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to 17891the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output. 17892 17893@item show debug darwin 17894@kindex show debug darwin 17895Show the current state of Darwin messages. 17896 17897@item set debug mach-o @var{num} 17898@kindex set debug mach-o 17899When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while 17900@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the 17901file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher 17902values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose 17903problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal 17904usage. 17905 17906@item show debug mach-o 17907@kindex show debug mach-o 17908Show the current state of Mach-O file messages. 17909 17910@item set mach-exceptions on 17911@itemx set mach-exceptions off 17912@kindex set mach-exceptions 17913On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then 17914mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of 17915Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to 17916better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off. 17917 17918@item show mach-exceptions 17919@kindex show mach-exceptions 17920Show the current state of exceptions trapping. 17921@end table 17922 17923 17924@node Embedded OS 17925@section Embedded Operating Systems 17926 17927This section describes configurations involving the debugging of 17928embedded operating systems that are available for several different 17929architectures. 17930 17931@menu 17932* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks 17933@end menu 17934 17935@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on 17936various real-time operating systems. 17937 17938@node VxWorks 17939@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks 17940 17941@cindex VxWorks 17942 17943@table @code 17944 17945@kindex target vxworks 17946@item target vxworks @var{machinename} 17947A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename} 17948is the target system's machine name or IP address. 17949 17950@end table 17951 17952On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the 17953current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}. 17954 17955@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked 17956VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from 17957the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on 17958both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program 17959@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be 17960installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a 17961@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.) 17962 17963@table @code 17964@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args} 17965@kindex vxworks-timeout 17966All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}. 17967This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of 17968seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if 17969your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side 17970of a thin network line. 17971@end table 17972 17973The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when 17974this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised 17975procedures. 17976 17977@findex INCLUDE_RDB 17978To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel 17979to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks 17980library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the 17981VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks 17982kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the 17983source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more 17984information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's 17985manual. 17986@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}. 17987 17988Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set 17989your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to 17990run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or 17991@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation). 17992 17993@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt: 17994 17995@smallexample 17996(vxgdb) 17997@end smallexample 17998 17999@menu 18000* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks 18001* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download 18002* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks 18003@end menu 18004 18005@node VxWorks Connection 18006@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks 18007 18008The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the 18009network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type: 18010 18011@smallexample 18012(vxgdb) target vxworks tt 18013@end smallexample 18014 18015@need 750 18016@value{GDBN} displays messages like these: 18017 18018@smallexample 18019Attaching remote machine across net... 18020Connected to tt. 18021@end smallexample 18022 18023@need 1000 18024@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules 18025loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates 18026these files by searching the directories listed in the command search 18027path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails 18028to find an object file, it displays a message such as: 18029 18030@smallexample 18031prog.o: No such file or directory. 18032@end smallexample 18033 18034When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with 18035the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target} 18036command again. 18037 18038@node VxWorks Download 18039@subsubsection VxWorks Download 18040 18041@cindex download to VxWorks 18042If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an 18043object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN} 18044@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks 18045incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load} 18046command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order 18047to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol 18048table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on 18049the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same 18050filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths. 18051Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems 18052to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference 18053the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program 18054@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks 18055and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this 18056program, type this on VxWorks: 18057 18058@smallexample 18059-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb" 18060@end smallexample 18061 18062@noindent 18063Then, in @value{GDBN}, type: 18064 18065@smallexample 18066(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb 18067(vxgdb) load prog.o 18068@end smallexample 18069 18070@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this: 18071 18072@smallexample 18073Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done. 18074@end smallexample 18075 18076You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module 18077after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that 18078this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints, 18079auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value 18080history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of 18081debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol 18082table.) 18083 18084@node VxWorks Attach 18085@subsubsection Running Tasks 18086 18087@cindex running VxWorks tasks 18088You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as 18089follows: 18090 18091@smallexample 18092(vxgdb) attach @var{task} 18093@end smallexample 18094 18095@noindent 18096where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running 18097or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at 18098the time of attachment. 18099 18100@node Embedded Processors 18101@section Embedded Processors 18102 18103This section goes into details specific to particular embedded 18104configurations. 18105 18106@cindex send command to simulator 18107Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN} 18108allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator. 18109 18110@table @code 18111@item sim @var{command} 18112@kindex sim@r{, a command} 18113Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the 18114documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about 18115acceptable commands. 18116@end table 18117 18118 18119@menu 18120* ARM:: ARM RDI 18121* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D 18122* M68K:: Motorola M68K 18123* MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze 18124* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded 18125* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000 18126* PA:: HP PA Embedded 18127* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded 18128* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet 18129* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite 18130* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000 18131* AVR:: Atmel AVR 18132* CRIS:: CRIS 18133* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H 18134@end menu 18135 18136@node ARM 18137@subsection ARM 18138@cindex ARM RDI 18139 18140@table @code 18141@kindex target rdi 18142@item target rdi @var{dev} 18143ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may 18144use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel 18145monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device. 18146 18147@kindex target rdp 18148@item target rdp @var{dev} 18149ARM Demon monitor. 18150 18151@end table 18152 18153@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands: 18154 18155@table @code 18156@item set arm disassembler 18157@kindex set arm 18158This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The 18159@code{"std"} style is the standard style. 18160 18161@item show arm disassembler 18162@kindex show arm 18163Show the current disassembly style. 18164 18165@item set arm apcs32 18166@cindex ARM 32-bit mode 18167This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit. 18168 18169@item show arm apcs32 18170Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode. 18171 18172@item set arm fpu @var{fputype} 18173This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The 18174argument @var{fputype} can be one of these: 18175 18176@table @code 18177@item auto 18178Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI. 18179@item softfpa 18180Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM 18181processors. 18182@item fpa 18183GCC-compiled FPA co-processor. 18184@item softvfp 18185Software FPU with pure-endian doubles. 18186@item vfp 18187VFP co-processor. 18188@end table 18189 18190@item show arm fpu 18191Show the current type of the FPU. 18192 18193@item set arm abi 18194This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI. 18195 18196@item show arm abi 18197Show the currently used ABI. 18198 18199@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 18200@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine 18201whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls 18202@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not 18203available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to 18204use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR} 18205register). 18206 18207@item show arm fallback-mode 18208Show the current fallback instruction mode. 18209 18210@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 18211This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether 18212instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which 18213causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting 18214of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}. 18215 18216@item show arm force-mode 18217Show the current forced instruction mode. 18218 18219@item set debug arm 18220Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM 18221target support subsystem. 18222 18223@item show debug arm 18224Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled. 18225@end table 18226 18227The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged 18228using the RDI interface: 18229 18230@table @code 18231@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 18232@kindex rdilogfile 18233@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging 18234Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log. 18235With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With 18236no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is 18237@file{rdi.log}. 18238 18239@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]} 18240@kindex rdilogenable 18241Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"} 18242enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With 18243no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled, 18244ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device 18245are logged to a file. 18246 18247@item set rdiromatzero 18248@kindex set rdiromatzero 18249@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI 18250Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on, 18251vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off 18252(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take 18253effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command. 18254 18255@item show rdiromatzero 18256@kindex show rdiromatzero 18257Show the current setting of ROM at zero address. 18258 18259@item set rdiheartbeat 18260@kindex set rdiheartbeat 18261@cindex RDI heartbeat 18262Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to 18263turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as 18264well as the Angel monitor. 18265 18266@item show rdiheartbeat 18267@kindex show rdiheartbeat 18268Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets. 18269@end table 18270 18271@table @code 18272@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 18273The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments. 18274 18275@table @code 18276@item --swi-support=@var{type} 18277Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. 18278@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values. 18279The default value is @code{all}. 18280 18281@table @code 18282@item none 18283@item demon 18284@item angel 18285@item redboot 18286@item all 18287@end table 18288@end table 18289@end table 18290 18291@node M32R/D 18292@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI 18293 18294@table @code 18295@kindex target m32r 18296@item target m32r @var{dev} 18297Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor. 18298 18299@kindex target m32rsdi 18300@item target m32rsdi @var{dev} 18301Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board. 18302@end table 18303 18304The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor: 18305 18306@table @code 18307@item set download-path @var{path} 18308@kindex set download-path 18309@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R) 18310Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files. 18311 18312@item show download-path 18313@kindex show download-path 18314Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files. 18315 18316@item set board-address @var{addr} 18317@kindex set board-address 18318@cindex M32-EVA target board address 18319Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board. 18320 18321@item show board-address 18322@kindex show board-address 18323Show the current IP address of the target board. 18324 18325@item set server-address @var{addr} 18326@kindex set server-address 18327@cindex download server address (M32R) 18328Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s 18329host machine. 18330 18331@item show server-address 18332@kindex show server-address 18333Display the IP address of the download server. 18334 18335@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 18336@kindex upload@r{, M32R} 18337Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet 18338upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current 18339executable file is uploaded. 18340 18341@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 18342@kindex tload@r{, M32R} 18343Test the @code{upload} command. 18344@end table 18345 18346The following commands are available for M32R/SDI: 18347 18348@table @code 18349@item sdireset 18350@kindex sdireset 18351@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R 18352This command resets the SDI connection. 18353 18354@item sdistatus 18355@kindex sdistatus 18356This command shows the SDI connection status. 18357 18358@item debug_chaos 18359@kindex debug_chaos 18360@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging 18361Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used. 18362 18363@item use_debug_dma 18364@kindex use_debug_dma 18365Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory. 18366 18367@item use_mon_code 18368@kindex use_mon_code 18369Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory. 18370 18371@item use_ib_break 18372@kindex use_ib_break 18373Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break. 18374 18375@item use_dbt_break 18376@kindex use_dbt_break 18377Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT. 18378@end table 18379 18380@node M68K 18381@subsection M68k 18382 18383The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a 18384target command for the following ROM monitor. 18385 18386@table @code 18387 18388@kindex target dbug 18389@item target dbug @var{dev} 18390dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire. 18391 18392@end table 18393 18394@node MicroBlaze 18395@subsection MicroBlaze 18396@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze 18397@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger 18398 18399The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx 18400FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors 18401usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx 18402Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK). 18403This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to 18404the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program 18405communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and 18406presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default 18407@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change 18408this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd} 18409commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.) 18410 18411Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor. 18412 18413@table @code 18414@item target remote :1234 18415Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN} 18416on the same system as @code{xmd}. 18417 18418@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234 18419Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd} 18420running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}. 18421 18422@item load 18423Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target. 18424 18425@item set debug microblaze @var{n} 18426Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero. 18427 18428@item show debug microblaze @var{n} 18429Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level. 18430@end table 18431 18432@node MIPS Embedded 18433@subsection MIPS Embedded 18434 18435@cindex MIPS boards 18436@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a 18437MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when 18438you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}. 18439 18440@need 1000 18441Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board: 18442 18443@table @code 18444@item target mips @var{port} 18445@kindex target mips @var{port} 18446To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the 18447name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the 18448command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of 18449the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already 18450been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to 18451download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. 18452 18453For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial 18454port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the 18455debugger: 18456 18457@smallexample 18458host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog} 18459@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{} 18460(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb 18461(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog} 18462(@value{GDBP}) run 18463@end smallexample 18464 18465@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber} 18466On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP 18467connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal 18468concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax 18469@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}. 18470 18471@item target pmon @var{port} 18472@kindex target pmon @var{port} 18473PMON ROM monitor. 18474 18475@item target ddb @var{port} 18476@kindex target ddb @var{port} 18477NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300. 18478 18479@item target lsi @var{port} 18480@kindex target lsi @var{port} 18481LSI variant of PMON. 18482 18483@kindex target r3900 18484@item target r3900 @var{dev} 18485Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips. 18486 18487@kindex target array 18488@item target array @var{dev} 18489Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board. 18490 18491@end table 18492 18493 18494@noindent 18495@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets: 18496 18497@table @code 18498@item set mipsfpu double 18499@itemx set mipsfpu single 18500@itemx set mipsfpu none 18501@itemx set mipsfpu auto 18502@itemx show mipsfpu 18503@kindex set mipsfpu 18504@kindex show mipsfpu 18505@cindex MIPS remote floating point 18506@cindex floating point, MIPS remote 18507If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point 18508coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you 18509need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init 18510file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of 18511functions which return floating point values. It also allows 18512@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling 18513functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor 18514with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650} 18515processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default 18516double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using 18517@samp{set mipsfpu double}. 18518 18519In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no 18520floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision 18521and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point. 18522 18523As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with 18524@samp{show mipsfpu}. 18525 18526@item set timeout @var{seconds} 18527@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds} 18528@itemx show timeout 18529@itemx show retransmit-timeout 18530@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol 18531@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol 18532@kindex set timeout 18533@kindex show timeout 18534@kindex set retransmit-timeout 18535@kindex show retransmit-timeout 18536You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS 18537remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The 18538default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while 18539waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set 18540retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds. 18541You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show 18542retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when 18543@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.) 18544 18545The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN} 18546is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits 18547forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going 18548to run before stopping. 18549 18550@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num} 18551@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote} 18552@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target 18553Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when 18554it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10 18555characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit. 18556 18557@item show syn-garbage-limit 18558@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote} 18559Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when 18560trying to synchronize with the remote system. 18561 18562@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt} 18563@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote} 18564@cindex remote monitor prompt 18565Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the 18566remote monitor. The default depends on the target: 18567@table @asis 18568@item pmon target 18569@samp{PMON} 18570@item ddb target 18571@samp{NEC010} 18572@item lsi target 18573@samp{PMON>} 18574@end table 18575 18576@item show monitor-prompt 18577@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote} 18578Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the 18579remote monitor. 18580 18581@item set monitor-warnings 18582@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote} 18583Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This 18584has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will 18585display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi} 18586PMON monitor for breakpoint commands. 18587 18588@item show monitor-warnings 18589@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote} 18590Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings. 18591 18592@item pmon @var{command} 18593@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote} 18594@cindex send PMON command 18595This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the 18596monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work. 18597@end table 18598 18599@node OpenRISC 1000 18600@subsection OpenRISC 1000 18601@cindex OpenRISC 1000 18602 18603@cindex or1k boards 18604See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information 18605about platform and commands. 18606 18607@table @code 18608 18609@kindex target jtag 18610@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port} 18611 18612Connects to remote JTAG server. 18613JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server, 18614connected via parallel port to the board. 18615 18616Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999} 18617 18618@kindex or1ksim 18619@item or1ksim @var{command} 18620If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural 18621Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed. 18622 18623@kindex info or1k spr 18624@item info or1k spr 18625Displays spr groups. 18626 18627@item info or1k spr @var{group} 18628@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} 18629Displays register names in selected group. 18630 18631@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register} 18632@itemx info or1k spr @var{register} 18633@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno} 18634@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno} 18635Shows information about specified spr register. 18636 18637@kindex spr 18638@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value} 18639@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}} 18640@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}} 18641@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}} 18642Writes @var{value} to specified spr register. 18643@end table 18644 18645Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace. 18646It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal 18647program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint 18648triggers can be set using: 18649@table @code 18650@item $LEA/$LDATA 18651Load effective address/data 18652@item $SEA/$SDATA 18653Store effective address/data 18654@item $AEA/$ADATA 18655Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA) 18656@item $FETCH 18657Fetch data 18658@end table 18659 18660When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA}, 18661@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}. 18662 18663@code{htrace} commands: 18664@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace 18665@table @code 18666@kindex hwatch 18667@item hwatch @var{conditional} 18668Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es) 18669or Data. For example: 18670 18671@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)} 18672 18673@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)} 18674 18675@kindex htrace 18676@item htrace info 18677Display information about current HW trace configuration. 18678 18679@item htrace trigger @var{conditional} 18680Set starting criteria for HW trace. 18681 18682@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional} 18683Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace. 18684 18685@item htrace stop @var{conditional} 18686Set HW trace stopping criteria. 18687 18688@item htrace record [@var{data}]* 18689Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was 18690triggered. 18691 18692@item htrace enable 18693@itemx htrace disable 18694Enables/disables the HW trace. 18695 18696@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}] 18697Clears currently recorded trace data. 18698 18699If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data 18700will be written there. 18701 18702@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]] 18703Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration. 18704 18705@item htrace mode continuous 18706Set continuous trace mode. 18707 18708@item htrace mode suspend 18709Set suspend trace mode. 18710 18711@end table 18712 18713@node PowerPC Embedded 18714@subsection PowerPC Embedded 18715 18716@cindex DVC register 18717@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to 18718implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form: 18719 18720@smallexample 18721(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \ 18722 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION} 18723@end smallexample 18724 18725The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects 18726such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one 18727debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the 18728variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature 18729is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 18730or newer. 18731 18732When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses 18733ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on, 18734in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when 18735watching variables of scalar types. 18736 18737You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory 18738region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}): 18739 18740@smallexample 18741(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length} 18742(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address} 18743@end smallexample 18744 18745@cindex ranged breakpoint 18746PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated 18747@dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of 18748the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within 18749the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN}, 18750use the @code{break-range} command. 18751 18752@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands: 18753 18754@table @code 18755@kindex break-range 18756@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location} 18757Set a breakpoint for an address range. 18758@var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name, 18759a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start 18760location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location}, 18761for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.) 18762The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it 18763executes an instruction at any address within the specified range, 18764(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.) 18765 18766@kindex set powerpc 18767@item set powerpc soft-float 18768@itemx show powerpc soft-float 18769Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling 18770convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based 18771on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 18772 18773@item set powerpc vector-abi 18774@itemx show powerpc vector-abi 18775Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector 18776arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto}; 18777@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present; 18778@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE 18779registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention 18780based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 18781 18782@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints 18783@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints 18784Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable 18785of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the 18786address of its first byte. 18787 18788@kindex target dink32 18789@item target dink32 @var{dev} 18790DINK32 ROM monitor. 18791 18792@kindex target ppcbug 18793@item target ppcbug @var{dev} 18794@kindex target ppcbug1 18795@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev} 18796PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC. 18797 18798@kindex target sds 18799@item target sds @var{dev} 18800SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS). 18801@end table 18802 18803@cindex SDS protocol 18804The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported 18805by @value{GDBN}: 18806 18807@table @code 18808@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec} 18809@kindex set sdstimeout 18810Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The 18811default is 2 seconds. 18812 18813@item show sdstimeout 18814@kindex show sdstimeout 18815Show the current value of the SDS timeout. 18816 18817@item sds @var{command} 18818@kindex sds@r{, a command} 18819Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor. 18820@end table 18821 18822 18823@node PA 18824@subsection HP PA Embedded 18825 18826@table @code 18827 18828@kindex target op50n 18829@item target op50n @var{dev} 18830OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board. 18831 18832@kindex target w89k 18833@item target w89k @var{dev} 18834W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board. 18835 18836@end table 18837 18838@node Sparclet 18839@subsection Tsqware Sparclet 18840 18841@cindex Sparclet 18842 18843@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on 18844Sparclet targets from a Unix host. 18845@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on 18846both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program 18847@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. 18848 18849@table @code 18850@item remotetimeout @var{args} 18851@kindex remotetimeout 18852@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}. 18853This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of 18854seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses. 18855@end table 18856 18857@cindex compiling, on Sparclet 18858When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug 18859information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to 18860load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or 18861@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example: 18862 18863@smallexample 18864sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N 18865@end smallexample 18866 18867You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended: 18868 18869@smallexample 18870sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog 18871@end smallexample 18872 18873@cindex running, on Sparclet 18874Once you have set 18875your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to 18876run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} 18877(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation). 18878 18879@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt: 18880 18881@smallexample 18882(gdbslet) 18883@end smallexample 18884 18885@menu 18886* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug 18887* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet 18888* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download 18889* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging 18890@end menu 18891 18892@node Sparclet File 18893@subsubsection Setting File to Debug 18894 18895The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug. 18896 18897@smallexample 18898(gdbslet) file prog 18899@end smallexample 18900 18901@need 1000 18902@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}. 18903@value{GDBN} locates 18904the file by searching the directories listed in the command search 18905path. 18906If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source 18907files will be searched as well. 18908@value{GDBN} locates 18909the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search 18910path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}). 18911If it fails 18912to find a file, it displays a message such as: 18913 18914@smallexample 18915prog: No such file or directory. 18916@end smallexample 18917 18918When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with 18919the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the 18920@code{target} command again. 18921 18922@node Sparclet Connection 18923@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet 18924 18925The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target. 18926To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type: 18927 18928@smallexample 18929(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya 18930Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya 18931main () at ../prog.c:3 18932@end smallexample 18933 18934@need 750 18935@value{GDBN} displays messages like these: 18936 18937@smallexample 18938Connected to ttya. 18939@end smallexample 18940 18941@node Sparclet Download 18942@subsubsection Sparclet Download 18943 18944@cindex download to Sparclet 18945Once connected to the Sparclet target, 18946you can use the @value{GDBN} 18947@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target. 18948The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load} 18949command. 18950Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting 18951address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load 18952offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address) 18953of each of the file's sections. 18954For instance, if the program 18955@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160 18956and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type: 18957 18958@smallexample 18959(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000 18960Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000 18961@end smallexample 18962 18963If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked 18964to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands 18965to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table. 18966 18967@node Sparclet Execution 18968@subsubsection Running and Debugging 18969 18970@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs 18971You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control 18972commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN} 18973manual for the list of commands. 18974 18975@smallexample 18976(gdbslet) b main 18977Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3. 18978(gdbslet) run 18979Starting program: prog 18980Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3 189813 char *symarg = 0; 18982(gdbslet) step 189834 char *execarg = "hello!"; 18984(gdbslet) 18985@end smallexample 18986 18987@node Sparclite 18988@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite 18989 18990@table @code 18991 18992@kindex target sparclite 18993@item target sparclite @var{dev} 18994Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading. 18995You must use an additional command to debug the program. 18996For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard 18997remote protocol. 18998 18999@end table 19000 19001@node Z8000 19002@subsection Zilog Z8000 19003 19004@cindex Z8000 19005@cindex simulator, Z8000 19006@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator 19007 19008When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes 19009a Z8000 simulator. 19010 19011For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the 19012unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the 19013segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is 19014appropriate by inspecting the object code. 19015 19016@table @code 19017@item target sim @var{args} 19018@kindex sim 19019@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000} 19020Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup 19021options, specify them via @var{args}. 19022@end table 19023 19024@noindent 19025After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated 19026CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the 19027@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command 19028to run your program, and so on. 19029 19030As well as making available all the usual machine registers 19031(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three 19032additional items of information as specially named registers: 19033 19034@table @code 19035 19036@item cycles 19037Counts clock-ticks in the simulator. 19038 19039@item insts 19040Counts instructions run in the simulator. 19041 19042@item time 19043Execution time in 60ths of a second. 19044 19045@end table 19046 19047You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual 19048conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a 19049conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000 19050simulated clock ticks. 19051 19052@node AVR 19053@subsection Atmel AVR 19054@cindex AVR 19055 19056When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the 19057following AVR-specific commands: 19058 19059@table @code 19060@item info io_registers 19061@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR} 19062@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR) 19063This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For 19064each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value. 19065@end table 19066 19067@node CRIS 19068@subsection CRIS 19069@cindex CRIS 19070 19071When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the 19072following CRIS-specific commands: 19073 19074@table @code 19075@item set cris-version @var{ver} 19076@cindex CRIS version 19077Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}. 19078The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in 19079case autodetection of the CRIS version fails. 19080 19081@item show cris-version 19082Show the current CRIS version. 19083 19084@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi 19085@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS 19086Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}. 19087Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below 19088@code{R59}. 19089 19090@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi 19091Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI. 19092 19093@item set cris-mode @var{mode} 19094@cindex CRIS mode 19095Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when 19096debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to 19097@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}). 19098 19099@item show cris-mode 19100Show the current CRIS mode. 19101@end table 19102 19103@node Super-H 19104@subsection Renesas Super-H 19105@cindex Super-H 19106 19107For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these 19108commands: 19109 19110@table @code 19111@item regs 19112@kindex regs@r{, Super-H} 19113Show the values of all Super-H registers. 19114 19115@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention} 19116@kindex set sh calling-convention 19117Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}. 19118Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}. 19119With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling 19120convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies 19121that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function 19122is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention 19123is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used, 19124regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the 19125default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler 19126does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function. 19127 19128@item show sh calling-convention 19129@kindex show sh calling-convention 19130Show the current calling convention setting. 19131 19132@end table 19133 19134 19135@node Architectures 19136@section Architectures 19137 19138This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect 19139all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross. 19140 19141@menu 19142* i386:: 19143* A29K:: 19144* Alpha:: 19145* MIPS:: 19146* HPPA:: HP PA architecture 19147* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 19148* PowerPC:: 19149@end menu 19150 19151@node i386 19152@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues 19153 19154@table @code 19155@item set struct-convention @var{mode} 19156@kindex set struct-convention 19157@cindex struct return convention 19158@cindex struct/union returned in registers 19159Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and 19160@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of 19161@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the 19162default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s 19163are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a 19164@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will 19165be returned in a register. 19166 19167@item show struct-convention 19168@kindex show struct-convention 19169Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s 19170from functions. 19171@end table 19172 19173@node A29K 19174@subsection A29K 19175 19176@table @code 19177 19178@kindex set rstack_high_address 19179@cindex AMD 29K register stack 19180@cindex register stack, AMD29K 19181@item set rstack_high_address @var{address} 19182On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate 19183@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the 19184extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the 19185stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing 19186memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around 19187this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with 19188the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an 19189address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in 19190hexadecimal. 19191 19192@kindex show rstack_high_address 19193@item show rstack_high_address 19194Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family 19195processors. 19196 19197@end table 19198 19199@node Alpha 19200@subsection Alpha 19201 19202See the following section. 19203 19204@node MIPS 19205@subsection MIPS 19206 19207@cindex stack on Alpha 19208@cindex stack on MIPS 19209@cindex Alpha stack 19210@cindex MIPS stack 19211Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which 19212sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to 19213find the beginning of a function. 19214 19215@cindex response time, MIPS debugging 19216To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where 19217@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search) 19218you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these 19219commands: 19220 19221@table @code 19222@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS) 19223@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit} 19224Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its 19225search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the 19226default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the 19227larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search 19228and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use 19229this command when debugging a stripped executable. 19230 19231@item show heuristic-fence-post 19232Display the current limit. 19233@end table 19234 19235@noindent 19236These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured 19237for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors. 19238 19239Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS 19240programs: 19241 19242@table @code 19243@item set mips abi @var{arg} 19244@kindex set mips abi 19245@cindex set ABI for MIPS 19246Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible 19247values of @var{arg} are: 19248 19249@table @samp 19250@item auto 19251The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the 19252default). 19253@item o32 19254@item o64 19255@item n32 19256@item n64 19257@item eabi32 19258@item eabi64 19259@item auto 19260@end table 19261 19262@item show mips abi 19263@kindex show mips abi 19264Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior. 19265 19266@item set mipsfpu 19267@itemx show mipsfpu 19268@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}. 19269 19270@item set mips mask-address @var{arg} 19271@kindex set mips mask-address 19272@cindex MIPS addresses, masking 19273This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit 19274MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be 19275@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default 19276setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value. 19277 19278@item show mips mask-address 19279@kindex show mips mask-address 19280Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or 19281not. 19282 19283@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 19284@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 19285This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that 19286transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target 19287that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr}, 19288and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}. 19289 19290@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 19291@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 19292Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets. 19293 19294@item set debug mips 19295@kindex set debug mips 19296This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific 19297target code in @value{GDBN}. 19298 19299@item show debug mips 19300@kindex show debug mips 19301Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages. 19302@end table 19303 19304 19305@node HPPA 19306@subsection HPPA 19307@cindex HPPA support 19308 19309When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the 19310following special commands: 19311 19312@table @code 19313@item set debug hppa 19314@kindex set debug hppa 19315This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging 19316messages are to be displayed. 19317 19318@item show debug hppa 19319Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed. 19320 19321@item maint print unwind @var{address} 19322@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA} 19323This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the 19324given @var{address}. 19325 19326@end table 19327 19328 19329@node SPU 19330@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 19331@cindex Cell Broadband Engine 19332@cindex SPU 19333 19334When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture, 19335it provides the following special commands: 19336 19337@table @code 19338@item info spu event 19339@kindex info spu 19340Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask 19341and pending event status. 19342 19343@item info spu signal 19344Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending 19345signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal 19346notification channels. 19347 19348@item info spu mailbox 19349Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries, 19350in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound, 19351SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes. 19352 19353@item info spu dma 19354Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 19355DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 19356and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 19357 19358@item info spu proxydma 19359Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 19360Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 19361and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 19362 19363@end table 19364 19365When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application 19366on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following 19367special commands: 19368 19369@table @code 19370@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg} 19371@kindex set spu 19372Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN} 19373will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main} 19374function. The default is @code{off}. 19375 19376@item show spu stop-on-load 19377@kindex show spu 19378Show whether to stop for new SPE threads. 19379 19380@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg} 19381Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to 19382@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed 19383cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent 19384view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application 19385does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect. 19386 19387@item show spu auto-flush-cache 19388Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. 19389 19390@end table 19391 19392@node PowerPC 19393@subsection PowerPC 19394@cindex PowerPC architecture 19395 19396When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of 19397pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point 19398numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored 19399in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like 19400@code{f0} or @code{f2}. 19401 19402The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed 19403by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0}, 19404@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on. 19405 19406For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit 19407wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}). 19408 19409 19410@node Controlling GDB 19411@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN} 19412 19413You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the 19414@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays 19415data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are 19416described here. 19417 19418@menu 19419* Prompt:: Prompt 19420* Editing:: Command editing 19421* Command History:: Command history 19422* Screen Size:: Screen size 19423* Numbers:: Numbers 19424* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI 19425* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages 19426* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings 19427* Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings 19428@end menu 19429 19430@node Prompt 19431@section Prompt 19432 19433@cindex prompt 19434 19435@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string 19436called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You 19437can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For 19438instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change 19439the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell 19440which one you are talking to. 19441 19442@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the 19443prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space 19444or a prompt that does not. 19445 19446@table @code 19447@kindex set prompt 19448@item set prompt @var{newprompt} 19449Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth. 19450 19451@kindex show prompt 19452@item show prompt 19453Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}} 19454@end table 19455 19456@node Editing 19457@section Command Editing 19458@cindex readline 19459@cindex command line editing 19460 19461@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This 19462@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a 19463command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style 19464or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history 19465substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across 19466debugging sessions. 19467 19468You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the 19469command @code{set}. 19470 19471@table @code 19472@kindex set editing 19473@cindex editing 19474@item set editing 19475@itemx set editing on 19476Enable command line editing (enabled by default). 19477 19478@item set editing off 19479Disable command line editing. 19480 19481@kindex show editing 19482@item show editing 19483Show whether command line editing is enabled. 19484@end table 19485 19486@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 19487@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}, 19488@end ifset 19489@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 19490@xref{Command Line Editing}, 19491@end ifclear 19492for more details about the Readline 19493interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are 19494encouraged to read that chapter. 19495 19496@node Command History 19497@section Command History 19498@cindex command history 19499 19500@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your 19501debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what 19502happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command 19503history facility. 19504 19505@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline 19506package, to provide the history facility. 19507@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 19508@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library}, 19509@end ifset 19510@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 19511@xref{Using History Interactively}, 19512@end ifclear 19513for the detailed description of the History library. 19514 19515To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of 19516the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server } 19517(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This 19518means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it 19519affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is 19520pressed on a line by itself. 19521 19522@cindex @code{server}, command prefix 19523The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value 19524history; to print a value without recording it into the value history, 19525use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command. 19526 19527Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command 19528history. 19529 19530@table @code 19531@cindex history substitution 19532@cindex history file 19533@kindex set history filename 19534@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable 19535@item set history filename @var{fname} 19536Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}. 19537This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history 19538list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it 19539exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through 19540the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults 19541to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to 19542@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable 19543is not set. 19544 19545@cindex save command history 19546@kindex set history save 19547@item set history save 19548@itemx set history save on 19549Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the 19550@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled. 19551 19552@item set history save off 19553Stop recording command history in a file. 19554 19555@cindex history size 19556@kindex set history size 19557@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable 19558@item set history size @var{size} 19559Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list. 19560This defaults to the value of the environment variable 19561@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. 19562@end table 19563 19564History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}. 19565@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 19566@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library}, 19567@end ifset 19568@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 19569@xref{Event Designators}, 19570@end ifclear 19571for more details. 19572 19573@cindex history expansion, turn on/off 19574Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion 19575is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the 19576@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to 19577follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with 19578a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline 19579history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings 19580@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled. 19581 19582The commands to control history expansion are: 19583 19584@table @code 19585@item set history expansion on 19586@itemx set history expansion 19587@kindex set history expansion 19588Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default. 19589 19590@item set history expansion off 19591Disable history expansion. 19592 19593@c @group 19594@kindex show history 19595@item show history 19596@itemx show history filename 19597@itemx show history save 19598@itemx show history size 19599@itemx show history expansion 19600These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters. 19601@code{show history} by itself displays all four states. 19602@c @end group 19603@end table 19604 19605@table @code 19606@kindex show commands 19607@cindex show last commands 19608@cindex display command history 19609@item show commands 19610Display the last ten commands in the command history. 19611 19612@item show commands @var{n} 19613Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}. 19614 19615@item show commands + 19616Print ten commands just after the commands last printed. 19617@end table 19618 19619@node Screen Size 19620@section Screen Size 19621@cindex size of screen 19622@cindex pauses in output 19623 19624Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of 19625information output to the screen. To help you read all of it, 19626@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of 19627output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q} 19628to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting 19629determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being 19630printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place, 19631rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line. 19632 19633Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal 19634driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base 19635together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the 19636@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct, 19637you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set 19638width} commands: 19639 19640@table @code 19641@kindex set height 19642@kindex set width 19643@kindex show width 19644@kindex show height 19645@item set height @var{lpp} 19646@itemx show height 19647@itemx set width @var{cpl} 19648@itemx show width 19649These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and 19650a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show} 19651commands display the current settings. 19652 19653If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during 19654output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a 19655file or to an editor buffer. 19656 19657Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} 19658from wrapping its output. 19659 19660@item set pagination on 19661@itemx set pagination off 19662@kindex set pagination 19663Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning 19664pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that 19665running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode 19666Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination. 19667 19668@item show pagination 19669@kindex show pagination 19670Show the current pagination mode. 19671@end table 19672 19673@node Numbers 19674@section Numbers 19675@cindex number representation 19676@cindex entering numbers 19677 19678You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in 19679@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with 19680@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers 19681begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or 19682@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base 1968310; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular 19684format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for 19685both input and output with the commands described below. 19686 19687@table @code 19688@kindex set input-radix 19689@item set input-radix @var{base} 19690Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices 19691for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be 19692specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for 19693example, any of 19694 19695@smallexample 19696set input-radix 012 19697set input-radix 10. 19698set input-radix 0xa 19699@end smallexample 19700 19701@noindent 19702sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10} 19703leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since 19704@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is 19705interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16, 19706@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't 19707change the radix. 19708 19709@kindex set output-radix 19710@item set output-radix @var{base} 19711Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices 19712for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be 19713specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix. 19714 19715@kindex show input-radix 19716@item show input-radix 19717Display the current default base for numeric input. 19718 19719@kindex show output-radix 19720@item show output-radix 19721Display the current default base for numeric display. 19722 19723@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]} 19724@itemx show radix 19725@kindex set radix 19726@kindex show radix 19727These commands set and show the default base for both input and output 19728of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to 19729the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its 19730default value of 10. 19731 19732@end table 19733 19734@node ABI 19735@section Configuring the Current ABI 19736 19737@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your 19738application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its 19739conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the 19740current ABI. 19741 19742@cindex OS ABI 19743@kindex set osabi 19744@kindex show osabi 19745 19746One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating 19747system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation. 19748@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use, 19749but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command. 19750One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use 19751an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does 19752not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your 19753platform provides. 19754 19755@table @code 19756@item show osabi 19757Show the OS ABI currently in use. 19758 19759@item set osabi 19760With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's. 19761 19762@item set osabi @var{abi} 19763Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}. 19764@end table 19765 19766@cindex float promotion 19767 19768Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a 19769function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped 19770(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged, 19771according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped 19772(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type 19773@code{double} and then passed. 19774 19775Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether 19776a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked 19777as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}. 19778 19779@table @code 19780@kindex set coerce-float-to-double 19781@item set coerce-float-to-double 19782@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on 19783Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed 19784to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting. 19785 19786@item set coerce-float-to-double off 19787Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped 19788functions. 19789 19790@kindex show coerce-float-to-double 19791@item show coerce-float-to-double 19792Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}. 19793@end table 19794 19795@kindex set cp-abi 19796@kindex show cp-abi 19797@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++} 19798objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was 19799used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports 19800programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using 19801multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your 19802program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use. 19803Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions 19804before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and 19805``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may 19806use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is 19807``auto''. 19808 19809@table @code 19810@item show cp-abi 19811Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use. 19812 19813@item set cp-abi 19814With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's. 19815 19816@item set cp-abi @var{abi} 19817@itemx set cp-abi auto 19818Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection. 19819@end table 19820 19821@node Messages/Warnings 19822@section Optional Warnings and Messages 19823 19824@cindex verbose operation 19825@cindex optional warnings 19826By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are 19827running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} 19828command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy 19829internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed. 19830 19831Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those 19832which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read; 19833see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}. 19834 19835@table @code 19836@kindex set verbose 19837@item set verbose on 19838Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 19839 19840@item set verbose off 19841Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 19842 19843@kindex show verbose 19844@item show verbose 19845Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off. 19846@end table 19847 19848By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an 19849object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may 19850find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading 19851Symbol Files}). 19852 19853@table @code 19854 19855@kindex set complaints 19856@item set complaints @var{limit} 19857Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of 19858unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set 19859@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number 19860to prevent complaints from being suppressed. 19861 19862@kindex show complaints 19863@item show complaints 19864Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce. 19865 19866@end table 19867 19868@anchor{confirmation requests} 19869By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a 19870lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if 19871you try to run a program which is already running: 19872 19873@smallexample 19874(@value{GDBP}) run 19875The program being debugged has been started already. 19876Start it from the beginning? (y or n) 19877@end smallexample 19878 19879If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own 19880commands, you can disable this ``feature'': 19881 19882@table @code 19883 19884@kindex set confirm 19885@cindex flinching 19886@cindex confirmation 19887@cindex stupid questions 19888@item set confirm off 19889Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with 19890the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also 19891automatically disables confirmation requests. 19892 19893@item set confirm on 19894Enables confirmation requests (the default). 19895 19896@kindex show confirm 19897@item show confirm 19898Displays state of confirmation requests. 19899 19900@end table 19901 19902@cindex command tracing 19903If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it 19904useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be 19905printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the 19906quantity denoting the call depth of each command. 19907 19908@table @code 19909@kindex set trace-commands 19910@cindex command scripts, debugging 19911@item set trace-commands on 19912Enable command tracing. 19913@item set trace-commands off 19914Disable command tracing. 19915@item show trace-commands 19916Display the current state of command tracing. 19917@end table 19918 19919@node Debugging Output 19920@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings 19921@cindex optional debugging messages 19922 19923@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from 19924various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of 19925interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This 19926section documents those commands. 19927 19928@table @code 19929@kindex set exec-done-display 19930@item set exec-done-display 19931Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands' 19932completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an 19933asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off. 19934@kindex show exec-done-display 19935@item show exec-done-display 19936Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion 19937notification. 19938@kindex set debug 19939@cindex gdbarch debugging info 19940@cindex architecture debugging info 19941@item set debug arch 19942Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off 19943@kindex show debug 19944@item show debug arch 19945Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info. 19946@item set debug aix-thread 19947@cindex AIX threads 19948Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread 19949module. 19950@item show debug aix-thread 19951Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display. 19952@item set debug check-physname 19953@cindex physname 19954Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF 19955debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute 19956each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two 19957different ways, depending on exactly what information is present. 19958When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names 19959both ways and display any discrepancies. 19960@item show debug check-physname 19961Show the current state of ``physname'' checking. 19962@item set debug dwarf2-die 19963@cindex DWARF2 DIEs 19964Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in. 19965The value is the number of nesting levels to print. 19966A value of zero turns off the display. 19967@item show debug dwarf2-die 19968Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging. 19969@item set debug displaced 19970@cindex displaced stepping debugging info 19971Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the 19972displaced stepping support. The default is off. 19973@item show debug displaced 19974Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info 19975related to displaced stepping. 19976@item set debug event 19977@cindex event debugging info 19978Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The 19979default is off. 19980@item show debug event 19981Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging 19982info. 19983@item set debug expression 19984@cindex expression debugging info 19985Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN} 19986expression parsing. The default is off. 19987@item show debug expression 19988Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about 19989@value{GDBN} expression parsing. 19990@item set debug frame 19991@cindex frame debugging info 19992Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The 19993default is off. 19994@item show debug frame 19995Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging 19996info. 19997@item set debug gnu-nat 19998@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages 19999Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support. 20000@item show debug gnu-nat 20001Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages. 20002@item set debug infrun 20003@cindex inferior debugging info 20004Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior. 20005The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used 20006for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior. 20007@item show debug infrun 20008Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging. 20009@item set debug jit 20010@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages 20011Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support. 20012@item show debug jit 20013Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging. 20014@item set debug lin-lwp 20015@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages 20016@cindex Linux lightweight processes 20017Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support. 20018@item show debug lin-lwp 20019Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages. 20020@item set debug lin-lwp-async 20021@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages 20022@cindex Linux lightweight processes 20023Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support. 20024@item show debug lin-lwp-async 20025Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages. 20026@item set debug observer 20027@cindex observer debugging info 20028Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This 20029includes info such as the notification of observable events. 20030@item show debug observer 20031Displays the current state of observer debugging. 20032@item set debug overload 20033@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info 20034Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging 20035info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default 20036is off. 20037@item show debug overload 20038Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload 20039debugging info. 20040@cindex expression parser, debugging info 20041@cindex debug expression parser 20042@item set debug parser 20043Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output. 20044Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression 20045parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for 20046details. The default is off. 20047@item show debug parser 20048Show the current state of expression parser debugging. 20049@cindex packets, reporting on stdout 20050@cindex serial connections, debugging 20051@cindex debug remote protocol 20052@cindex remote protocol debugging 20053@cindex display remote packets 20054@item set debug remote 20055Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across 20056the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the 20057@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off. 20058@item show debug remote 20059Displays the state of display of remote packets. 20060@item set debug serial 20061Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The 20062default is off. 20063@item show debug serial 20064Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging 20065info. 20066@item set debug solib-frv 20067@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging 20068Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code. 20069@item show debug solib-frv 20070Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging 20071messages. 20072@item set debug target 20073@cindex target debugging info 20074Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info 20075includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The 20076default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the 20077value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect 20078until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command. 20079@item show debug target 20080Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging 20081info. 20082@item set debug timestamp 20083@cindex timestampping debugging info 20084Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info. 20085When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging 20086message. 20087@item show debug timestamp 20088Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN} 20089debugging info. 20090@item set debugvarobj 20091@cindex variable object debugging info 20092Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging 20093info. The default is off. 20094@item show debugvarobj 20095Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object 20096debugging info. 20097@item set debug xml 20098@cindex XML parser debugging 20099Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers. 20100@item show debug xml 20101Displays the current state of XML debugging messages. 20102@end table 20103 20104@node Other Misc Settings 20105@section Other Miscellaneous Settings 20106@cindex miscellaneous settings 20107 20108@table @code 20109@kindex set interactive-mode 20110@item set interactive-mode 20111If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started 20112in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait 20113for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at 20114the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate 20115in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries. 20116If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether 20117its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it 20118is, non-interactively otherwise. 20119 20120In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess 20121correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful 20122in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN} 20123inside a cygwin window. 20124 20125@kindex show interactive-mode 20126@item show interactive-mode 20127Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not. 20128@end table 20129 20130@node Extending GDB 20131@chapter Extending @value{GDBN} 20132@cindex extending GDB 20133 20134@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based 20135on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the 20136Python scripting language. 20137 20138To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable 20139of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN} 20140can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at 20141the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension 20142are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files. 20143@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 20144 20145You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following 20146setting: 20147 20148@table @code 20149@kindex set script-extension 20150@kindex show script-extension 20151@item set script-extension off 20152All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files. 20153 20154@item set script-extension soft 20155The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 20156extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN} 20157evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates 20158the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File. 20159 20160@item set script-extension strict 20161The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 20162extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the 20163language is not supported, then the evaluation fails. 20164 20165@item show script-extension 20166Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option. 20167 20168@end table 20169 20170@menu 20171* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands 20172* Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python 20173@end menu 20174 20175@node Sequences 20176@section Canned Sequences of Commands 20177 20178Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint 20179Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of 20180commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command 20181files. 20182 20183@menu 20184* Define:: How to define your own commands 20185* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands 20186* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file 20187* Output:: Commands for controlled output 20188@end menu 20189 20190@node Define 20191@subsection User-defined Commands 20192 20193@cindex user-defined command 20194@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands 20195A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to 20196which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the 20197@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments 20198separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command 20199via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example: 20200 20201@smallexample 20202define adder 20203 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 20204end 20205@end smallexample 20206 20207@noindent 20208To execute the command use: 20209 20210@smallexample 20211adder 1 2 3 20212@end smallexample 20213 20214@noindent 20215This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of 20216its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may 20217reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior 20218functions calls. 20219 20220@cindex argument count in user-defined commands 20221@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands) 20222In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have 20223been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10. 20224 20225@smallexample 20226define adder 20227 if $argc == 2 20228 print $arg0 + $arg1 20229 end 20230 if $argc == 3 20231 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 20232 end 20233end 20234@end smallexample 20235 20236@table @code 20237 20238@kindex define 20239@item define @var{commandname} 20240Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command 20241by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it. 20242@var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters, 20243numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined 20244prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates 20245a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command. 20246 20247The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines, 20248which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these 20249commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 20250 20251@kindex document 20252@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)} 20253@item document @var{commandname} 20254Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be 20255accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be 20256defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define} 20257reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}. 20258After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command 20259@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written. 20260 20261You may use the @code{document} command again to change the 20262documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define} 20263does not change the documentation. 20264 20265@kindex dont-repeat 20266@cindex don't repeat command 20267@item dont-repeat 20268Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this 20269command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET} 20270(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}). 20271 20272@kindex help user-defined 20273@item help user-defined 20274List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation 20275(if any) for each. 20276 20277@kindex show user 20278@item show user 20279@itemx show user @var{commandname} 20280Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but 20281not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the 20282definitions for all user-defined commands. 20283 20284@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands 20285@kindex show max-user-call-depth 20286@kindex set max-user-call-depth 20287@item show max-user-call-depth 20288@itemx set max-user-call-depth 20289The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion 20290levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an 20291infinite recursion and aborts the command. 20292@end table 20293 20294In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently 20295use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}. 20296 20297When user-defined commands are executed, the 20298commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command 20299stops execution of the user-defined command. 20300 20301If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed 20302without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN} 20303commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the 20304messages when used in a user-defined command. 20305 20306@node Hooks 20307@subsection User-defined Command Hooks 20308@cindex command hooks 20309@cindex hooks, for commands 20310@cindex hooks, pre-command 20311 20312@kindex hook 20313You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined 20314command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined 20315command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) 20316before that command. 20317 20318@cindex hooks, post-command 20319@kindex hookpost 20320A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed. 20321Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command 20322@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after 20323that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with 20324pre-execution hooks, for the same command. 20325 20326It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this 20327occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion. 20328 20329@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating 20330@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME! 20331 20332@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command} 20333In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining 20334(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time 20335execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run, 20336displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed. 20337 20338For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while 20339single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution, 20340you could define: 20341 20342@smallexample 20343define hook-stop 20344handle SIGALRM nopass 20345end 20346 20347define hook-run 20348handle SIGALRM pass 20349end 20350 20351define hook-continue 20352handle SIGALRM pass 20353end 20354@end smallexample 20355 20356As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo} 20357command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message, 20358you could define: 20359 20360@smallexample 20361define hook-echo 20362echo <<<--- 20363end 20364 20365define hookpost-echo 20366echo --->>>\n 20367end 20368 20369(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World 20370<<<---Hello World--->>> 20371(@value{GDBP}) 20372 20373@end smallexample 20374 20375You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but 20376not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command 20377name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}. 20378@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias 20379@c or not? 20380You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or 20381@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@: 20382@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}. 20383 20384If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of 20385@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt 20386(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run). 20387 20388If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you 20389get a warning from the @code{define} command. 20390 20391@node Command Files 20392@subsection Command Files 20393 20394@cindex command files 20395@cindex scripting commands 20396A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are 20397@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may 20398also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it 20399does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the 20400terminal. 20401 20402You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source} 20403command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate 20404scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured 20405using the @code{script-extension} setting. 20406@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}. 20407 20408@table @code 20409@kindex source 20410@cindex execute commands from a file 20411@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename} 20412Execute the command file @var{filename}. 20413@end table 20414 20415The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially, 20416unless the order of execution is changed by one of the 20417@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not 20418printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates 20419execution of the command file and control is returned to the console. 20420 20421@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory. 20422If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a 20423directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path 20424(specified with the @samp{directory} command); 20425except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory 20426is not relevant to scripts. 20427 20428If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} 20429on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory. 20430The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the 20431search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript} 20432and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 20433look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}. 20434The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path. 20435For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and 20436the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 20437look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}. 20438For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification, 20439it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is 20440@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN} 20441will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}. 20442 20443If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays 20444each command as it is executed. The option must be given before 20445@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else. 20446 20447Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed 20448without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that 20449normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages 20450when called from command files. 20451 20452@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this 20453mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to 20454standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do 20455not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with 20456the next command. 20457 20458@smallexample 20459gdb < cmds > log 2>&1 20460@end smallexample 20461 20462(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example 20463will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors 20464would be directed to @file{log}. 20465 20466Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than 20467commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with 20468complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of 20469variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is 20470built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to 20471deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write 20472complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands 20473conditionally, etc. 20474 20475@table @code 20476@kindex if 20477@kindex else 20478@item if 20479@itemx else 20480This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed 20481commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an 20482expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that 20483are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero). 20484There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series 20485of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The 20486end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 20487 20488@kindex while 20489@item while 20490This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to 20491@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression 20492to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per 20493line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the 20494@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are 20495executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true. 20496 20497@kindex loop_break 20498@item loop_break 20499This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. 20500Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end} 20501line. 20502 20503@kindex loop_continue 20504@item loop_continue 20505This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands 20506in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution 20507branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates 20508the controlling expression. 20509 20510@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)} 20511@item end 20512Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if}, 20513@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands. 20514@end table 20515 20516 20517@node Output 20518@subsection Commands for Controlled Output 20519 20520During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal 20521@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is 20522explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section 20523describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you 20524want. 20525 20526@table @code 20527@kindex echo 20528@item echo @var{text} 20529@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence 20530@c because it is not in ANSI. 20531Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in 20532@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a 20533newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.} 20534In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed 20535by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a 20536string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and 20537trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments. 20538To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command 20539@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}. 20540 20541A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue 20542the command onto subsequent lines. For example, 20543 20544@smallexample 20545echo This is some text\n\ 20546which is continued\n\ 20547onto several lines.\n 20548@end smallexample 20549 20550produces the same output as 20551 20552@smallexample 20553echo This is some text\n 20554echo which is continued\n 20555echo onto several lines.\n 20556@end smallexample 20557 20558@kindex output 20559@item output @var{expression} 20560Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no 20561newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the 20562value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information 20563on expressions. 20564 20565@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression} 20566Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use 20567the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output 20568Formats}, for more information. 20569 20570@kindex printf 20571@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 20572Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 20573the string @var{template}. To print several values, make 20574@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions, 20575which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as 20576specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by 20577executing the code below: 20578 20579@smallexample 20580printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}); 20581@end smallexample 20582 20583As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template} 20584are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced 20585by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be 20586evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and 20587style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then 20588printed. 20589 20590For example, you can print two values in hex like this: 20591 20592@smallexample 20593printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo 20594@end smallexample 20595 20596@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion 20597specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%} 20598character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions: 20599 20600@itemize @bullet 20601@item 20602The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported. 20603 20604@item 20605The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or 20606width. 20607 20608@item 20609The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to 20610@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported. 20611 20612@item 20613The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not 20614supported. 20615 20616@item 20617The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported. 20618 20619@item 20620The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported. 20621@end itemize 20622 20623@noindent 20624Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the 20625underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports 20626the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is 20627supported only if @code{long double} type is available. 20628 20629As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape 20630sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"}, 20631@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a 20632single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not 20633supported. 20634 20635Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP 20636(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers 20637together with a floating point specifier. 20638letters: 20639 20640@itemize @bullet 20641@item 20642@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types. 20643 20644@item 20645@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types. 20646 20647@item 20648@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types. 20649@end itemize 20650 20651If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has 20652support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers 20653such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use. 20654 20655In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be 20656available and the value will be printed in the standard way. 20657 20658Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters: 20659@smallexample 20660printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl 20661@end smallexample 20662 20663@kindex eval 20664@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 20665Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 20666the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it. 20667 20668@end table 20669 20670@node Python 20671@section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python 20672@cindex python scripting 20673@cindex scripting with python 20674 20675You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/, 20676Python programming language}. This feature is available only if 20677@value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}. 20678 20679@cindex python directory 20680Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in 20681@file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is 20682the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). 20683This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory}, 20684is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow 20685the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location. 20686 20687@menu 20688* Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}. 20689* Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python. 20690* Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code. 20691* Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}. 20692@end menu 20693 20694@node Python Commands 20695@subsection Python Commands 20696@cindex python commands 20697@cindex commands to access python 20698 20699@value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter, 20700and one related setting: 20701 20702@table @code 20703@kindex python 20704@item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]} 20705The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code. 20706 20707If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the 20708argument as a Python command. For example: 20709 20710@smallexample 20711(@value{GDBP}) python print 23 2071223 20713@end smallexample 20714 20715If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a 20716multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python 20717script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the 20718@code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line 20719containing @code{end}. For example: 20720 20721@smallexample 20722(@value{GDBP}) python 20723Type python script 20724End with a line saying just "end". 20725>print 23 20726>end 2072723 20728@end smallexample 20729 20730@kindex maint set python print-stack 20731@item maint set python print-stack 20732By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs 20733in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set 20734python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack 20735printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is 20736disabled. 20737@end table 20738 20739It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN} 20740interpreter: 20741 20742@table @code 20743@item source @file{script-name} 20744The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured 20745to recognize the script language based on filename extension using 20746the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}. 20747 20748@item python execfile ("script-name") 20749This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function, 20750and thus is always available. 20751@end table 20752 20753@node Python API 20754@subsection Python API 20755@cindex python api 20756@cindex programming in python 20757 20758@cindex python stdout 20759@cindex python pagination 20760At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and 20761@code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams. 20762A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its 20763output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this 20764situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown. 20765 20766@menu 20767* Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions. 20768* Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated. 20769* Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values. 20770* Types In Python:: Python representation of types. 20771* Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values. 20772* Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer. 20773* Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer. 20774* Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes) 20775* Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}. 20776* Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python. 20777* Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python. 20778* Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters. 20779* Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions. 20780* Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces. 20781* Objfiles In Python:: Object files. 20782* Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python. 20783* Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python. 20784* Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols. 20785* Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables. 20786* Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings. 20787* Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python. 20788@end menu 20789 20790@node Basic Python 20791@subsubsection Basic Python 20792 20793@cindex python functions 20794@cindex python module 20795@cindex gdb module 20796@value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All 20797methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module. 20798@value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for 20799use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command. 20800 20801@findex gdb.PYTHONDIR 20802@defvar PYTHONDIR 20803A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}). 20804@end defvar 20805 20806@findex gdb.execute 20807@defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string] 20808Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command. 20809If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is 20810translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}. 20811 20812@var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this 20813command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively. 20814It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}. 20815 20816By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to 20817@value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is 20818@code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and 20819returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the 20820return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the 20821@value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width 20822and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}. 20823@end defun 20824 20825@findex gdb.breakpoints 20826@defun breakpoints 20827Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints. 20828@xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information. 20829@end defun 20830 20831@findex gdb.parameter 20832@defun parameter parameter 20833Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a 20834string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain 20835spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example, 20836@samp{print object} is a valid parameter name. 20837 20838If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a 20839@code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the 20840parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate 20841type, and returned. 20842@end defun 20843 20844@findex gdb.history 20845@defun history number 20846Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value 20847History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return. 20848If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value 20849and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to 20850find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will 20851return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number} 20852doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be 20853raised. 20854 20855If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of 20856@code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}). 20857@end defun 20858 20859@findex gdb.parse_and_eval 20860@defun parse_and_eval expression 20861Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language, 20862evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}. 20863@var{expression} must be a string. 20864 20865This function can be useful when implementing a new command 20866(@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the 20867command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to 20868compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a 20869convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}. 20870@end defun 20871 20872@findex gdb.post_event 20873@defun post_event event 20874Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into 20875@value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at 20876some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events 20877posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they 20878were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be 20879processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}. 20880 20881@value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple 20882threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific 20883functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures 20884this. For example: 20885 20886@smallexample 20887(@value{GDBP}) python 20888>import threading 20889> 20890>class Writer(): 20891> def __init__(self, message): 20892> self.message = message; 20893> def __call__(self): 20894> gdb.write(self.message) 20895> 20896>class MyThread1 (threading.Thread): 20897> def run (self): 20898> gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello ")) 20899> 20900>class MyThread2 (threading.Thread): 20901> def run (self): 20902> gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n")) 20903> 20904>MyThread1().start() 20905>MyThread2().start() 20906>end 20907(@value{GDBP}) Hello World 20908@end smallexample 20909@end defun 20910 20911@findex gdb.write 20912@defun write string @r{[}stream{]} 20913Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The 20914optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default 20915stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream 20916values are: 20917 20918@table @code 20919@findex STDOUT 20920@findex gdb.STDOUT 20921@item STDOUT 20922@value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. 20923 20924@findex STDERR 20925@findex gdb.STDERR 20926@item STDERR 20927@value{GDBN}'s standard error stream. 20928 20929@findex STDLOG 20930@findex gdb.STDLOG 20931@item STDLOG 20932@value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}). 20933@end table 20934 20935Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically 20936call this function and will automatically direct the output to the 20937relevant stream. 20938@end defun 20939 20940@findex gdb.flush 20941@defun flush 20942Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the 20943contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the 20944contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the 20945buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The 20946default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible 20947stream values are: 20948 20949@table @code 20950@findex STDOUT 20951@findex gdb.STDOUT 20952@item STDOUT 20953@value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. 20954 20955@findex STDERR 20956@findex gdb.STDERR 20957@item STDERR 20958@value{GDBN}'s standard error stream. 20959 20960@findex STDLOG 20961@findex gdb.STDLOG 20962@item STDLOG 20963@value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}). 20964 20965@end table 20966 20967Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically 20968call this function for the relevant stream. 20969@end defun 20970 20971@findex gdb.target_charset 20972@defun target_charset 20973Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character 20974Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in 20975that @samp{auto} is never returned. 20976@end defun 20977 20978@findex gdb.target_wide_charset 20979@defun target_wide_charset 20980Return the name of the current target wide character set 20981(@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from 20982@code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is 20983never returned. 20984@end defun 20985 20986@findex gdb.solib_name 20987@defun solib_name address 20988Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address} 20989as a string, or @code{None}. 20990@end defun 20991 20992@findex gdb.decode_line 20993@defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]} 20994Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the 20995current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python 20996tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string 20997holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if 20998the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains 20999either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations 21000that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} 21001objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is 21002provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt 21003@code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}). 21004@end defun 21005 21006@node Exception Handling 21007@subsubsection Exception Handling 21008@cindex python exceptions 21009@cindex exceptions, python 21010 21011When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions 21012uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to 21013@value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called 21014@code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will 21015terminate it and print an error message containing the Python 21016exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack 21017backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example: 21018 21019@smallexample 21020(@value{GDBP}) python print foo 21021Traceback (most recent call last): 21022 File "<string>", line 1, in <module> 21023NameError: name 'foo' is not defined 21024@end smallexample 21025 21026@value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by 21027Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the 21028Python exception depends on the error. 21029 21030@ftable @code 21031@item gdb.error 21032This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}. 21033It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier 21034versions of @value{GDBN}. 21035 21036If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more 21037specific category, then the generated exception will have this type. 21038 21039@item gdb.MemoryError 21040This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an 21041operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior. 21042 21043@item KeyboardInterrupt 21044User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination 21045prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception. 21046@end ftable 21047 21048In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error 21049message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python 21050statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the 21051traceback. 21052 21053@findex gdb.GdbError 21054When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command}, 21055it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a 21056traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the 21057command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception 21058to handle this case. Example: 21059 21060@smallexample 21061(gdb) python 21062>class HelloWorld (gdb.Command): 21063> """Greet the whole world.""" 21064> def __init__ (self): 21065> super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE) 21066> def invoke (self, args, from_tty): 21067> argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args) 21068> if len (argv) != 0: 21069> raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments") 21070> print "Hello, World!" 21071>HelloWorld () 21072>end 21073(gdb) hello-world 42 21074hello-world takes no arguments 21075@end smallexample 21076 21077@node Values From Inferior 21078@subsubsection Values From Inferior 21079@cindex values from inferior, with Python 21080@cindex python, working with values from inferior 21081 21082@cindex @code{gdb.Value} 21083@value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in 21084an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object 21085for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for 21086fetching values when necessary. 21087 21088Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in 21089Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's 21090an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}: 21091 21092@smallexample 21093bar = some_val + 2 21094@end smallexample 21095 21096@noindent 21097As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object 21098whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}. 21099 21100Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can 21101be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if 21102@code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you 21103can access its @code{foo} element with: 21104 21105@smallexample 21106bar = some_val['foo'] 21107@end smallexample 21108 21109Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object. 21110 21111A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via 21112inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match 21113the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified 21114by that prototype. 21115 21116For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance 21117representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To 21118execute this function, call it like so: 21119 21120@smallexample 21121result = some_val (10,20) 21122@end smallexample 21123 21124Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a 21125@code{gdb.Value}. 21126 21127The following attributes are provided: 21128 21129@table @code 21130@defivar Value address 21131If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a 21132@code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise, 21133this attribute holds @code{None}. 21134@end defivar 21135 21136@cindex optimized out value in Python 21137@defivar Value is_optimized_out 21138This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out 21139this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior. 21140@end defivar 21141 21142@defivar Value type 21143The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a 21144@code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}). 21145@end defivar 21146 21147@defivar Value dynamic_type 21148The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time 21149type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the 21150value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in 21151which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or 21152reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the 21153referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type, 21154respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static 21155type. 21156 21157Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program 21158that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise, 21159it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo} 21160(@pxref{Symbols, ptype}). 21161@end defivar 21162@end table 21163 21164The following methods are provided: 21165 21166@table @code 21167@defmethod Value __init__ @var{val} 21168Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via 21169this object initializer. Specifically: 21170 21171@table @asis 21172@item Python boolean 21173A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current 21174language. 21175 21176@item Python integer 21177A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the 21178current architecture. 21179 21180@item Python long 21181A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the 21182current architecture. 21183 21184@item Python float 21185A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the 21186current architecture. 21187 21188@item Python string 21189A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current 21190target encoding. 21191 21192@item @code{gdb.Value} 21193If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made. 21194 21195@item @code{gdb.LazyString} 21196If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In 21197Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and 21198its result is used. 21199@end table 21200@end defmethod 21201 21202@defmethod Value cast type 21203Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of 21204casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must 21205be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some 21206reason, this method throws an exception. 21207@end defmethod 21208 21209@defmethod Value dereference 21210For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object 21211whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if 21212@code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as 21213 21214@smallexample 21215int *foo; 21216@end smallexample 21217 21218@noindent 21219then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what 21220@code{foo} points to like this: 21221 21222@smallexample 21223bar = foo.dereference () 21224@end smallexample 21225 21226The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the 21227value pointed to by @code{foo}. 21228@end defmethod 21229 21230@defmethod Value dynamic_cast type 21231Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast} 21232operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details. 21233@end defmethod 21234 21235@defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type 21236Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast} 21237operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details. 21238@end defmethod 21239 21240@defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]} 21241If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method 21242converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will 21243throw an exception. 21244 21245Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given 21246@code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current 21247language. 21248 21249For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an 21250array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated 21251by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length 21252argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length, 21253ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain. 21254 21255If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string 21256naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as 21257@code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts 21258the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's 21259@code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used 21260to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if 21261@var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset} 21262(@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding 21263will be used, if the current language is able to supply one. 21264 21265The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding 21266argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method. 21267 21268If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be 21269fetched and converted to the given length. 21270@end defmethod 21271 21272@defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]} 21273If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method 21274converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings 21275In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception. 21276 21277If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string 21278naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are: 21279@samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the 21280@var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does 21281recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error. 21282 21283When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is 21284used to convert the string during printing. If the optional 21285@var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string, 21286@value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for 21287the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN} 21288please see @ref{Character Sets}. 21289 21290If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be 21291fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If 21292the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched 21293and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found. 21294@end defmethod 21295@end table 21296 21297@node Types In Python 21298@subsubsection Types In Python 21299@cindex types in Python 21300@cindex Python, working with types 21301 21302@tindex gdb.Type 21303@value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class 21304@code{gdb.Type}. 21305 21306The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} 21307module: 21308 21309@findex gdb.lookup_type 21310@defun lookup_type name [block] 21311This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the 21312type to look up. It must be a string. 21313 21314If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope. 21315Otherwise, it is searched for globally. 21316 21317Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}. 21318If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception. 21319@end defun 21320 21321An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes: 21322 21323@table @code 21324@defivar Type code 21325The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the 21326@code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below. 21327@end defivar 21328 21329@defivar Type sizeof 21330The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a 21331target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some 21332unusual platforms, this type may have a different size. 21333@end defivar 21334 21335@defivar Type tag 21336The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after 21337@code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all 21338languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then 21339@code{None} is returned. 21340@end defivar 21341@end table 21342 21343The following methods are provided: 21344 21345@table @code 21346@defmethod Type fields 21347For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range 21348types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types 21349have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one 21350field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also 21351represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit 21352into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned. 21353 21354Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes: 21355@table @code 21356@item bitpos 21357This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in 21358C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit 21359position of the field. 21360 21361@item name 21362The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields. 21363 21364@item artificial 21365This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that 21366it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is 21367always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial. 21368 21369@item is_base_class 21370This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++} 21371structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False} 21372if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of 21373@code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class. 21374 21375@item bitsize 21376If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a 21377non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise, 21378this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type. 21379 21380@item type 21381The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type}, 21382but it can be @code{None} in some situations. 21383@end table 21384@end defmethod 21385 21386@defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]} 21387Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this 21388type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of 21389the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are 21390given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the 21391second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length 21392must not be negative, but the bounds can be. 21393@end defmethod 21394 21395@defmethod Type const 21396Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a 21397@code{const}-qualified variant of this type. 21398@end defmethod 21399 21400@defmethod Type volatile 21401Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a 21402@code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type. 21403@end defmethod 21404 21405@defmethod Type unqualified 21406Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified 21407variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor 21408@code{volatile}. 21409@end defmethod 21410 21411@defmethod Type range 21412Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the 21413low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If 21414the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a 21415@code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}). 21416@end defmethod 21417 21418@defmethod Type reference 21419Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this 21420type. 21421@end defmethod 21422 21423@defmethod Type pointer 21424Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this 21425type. 21426@end defmethod 21427 21428@defmethod Type strip_typedefs 21429Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type, 21430after removing all layers of typedefs. 21431@end defmethod 21432 21433@defmethod Type target 21434Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type 21435of this type. 21436 21437For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to 21438object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is 21439the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type, 21440the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type, 21441the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the 21442target type is the aliased type. 21443 21444If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an 21445exception. 21446@end defmethod 21447 21448@defmethod Type template_argument n [block] 21449If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will 21450return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the 21451@var{n}th template argument. 21452 21453If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an 21454exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types. 21455 21456If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope. 21457Otherwise, it is searched for globally. 21458@end defmethod 21459@end table 21460 21461 21462Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls 21463into. The available type categories are represented by constants 21464defined in the @code{gdb} module: 21465 21466@table @code 21467@findex TYPE_CODE_PTR 21468@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR 21469@item TYPE_CODE_PTR 21470The type is a pointer. 21471 21472@findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 21473@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 21474@item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY 21475The type is an array. 21476 21477@findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 21478@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 21479@item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT 21480The type is a structure. 21481 21482@findex TYPE_CODE_UNION 21483@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION 21484@item TYPE_CODE_UNION 21485The type is a union. 21486 21487@findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM 21488@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM 21489@item TYPE_CODE_ENUM 21490The type is an enum. 21491 21492@findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS 21493@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS 21494@item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS 21495A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers. 21496 21497@findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC 21498@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC 21499@item TYPE_CODE_FUNC 21500The type is a function. 21501 21502@findex TYPE_CODE_INT 21503@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT 21504@item TYPE_CODE_INT 21505The type is an integer type. 21506 21507@findex TYPE_CODE_FLT 21508@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT 21509@item TYPE_CODE_FLT 21510A floating point type. 21511 21512@findex TYPE_CODE_VOID 21513@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID 21514@item TYPE_CODE_VOID 21515The special type @code{void}. 21516 21517@findex TYPE_CODE_SET 21518@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET 21519@item TYPE_CODE_SET 21520A Pascal set type. 21521 21522@findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE 21523@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE 21524@item TYPE_CODE_RANGE 21525A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds. 21526 21527@findex TYPE_CODE_STRING 21528@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING 21529@item TYPE_CODE_STRING 21530A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with 21531language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way. 21532 21533@findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING 21534@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING 21535@item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING 21536A string of bits. 21537 21538@findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR 21539@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR 21540@item TYPE_CODE_ERROR 21541An unknown or erroneous type. 21542 21543@findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD 21544@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD 21545@item TYPE_CODE_METHOD 21546A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java. 21547 21548@findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR 21549@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR 21550@item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR 21551A pointer-to-member-function. 21552 21553@findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR 21554@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR 21555@item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR 21556A pointer-to-member. 21557 21558@findex TYPE_CODE_REF 21559@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF 21560@item TYPE_CODE_REF 21561A reference type. 21562 21563@findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR 21564@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR 21565@item TYPE_CODE_CHAR 21566A character type. 21567 21568@findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL 21569@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL 21570@item TYPE_CODE_BOOL 21571A boolean type. 21572 21573@findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX 21574@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX 21575@item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX 21576A complex float type. 21577 21578@findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF 21579@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF 21580@item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF 21581A typedef to some other type. 21582 21583@findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE 21584@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE 21585@item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE 21586A C@t{++} namespace. 21587 21588@findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT 21589@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT 21590@item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT 21591A decimal floating point type. 21592 21593@findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION 21594@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION 21595@item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION 21596A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent 21597convenience functions. 21598@end table 21599 21600Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types} 21601Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}). 21602 21603@node Pretty Printing API 21604@subsubsection Pretty Printing API 21605 21606An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). 21607 21608A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a 21609specific interface, defined here. 21610 21611@defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self) 21612@value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the 21613children of the pretty-printer's value. 21614 21615This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator 21616protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding 21617two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the 21618second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python 21619object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value. 21620 21621This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act 21622as though the value has no children. 21623@end defop 21624 21625@defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self) 21626The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the 21627formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI 21628consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being 21629printed. 21630 21631This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a 21632string. 21633 21634Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}: 21635 21636@table @samp 21637@item array 21638Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI 21639uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and 21640@code{set print array}. 21641 21642@item map 21643Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the 21644children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and 21645values. 21646 21647@item string 21648Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the 21649printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some 21650kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific 21651string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means 21652adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting 21653@code{set print elements}, and the like. 21654@end table 21655@end defop 21656 21657@defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self) 21658@value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string 21659representation of the value passed to the object's constructor. 21660 21661When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists, 21662then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by 21663@code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on 21664the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also, 21665depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may 21666print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting 21667the result of @code{children}. 21668 21669If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim. 21670 21671Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value}, 21672then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to 21673another pretty-printer. 21674 21675If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a 21676@code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints 21677the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another 21678pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and 21679strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not. 21680 21681Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations 21682are peformed in this method and nothing is printed. 21683 21684If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised. 21685@end defop 21686 21687@value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the 21688default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}: 21689 21690@findex gdb.default_visualizer 21691@defun default_visualizer value 21692This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a 21693pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such 21694printer exists, then this returns @code{None}. 21695@end defun 21696 21697@node Selecting Pretty-Printers 21698@subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers 21699 21700The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of 21701functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition 21702as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global} 21703printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors. 21704Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute. 21705Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers} 21706attribute. 21707 21708Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value} 21709argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the 21710interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function 21711cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return 21712@code{None}. 21713 21714@value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each 21715@code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls 21716each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile} 21717until it receives a pretty-printer object. 21718If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then 21719searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space, 21720calling each enabled function until an object is returned. 21721After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global 21722@code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an 21723object is returned. 21724 21725The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a 21726given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list, 21727and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer 21728object is returned. 21729 21730For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work. 21731For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and 21732the pretty-printer is out of date. 21733 21734The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that 21735@value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual 21736printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on, 21737a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed 21738with a broken printer. 21739 21740Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled} 21741attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute 21742is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise 21743the printer is enabled. 21744 21745@node Writing a Pretty-Printer 21746@subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer 21747@cindex writing a pretty-printer 21748 21749A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect 21750if the type is supported, and the printer itself. 21751 21752Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be 21753written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class 21754must provide. 21755 21756@smallexample 21757class StdStringPrinter(object): 21758 "Print a std::string" 21759 21760 def __init__(self, val): 21761 self.val = val 21762 21763 def to_string(self): 21764 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p'] 21765 21766 def display_hint(self): 21767 return 'string' 21768@end smallexample 21769 21770And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer 21771example above might be written. 21772 21773@smallexample 21774def str_lookup_function(val): 21775 lookup_tag = val.type.tag 21776 if lookup_tag == None: 21777 return None 21778 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$") 21779 if regex.match(lookup_tag): 21780 return StdStringPrinter(val) 21781 return None 21782@end smallexample 21783 21784The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to 21785match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the 21786printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it 21787returns @code{None}. 21788 21789We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python 21790package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we 21791further recommend embedding a version number into the package name. 21792This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of 21793your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have 21794different names. 21795 21796You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it 21797can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An 21798ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your 21799printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with 21800the current objfile. 21801 21802Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple 21803inferiors, each potentially using a different library version. 21804Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that 21805@value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously. 21806Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and 21807because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's 21808printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct 21809printers for the specific version of the library used by each 21810inferior. 21811 21812To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}), 21813this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}: 21814 21815@smallexample 21816def register_printers(objfile): 21817 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function) 21818@end smallexample 21819 21820@noindent 21821And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be: 21822 21823@smallexample 21824import gdb.libstdcxx.v6 21825gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile()) 21826@end smallexample 21827 21828The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer. 21829There are a few things that can be improved on. 21830The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a 21831list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but 21832lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names. 21833 21834Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has 21835several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type 21836in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize 21837several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled. 21838If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its 21839@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types. 21840 21841The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these 21842problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}). 21843Here is another example that handles multiple types. 21844 21845These are the types we are going to pretty-print: 21846 21847@smallexample 21848struct foo @{ int a, b; @}; 21849struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @}; 21850@end smallexample 21851 21852Here are the printers: 21853 21854@smallexample 21855class fooPrinter: 21856 """Print a foo object.""" 21857 21858 def __init__(self, val): 21859 self.val = val 21860 21861 def to_string(self): 21862 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) + 21863 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">") 21864 21865class barPrinter: 21866 """Print a bar object.""" 21867 21868 def __init__(self, val): 21869 self.val = val 21870 21871 def to_string(self): 21872 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) + 21873 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">") 21874@end smallexample 21875 21876This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the 21877@code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up 21878the object that handles the lookup. 21879 21880@smallexample 21881import gdb.printing 21882 21883def build_pretty_printer(): 21884 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter( 21885 "my_library") 21886 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter) 21887 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter) 21888 return pp 21889@end smallexample 21890 21891And here is the autoload support: 21892 21893@smallexample 21894import gdb.printing 21895import my_library 21896gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer( 21897 gdb.current_objfile(), 21898 my_library.build_pretty_printer()) 21899@end smallexample 21900 21901Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the 21902corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}: 21903 21904@smallexample 21905(gdb) info pretty-printer 21906my_library.so: 21907 my_library 21908 foo 21909 bar 21910@end smallexample 21911 21912@node Inferiors In Python 21913@subsubsection Inferiors In Python 21914@cindex inferiors in Python 21915 21916@findex gdb.Inferior 21917Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors 21918(@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access 21919information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN} 21920via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class. 21921 21922The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} 21923module: 21924 21925@defun inferiors 21926Return a tuple containing all inferior objects. 21927@end defun 21928 21929A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes: 21930 21931@table @code 21932@defivar Inferior num 21933ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB. 21934@end defivar 21935 21936@defivar Inferior pid 21937Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating 21938system. 21939@end defivar 21940 21941@defivar Inferior was_attached 21942Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or 21943started by @value{GDBN} itself. 21944@end defivar 21945@end table 21946 21947A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods: 21948 21949@table @code 21950@defmethod Inferior is_valid 21951Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid, 21952@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid 21953if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other 21954@code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid 21955at the time the method is called. 21956@end defmethod 21957 21958@defmethod Inferior threads 21959This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid 21960when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will 21961return an empty tuple. 21962@end defmethod 21963 21964@findex gdb.read_memory 21965@defmethod Inferior read_memory address length 21966Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at 21967@var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array 21968or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory} 21969function. 21970@end defmethod 21971 21972@findex gdb.write_memory 21973@defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]} 21974Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at 21975@var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object 21976which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the 21977object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length} 21978determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written. 21979@end defmethod 21980 21981@findex gdb.search_memory 21982@defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern 21983Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with 21984the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in 21985@var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object 21986which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the 21987object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long} 21988containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if 21989the pattern could not be found. 21990@end defmethod 21991@end table 21992 21993@node Events In Python 21994@subsubsection Events In Python 21995@cindex inferior events in Python 21996 21997@value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be 21998notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in 21999the inferior. 22000 22001An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The 22002type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details 22003of the change. All the existing events are described below. 22004 22005In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler 22006with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the 22007@code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry 22008provides methods to register and unregister event handlers: 22009 22010@table @code 22011@defmethod EventRegistry connect object 22012Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be 22013called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs. 22014@end defmethod 22015 22016@defmethod EventRegistry disconnect object 22017Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object 22018will no longer receive notifications of events. 22019@end defmethod 22020@end table 22021 22022Here is an example: 22023 22024@smallexample 22025def exit_handler (event): 22026 print "event type: exit" 22027 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code) 22028 22029gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler) 22030@end smallexample 22031 22032In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the 22033registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets 22034called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is 22035of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the 22036@code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of 22037the inferior. 22038 22039The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and 22040details of the events they emit: 22041 22042@table @code 22043 22044@item events.cont 22045Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. 22046 22047Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop 22048mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend 22049@code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead, 22050events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event. 22051Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and 22052@code{gdb.ContinueEvent}. 22053 22054@table @code 22055@defivar ThreadEvent inferior_thread 22056In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was 22057involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}. 22058@end defivar 22059@end table 22060 22061Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. 22062 22063This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For 22064inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above. 22065 22066@item events.exited 22067Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited. 22068@code{events.ExitedEvent} has one optional attribute. This attribute 22069will exist only in the case that the inferior exited with some 22070status. 22071@table @code 22072@defivar ExitedEvent exit_code 22073An integer representing the exit code which the inferior has returned. 22074@end defivar 22075@end table 22076 22077@item events.stop 22078Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. 22079 22080Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry 22081extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent} 22082will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop 22083mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details. 22084 22085Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}. 22086 22087This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as 22088signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes: 22089 22090@table @code 22091@defivar SignalEvent stop_signal 22092A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible 22093signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in 22094the @value{GDBN} command prompt. 22095@end defivar 22096@end table 22097 22098Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}. 22099 22100@code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that a breakpoint has been hit, and 22101has the following attributes: 22102 22103@table @code 22104@defivar BreakpointEvent breakpoint 22105A reference to the breakpoint that was hit of type @code{gdb.Breakpoint}. 22106@xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object. 22107@end defivar 22108@end table 22109 22110@end table 22111 22112@node Threads In Python 22113@subsubsection Threads In Python 22114@cindex threads in python 22115 22116@findex gdb.InferiorThread 22117Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads 22118controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class. 22119 22120The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} 22121module: 22122 22123@findex gdb.selected_thread 22124@defun selected_thread 22125This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there 22126is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}. 22127@end defun 22128 22129A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes: 22130 22131@table @code 22132@defivar InferiorThread name 22133The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using 22134@code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an 22135OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this 22136returns @code{None}. 22137 22138This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string 22139object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any 22140user-specified thread name. 22141@end defivar 22142 22143@defivar InferiorThread num 22144ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB. 22145@end defivar 22146 22147@defivar InferiorThread ptid 22148ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a 22149tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second 22150is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID). 22151Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system 22152does not use that identifier. 22153@end defivar 22154@end table 22155 22156A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods: 22157 22158@table @code 22159@defmethod InferiorThread is_valid 22160Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid, 22161@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become 22162invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs 22163is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an 22164exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called. 22165@end defmethod 22166 22167@defmethod InferiorThread switch 22168This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented 22169by this object. 22170@end defmethod 22171 22172@defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped 22173Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped. 22174@end defmethod 22175 22176@defmethod InferiorThread is_running 22177Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running. 22178@end defmethod 22179 22180@defmethod InferiorThread is_exited 22181Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited. 22182@end defmethod 22183@end table 22184 22185@node Commands In Python 22186@subsubsection Commands In Python 22187 22188@cindex commands in python 22189@cindex python commands 22190You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI 22191command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command} 22192class, most commonly using a subclass. 22193 22194@defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]} 22195The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command 22196with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the 22197subclass' own @code{__init__} method. 22198 22199@var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of 22200multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix 22201commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist, 22202an exception is raised. 22203 22204There is no support for multi-line commands. 22205 22206@var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants 22207defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the 22208new command in the help system. 22209 22210@var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be 22211one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument 22212tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not 22213given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's 22214@code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an 22215error will occur when completion is attempted. 22216 22217@var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new 22218command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be 22219registered. 22220 22221The help text for the new command is taken from the Python 22222documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no 22223documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is 22224not documented.'' is used. 22225@end defmethod 22226 22227@cindex don't repeat Python command 22228@defmethod Command dont_repeat 22229By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a 22230blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this 22231behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar 22232to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}. 22233@end defmethod 22234 22235@defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty 22236This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked. 22237 22238@var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after 22239leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped. 22240 22241@var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the 22242command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means 22243that the command came from elsewhere. 22244 22245If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN} 22246@code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored. 22247 22248@findex gdb.string_to_argv 22249To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use 22250@code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to 22251@value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}. 22252It is recommended to use this for consistency. 22253Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted. 22254Example: 22255 22256@smallexample 22257print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"") 22258['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"] 22259@end smallexample 22260 22261@end defmethod 22262 22263@cindex completion of Python commands 22264@defmethod Command complete text word 22265This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts 22266completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by 22267this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings 22268(@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help, 22269complete}). 22270 22271The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text} 22272holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location. 22273@var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed 22274using a word-breaking heuristic. 22275 22276The @code{complete} method can return several values: 22277@itemize @bullet 22278@item 22279If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are 22280used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the 22281contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is 22282allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only 22283string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the 22284sequence are ignored. 22285 22286@item 22287If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined 22288below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion 22289function is invoked, and its result is used. 22290 22291@item 22292All other results are treated as though there were no available 22293completions. 22294@end itemize 22295@end defmethod 22296 22297When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of 22298some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level 22299commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not 22300listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level 22301command. The available classifications are represented by constants 22302defined in the @code{gdb} module: 22303 22304@table @code 22305@findex COMMAND_NONE 22306@findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE 22307@item COMMAND_NONE 22308The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in 22309this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories. 22310 22311@findex COMMAND_RUNNING 22312@findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING 22313@item COMMAND_RUNNING 22314The command is related to running the inferior. For example, 22315@code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category. 22316Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of 22317commands in this category. 22318 22319@findex COMMAND_DATA 22320@findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA 22321@item COMMAND_DATA 22322The command is related to data or variables. For example, 22323@code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type 22324@kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands 22325in this category. 22326 22327@findex COMMAND_STACK 22328@findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK 22329@item COMMAND_STACK 22330The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example, 22331@code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this 22332category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a 22333list of commands in this category. 22334 22335@findex COMMAND_FILES 22336@findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES 22337@item COMMAND_FILES 22338This class is used for file-related commands. For example, 22339@code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category. 22340Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of 22341commands in this category. 22342 22343@findex COMMAND_SUPPORT 22344@findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT 22345@item COMMAND_SUPPORT 22346This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning 22347things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN}, 22348but not related to the state of the inferior. For example, 22349@code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type 22350@kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of 22351commands in this category. 22352 22353@findex COMMAND_STATUS 22354@findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS 22355@item COMMAND_STATUS 22356The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the 22357state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro}, 22358and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the 22359@value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category. 22360 22361@findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS 22362@findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS 22363@item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS 22364The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break}, 22365@code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help 22366breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in 22367this category. 22368 22369@findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS 22370@findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS 22371@item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS 22372The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace}, 22373@code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type 22374@kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of 22375commands in this category. 22376 22377@findex COMMAND_OBSCURE 22378@findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE 22379@item COMMAND_OBSCURE 22380The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of 22381general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint}, 22382@code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help 22383obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this 22384category. 22385 22386@findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE 22387@findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE 22388@item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE 22389The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The 22390@code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category. 22391Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of 22392commands in this category. 22393@end table 22394 22395A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by 22396specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it 22397from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion 22398constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module: 22399 22400@table @code 22401@findex COMPLETE_NONE 22402@findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE 22403@item COMPLETE_NONE 22404This constant means that no completion should be done. 22405 22406@findex COMPLETE_FILENAME 22407@findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME 22408@item COMPLETE_FILENAME 22409This constant means that filename completion should be performed. 22410 22411@findex COMPLETE_LOCATION 22412@findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION 22413@item COMPLETE_LOCATION 22414This constant means that location completion should be done. 22415@xref{Specify Location}. 22416 22417@findex COMPLETE_COMMAND 22418@findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND 22419@item COMPLETE_COMMAND 22420This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN} 22421command names. 22422 22423@findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL 22424@findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL 22425@item COMPLETE_SYMBOL 22426This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names 22427as the source. 22428@end table 22429 22430The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be 22431implemented in Python: 22432 22433@smallexample 22434class HelloWorld (gdb.Command): 22435 """Greet the whole world.""" 22436 22437 def __init__ (self): 22438 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE) 22439 22440 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty): 22441 print "Hello, World!" 22442 22443HelloWorld () 22444@end smallexample 22445 22446The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the 22447registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the 22448Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the 22449@code{gdb} module explicitly. 22450 22451@node Parameters In Python 22452@subsubsection Parameters In Python 22453 22454@cindex parameters in python 22455@cindex python parameters 22456@tindex gdb.Parameter 22457@tindex Parameter 22458You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new 22459parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter} 22460class. 22461 22462Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and 22463@code{show} commands. @xref{Help}. 22464 22465There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in 22466@value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and 22467@code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain 22468behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that 22469can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands. 22470 22471@defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]} 22472The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new 22473parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked 22474from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method. 22475 22476@var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists 22477of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix 22478parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the 22479@code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is 22480@code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix 22481parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in 22482@value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}. 22483 22484If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group 22485can be found, an exception is raised. 22486 22487@var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants 22488(@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to 22489categorize the new parameter in the help system. 22490 22491@var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants 22492defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new 22493parameter; this information is used for input validation and 22494completion. 22495 22496If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then 22497@var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings 22498represent the possible values for the parameter. 22499 22500If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence 22501of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown. 22502 22503The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python 22504documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If 22505there is no documentation string, a default value is used. 22506@end defmethod 22507 22508@defivar Parameter set_doc 22509If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as 22510the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is 22511examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes 22512have no effect. 22513@end defivar 22514 22515@defivar Parameter show_doc 22516If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as 22517the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is 22518examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes 22519have no effect. 22520@end defivar 22521 22522@defivar Parameter value 22523The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the 22524parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other 22525attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made. 22526@end defivar 22527 22528There are two methods that should be implemented in any 22529@code{Parameter} class. These are: 22530 22531@defop Operation {parameter} get_set_string self 22532@value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has 22533been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}). 22534The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new 22535value and may be used in output. This method must return a string. 22536@end defop 22537 22538@defop Operation {parameter} get_show_string self svalue 22539@value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s 22540@code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The 22541argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the 22542current value. This method must return a string. 22543@end defop 22544 22545When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The 22546available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb} 22547module: 22548 22549@table @code 22550@findex PARAM_BOOLEAN 22551@findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN 22552@item PARAM_BOOLEAN 22553The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True} 22554and @code{False} are the only valid values. 22555 22556@findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN 22557@findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN 22558@item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN 22559The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In 22560Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and 22561@samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}. 22562 22563@findex PARAM_UINTEGER 22564@findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER 22565@item PARAM_UINTEGER 22566The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be 22567interpreted to mean ``unlimited''. 22568 22569@findex PARAM_INTEGER 22570@findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER 22571@item PARAM_INTEGER 22572The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted 22573to mean ``unlimited''. 22574 22575@findex PARAM_STRING 22576@findex gdb.PARAM_STRING 22577@item PARAM_STRING 22578The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape 22579sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are 22580translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current 22581host charset. 22582 22583@findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE 22584@findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE 22585@item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE 22586The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are 22587passed through untranslated. 22588 22589@findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME 22590@findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME 22591@item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME 22592The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}. 22593 22594@findex PARAM_FILENAME 22595@findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME 22596@item PARAM_FILENAME 22597The value is a filename. This is just like 22598@code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion. 22599 22600@findex PARAM_ZINTEGER 22601@findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER 22602@item PARAM_ZINTEGER 22603The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0 22604is interpreted as itself. 22605 22606@findex PARAM_ENUM 22607@findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM 22608@item PARAM_ENUM 22609The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string 22610constants provided when the parameter is created. 22611@end table 22612 22613@node Functions In Python 22614@subsubsection Writing new convenience functions 22615 22616@cindex writing convenience functions 22617@cindex convenience functions in python 22618@cindex python convenience functions 22619@tindex gdb.Function 22620@tindex Function 22621You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) 22622in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the 22623class @code{gdb.Function}. 22624 22625@defmethod Function __init__ name 22626The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with 22627@value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function, 22628a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience 22629variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as 22630the given @var{name}. 22631 22632The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation 22633string for the new class. 22634@end defmethod 22635 22636@defmethod Function invoke @var{*args} 22637When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted 22638to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's 22639@code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not 22640predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all 22641available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the 22642standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience 22643function can have default values for parameters without ill effect. 22644 22645The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing 22646expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted 22647to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules. 22648@end defmethod 22649 22650The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can 22651be implemented in Python: 22652 22653@smallexample 22654class Greet (gdb.Function): 22655 """Return string to greet someone. 22656Takes a name as argument.""" 22657 22658 def __init__ (self): 22659 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet") 22660 22661 def invoke (self, name): 22662 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string () 22663 22664Greet () 22665@end smallexample 22666 22667The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the 22668registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the 22669Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the 22670@code{gdb} module explicitly. 22671 22672@node Progspaces In Python 22673@subsubsection Program Spaces In Python 22674 22675@cindex progspaces in python 22676@tindex gdb.Progspace 22677@tindex Progspace 22678A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view 22679of an address space. 22680It consists of all of the objfiles of the program. 22681@xref{Objfiles In Python}. 22682@xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details 22683about program spaces. 22684 22685The following progspace-related functions are available in the 22686@code{gdb} module: 22687 22688@findex gdb.current_progspace 22689@defun current_progspace 22690This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior. 22691@xref{Inferiors and Programs}. 22692@end defun 22693 22694@findex gdb.progspaces 22695@defun progspaces 22696Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}. 22697@end defun 22698 22699Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace} 22700class. 22701 22702@defivar Progspace filename 22703The file name of the progspace as a string. 22704@end defivar 22705 22706@defivar Progspace pretty_printers 22707The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is 22708used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each 22709function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the 22710search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object 22711which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more 22712information. 22713@end defivar 22714 22715@node Objfiles In Python 22716@subsubsection Objfiles In Python 22717 22718@cindex objfiles in python 22719@tindex gdb.Objfile 22720@tindex Objfile 22721@value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various 22722symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary 22723executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any 22724separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}). 22725@value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}. 22726 22727The following objfile-related functions are available in the 22728@code{gdb} module: 22729 22730@findex gdb.current_objfile 22731@defun current_objfile 22732When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN} 22733sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This 22734function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile, 22735this function returns @code{None}. 22736@end defun 22737 22738@findex gdb.objfiles 22739@defun objfiles 22740Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}. 22741@xref{Objfiles In Python}. 22742@end defun 22743 22744Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile} 22745class. 22746 22747@defivar Objfile filename 22748The file name of the objfile as a string. 22749@end defivar 22750 22751@defivar Objfile pretty_printers 22752The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is 22753used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each 22754function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the 22755search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object 22756which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more 22757information. 22758@end defivar 22759 22760A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods: 22761 22762@defmethod Objfile is_valid 22763Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid, 22764@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid 22765if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any 22766longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception 22767if it is invalid at the time the method is called. 22768@end defmethod 22769 22770@node Frames In Python 22771@subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python. 22772 22773@cindex frames in python 22774When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call 22775stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class 22776represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid 22777while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try 22778to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error} 22779exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}). 22780 22781Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==} 22782operator, like: 22783 22784@smallexample 22785(@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame () 22786True 22787@end smallexample 22788 22789The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module: 22790 22791@findex gdb.selected_frame 22792@defun selected_frame 22793Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}). 22794@end defun 22795 22796@findex gdb.newest_frame 22797@defun newest_frame 22798Return the newest frame object for the selected thread. 22799@end defun 22800 22801@defun frame_stop_reason_string reason 22802Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding 22803frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the 22804@code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section). 22805@end defun 22806 22807A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods: 22808 22809@table @code 22810@defmethod Frame is_valid 22811Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not. 22812A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't 22813exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw 22814an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called. 22815@end defmethod 22816 22817@defmethod Frame name 22818Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be 22819obtained. 22820@end defmethod 22821 22822@defmethod Frame type 22823Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of: 22824@table @code 22825@item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME 22826An ordinary stack frame. 22827 22828@item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME 22829A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an 22830inferior function call. 22831 22832@item gdb.INLINE_FRAME 22833A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined 22834into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one. 22835 22836@item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME 22837A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when 22838it calls into a signal handler. 22839 22840@item gdb.ARCH_FRAME 22841A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call. 22842 22843@item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME 22844This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the 22845newest frame. 22846@end table 22847@end defmethod 22848 22849@defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason 22850Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find 22851more frames toward the outermost frame. Use 22852@code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this 22853function to a string. 22854@end defmethod 22855 22856@defmethod Frame pc 22857Returns the frame's resume address. 22858@end defmethod 22859 22860@defmethod Frame block 22861Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}. 22862@end defmethod 22863 22864@defmethod Frame function 22865Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame. 22866@xref{Symbols In Python}. 22867@end defmethod 22868 22869@defmethod Frame older 22870Return the frame that called this frame. 22871@end defmethod 22872 22873@defmethod Frame newer 22874Return the frame called by this frame. 22875@end defmethod 22876 22877@defmethod Frame find_sal 22878Return the frame's symtab and line object. 22879@xref{Symbol Tables In Python}. 22880@end defmethod 22881 22882@defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]} 22883Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional 22884argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that 22885block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is 22886determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable} 22887must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a 22888@code{gdb.Block} object. 22889@end defmethod 22890 22891@defmethod Frame select 22892Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the 22893Stack}. 22894@end defmethod 22895@end table 22896 22897@node Blocks In Python 22898@subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python. 22899 22900@cindex blocks in python 22901@tindex gdb.Block 22902 22903Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block 22904stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and 22905are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}. 22906Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on 22907frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more 22908detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the 22909stack. 22910 22911The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} 22912module: 22913 22914@findex gdb.block_for_pc 22915@defun block_for_pc pc 22916Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the 22917block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function 22918will return @code{None}. 22919@end defun 22920 22921A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods: 22922 22923@table @code 22924@defmethod Block is_valid 22925Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid, 22926@code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it 22927refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other 22928@code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at 22929the time the method is called. This method is also made available to 22930the Python iterator object that @code{gdb.Block} provides in an iteration 22931context and via the Python @code{iter} built-in function. 22932@end defmethod 22933@end table 22934 22935A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes: 22936 22937@table @code 22938@defivar Block start 22939The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable. 22940@end defivar 22941 22942@defivar Block end 22943The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable. 22944@end defivar 22945 22946@defivar Block function 22947The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the 22948block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This 22949attribute is not writable. 22950@end defivar 22951 22952@defivar Block superblock 22953The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist, 22954this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable. 22955@end defivar 22956@end table 22957 22958@node Symbols In Python 22959@subsubsection Python representation of Symbols. 22960 22961@cindex symbols in python 22962@tindex gdb.Symbol 22963 22964@value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an 22965entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}. 22966Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the 22967@code{gdb.Symbol} object. 22968 22969The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} 22970module: 22971 22972@findex gdb.lookup_symbol 22973@defun lookup_symbol name @r{[}block@r{]} @r{[}domain@r{]} 22974This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be 22975restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block 22976arguments. 22977 22978@var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The 22979optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible 22980in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a 22981@code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame 22982is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts 22983the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a 22984domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later 22985in this chapter. 22986 22987The result is a tuple of two elements. 22988The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol 22989is not found. 22990If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol 22991is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}), 22992otherwise it is @code{False}. 22993If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}. 22994@end defun 22995 22996@findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol 22997@defun lookup_global_symbol name @r{[}domain@r{]} 22998This function searches for a global symbol by name. 22999The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument. 23000 23001@var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. 23002The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type. 23003The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} 23004module and described later in this chapter. 23005 23006The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol 23007is not found. 23008@end defun 23009 23010A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes: 23011 23012@table @code 23013@defivar Symbol symtab 23014The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is 23015represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In 23016Python}. This attribute is not writable. 23017@end defivar 23018 23019@defivar Symbol name 23020The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable. 23021@end defivar 23022 23023@defivar Symbol linkage_name 23024The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled). 23025This attribute is not writable. 23026@end defivar 23027 23028@defivar Symbol print_name 23029The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either 23030@code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user 23031asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names. 23032@end defivar 23033 23034@defivar Symbol addr_class 23035The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value 23036of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the 23037@code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter. 23038@end defivar 23039 23040@defivar Symbol is_argument 23041@code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function. 23042@end defivar 23043 23044@defivar Symbol is_constant 23045@code{True} if the symbol is a constant. 23046@end defivar 23047 23048@defivar Symbol is_function 23049@code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method. 23050@end defivar 23051 23052@defivar Symbol is_variable 23053@code{True} if the symbol is a variable. 23054@end defivar 23055@end table 23056 23057A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods: 23058 23059@table @code 23060@defmethod Symbol is_valid 23061Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid, 23062@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if 23063the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. 23064All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is 23065invalid at the time the method is called. 23066@end defmethod 23067@end table 23068 23069The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented 23070as constants in the @code{gdb} module: 23071 23072@table @code 23073@findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN 23074@findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN 23075@item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN 23076This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the 23077following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either 23078in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols. 23079@findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN 23080@findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN 23081@item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN 23082This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum 23083type values. 23084@findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN 23085@findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN 23086@item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN 23087This domain holds struct, union and enum type names. 23088@findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN 23089@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN 23090@item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN 23091This domain contains names of labels (for gotos). 23092@findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN 23093@findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN 23094@item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN 23095This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it 23096contains everything minus functions and types. 23097@findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN 23098@findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN 23099@item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN 23100This domain contains all functions. 23101@findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN 23102@findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN 23103@item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN 23104This domain contains all types. 23105@end table 23106 23107The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented 23108as constants in the @code{gdb} module: 23109 23110@table @code 23111@findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF 23112@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF 23113@item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF 23114If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in 23115the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols. 23116@findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST 23117@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST 23118@item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST 23119Value is constant int. 23120@findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC 23121@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC 23122@item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC 23123Value is at a fixed address. 23124@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER 23125@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER 23126@item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER 23127Value is in a register. 23128@findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG 23129@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG 23130@item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG 23131Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the 23132symbol inside the frame's argument list. 23133@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG 23134@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG 23135@item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG 23136Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like 23137@code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the 23138offset, not the value itself. 23139@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR 23140@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR 23141@item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR 23142Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except 23143the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument 23144itself. 23145@findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL 23146@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL 23147@item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL 23148Value is a local variable. 23149@findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF 23150@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF 23151@item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF 23152Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all 23153have this class. 23154@findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK 23155@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK 23156@item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK 23157Value is a block. 23158@findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES 23159@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES 23160@item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES 23161Value is a byte-sequence. 23162@findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED 23163@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED 23164@item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED 23165Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be 23166determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is 23167referenced. 23168@findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT 23169@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT 23170@item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT 23171The value does not actually exist in the program. 23172@findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED 23173@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED 23174@item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED 23175The value's address is a computed location. 23176@end table 23177 23178@node Symbol Tables In Python 23179@subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python. 23180 23181@cindex symbol tables in python 23182@tindex gdb.Symtab 23183@tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line 23184 23185Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior 23186is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and 23187@code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned 23188from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object. 23189@xref{Frames In Python}. 23190 23191For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see 23192@ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information. 23193 23194A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes: 23195 23196@table @code 23197@defivar Symtab_and_line symtab 23198The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame. 23199This attribute is not writable. 23200@end defivar 23201 23202@defivar Symtab_and_line pc 23203Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not 23204writable. 23205@end defivar 23206 23207@defivar Symtab_and_line line 23208Indicates the current line number for this object. This 23209attribute is not writable. 23210@end defivar 23211@end table 23212 23213A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods: 23214 23215@table @code 23216@defmethod Symtab_and_line is_valid 23217Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid, 23218@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become 23219invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not 23220exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other 23221@code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is 23222invalid at the time the method is called. 23223@end defmethod 23224@end table 23225 23226A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes: 23227 23228@table @code 23229@defivar Symtab filename 23230The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable. 23231@end defivar 23232 23233@defivar Symtab objfile 23234The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}. 23235This attribute is not writable. 23236@end defivar 23237@end table 23238 23239A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods: 23240 23241@table @code 23242@defmethod Symtab is_valid 23243Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid, 23244@code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if 23245the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any 23246longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception 23247if it is invalid at the time the method is called. 23248@end defmethod 23249 23250@defmethod Symtab fullname 23251Return the symbol table's source absolute file name. 23252@end defmethod 23253@end table 23254 23255@node Breakpoints In Python 23256@subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python 23257 23258@cindex breakpoints in python 23259@tindex gdb.Breakpoint 23260 23261Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} 23262class. 23263 23264@defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]} 23265Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the 23266location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a 23267watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the 23268@code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch} 23269command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create 23270from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be 23271either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type} 23272defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument 23273allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint 23274will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the 23275output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the 23276@code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class} 23277argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is 23278@code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is 23279assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class. 23280@end defmethod 23281 23282@defop Operation {gdb.Breakpoint} stop (self) 23283The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in 23284particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method. 23285If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint}, 23286it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a 23287breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns 23288@code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the 23289breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue. 23290 23291If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a 23292@code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the 23293return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop} 23294methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario 23295if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return 23296@code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped. 23297 23298Example @code{stop} implementation: 23299 23300@smallexample 23301class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint): 23302 def stop (self): 23303 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo") 23304 if inf_val == 3: 23305 return True 23306 return False 23307@end smallexample 23308@end defop 23309 23310The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the 23311@code{gdb} module: 23312 23313@table @code 23314@findex WP_READ 23315@findex gdb.WP_READ 23316@item WP_READ 23317Read only watchpoint. 23318 23319@findex WP_WRITE 23320@findex gdb.WP_WRITE 23321@item WP_WRITE 23322Write only watchpoint. 23323 23324@findex WP_ACCESS 23325@findex gdb.WP_ACCESS 23326@item WP_ACCESS 23327Read/Write watchpoint. 23328@end table 23329 23330@defmethod Breakpoint is_valid 23331Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid, 23332@code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid 23333if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still 23334exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of 23335watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the 23336inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint. 23337@end defmethod 23338 23339@defmethod Breakpoint delete 23340Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also 23341invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access 23342to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error. 23343@end defmethod 23344 23345@defivar Breakpoint enabled 23346This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and 23347@code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable. 23348@end defivar 23349 23350@defivar Breakpoint silent 23351This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and 23352@code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable. 23353 23354Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the 23355first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the 23356@code{silent} attribute. 23357@end defivar 23358 23359@defivar Breakpoint thread 23360If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread 23361id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is 23362@code{None}. This attribute is writable. 23363@end defivar 23364 23365@defivar Breakpoint task 23366If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task 23367id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying 23368language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute 23369is writable. 23370@end defivar 23371 23372@defivar Breakpoint ignore_count 23373This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer. 23374This attribute is writable. 23375@end defivar 23376 23377@defivar Breakpoint number 23378This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by 23379the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable. 23380@end defivar 23381 23382@defivar Breakpoint type 23383This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to 23384determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not 23385writable. 23386@end defivar 23387 23388@defivar Breakpoint visible 23389This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user 23390when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This 23391attribute is not writable. 23392@end defivar 23393 23394The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb} 23395module: 23396 23397@table @code 23398@findex BP_BREAKPOINT 23399@findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT 23400@item BP_BREAKPOINT 23401Normal code breakpoint. 23402 23403@findex BP_WATCHPOINT 23404@findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT 23405@item BP_WATCHPOINT 23406Watchpoint breakpoint. 23407 23408@findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT 23409@findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT 23410@item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT 23411Hardware assisted watchpoint. 23412 23413@findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT 23414@findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT 23415@item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT 23416Hardware assisted read watchpoint. 23417 23418@findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT 23419@findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT 23420@item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT 23421Hardware assisted access watchpoint. 23422@end table 23423 23424@defivar Breakpoint hit_count 23425This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer. 23426This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero. 23427@end defivar 23428 23429@defivar Breakpoint location 23430This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by 23431the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location 23432(that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This 23433attribute is not writable. 23434@end defivar 23435 23436@defivar Breakpoint expression 23437This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by 23438the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an 23439expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value 23440is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable. 23441@end defivar 23442 23443@defivar Breakpoint condition 23444This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by 23445the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's 23446value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable. 23447@end defivar 23448 23449@defivar Breakpoint commands 23450This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If 23451there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the 23452commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this 23453attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable. 23454@end defivar 23455 23456@node Lazy Strings In Python 23457@subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings. 23458 23459@cindex lazy strings in python 23460@tindex gdb.LazyString 23461 23462A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or 23463encoded until it is needed. 23464 23465A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an 23466@code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding} 23467that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length} 23468to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The 23469difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within 23470a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated 23471differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is 23472retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value} 23473wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation. 23474 23475A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions: 23476 23477@defmethod LazyString value 23478Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value 23479will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed 23480retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a 23481@code{gdb.LazyString}. 23482@end defmethod 23483 23484@defivar LazyString address 23485This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not 23486writable. 23487@end defivar 23488 23489@defivar LazyString length 23490This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the 23491length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the 23492first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable. 23493@end defivar 23494 23495@defivar LazyString encoding 23496This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string 23497when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not 23498set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the 23499most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute 23500is not writable. 23501@end defivar 23502 23503@defivar LazyString type 23504This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's 23505type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To 23506resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's 23507@code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not 23508writable. 23509@end defivar 23510 23511@node Auto-loading 23512@subsection Auto-loading 23513@cindex auto-loading, Python 23514 23515When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file} 23516command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library), 23517@value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways: 23518@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section. 23519 23520@menu 23521* objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file 23522* .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 23523* Which flavor to choose?:: 23524@end menu 23525 23526The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific 23527debugging commands and scripts. 23528 23529Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled. 23530 23531@table @code 23532@kindex set auto-load-scripts 23533@item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no] 23534Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts. 23535 23536@kindex show auto-load-scripts 23537@item show auto-load-scripts 23538Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled. 23539@end table 23540 23541When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the 23542@dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile} 23543function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for 23544registering objfile-specific pretty-printers. 23545 23546@node objfile-gdb.py file 23547@subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file 23548@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} 23549 23550When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for 23551a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}, 23552where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring 23553that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving 23554@code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is 23555readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script. 23556 23557If this file does not exist, and if the parameter 23558@code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}), 23559then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the 23560directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}. 23561 23562Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for 23563a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where 23564@var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via 23565@code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name} 23566is the object file's real name, as described above. 23567 23568@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way. 23569@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding 23570@var{objfile} is opened. 23571So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it 23572is evaluated more than once. 23573 23574@node .debug_gdb_scripts section 23575@subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 23576@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 23577 23578For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF, 23579when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file 23580it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}. 23581If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load. 23582 23583@value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the 23584current directory and then along the source search path 23585(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}), 23586except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation 23587directory is not relevant to scripts. 23588 23589Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with, 23590for example, this GCC macro: 23591 23592@example 23593/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */ 23594#define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \ 23595 asm("\ 23596.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\ 23597.byte 1\n\ 23598.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\ 23599.popsection \n\ 23600"); 23601@end example 23602 23603@noindent 23604Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this: 23605 23606@example 23607DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py") 23608@end example 23609 23610The script name may include directories if desired. 23611 23612If the macro is put in a header, any application or library 23613using this header will get a reference to the specified script. 23614 23615@node Which flavor to choose? 23616@subsubsection Which flavor to choose? 23617 23618Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always 23619be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance. 23620 23621Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way: 23622 23623@itemize @bullet 23624@item 23625Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections. 23626 23627@item 23628Ease of finding scripts for public libraries. 23629 23630Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for 23631in the source search path. 23632For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically 23633isn't a source directory in which to find the script. 23634 23635@item 23636Doesn't require source code additions. 23637@end itemize 23638 23639Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way: 23640 23641@itemize @bullet 23642@item 23643Works with static linking. 23644 23645Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to 23646trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only 23647objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the 23648scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script. 23649 23650@item 23651Works with classes that are entirely inlined. 23652 23653Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated 23654shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to. 23655 23656@item 23657Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree. 23658 23659In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal 23660libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the 23661@file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is 23662cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the 23663@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the 23664top of the source tree to the source search path. 23665@end itemize 23666 23667@node Python modules 23668@subsection Python modules 23669@cindex python modules 23670 23671@value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code. 23672 23673@menu 23674* gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers. 23675* gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types. 23676@end menu 23677 23678@node gdb.printing 23679@subsubsection gdb.printing 23680@cindex gdb.printing 23681 23682This module provides a collection of utilities for working with 23683pretty-printers. 23684 23685@table @code 23686@item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None) 23687This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer}, 23688@samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work. 23689Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class. 23690 23691@item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name}) 23692For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the 23693corresponding API for the subprinters. 23694 23695@item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name}) 23696Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via 23697regular expressions. 23698@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example. 23699 23700@item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}) 23701Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}. 23702@end table 23703 23704@node gdb.types 23705@subsubsection gdb.types 23706@cindex gdb.types 23707 23708This module provides a collection of utilities for working with 23709@code{gdb.Types} objects. 23710 23711@table @code 23712@item get_basic_type (@var{type}) 23713Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped, 23714and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type. 23715 23716C@t{++} example: 23717 23718@smallexample 23719typedef const int const_int; 23720const_int foo (3); 23721const_int& foo_ref (foo); 23722int main () @{ return 0; @} 23723@end smallexample 23724 23725Then in gdb: 23726 23727@smallexample 23728(gdb) start 23729(gdb) python import gdb.types 23730(gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref") 23731(gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type) 23732int 23733@end smallexample 23734 23735@item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field}) 23736Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields 23737(e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}. 23738 23739@item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type}) 23740Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}. 23741@end table 23742 23743@node Interpreters 23744@chapter Command Interpreters 23745@cindex command interpreters 23746 23747@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command 23748infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch 23749between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters. 23750 23751@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console 23752interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli}) 23753and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual 23754describes both of these interfaces in great detail. 23755 23756By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter. 23757However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another 23758interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter} 23759startup options. Defined interpreters include: 23760 23761@table @code 23762@item console 23763@cindex console interpreter 23764The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often 23765used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime, 23766@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter. 23767 23768@item mi 23769@cindex mi interpreter 23770The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily 23771by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI 23772or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} 23773Interface}. 23774 23775@item mi2 23776@cindex mi2 interpreter 23777The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 23778 23779@item mi1 23780@cindex mi1 interpreter 23781The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3. 23782 23783@end table 23784 23785@cindex invoke another interpreter 23786The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically 23787switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very 23788precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user 23789enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view, 23790@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering 23791the IDE inoperable! 23792 23793@kindex interpreter-exec 23794Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute 23795commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate 23796command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the 23797@code{interpreter-exec} command: 23798 23799@smallexample 23800interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names" 23801@end smallexample 23802 23803@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of 23804@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater). 23805 23806@node TUI 23807@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 23808@cindex TUI 23809@cindex Text User Interface 23810 23811@menu 23812* TUI Overview:: TUI overview 23813* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings 23814* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode 23815* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands 23816* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables 23817@end menu 23818 23819The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal 23820interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source 23821file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN} 23822commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only 23823on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library 23824is available. 23825 23826@pindex @value{GDBTUI} 23827The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as 23828either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}. 23829You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by 23830using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}. 23831@xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}. 23832 23833@node TUI Overview 23834@section TUI Overview 23835 23836In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows: 23837 23838@table @emph 23839@item command 23840This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN} 23841prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still 23842managed using readline. 23843 23844@item source 23845The source window shows the source file of the program. The current 23846line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window. 23847 23848@item assembly 23849The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program. 23850 23851@item register 23852This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted 23853when their values change. 23854@end table 23855 23856The source and assembly windows show the current program position 23857by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker. 23858Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker 23859indicates the breakpoint type: 23860 23861@table @code 23862@item B 23863Breakpoint which was hit at least once. 23864 23865@item b 23866Breakpoint which was never hit. 23867 23868@item H 23869Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once. 23870 23871@item h 23872Hardware breakpoint which was never hit. 23873@end table 23874 23875The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not: 23876 23877@table @code 23878@item + 23879Breakpoint is enabled. 23880 23881@item - 23882Breakpoint is disabled. 23883@end table 23884 23885The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current 23886thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter 23887changes. 23888 23889These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command 23890window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several 23891layouts: 23892 23893@itemize @bullet 23894@item 23895source only, 23896 23897@item 23898assembly only, 23899 23900@item 23901source and assembly, 23902 23903@item 23904source and registers, or 23905 23906@item 23907assembly and registers. 23908@end itemize 23909 23910A status line above the command window shows the following information: 23911 23912@table @emph 23913@item target 23914Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target. 23915(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 23916 23917@item process 23918Gives the current process or thread number. 23919When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}. 23920 23921@item function 23922Gives the current function name for the selected frame. 23923The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}). 23924When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter, 23925the string @code{??} is displayed. 23926 23927@item line 23928Indicates the current line number for the selected frame. 23929When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed. 23930 23931@item pc 23932Indicates the current program counter address. 23933@end table 23934 23935@node TUI Keys 23936@section TUI Key Bindings 23937@cindex TUI key bindings 23938 23939The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps 23940@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 23941(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}). 23942@end ifset 23943@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 23944(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). 23945@end ifclear 23946The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the 23947@value{GDBN} standard mode. 23948 23949@table @kbd 23950@kindex C-x C-a 23951@item C-x C-a 23952@kindex C-x a 23953@itemx C-x a 23954@kindex C-x A 23955@itemx C-x A 23956Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode, 23957the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using 23958its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering 23959the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows. 23960The screen is then refreshed. 23961 23962@kindex C-x 1 23963@item C-x 1 23964Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will 23965either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode 23966is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode. 23967 23968Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding. 23969 23970@kindex C-x 2 23971@item C-x 2 23972Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current 23973layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used. 23974When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the 23975previous layout and the new one. 23976 23977Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding. 23978 23979@kindex C-x o 23980@item C-x o 23981Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings 23982(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command 23983gives the focus to the next TUI window. 23984 23985Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding. 23986 23987@kindex C-x s 23988@item C-x s 23989Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single 23990keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}). 23991@end table 23992 23993The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode: 23994 23995@table @asis 23996@kindex PgUp 23997@item @key{PgUp} 23998Scroll the active window one page up. 23999 24000@kindex PgDn 24001@item @key{PgDn} 24002Scroll the active window one page down. 24003 24004@kindex Up 24005@item @key{Up} 24006Scroll the active window one line up. 24007 24008@kindex Down 24009@item @key{Down} 24010Scroll the active window one line down. 24011 24012@kindex Left 24013@item @key{Left} 24014Scroll the active window one column left. 24015 24016@kindex Right 24017@item @key{Right} 24018Scroll the active window one column right. 24019 24020@kindex C-L 24021@item @kbd{C-L} 24022Refresh the screen. 24023@end table 24024 24025Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they 24026are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command 24027window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use 24028other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} 24029and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window. 24030 24031@node TUI Single Key Mode 24032@section TUI Single Key Mode 24033@cindex TUI single key mode 24034 24035The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several 24036frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to 24037switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used: 24038 24039@table @kbd 24040@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24041@item c 24042continue 24043 24044@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24045@item d 24046down 24047 24048@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24049@item f 24050finish 24051 24052@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24053@item n 24054next 24055 24056@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24057@item q 24058exit the SingleKey mode. 24059 24060@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24061@item r 24062run 24063 24064@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24065@item s 24066step 24067 24068@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24069@item u 24070up 24071 24072@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24073@item v 24074info locals 24075 24076@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 24077@item w 24078where 24079@end table 24080 24081Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt. 24082The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that 24083it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction 24084with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI 24085SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave 24086this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}. 24087 24088 24089@node TUI Commands 24090@section TUI-specific Commands 24091@cindex TUI commands 24092 24093The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows. 24094These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in 24095the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most 24096of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode. 24097 24098Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a 24099terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface 24100interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of 24101these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be 24102possible or desirable to enable curses window management. 24103 24104@table @code 24105@item info win 24106@kindex info win 24107List and give the size of all displayed windows. 24108 24109@item layout next 24110@kindex layout 24111Display the next layout. 24112 24113@item layout prev 24114Display the previous layout. 24115 24116@item layout src 24117Display the source window only. 24118 24119@item layout asm 24120Display the assembly window only. 24121 24122@item layout split 24123Display the source and assembly window. 24124 24125@item layout regs 24126Display the register window together with the source or assembly window. 24127 24128@item focus next 24129@kindex focus 24130Make the next window active for scrolling. 24131 24132@item focus prev 24133Make the previous window active for scrolling. 24134 24135@item focus src 24136Make the source window active for scrolling. 24137 24138@item focus asm 24139Make the assembly window active for scrolling. 24140 24141@item focus regs 24142Make the register window active for scrolling. 24143 24144@item focus cmd 24145Make the command window active for scrolling. 24146 24147@item refresh 24148@kindex refresh 24149Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}. 24150 24151@item tui reg float 24152@kindex tui reg 24153Show the floating point registers in the register window. 24154 24155@item tui reg general 24156Show the general registers in the register window. 24157 24158@item tui reg next 24159Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as 24160their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the 24161following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector}, 24162@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}. 24163 24164@item tui reg system 24165Show the system registers in the register window. 24166 24167@item update 24168@kindex update 24169Update the source window and the current execution point. 24170 24171@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count} 24172@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count} 24173@kindex winheight 24174Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count} 24175lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts 24176decrease it. 24177 24178@item tabset @var{nchars} 24179@kindex tabset 24180Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. 24181@end table 24182 24183@node TUI Configuration 24184@section TUI Configuration Variables 24185@cindex TUI configuration variables 24186 24187Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows. 24188 24189@table @code 24190@item set tui border-kind @var{kind} 24191@kindex set tui border-kind 24192Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows. 24193The possible values are the following: 24194@table @code 24195@item space 24196Use a space character to draw the border. 24197 24198@item ascii 24199Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border. 24200 24201@item acs 24202Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is 24203drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them. 24204@end table 24205 24206@item set tui border-mode @var{mode} 24207@kindex set tui border-mode 24208@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode} 24209@kindex set tui active-border-mode 24210Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows 24211or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following: 24212@table @code 24213@item normal 24214Use normal attributes to display the border. 24215 24216@item standout 24217Use standout mode. 24218 24219@item reverse 24220Use reverse video mode. 24221 24222@item half 24223Use half bright mode. 24224 24225@item half-standout 24226Use half bright and standout mode. 24227 24228@item bold 24229Use extra bright or bold mode. 24230 24231@item bold-standout 24232Use extra bright or bold and standout mode. 24233@end table 24234@end table 24235 24236@node Emacs 24237@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 24238 24239@cindex Emacs 24240@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs 24241A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and 24242edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with 24243@value{GDBN}. 24244 24245To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the 24246executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts 24247@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly 24248created Emacs buffer. 24249@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.) 24250 24251Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two 24252things: 24253 24254@itemize @bullet 24255@item 24256All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called 24257the GUD buffer. 24258 24259This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input 24260and output done by the program you are debugging. 24261 24262This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous 24263commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output 24264in this way. 24265 24266All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting 24267with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual 24268way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a 24269stop. 24270 24271@item 24272@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs. 24273 24274Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the 24275source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the 24276left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for 24277source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session 24278and the source. 24279 24280Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as 24281usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs. 24282@end itemize 24283 24284We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses 24285a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers 24286that can control the execution and describe the state of your program. 24287@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}. 24288 24289If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x 24290gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where 24291your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs 24292sets your current working directory to to the directory associated 24293with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your 24294program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on 24295some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the 24296@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary 24297buffer does not display the current source and line of execution. 24298 24299The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top 24300line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands 24301that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, 24302,Commands to Specify Files}. 24303 24304By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you 24305need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you 24306keep several configurations around, with different names) you can 24307customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the 24308one you want. 24309 24310In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in 24311addition to the standard Shell mode commands: 24312 24313@table @kbd 24314@item C-h m 24315Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode. 24316 24317@item C-c C-s 24318Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also 24319update the display window to show the current file and location. 24320 24321@item C-c C-n 24322Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function 24323calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window 24324to show the current file and location. 24325 24326@item C-c C-i 24327Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update 24328display window accordingly. 24329 24330@item C-c C-f 24331Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN} 24332@code{finish} command. 24333 24334@item C-c C-r 24335Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue} 24336command. 24337 24338@item C-c < 24339Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument 24340(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}), 24341like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command. 24342 24343@item C-c > 24344Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the 24345@value{GDBN} @code{down} command. 24346@end table 24347 24348In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break}) 24349tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on. 24350 24351In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a 24352separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current. 24353Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it 24354become the current frame and display the associated source in the 24355source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the 24356selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the 24357speedbar displays watch expressions. 24358 24359If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get 24360it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to 24361request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates 24362the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current 24363frame. 24364 24365The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers 24366which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit 24367the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN} 24368communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or 24369delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease 24370to correspond properly with the code. 24371 24372A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is 24373given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} 24374Emacs Manual}). 24375 24376@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate 24377@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990 24378@ignore 24379@kindex Emacs Epoch environment 24380@kindex Epoch 24381@kindex inspect 24382 24383Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system 24384called the @code{epoch} 24385environment. Users of this environment can use a new command, 24386@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that 24387each value is printed in its own window. 24388@end ignore 24389 24390 24391@node GDB/MI 24392@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface 24393 24394@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose 24395 24396@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose 24397@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to 24398@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the 24399@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It 24400is specifically intended to support the development of systems which 24401use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system. 24402 24403This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written 24404in the form of a reference manual. 24405 24406Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the 24407features described below are incomplete and subject to change 24408(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}). 24409 24410@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology 24411 24412@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi} 24413This chapter uses the following notation: 24414 24415@itemize @bullet 24416@item 24417@code{|} separates two alternatives. 24418 24419@item 24420@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional: 24421it may or may not be given. 24422 24423@item 24424@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 24425may repeat zero or more times. 24426 24427@item 24428@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 24429may repeat one or more times. 24430 24431@item 24432@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}. 24433@end itemize 24434 24435@ignore 24436@heading Dependencies 24437@end ignore 24438 24439@menu 24440* GDB/MI General Design:: 24441* GDB/MI Command Syntax:: 24442* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI:: 24443* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends:: 24444* GDB/MI Output Records:: 24445* GDB/MI Simple Examples:: 24446* GDB/MI Command Description Format:: 24447* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands:: 24448* GDB/MI Program Context:: 24449* GDB/MI Thread Commands:: 24450* GDB/MI Program Execution:: 24451* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation:: 24452* GDB/MI Variable Objects:: 24453* GDB/MI Data Manipulation:: 24454* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands:: 24455* GDB/MI Symbol Query:: 24456* GDB/MI File Commands:: 24457@ignore 24458* GDB/MI Kod Commands:: 24459* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands:: 24460* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands:: 24461@end ignore 24462* GDB/MI Target Manipulation:: 24463* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands:: 24464* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands:: 24465@end menu 24466 24467@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 24468@node GDB/MI General Design 24469@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design 24470@cindex GDB/MI General Design 24471 24472Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three 24473parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands 24474and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response, 24475indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error. 24476For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the 24477requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the 24478response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed. 24479Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the 24480target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with 24481a command and reported as part of that command response. 24482 24483The important examples of notifications are: 24484@itemize @bullet 24485 24486@item 24487Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in 24488target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not 24489be feasible to include this information in response of resuming 24490commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in 24491different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event 24492happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming 24493command itself was successfully executed. 24494 24495@item 24496Console output, and status notifications. Console output 24497notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as 24498diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to 24499report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including 24500this information in command response would mean no output is produced 24501until the command is finished, which is undesirable. 24502 24503@item 24504General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on 24505the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example, 24506a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can 24507be included in command response, using notification allows for more 24508orthogonal frontend design. 24509 24510@end itemize 24511 24512There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error, 24513@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially, 24514the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was 24515processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error, 24516we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in 24517the user interface. 24518 24519 24520@menu 24521* Context management:: 24522* Asynchronous and non-stop modes:: 24523* Thread groups:: 24524@end menu 24525 24526@node Context management 24527@subsection Context management 24528 24529In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is 24530done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}). 24531Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread 24532be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame, 24533and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient, 24534because a command line user would not want to specify that information 24535explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with 24536@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as 24537to what thread and frame are the current ones. 24538 24539In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less 24540useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information 24541itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window, 24542each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might 24543want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This 24544increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the 24545frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command 24546should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To 24547make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and 24548@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier 24549for thread and frame to operate on. 24550 24551Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select 24552a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further 24553operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the 24554current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint 24555it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For 24556another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via 24557the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the 24558one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to 24559change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification. 24560No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment. 24561 24562Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so 24563frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the 24564right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The 24565simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command 24566before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need 24567to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select} 24568if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the 24569thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this 24570optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend 24571sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the 24572selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will 24573change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such 24574problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for 24575all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly 24576right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and 24577@samp{--frame} options. 24578 24579@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes 24580@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode 24581 24582On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands 24583even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous 24584command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may 24585specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the 24586@code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before 24587either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the 24588frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can 24589find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the 24590@code{-list-target-features} command. 24591 24592Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running, 24593many commands that access the target do not work when the target is 24594running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful 24595when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then, 24596it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads 24597are running. 24598 24599When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the 24600target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on 24601some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's 24602stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or 24603modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note 24604that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print}, 24605@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the 24606context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a 24607stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the 24608@samp{--thread} option). 24609 24610Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is 24611highly target dependent. However, the two commands 24612@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info}, 24613to find the state of a thread, will always work. 24614 24615@node Thread groups 24616@subsection Thread groups 24617@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time. 24618On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several 24619hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different 24620processes running on each core. This section describes the MI 24621mechanism to support such debugging scenarios. 24622 24623The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the 24624target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that 24625accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that 24626thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce 24627neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the 24628current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature 24629that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped 24630into processes. 24631 24632To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary 24633hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a 24634@dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other 24635thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type, 24636and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new 24637command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level 24638thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is 24639debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group 24640to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain 24641the members of specific thread group. 24642 24643To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he 24644wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is 24645introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that 24646@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the 24647@code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread 24648groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}. 24649In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only 24650after attaching to that thread group. 24651 24652Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and 24653Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special 24654type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on 24655such thread groups. 24656 24657@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 24658@node GDB/MI Command Syntax 24659@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax 24660 24661@menu 24662* GDB/MI Input Syntax:: 24663* GDB/MI Output Syntax:: 24664@end menu 24665 24666@node GDB/MI Input Syntax 24667@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax 24668 24669@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi} 24670@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax 24671@table @code 24672@item @var{command} @expansion{} 24673@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}} 24674 24675@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{} 24676@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where 24677@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command. 24678 24679@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{} 24680@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )* 24681@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}} 24682 24683@item @var{token} @expansion{} 24684"any sequence of digits" 24685 24686@item @var{option} @expansion{} 24687@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]} 24688 24689@item @var{parameter} @expansion{} 24690@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}} 24691 24692@item @var{operation} @expansion{} 24693@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter} 24694 24695@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{} 24696@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as 24697"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "} 24698 24699@item @var{c-string} @expansion{} 24700@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """} 24701 24702@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 24703@code{CR | CR-LF} 24704@end table 24705 24706@noindent 24707Notes: 24708 24709@itemize @bullet 24710@item 24711The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their 24712output is described below. 24713 24714@item 24715The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command 24716finishes. 24717 24718@item 24719Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter 24720list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be 24721followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the 24722parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using 24723@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash). 24724@end itemize 24725 24726Pragmatics: 24727 24728@itemize @bullet 24729@item 24730We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging). 24731 24732@item 24733We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation. 24734@end itemize 24735 24736@node GDB/MI Output Syntax 24737@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax 24738 24739@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi} 24740@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax 24741The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records 24742followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record 24743is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is 24744terminated by @samp{(gdb)}. 24745 24746If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the 24747corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same 24748@var{token}. 24749 24750@table @code 24751@item @var{output} @expansion{} 24752@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}} 24753 24754@item @var{result-record} @expansion{} 24755@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}} 24756 24757@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{} 24758@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}} 24759 24760@item @var{async-record} @expansion{} 24761@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}} 24762 24763@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{} 24764@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}} 24765 24766@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{} 24767@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}} 24768 24769@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{} 24770@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}} 24771 24772@item @var{async-output} @expansion{} 24773@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}} 24774 24775@item @var{result-class} @expansion{} 24776@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"} 24777 24778@item @var{async-class} @expansion{} 24779@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added 24780depending on the needs---this is still in development). 24781 24782@item @var{result} @expansion{} 24783@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}} 24784 24785@item @var{variable} @expansion{} 24786@code{ @var{string} } 24787 24788@item @var{value} @expansion{} 24789@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} } 24790 24791@item @var{const} @expansion{} 24792@code{@var{c-string}} 24793 24794@item @var{tuple} @expansion{} 24795@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" } 24796 24797@item @var{list} @expansion{} 24798@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "[" 24799@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" } 24800 24801@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{} 24802@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}} 24803 24804@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{} 24805@code{"~" @var{c-string}} 24806 24807@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{} 24808@code{"@@" @var{c-string}} 24809 24810@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{} 24811@code{"&" @var{c-string}} 24812 24813@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 24814@code{CR | CR-LF} 24815 24816@item @var{token} @expansion{} 24817@emph{any sequence of digits}. 24818@end table 24819 24820@noindent 24821Notes: 24822 24823@itemize @bullet 24824@item 24825All output sequences end in a single line containing a period. 24826 24827@item 24828The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that 24829for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and 24830may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async 24831output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat 24832all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the 24833target and there should be no need to associate async output to any 24834prior command. 24835 24836@item 24837@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24838@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the 24839progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is 24840prefixed by @samp{+}. 24841 24842@item 24843@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24844@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target 24845(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by 24846@samp{*}. 24847 24848@item 24849@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24850@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the 24851client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify 24852output is prefixed by @samp{=}. 24853 24854@item 24855@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24856@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the 24857console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console 24858output is prefixed by @samp{~}. 24859 24860@item 24861@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24862@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program. 24863All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}. 24864 24865@item 24866@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24867@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for 24868instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All 24869the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}. 24870 24871@item 24872@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi} 24873New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing 24874@var{values}. 24875 24876 24877@end itemize 24878 24879@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more 24880details about the various output records. 24881 24882@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 24883@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI 24884@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI 24885 24886@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI 24887@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI 24888 24889For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly, 24890but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands 24891that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint 24892command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as 24893@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with 24894@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output. 24895 24896This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is 24897recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command 24898(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}). 24899 24900@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 24901@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends 24902@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends 24903@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development 24904 24905The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the 24906program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}. 24907 24908Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used 24909by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult 24910to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This 24911section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol 24912might change. 24913 24914Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and 24915for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a 24916list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should 24917parse MI output in a way that can handle them: 24918 24919@itemize @bullet 24920@item 24921New MI commands may be added. 24922 24923@item 24924New fields may be added to the output of any MI command. 24925 24926@item 24927The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g., 24928@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended. 24929 24930@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it 24931@c at your own risk. Yes, in general? 24932 24933@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might 24934@c resolve inconsistencies. 24935@end itemize 24936 24937If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level 24938will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the 24939output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of 24940@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the 24941responsibility of the front end to work with the new one. 24942 24943@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI 24944@c version? 24945 24946The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front 24947end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and 24948follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and 24949@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. 24950@cindex mailing lists 24951 24952@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 24953@node GDB/MI Output Records 24954@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records 24955 24956@menu 24957* GDB/MI Result Records:: 24958* GDB/MI Stream Records:: 24959* GDB/MI Async Records:: 24960* GDB/MI Frame Information:: 24961* GDB/MI Thread Information:: 24962* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information:: 24963@end menu 24964 24965@node GDB/MI Result Records 24966@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records 24967 24968@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi} 24969@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records 24970In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a 24971@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications: 24972 24973@table @code 24974@findex ^done 24975@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ] 24976The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return 24977values. 24978 24979@item "^running" 24980@findex ^running 24981This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it 24982was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the 24983target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but 24984all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running} 24985identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine 24986which threads are resumed. 24987 24988@item "^connected" 24989@findex ^connected 24990@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target. 24991 24992@item "^error" "," @var{c-string} 24993@findex ^error 24994The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding 24995error message. 24996 24997@item "^exit" 24998@findex ^exit 24999@value{GDBN} has terminated. 25000 25001@end table 25002 25003@node GDB/MI Stream Records 25004@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records 25005 25006@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records 25007@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi} 25008@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the 25009target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is 25010funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}. 25011 25012Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which 25013identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output 25014Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a 25015@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new 25016line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline). 25017 25018@table @code 25019@item "~" @var{string-output} 25020The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the 25021CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands. 25022 25023@item "@@" @var{string-output} 25024The target output stream contains any textual output from the running 25025target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly 25026asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets. 25027 25028@item "&" @var{string-output} 25029The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s 25030internals. 25031@end table 25032 25033@node GDB/MI Async Records 25034@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records 25035 25036@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi} 25037@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records 25038@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of 25039additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a 25040consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of 25041target activity (e.g., target stopped). 25042 25043The following is the list of possible async records: 25044 25045@table @code 25046 25047@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}" 25048The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which 25049specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads 25050are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a 25051running thread is possible after this notification is produced. 25052The frontend should not assume that this notification is output 25053only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification 25054several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume 25055all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must 25056be stepped though some code before letting it run freely. 25057 25058@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}" 25059The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the 25060following values: 25061 25062@table @code 25063@item breakpoint-hit 25064A breakpoint was reached. 25065@item watchpoint-trigger 25066A watchpoint was triggered. 25067@item read-watchpoint-trigger 25068A read watchpoint was triggered. 25069@item access-watchpoint-trigger 25070An access watchpoint was triggered. 25071@item function-finished 25072An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished. 25073@item location-reached 25074An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished. 25075@item watchpoint-scope 25076A watchpoint has gone out of scope. 25077@item end-stepping-range 25078An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or 25079similar CLI command was accomplished. 25080@item exited-signalled 25081The inferior exited because of a signal. 25082@item exited 25083The inferior exited. 25084@item exited-normally 25085The inferior exited normally. 25086@item signal-received 25087A signal was received by the inferior. 25088@end table 25089 25090The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop 25091-- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop 25092mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either 25093stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop. 25094If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the 25095value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped} 25096field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will 25097always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see 25098several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the 25099processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent 25100if such information is not available. 25101 25102@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}" 25103@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}" 25104A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field 25105contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread 25106group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running 25107process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and 25108cannot be used in any way. 25109 25110@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}" 25111A thread group became associated with a running program, 25112either because the program was just started or the thread group 25113was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the 25114@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field 25115contains process identifier, specific to the operating system. 25116 25117@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"] 25118A thread group is no longer associated with a running program, 25119either because the program has exited, or because it was detached 25120from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the 25121thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists 25122only when the inferior exited with some code. 25123 25124@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 25125@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 25126A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field 25127contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid} 25128field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to. 25129 25130@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}" 25131Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last 25132command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select} 25133command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented 25134to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular, 25135invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI 25136@code{thread} command, will generate this notification. 25137 25138We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends 25139highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to 25140that thread. 25141 25142@item =library-loaded,... 25143Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This 25144notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name}, 25145@var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an 25146opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case, 25147@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the 25148library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native 25149debugging, both those fields have the same value. The 25150@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility 25151and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The 25152@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread 25153group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is 25154absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present 25155thread groups. 25156 25157@item =library-unloaded,... 25158Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification 25159has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with 25160the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification. 25161The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the 25162thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is 25163absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present 25164thread groups. 25165 25166@end table 25167 25168@node GDB/MI Frame Information 25169@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information 25170 25171Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack 25172frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following 25173fields: 25174 25175@table @code 25176@item level 25177The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of 25178zero. This field is always present. 25179 25180@item func 25181The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may 25182be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name. 25183 25184@item addr 25185The code address for the frame. This field is always present. 25186 25187@item file 25188The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code 25189address. This field may be absent. 25190 25191@item line 25192The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field 25193may be absent. 25194 25195@item from 25196The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the 25197corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent. 25198 25199@end table 25200 25201@node GDB/MI Thread Information 25202@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information 25203 25204Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it 25205uses a tuple with the following fields: 25206 25207@table @code 25208@item id 25209The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is 25210always present. 25211 25212@item target-id 25213Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present. 25214 25215@item details 25216Additional information about the thread provided by the target. 25217It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the 25218frontend. This field is optional. 25219 25220@item state 25221Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the 25222thread is presently running. This field is always present. 25223 25224@item core 25225The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the 25226thread was last seen on. This field is optional. 25227@end table 25228 25229@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information 25230@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information 25231 25232Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program 25233stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}), 25234@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via 25235the @code{exception-name} field. 25236 25237@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25238@node GDB/MI Simple Examples 25239@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction 25240@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples 25241 25242This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using 25243the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the 25244following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means 25245the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}. 25246 25247Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for 25248readability, they don't appear in the real output. 25249 25250@subheading Setting a Breakpoint 25251 25252Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed 25253information of the breakpoint. 25254 25255@smallexample 25256-> -break-insert main 25257<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 25258 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c", 25259 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@} 25260<- (gdb) 25261@end smallexample 25262 25263@subheading Program Execution 25264 25265Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the 25266reason that execution stopped. 25267 25268@smallexample 25269-> -exec-run 25270<- ^running 25271<- (gdb) 25272<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 25273 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main", 25274 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}], 25275 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@} 25276<- (gdb) 25277-> -exec-continue 25278<- ^running 25279<- (gdb) 25280<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally" 25281<- (gdb) 25282@end smallexample 25283 25284@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN} 25285 25286Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}. 25287 25288@smallexample 25289-> (gdb) 25290<- -gdb-exit 25291<- ^exit 25292@end smallexample 25293 25294Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might 25295take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN} 25296performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged 25297or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till 25298@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it 25299fails to exit in reasonable time. 25300 25301@subheading A Bad Command 25302 25303Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command: 25304 25305@smallexample 25306-> -rubbish 25307<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish" 25308<- (gdb) 25309@end smallexample 25310 25311 25312@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25313@node GDB/MI Command Description Format 25314@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format 25315 25316The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of 25317commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section. 25318 25319@subheading Motivation 25320 25321The motivation for this collection of commands. 25322 25323@subheading Introduction 25324 25325A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole. 25326 25327@subheading Commands 25328 25329For each command in the block, the following is described: 25330 25331@subsubheading Synopsis 25332 25333@smallexample 25334 -command @var{args}@dots{} 25335@end smallexample 25336 25337@subsubheading Result 25338 25339@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25340 25341The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any. 25342 25343@subsubheading Example 25344 25345Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have 25346not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available). 25347 25348 25349@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25350@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands 25351@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands 25352 25353@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi} 25354@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands 25355This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating 25356breakpoints. 25357 25358@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command 25359@findex -break-after 25360 25361@subsubheading Synopsis 25362 25363@smallexample 25364 -break-after @var{number} @var{count} 25365@end smallexample 25366 25367The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been 25368hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of 25369the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the 25370@samp{-break-list} command below. 25371 25372@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25373 25374The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}. 25375 25376@subsubheading Example 25377 25378@smallexample 25379(gdb) 25380-break-insert main 25381^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 25382enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 25383fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@} 25384(gdb) 25385-break-after 1 3 25386~ 25387^done 25388(gdb) 25389-break-list 25390^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 25391hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25392@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25393@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25394@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25395@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25396@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25397body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25398addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 25399line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 25400(gdb) 25401@end smallexample 25402 25403@ignore 25404@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command 25405@findex -break-catch 25406@end ignore 25407 25408@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command 25409@findex -break-commands 25410 25411@subsubheading Synopsis 25412 25413@smallexample 25414 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ] 25415@end smallexample 25416 25417Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint 25418@var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN} 25419are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set 25420commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this 25421functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of 25422some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing. 25423 25424@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25425 25426The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}. 25427 25428@subsubheading Example 25429 25430@smallexample 25431(gdb) 25432-break-insert main 25433^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 25434enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 25435fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@} 25436(gdb) 25437-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue" 25438^done 25439(gdb) 25440@end smallexample 25441 25442@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command 25443@findex -break-condition 25444 25445@subsubheading Synopsis 25446 25447@smallexample 25448 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr} 25449@end smallexample 25450 25451Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in 25452@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the 25453@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list} 25454command below). 25455 25456@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25457 25458The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}. 25459 25460@subsubheading Example 25461 25462@smallexample 25463(gdb) 25464-break-condition 1 1 25465^done 25466(gdb) 25467-break-list 25468^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 25469hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25470@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25471@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25472@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25473@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25474@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25475body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25476addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 25477line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 25478(gdb) 25479@end smallexample 25480 25481@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command 25482@findex -break-delete 25483 25484@subsubheading Synopsis 25485 25486@smallexample 25487 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 25488@end smallexample 25489 25490Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument 25491list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list. 25492 25493@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25494 25495The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}. 25496 25497@subsubheading Example 25498 25499@smallexample 25500(gdb) 25501-break-delete 1 25502^done 25503(gdb) 25504-break-list 25505^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 25506hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25507@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25508@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25509@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25510@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25511@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25512body=[]@} 25513(gdb) 25514@end smallexample 25515 25516@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command 25517@findex -break-disable 25518 25519@subsubheading Synopsis 25520 25521@smallexample 25522 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 25523@end smallexample 25524 25525Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the 25526break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s). 25527 25528@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25529 25530The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}. 25531 25532@subsubheading Example 25533 25534@smallexample 25535(gdb) 25536-break-disable 2 25537^done 25538(gdb) 25539-break-list 25540^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 25541hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25542@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25543@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25544@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25545@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25546@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25547body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n", 25548addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 25549line="5",times="0"@}]@} 25550(gdb) 25551@end smallexample 25552 25553@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command 25554@findex -break-enable 25555 25556@subsubheading Synopsis 25557 25558@smallexample 25559 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 25560@end smallexample 25561 25562Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s). 25563 25564@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25565 25566The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}. 25567 25568@subsubheading Example 25569 25570@smallexample 25571(gdb) 25572-break-enable 2 25573^done 25574(gdb) 25575-break-list 25576^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 25577hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25578@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25579@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25580@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25581@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25582@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25583body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25584addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 25585line="5",times="0"@}]@} 25586(gdb) 25587@end smallexample 25588 25589@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command 25590@findex -break-info 25591 25592@subsubheading Synopsis 25593 25594@smallexample 25595 -break-info @var{breakpoint} 25596@end smallexample 25597 25598@c REDUNDANT??? 25599Get information about a single breakpoint. 25600 25601@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25602 25603The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}. 25604 25605@subsubheading Example 25606N.A. 25607 25608@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command 25609@findex -break-insert 25610 25611@subsubheading Synopsis 25612 25613@smallexample 25614 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ] 25615 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ] 25616 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ] 25617@end smallexample 25618 25619@noindent 25620If specified, @var{location}, can be one of: 25621 25622@itemize @bullet 25623@item function 25624@c @item +offset 25625@c @item -offset 25626@c @item linenum 25627@item filename:linenum 25628@item filename:function 25629@item *address 25630@end itemize 25631 25632The possible optional parameters of this command are: 25633 25634@table @samp 25635@item -t 25636Insert a temporary breakpoint. 25637@item -h 25638Insert a hardware breakpoint. 25639@item -c @var{condition} 25640Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 25641@item -i @var{ignore-count} 25642Initialize the @var{ignore-count}. 25643@item -f 25644If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it 25645refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending 25646breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report 25647an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location} 25648cannot be parsed. 25649@item -d 25650Create a disabled breakpoint. 25651@item -a 25652Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter 25653is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created. 25654@end table 25655 25656@subsubheading Result 25657 25658The result is in the form: 25659 25660@smallexample 25661^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep", 25662enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}", 25663fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},] 25664times="@var{times}"@} 25665@end smallexample 25666 25667@noindent 25668where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, 25669@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was 25670inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains 25671this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file 25672and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit 25673(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list 25674which use the same output). 25675 25676Note: this format is open to change. 25677@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result? 25678 25679@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25680 25681The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak}, 25682@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}. 25683 25684@subsubheading Example 25685 25686@smallexample 25687(gdb) 25688-break-insert main 25689^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c", 25690fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@} 25691(gdb) 25692-break-insert -t foo 25693^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c", 25694fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@} 25695(gdb) 25696-break-list 25697^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 25698hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25699@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25700@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25701@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25702@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25703@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25704body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25705addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c", 25706fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@}, 25707bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y", 25708addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c", 25709fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@} 25710(gdb) 25711-break-insert -r foo.* 25712~int foo(int, int); 25713^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c, 25714"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@} 25715(gdb) 25716@end smallexample 25717 25718@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command 25719@findex -break-list 25720 25721@subsubheading Synopsis 25722 25723@smallexample 25724 -break-list 25725@end smallexample 25726 25727Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields: 25728 25729@table @samp 25730@item Number 25731number of the breakpoint 25732@item Type 25733type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint} 25734@item Disposition 25735should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep} 25736or @samp{nokeep} 25737@item Enabled 25738is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n} 25739@item Address 25740memory location at which the breakpoint is set 25741@item What 25742logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file 25743name, line number 25744@item Times 25745number of times the breakpoint has been hit 25746@end table 25747 25748If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable} 25749@code{body} field is an empty list. 25750 25751@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25752 25753The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}. 25754 25755@subsubheading Example 25756 25757@smallexample 25758(gdb) 25759-break-list 25760^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 25761hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25762@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25763@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25764@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25765@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25766@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25767body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25768addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}, 25769bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25770addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 25771line="13",times="0"@}]@} 25772(gdb) 25773@end smallexample 25774 25775Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints: 25776 25777@smallexample 25778(gdb) 25779-break-list 25780^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 25781hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25782@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25783@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25784@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25785@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25786@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25787body=[]@} 25788(gdb) 25789@end smallexample 25790 25791@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command 25792@findex -break-passcount 25793 25794@subsubheading Synopsis 25795 25796@smallexample 25797 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount} 25798@end smallexample 25799 25800Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to 25801@var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number} 25802is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI 25803command @samp{passcount}. 25804 25805@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command 25806@findex -break-watch 25807 25808@subsubheading Synopsis 25809 25810@smallexample 25811 -break-watch [ -a | -r ] 25812@end smallexample 25813 25814Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an 25815@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a 25816read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r} 25817option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will 25818trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without 25819either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint, 25820i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing. 25821@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}. 25822 25823Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and 25824breakpoints inserted. 25825 25826@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25827 25828The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and 25829@samp{rwatch}. 25830 25831@subsubheading Example 25832 25833Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function: 25834 25835@smallexample 25836(gdb) 25837-break-watch x 25838^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@} 25839(gdb) 25840-exec-continue 25841^running 25842(gdb) 25843*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}, 25844value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@}, 25845frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 25846fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@} 25847(gdb) 25848@end smallexample 25849 25850Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop 25851the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then 25852for the watchpoint going out of scope. 25853 25854@smallexample 25855(gdb) 25856-break-watch C 25857^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@} 25858(gdb) 25859-exec-continue 25860^running 25861(gdb) 25862*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger", 25863wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 25864frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 25865file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25866fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 25867(gdb) 25868-exec-continue 25869^running 25870(gdb) 25871*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5", 25872frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 25873value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 25874file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25875fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 25876(gdb) 25877@end smallexample 25878 25879Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program 25880execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is 25881deleted. 25882 25883@smallexample 25884(gdb) 25885-break-watch C 25886^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@} 25887(gdb) 25888-break-list 25889^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 25890hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25891@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25892@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25893@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25894@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25895@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25896body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25897addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 25898file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25899fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@}, 25900bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 25901enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@} 25902(gdb) 25903-exec-continue 25904^running 25905(gdb) 25906*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}, 25907value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 25908frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 25909file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25910fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 25911(gdb) 25912-break-list 25913^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 25914hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25915@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25916@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25917@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25918@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25919@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25920body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25921addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 25922file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25923fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}, 25924bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 25925enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@} 25926(gdb) 25927-exec-continue 25928^running 25929^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2", 25930frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 25931value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 25932file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25933fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 25934(gdb) 25935-break-list 25936^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 25937hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 25938@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 25939@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 25940@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 25941@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 25942@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 25943body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 25944addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 25945file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 25946fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8", 25947times="1"@}]@} 25948(gdb) 25949@end smallexample 25950 25951@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25952@node GDB/MI Program Context 25953@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context 25954 25955@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command 25956@findex -exec-arguments 25957 25958 25959@subsubheading Synopsis 25960 25961@smallexample 25962 -exec-arguments @var{args} 25963@end smallexample 25964 25965Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next 25966@samp{-exec-run}. 25967 25968@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25969 25970The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}. 25971 25972@subsubheading Example 25973 25974@smallexample 25975(gdb) 25976-exec-arguments -v word 25977^done 25978(gdb) 25979@end smallexample 25980 25981 25982@ignore 25983@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command 25984@findex -exec-show-arguments 25985 25986@subsubheading Synopsis 25987 25988@smallexample 25989 -exec-show-arguments 25990@end smallexample 25991 25992Print the arguments of the program. 25993 25994@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 25995 25996The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}. 25997 25998@subsubheading Example 25999N.A. 26000@end ignore 26001 26002 26003@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command 26004@findex -environment-cd 26005 26006@subsubheading Synopsis 26007 26008@smallexample 26009 -environment-cd @var{pathdir} 26010@end smallexample 26011 26012Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory. 26013 26014@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26015 26016The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}. 26017 26018@subsubheading Example 26019 26020@smallexample 26021(gdb) 26022-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 26023^done 26024(gdb) 26025@end smallexample 26026 26027 26028@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command 26029@findex -environment-directory 26030 26031@subsubheading Synopsis 26032 26033@smallexample 26034 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 26035@end smallexample 26036 26037Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files. 26038If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default 26039search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the 26040@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 26041occurs as normal. 26042Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 26043multiple directories in a single command 26044results in the directories added to the beginning of the 26045search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 26046If blanks are needed as 26047part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 26048the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 26049by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 26050character must not be used 26051in any directory name. 26052If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed. 26053 26054@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26055 26056The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}. 26057 26058@subsubheading Example 26059 26060@smallexample 26061(gdb) 26062-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 26063^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 26064(gdb) 26065-environment-directory "" 26066^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 26067(gdb) 26068-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src 26069^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd" 26070(gdb) 26071-environment-directory -r 26072^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd" 26073(gdb) 26074@end smallexample 26075 26076 26077@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command 26078@findex -environment-path 26079 26080@subsubheading Synopsis 26081 26082@smallexample 26083 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 26084@end smallexample 26085 26086Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files. 26087If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original 26088search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are 26089supplied in addition to the 26090@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 26091occurs as normal. 26092Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 26093multiple directories in a single command 26094results in the directories added to the beginning of the 26095search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 26096If blanks are needed as 26097part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 26098the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 26099by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 26100character must not be used 26101in any directory name. 26102If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed. 26103 26104 26105@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26106 26107The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}. 26108 26109@subsubheading Example 26110 26111@smallexample 26112(gdb) 26113-environment-path 26114^done,path="/usr/bin" 26115(gdb) 26116-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin 26117^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin" 26118(gdb) 26119-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin 26120^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin" 26121(gdb) 26122@end smallexample 26123 26124 26125@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command 26126@findex -environment-pwd 26127 26128@subsubheading Synopsis 26129 26130@smallexample 26131 -environment-pwd 26132@end smallexample 26133 26134Show the current working directory. 26135 26136@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26137 26138The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}. 26139 26140@subsubheading Example 26141 26142@smallexample 26143(gdb) 26144-environment-pwd 26145^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb" 26146(gdb) 26147@end smallexample 26148 26149@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26150@node GDB/MI Thread Commands 26151@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands 26152 26153 26154@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command 26155@findex -thread-info 26156 26157@subsubheading Synopsis 26158 26159@smallexample 26160 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ] 26161@end smallexample 26162 26163Reports information about either a specific thread, if 26164the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all 26165threads. When printing information about all threads, 26166also reports the current thread. 26167 26168@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26169 26170The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information 26171about all threads. 26172 26173@subsubheading Result 26174 26175The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are 26176defined for a given thread: 26177 26178@table @samp 26179@item current 26180This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}. 26181 26182@item id 26183The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread. 26184 26185@item target-id 26186The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread. 26187 26188@item details 26189Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This 26190field is optional. 26191 26192@item name 26193The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the 26194@code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if 26195@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that 26196name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this 26197field is omitted. 26198 26199@item frame 26200The stack frame currently executing in the thread. 26201 26202@item state 26203The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following 26204values: 26205 26206@table @code 26207@item stopped 26208The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped 26209threads. 26210 26211@item running 26212The thread is running. There's no frame information for running 26213threads. 26214 26215@end table 26216 26217@item core 26218If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running, 26219then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional. 26220 26221@end table 26222 26223@subsubheading Example 26224 26225@smallexample 26226-thread-info 26227^done,threads=[ 26228@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 26229 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall", 26230 args=[]@},state="running"@}, 26231@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 26232 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo", 26233 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 26234 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}, 26235 state="running"@}], 26236current-thread-id="1" 26237(gdb) 26238@end smallexample 26239 26240@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command 26241@findex -thread-list-ids 26242 26243@subsubheading Synopsis 26244 26245@smallexample 26246 -thread-list-ids 26247@end smallexample 26248 26249Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the 26250end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads. 26251 26252This command is retained for historical reasons, the 26253@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead. 26254 26255@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26256 26257Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information. 26258 26259@subsubheading Example 26260 26261@smallexample 26262(gdb) 26263-thread-list-ids 26264^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 26265current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3" 26266(gdb) 26267@end smallexample 26268 26269 26270@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command 26271@findex -thread-select 26272 26273@subsubheading Synopsis 26274 26275@smallexample 26276 -thread-select @var{threadnum} 26277@end smallexample 26278 26279Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new 26280current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread. 26281 26282This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the 26283@samp{--thread} option to each command. 26284 26285@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26286 26287The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}. 26288 26289@subsubheading Example 26290 26291@smallexample 26292(gdb) 26293-exec-next 26294^running 26295(gdb) 26296*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187", 26297file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c" 26298(gdb) 26299-thread-list-ids 26300^done, 26301thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 26302number-of-threads="3" 26303(gdb) 26304-thread-select 3 26305^done,new-thread-id="3", 26306frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf", 26307args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@}, 26308@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@} 26309(gdb) 26310@end smallexample 26311 26312@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26313@node GDB/MI Program Execution 26314@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution 26315 26316These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band 26317record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes 26318asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in 26319other cases. 26320 26321@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command 26322@findex -exec-continue 26323 26324@subsubheading Synopsis 26325 26326@smallexample 26327 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N] 26328@end smallexample 26329 26330Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue 26331to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the 26332@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until 26333it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include 26334@itemize @bullet 26335@item 26336breakpoints or watchpoints 26337@item 26338signals or exceptions 26339@item 26340the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse}) 26341@item 26342the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used. 26343@end itemize 26344In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop 26345Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the 26346value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is 26347specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is 26348ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is 26349specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed. 26350 26351@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26352 26353The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}. 26354 26355@subsubheading Example 26356 26357@smallexample 26358-exec-continue 26359^running 26360(gdb) 26361@@Hello world 26362*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{ 26363func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c", 26364line="13"@} 26365(gdb) 26366@end smallexample 26367 26368 26369@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command 26370@findex -exec-finish 26371 26372@subsubheading Synopsis 26373 26374@smallexample 26375 -exec-finish [--reverse] 26376@end smallexample 26377 26378Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current 26379function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function. 26380If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse 26381execution of the inferior program until the point where current 26382function was called. 26383 26384@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26385 26386The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}. 26387 26388@subsubheading Example 26389 26390Function returning @code{void}. 26391 26392@smallexample 26393-exec-finish 26394^running 26395(gdb) 26396@@hello from foo 26397*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 26398file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@} 26399(gdb) 26400@end smallexample 26401 26402Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal 26403@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the 26404value itself. 26405 26406@smallexample 26407-exec-finish 26408^running 26409(gdb) 26410*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo", 26411args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@}, 26412file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 26413gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0" 26414(gdb) 26415@end smallexample 26416 26417 26418@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command 26419@findex -exec-interrupt 26420 26421@subsubheading Synopsis 26422 26423@smallexample 26424 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N] 26425@end smallexample 26426 26427Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token 26428associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command 26429that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only 26430appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to 26431interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed. 26432 26433Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is 26434asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the 26435@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be 26436reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification. 26437 26438In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default. 26439All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the 26440@samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} 26441option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted. 26442 26443@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26444 26445The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}. 26446 26447@subsubheading Example 26448 26449@smallexample 26450(gdb) 26451111-exec-continue 26452111^running 26453 26454(gdb) 26455222-exec-interrupt 26456222^done 26457(gdb) 26458111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt", 26459frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 26460fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@} 26461(gdb) 26462 26463(gdb) 26464-exec-interrupt 26465^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing." 26466(gdb) 26467@end smallexample 26468 26469@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command 26470@findex -exec-jump 26471 26472@subsubheading Synopsis 26473 26474@smallexample 26475 -exec-jump @var{location} 26476@end smallexample 26477 26478Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by 26479parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the 26480different forms of @var{location}. 26481 26482@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26483 26484The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}. 26485 26486@subsubheading Example 26487 26488@smallexample 26489-exec-jump foo.c:10 26490*running,thread-id="all" 26491^running 26492@end smallexample 26493 26494 26495@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command 26496@findex -exec-next 26497 26498@subsubheading Synopsis 26499 26500@smallexample 26501 -exec-next [--reverse] 26502@end smallexample 26503 26504Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 26505of the next source line is reached. 26506 26507If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 26508of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous 26509source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a 26510function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the 26511source line where the function was called. 26512 26513 26514@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26515 26516The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}. 26517 26518@subsubheading Example 26519 26520@smallexample 26521-exec-next 26522^running 26523(gdb) 26524*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c" 26525(gdb) 26526@end smallexample 26527 26528 26529@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command 26530@findex -exec-next-instruction 26531 26532@subsubheading Synopsis 26533 26534@smallexample 26535 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse] 26536@end smallexample 26537 26538Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function 26539call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an 26540instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be 26541printed as well. 26542 26543If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 26544of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the 26545previously executed instruction was a return from another function, 26546it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function 26547(from the current stack frame) is reached. 26548 26549@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26550 26551The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}. 26552 26553@subsubheading Example 26554 26555@smallexample 26556(gdb) 26557-exec-next-instruction 26558^running 26559 26560(gdb) 26561*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 26562addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c" 26563(gdb) 26564@end smallexample 26565 26566 26567@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command 26568@findex -exec-return 26569 26570@subsubheading Synopsis 26571 26572@smallexample 26573 -exec-return 26574@end smallexample 26575 26576Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior. 26577Displays the new current frame. 26578 26579@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26580 26581The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}. 26582 26583@subsubheading Example 26584 26585@smallexample 26586(gdb) 26587200-break-insert callee4 26588200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734", 26589file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 26590(gdb) 26591000-exec-run 26592000^running 26593(gdb) 26594000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 26595frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 26596file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26597fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 26598(gdb) 26599205-break-delete 26600205^done 26601(gdb) 26602111-exec-return 26603111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3", 26604args=[@{name="strarg", 26605value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 26606file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26607fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 26608(gdb) 26609@end smallexample 26610 26611 26612@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command 26613@findex -exec-run 26614 26615@subsubheading Synopsis 26616 26617@smallexample 26618 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N] 26619@end smallexample 26620 26621Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior 26622executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program 26623exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if 26624the program has exited exceptionally. 26625 26626When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the 26627@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread 26628group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started. 26629If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started. 26630 26631@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26632 26633The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}. 26634 26635@subsubheading Examples 26636 26637@smallexample 26638(gdb) 26639-break-insert main 26640^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@} 26641(gdb) 26642-exec-run 26643^running 26644(gdb) 26645*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 26646frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 26647fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@} 26648(gdb) 26649@end smallexample 26650 26651@noindent 26652Program exited normally: 26653 26654@smallexample 26655(gdb) 26656-exec-run 26657^running 26658(gdb) 26659x = 55 26660*stopped,reason="exited-normally" 26661(gdb) 26662@end smallexample 26663 26664@noindent 26665Program exited exceptionally: 26666 26667@smallexample 26668(gdb) 26669-exec-run 26670^running 26671(gdb) 26672x = 55 26673*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01" 26674(gdb) 26675@end smallexample 26676 26677Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as 26678@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this: 26679 26680@smallexample 26681(gdb) 26682*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT", 26683signal-meaning="Interrupt" 26684@end smallexample 26685 26686 26687@c @subheading -exec-signal 26688 26689 26690@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command 26691@findex -exec-step 26692 26693@subsubheading Synopsis 26694 26695@smallexample 26696 -exec-step [--reverse] 26697@end smallexample 26698 26699Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 26700of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a 26701function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called 26702function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse 26703execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the 26704previously executed source line. 26705 26706@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26707 26708The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}. 26709 26710@subsubheading Example 26711 26712Stepping into a function: 26713 26714@smallexample 26715-exec-step 26716^running 26717(gdb) 26718*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 26719frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@}, 26720@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c", 26721fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@} 26722(gdb) 26723@end smallexample 26724 26725Regular stepping: 26726 26727@smallexample 26728-exec-step 26729^running 26730(gdb) 26731*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c" 26732(gdb) 26733@end smallexample 26734 26735 26736@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command 26737@findex -exec-step-instruction 26738 26739@subsubheading Synopsis 26740 26741@smallexample 26742 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse] 26743@end smallexample 26744 26745Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the 26746@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the 26747inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction. 26748The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on 26749whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the 26750former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed 26751as well. 26752 26753@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26754 26755The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}. 26756 26757@subsubheading Example 26758 26759@smallexample 26760(gdb) 26761-exec-step-instruction 26762^running 26763 26764(gdb) 26765*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 26766frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 26767fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 26768(gdb) 26769-exec-step-instruction 26770^running 26771 26772(gdb) 26773*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 26774frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 26775fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 26776(gdb) 26777@end smallexample 26778 26779 26780@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command 26781@findex -exec-until 26782 26783@subsubheading Synopsis 26784 26785@smallexample 26786 -exec-until [ @var{location} ] 26787@end smallexample 26788 26789Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the 26790argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes 26791until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The 26792reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}. 26793 26794@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26795 26796The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}. 26797 26798@subsubheading Example 26799 26800@smallexample 26801(gdb) 26802-exec-until recursive2.c:6 26803^running 26804(gdb) 26805x = 55 26806*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 26807file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@} 26808(gdb) 26809@end smallexample 26810 26811@ignore 26812@subheading -file-clear 26813Is this going away???? 26814@end ignore 26815 26816@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26817@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation 26818@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands 26819 26820 26821@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command 26822@findex -stack-info-frame 26823 26824@subsubheading Synopsis 26825 26826@smallexample 26827 -stack-info-frame 26828@end smallexample 26829 26830Get info on the selected frame. 26831 26832@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26833 26834The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame} 26835(without arguments). 26836 26837@subsubheading Example 26838 26839@smallexample 26840(gdb) 26841-stack-info-frame 26842^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 26843file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26844fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@} 26845(gdb) 26846@end smallexample 26847 26848@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command 26849@findex -stack-info-depth 26850 26851@subsubheading Synopsis 26852 26853@smallexample 26854 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ] 26855@end smallexample 26856 26857Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth} 26858is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames. 26859 26860@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26861 26862There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 26863 26864@subsubheading Example 26865 26866For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11: 26867 26868@smallexample 26869(gdb) 26870-stack-info-depth 26871^done,depth="12" 26872(gdb) 26873-stack-info-depth 4 26874^done,depth="4" 26875(gdb) 26876-stack-info-depth 12 26877^done,depth="12" 26878(gdb) 26879-stack-info-depth 11 26880^done,depth="11" 26881(gdb) 26882-stack-info-depth 13 26883^done,depth="12" 26884(gdb) 26885@end smallexample 26886 26887@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command 26888@findex -stack-list-arguments 26889 26890@subsubheading Synopsis 26891 26892@smallexample 26893 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values} 26894 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 26895@end smallexample 26896 26897Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame} 26898and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and 26899@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole 26900call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame 26901at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is 26902larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand, 26903@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in 26904which case only existing frames will be returned. 26905 26906If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 26907the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 26908values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 26909type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 26910structures and unions. 26911 26912Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is 26913deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 26914 26915@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26916 26917@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a 26918@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the 26919functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}. 26920 26921@subsubheading Example 26922 26923@smallexample 26924(gdb) 26925-stack-list-frames 26926^done, 26927stack=[ 26928frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 26929file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26930fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}, 26931frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 26932file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26933fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}, 26934frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2", 26935file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26936fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@}, 26937frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1", 26938file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26939fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@}, 26940frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main", 26941file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 26942fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}] 26943(gdb) 26944-stack-list-arguments 0 26945^done, 26946stack-args=[ 26947frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 26948frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@}, 26949frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}, 26950frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@}, 26951frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 26952(gdb) 26953-stack-list-arguments 1 26954^done, 26955stack-args=[ 26956frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 26957frame=@{level="1", 26958 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 26959frame=@{level="2",args=[ 26960@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 26961@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 26962@{frame=@{level="3",args=[ 26963@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 26964@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}, 26965@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@}, 26966frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 26967(gdb) 26968-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2 26969^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}] 26970(gdb) 26971-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2 26972^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2", 26973args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 26974@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}] 26975(gdb) 26976@end smallexample 26977 26978@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers 26979 26980 26981@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command 26982@findex -stack-list-frames 26983 26984@subsubheading Synopsis 26985 26986@smallexample 26987 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 26988@end smallexample 26989 26990List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the 26991following info: 26992 26993@table @samp 26994@item @var{level} 26995The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function. 26996@item @var{addr} 26997The @code{$pc} value for that frame. 26998@item @var{func} 26999Function name. 27000@item @var{file} 27001File name of the source file where the function lives. 27002@item @var{fullname} 27003The full file name of the source file where the function lives. 27004@item @var{line} 27005Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}. 27006@item @var{from} 27007The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given 27008if the frame's function is not known. 27009@end table 27010 27011If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the 27012whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose 27013levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments 27014are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is 27015an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of 27016frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the 27017actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned. 27018 27019@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27020 27021The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}. 27022 27023@subsubheading Example 27024 27025Full stack backtrace: 27026 27027@smallexample 27028(gdb) 27029-stack-list-frames 27030^done,stack= 27031[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo", 27032 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}, 27033frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27034 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27035frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27036 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27037frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27038 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27039frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27040 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27041frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27042 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27043frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27044 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27045frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27046 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27047frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27048 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27049frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27050 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27051frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27052 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27053frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main", 27054 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}] 27055(gdb) 27056@end smallexample 27057 27058Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}: 27059 27060@smallexample 27061(gdb) 27062-stack-list-frames 3 5 27063^done,stack= 27064[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27066frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 27068frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27069 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 27070(gdb) 27071@end smallexample 27072 27073Show a single frame: 27074 27075@smallexample 27076(gdb) 27077-stack-list-frames 3 3 27078^done,stack= 27079[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 27080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 27081(gdb) 27082@end smallexample 27083 27084 27085@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command 27086@findex -stack-list-locals 27087 27088@subsubheading Synopsis 27089 27090@smallexample 27091 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values} 27092@end smallexample 27093 27094Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If 27095@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 27096the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 27097values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 27098type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 27099structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately 27100display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for 27101other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in 27102more detail. 27103 27104This command is deprecated in favor of the 27105@samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 27106 27107@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27108 27109@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}. 27110 27111@subsubheading Example 27112 27113@smallexample 27114(gdb) 27115-stack-list-locals 0 27116^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"] 27117(gdb) 27118-stack-list-locals --all-values 27119^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@}, 27120 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}] 27121-stack-list-locals --simple-values 27122^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@}, 27123 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}] 27124(gdb) 27125@end smallexample 27126 27127@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command 27128@findex -stack-list-variables 27129 27130@subsubheading Synopsis 27131 27132@smallexample 27133 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values} 27134@end smallexample 27135 27136Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If 27137@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 27138the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 27139values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 27140type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 27141structures and unions. 27142 27143@subsubheading Example 27144 27145@smallexample 27146(gdb) 27147-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values 27148^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}] 27149(gdb) 27150@end smallexample 27151 27152 27153@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command 27154@findex -stack-select-frame 27155 27156@subsubheading Synopsis 27157 27158@smallexample 27159 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum} 27160@end smallexample 27161 27162Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on 27163the stack. 27164 27165This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame} 27166option to every command. 27167 27168@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27169 27170The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up}, 27171@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}. 27172 27173@subsubheading Example 27174 27175@smallexample 27176(gdb) 27177-stack-select-frame 2 27178^done 27179(gdb) 27180@end smallexample 27181 27182@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27183@node GDB/MI Variable Objects 27184@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects 27185 27186@ignore 27187 27188@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 27189 27190For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched 27191expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code 27192used by @code{Insight}. 27193 27194The two main reasons for that are: 27195 27196@enumerate 1 27197@item 27198It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation). 27199 27200@item 27201It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is 27202now). 27203@end enumerate 27204 27205The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was 27206slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section 27207describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some 27208hints about their use. 27209 27210@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we 27211expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at 27212least, the following operations: 27213 27214@itemize @bullet 27215@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix} 27216@item @code{-stack-list-arguments} 27217@item @code{-stack-list-locals} 27218@item @code{-stack-select-frame} 27219@end itemize 27220 27221@end ignore 27222 27223@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects 27224 27225@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 27226 27227Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and 27228changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that 27229work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for 27230simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object 27231is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the 27232frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The 27233expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex 27234expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a 27235variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object 27236operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable 27237object, or to change display format. 27238 27239Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object 27240that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has 27241a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each 27242element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have 27243children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach 27244leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable 27245objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend 27246is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no 27247child will be created. 27248 27249For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a 27250string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also 27251obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string 27252that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its 27253contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed. 27254 27255A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time 27256the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all 27257variable objects whose values has changed since the last update 27258operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must 27259be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable 27260objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a 27261real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf 27262variables that frontend has created. 27263 27264The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend 27265might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference, 27266and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is 27267relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want 27268to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not 27269visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so 27270called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never 27271implicitly updated. 27272 27273Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the 27274fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable 27275object is created, including associating identifiers to specific 27276variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating 27277variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the 27278expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current 27279frame. Consider this example: 27280 27281@smallexample 27282void do_work(...) 27283@{ 27284 struct work_state state; 27285 27286 if (...) 27287 do_work(...); 27288@} 27289@end smallexample 27290 27291If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in 27292this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable 27293object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level 27294@code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable 27295object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame. 27296 27297If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object 27298refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the 27299thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such 27300variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the 27301thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists, 27302and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame. 27303 27304The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to 27305access this functionality: 27306 27307@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6 27308@item @strong{Operation} 27309@tab @strong{Description} 27310 27311@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing} 27312@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing 27313@item @code{-var-create} 27314@tab create a variable object 27315@item @code{-var-delete} 27316@tab delete the variable object and/or its children 27317@item @code{-var-set-format} 27318@tab set the display format of this variable 27319@item @code{-var-show-format} 27320@tab show the display format of this variable 27321@item @code{-var-info-num-children} 27322@tab tells how many children this object has 27323@item @code{-var-list-children} 27324@tab return a list of the object's children 27325@item @code{-var-info-type} 27326@tab show the type of this variable object 27327@item @code{-var-info-expression} 27328@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents 27329@item @code{-var-info-path-expression} 27330@tab print full expression that this variable object represents 27331@item @code{-var-show-attributes} 27332@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here? 27333@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression} 27334@tab get the value of this variable 27335@item @code{-var-assign} 27336@tab set the value of this variable 27337@item @code{-var-update} 27338@tab update the variable and its children 27339@item @code{-var-set-frozen} 27340@tab set frozeness attribute 27341@item @code{-var-set-update-range} 27342@tab set range of children to display on update 27343@end multitable 27344 27345In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest 27346how it can be used. 27347 27348@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects 27349 27350@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command 27351@findex -enable-pretty-printing 27352 27353@smallexample 27354-enable-pretty-printing 27355@end smallexample 27356 27357@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the 27358MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to 27359implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must 27360request that this functionality be enabled. 27361 27362Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled. 27363 27364Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN}, 27365this command will still succeed (and do nothing). 27366 27367This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and 27368may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}. 27369 27370@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command 27371@findex -var-create 27372 27373@subsubheading Synopsis 27374 27375@smallexample 27376 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@} 27377 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression} 27378@end smallexample 27379 27380This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of 27381a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU 27382register. 27383 27384The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be 27385referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj 27386system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be 27387unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format. 27388The command fails if a duplicate name is found. 27389 27390The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be 27391specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current 27392frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable 27393object must be created. 27394 27395@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not 27396begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following: 27397 27398@itemize @bullet 27399@item 27400@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell 27401 27402@item 27403@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD) 27404 27405@item 27406@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name 27407@end itemize 27408 27409@cindex dynamic varobj 27410A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this 27411case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs 27412have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the 27413@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN} 27414will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward 27415compatibility for existing clients. 27416 27417@subsubheading Result 27418 27419This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These 27420are: 27421 27422@table @samp 27423@item name 27424The name of the varobj. 27425 27426@item numchild 27427The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily 27428reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the 27429@samp{has_more} attribute. 27430 27431@item value 27432The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of 27433aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value 27434will not be interesting. 27435 27436@item type 27437The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as 27438would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. 27439 27440@item thread-id 27441If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the 27442thread's identifier. 27443 27444@item has_more 27445For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any 27446children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0. 27447 27448@item dynamic 27449This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 27450varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 27451then this attribute will not be present. 27452 27453@item displayhint 27454A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 27455value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 27456@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 27457@end table 27458 27459Typical output will look like this: 27460 27461@smallexample 27462 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}", 27463 has_more="@var{has_more}" 27464@end smallexample 27465 27466 27467@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command 27468@findex -var-delete 27469 27470@subsubheading Synopsis 27471 27472@smallexample 27473 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name} 27474@end smallexample 27475 27476Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children. 27477With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children. 27478 27479Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found. 27480 27481 27482@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command 27483@findex -var-set-format 27484 27485@subsubheading Synopsis 27486 27487@smallexample 27488 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec} 27489@end smallexample 27490 27491Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be 27492@var{format-spec}. 27493 27494@anchor{-var-set-format} 27495The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows: 27496 27497@smallexample 27498 @var{format-spec} @expansion{} 27499 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@} 27500@end smallexample 27501 27502The natural format is the default format choosen automatically 27503based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex 27504for pointers, etc.). 27505 27506For a variable with children, the format is set only on the 27507variable itself, and the children are not affected. 27508 27509@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command 27510@findex -var-show-format 27511 27512@subsubheading Synopsis 27513 27514@smallexample 27515 -var-show-format @var{name} 27516@end smallexample 27517 27518Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}. 27519 27520@smallexample 27521 @var{format} @expansion{} 27522 @var{format-spec} 27523@end smallexample 27524 27525 27526@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command 27527@findex -var-info-num-children 27528 27529@subsubheading Synopsis 27530 27531@smallexample 27532 -var-info-num-children @var{name} 27533@end smallexample 27534 27535Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}: 27536 27537@smallexample 27538 numchild=@var{n} 27539@end smallexample 27540 27541Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj. 27542It will return the current number of children, but more children may 27543be available. 27544 27545 27546@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command 27547@findex -var-list-children 27548 27549@subsubheading Synopsis 27550 27551@smallexample 27552 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}] 27553@end smallexample 27554@anchor{-var-list-children} 27555 27556Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and 27557create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With 27558a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or 27559@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if 27560@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their 27561values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and 27562value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures 27563and unions. 27564 27565@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children 27566to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is 27567reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting 27568at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be 27569reported. 27570 27571If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to 27572@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}. 27573For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The 27574intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any 27575update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the 27576front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and 27577then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a 27578different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just 27579the visible items. 27580 27581For each child the following results are returned: 27582 27583@table @var 27584 27585@item name 27586Name of the variable object created for this child. 27587 27588@item exp 27589The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child. 27590For example this may be the name of a structure member. 27591 27592For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an 27593expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj. 27594 27595For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to 27596designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is 27597@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the 27598type and value are not present. 27599 27600A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying 27601pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not 27602available at all with a dynamic varobj. 27603 27604@item numchild 27605Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be 276060. 27607 27608@item type 27609The type of the child. 27610 27611@item value 27612If values were requested, this is the value. 27613 27614@item thread-id 27615If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id. 27616Otherwise this result is not present. 27617 27618@item frozen 27619If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1. 27620@end table 27621 27622The result may have its own attributes: 27623 27624@table @samp 27625@item displayhint 27626A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 27627value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 27628@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 27629 27630@item has_more 27631This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children 27632remaining after the end of the selected range. 27633@end table 27634 27635@subsubheading Example 27636 27637@smallexample 27638(gdb) 27639 -var-list-children n 27640 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 27641 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 27642(gdb) 27643 -var-list-children --all-values n 27644 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 27645 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 27646@end smallexample 27647 27648 27649@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command 27650@findex -var-info-type 27651 27652@subsubheading Synopsis 27653 27654@smallexample 27655 -var-info-type @var{name} 27656@end smallexample 27657 27658Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is 27659returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the 27660@value{GDBN} CLI: 27661 27662@smallexample 27663 type=@var{typename} 27664@end smallexample 27665 27666 27667@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command 27668@findex -var-info-expression 27669 27670@subsubheading Synopsis 27671 27672@smallexample 27673 -var-info-expression @var{name} 27674@end smallexample 27675 27676Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this 27677variable object in user interface. The string is generally 27678not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated. 27679 27680For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object 27681@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output: 27682 27683@smallexample 27684(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1 27685^done,lang="C",exp="1" 27686@end smallexample 27687 27688@noindent 27689Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}. 27690 27691Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also 27692includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command 27693is of limited use. 27694 27695@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command 27696@findex -var-info-path-expression 27697 27698@subsubheading Synopsis 27699 27700@smallexample 27701 -var-info-path-expression @var{name} 27702@end smallexample 27703 27704Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current 27705context and will yield the same value that a variable object has. 27706Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which 27707result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of 27708the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a 27709watchpoint from a variable object. 27710 27711This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj, 27712and will give an error when invoked on one. 27713 27714For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class 27715@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called 27716@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of 27717@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable 27718@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output: 27719@smallexample 27720(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size 27721^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size) 27722@end smallexample 27723 27724@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command 27725@findex -var-show-attributes 27726 27727@subsubheading Synopsis 27728 27729@smallexample 27730 -var-show-attributes @var{name} 27731@end smallexample 27732 27733List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}: 27734 27735@smallexample 27736 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ] 27737@end smallexample 27738 27739@noindent 27740where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}. 27741 27742@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command 27743@findex -var-evaluate-expression 27744 27745@subsubheading Synopsis 27746 27747@smallexample 27748 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name} 27749@end smallexample 27750 27751Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable 27752object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string 27753can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of 27754this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format} 27755(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified, 27756the current display format will be used. The current display format 27757can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command. 27758 27759@smallexample 27760 value=@var{value} 27761@end smallexample 27762 27763Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable 27764before the value of a child variable can be evaluated. 27765 27766@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command 27767@findex -var-assign 27768 27769@subsubheading Synopsis 27770 27771@smallexample 27772 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression} 27773@end smallexample 27774 27775Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified 27776by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's 27777value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any 27778subsequent @code{-var-update} list. 27779 27780@subsubheading Example 27781 27782@smallexample 27783(gdb) 27784-var-assign var1 3 27785^done,value="3" 27786(gdb) 27787-var-update * 27788^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}] 27789(gdb) 27790@end smallexample 27791 27792@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command 27793@findex -var-update 27794 27795@subsubheading Synopsis 27796 27797@smallexample 27798 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@} 27799@end smallexample 27800 27801Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object 27802@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the 27803list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must 27804be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of 27805@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the 27806@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable 27807object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except 27808for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option 27809@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just 27810names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same 27811as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is 27812recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the 27813number of MI commands needed on each program stop. 27814 27815With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a 27816currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any 27817diagnostic. 27818 27819If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then 27820only the selected range of children will be reported. 27821 27822@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named 27823@samp{changelist}. 27824 27825Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding: 27826 27827@table @samp 27828@item name 27829The name of the varobj. 27830 27831@item value 27832If values were requested for this update, then this field will be 27833present and will hold the value of the varobj. 27834 27835@item in_scope 27836@anchor{-var-update} 27837This field is a string which may take one of three values: 27838 27839@table @code 27840@item "true" 27841The variable object's current value is valid. 27842 27843@item "false" 27844The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may 27845hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into 27846scope. 27847 27848@item "invalid" 27849The variable object no longer holds a valid value. 27850This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed, 27851either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file} 27852command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable 27853objects. 27854@end table 27855 27856In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should 27857be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}. 27858 27859@item type_changed 27860This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type 27861changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will 27862be @samp{false}. 27863 27864@item new_type 27865If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will 27866hold the new type. 27867 27868@item new_num_children 27869For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the 27870type changed, this will be the new number of children. 27871 27872The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not 27873valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that 27874@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily 27875instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of 27876children which may be available. 27877 27878The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the 27879number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to 27880detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can 27881only happen at the end of the update range). 27882 27883@item displayhint 27884The display hint, if any. 27885 27886@item has_more 27887This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children 27888available outside the varobj's update range. 27889 27890@item dynamic 27891This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 27892varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 27893then this attribute will not be present. 27894 27895@item new_children 27896If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected 27897update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will 27898be listed in this attribute. 27899@end table 27900 27901@subsubheading Example 27902 27903@smallexample 27904(gdb) 27905-var-assign var1 3 27906^done,value="3" 27907(gdb) 27908-var-update --all-values var1 27909^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true", 27910type_changed="false"@}] 27911(gdb) 27912@end smallexample 27913 27914@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command 27915@findex -var-set-frozen 27916@anchor{-var-set-frozen} 27917 27918@subsubheading Synopsis 27919 27920@smallexample 27921 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag} 27922@end smallexample 27923 27924Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The 27925@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable 27926frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is 27927frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are 27928implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of 27929a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only 27930@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and 27931values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is 27932implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations. 27933Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent 27934@code{-var-update} does. 27935 27936@subsubheading Example 27937 27938@smallexample 27939(gdb) 27940-var-set-frozen V 1 27941^done 27942(gdb) 27943@end smallexample 27944 27945@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command 27946@findex -var-set-update-range 27947@anchor{-var-set-update-range} 27948 27949@subsubheading Synopsis 27950 27951@smallexample 27952 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to} 27953@end smallexample 27954 27955Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of 27956@code{-var-update}. 27957 27958@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If 27959@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all 27960children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from} 27961(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported. 27962 27963@subsubheading Example 27964 27965@smallexample 27966(gdb) 27967-var-set-update-range V 1 2 27968^done 27969@end smallexample 27970 27971@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command 27972@findex -var-set-visualizer 27973@anchor{-var-set-visualizer} 27974 27975@subsubheading Synopsis 27976 27977@smallexample 27978 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer} 27979@end smallexample 27980 27981Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}. 27982 27983@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value 27984@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use. 27985 27986If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression. 27987This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a 27988single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of 27989the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same 27990Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI). 27991When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the 27992pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). 27993 27994The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to 27995select a visualizer by following the built-in process 27996(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when 27997a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed. 27998 27999This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI 28000command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands}) 28001can be used to check this. 28002 28003@subsubheading Example 28004 28005Resetting the visualizer: 28006 28007@smallexample 28008(gdb) 28009-var-set-visualizer V None 28010^done 28011@end smallexample 28012 28013Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer: 28014 28015@smallexample 28016(gdb) 28017-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer 28018^done 28019@end smallexample 28020 28021Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression 28022can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj: 28023 28024@smallexample 28025(gdb) 28026-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()" 28027^done 28028@end smallexample 28029 28030@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28031@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation 28032@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation 28033 28034@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi} 28035@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation 28036This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data: 28037examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc. 28038 28039@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE. 28040@c @subheading -data-assign 28041@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects. 28042@c @subsubheading GDB Command 28043@c set variable 28044@c @subsubheading Example 28045@c N.A. 28046 28047@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command 28048@findex -data-disassemble 28049 28050@subsubheading Synopsis 28051 28052@smallexample 28053 -data-disassemble 28054 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ] 28055 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ] 28056 -- @var{mode} 28057@end smallexample 28058 28059@noindent 28060Where: 28061 28062@table @samp 28063@item @var{start-addr} 28064is the beginning address (or @code{$pc}) 28065@item @var{end-addr} 28066is the end address 28067@item @var{filename} 28068is the name of the file to disassemble 28069@item @var{linenum} 28070is the line number to disassemble around 28071@item @var{lines} 28072is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1, 28073the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is 28074specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and 28075@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between 28076@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are 28077displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between 28078@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr} 28079are displayed. 28080@item @var{mode} 28081is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and 28082disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning 28083mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes). 28084@end table 28085 28086@subsubheading Result 28087 28088The output for each instruction is composed of four fields: 28089 28090@itemize @bullet 28091@item Address 28092@item Func-name 28093@item Offset 28094@item Instruction 28095@end itemize 28096 28097Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated 28098directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format. 28099 28100@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28101 28102There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI. 28103 28104@subsubheading Example 28105 28106Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}: 28107 28108@smallexample 28109(gdb) 28110-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0 28111^done, 28112asm_insns=[ 28113@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 28114inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 28115@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 28116inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 28117@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12", 28118inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@}, 28119@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16", 28120inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 28121@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20", 28122inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}] 28123(gdb) 28124@end smallexample 28125 28126Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of 28127@code{main}. 28128 28129@smallexample 28130-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0 28131^done,asm_insns=[ 28132@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 28133inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 28134@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 28135inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 28136@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 28137inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 28138[@dots{}] 28139@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@}, 28140@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}] 28141(gdb) 28142@end smallexample 28143 28144Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}: 28145 28146@smallexample 28147(gdb) 28148-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0 28149^done,asm_insns=[ 28150@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 28151inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 28152@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 28153inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 28154@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 28155inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}] 28156(gdb) 28157@end smallexample 28158 28159Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode: 28160 28161@smallexample 28162(gdb) 28163-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1 28164^done,asm_insns=[ 28165src_and_asm_line=@{line="31", 28166file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \ 28167 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[ 28168@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 28169inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@}, 28170src_and_asm_line=@{line="32", 28171file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \ 28172 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[ 28173@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 28174inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 28175@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 28176inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}] 28177(gdb) 28178@end smallexample 28179 28180 28181@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command 28182@findex -data-evaluate-expression 28183 28184@subsubheading Synopsis 28185 28186@smallexample 28187 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr} 28188@end smallexample 28189 28190Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an 28191inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously. 28192If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes. 28193 28194@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28195 28196The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and 28197@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding 28198@samp{gdb_eval} command. 28199 28200@subsubheading Example 28201 28202In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the 28203@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi} 28204Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its 28205output. 28206 28207@smallexample 28208211-data-evaluate-expression A 28209211^done,value="1" 28210(gdb) 28211311-data-evaluate-expression &A 28212311^done,value="0xefffeb7c" 28213(gdb) 28214411-data-evaluate-expression A+3 28215411^done,value="4" 28216(gdb) 28217511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3" 28218511^done,value="4" 28219(gdb) 28220@end smallexample 28221 28222 28223@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command 28224@findex -data-list-changed-registers 28225 28226@subsubheading Synopsis 28227 28228@smallexample 28229 -data-list-changed-registers 28230@end smallexample 28231 28232Display a list of the registers that have changed. 28233 28234@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28235 28236@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk} 28237has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}. 28238 28239@subsubheading Example 28240 28241On a PPC MBX board: 28242 28243@smallexample 28244(gdb) 28245-exec-continue 28246^running 28247 28248(gdb) 28249*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{ 28250func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c", 28251line="5"@} 28252(gdb) 28253-data-list-changed-registers 28254^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9", 28255"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23", 28256"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"] 28257(gdb) 28258@end smallexample 28259 28260 28261@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command 28262@findex -data-list-register-names 28263 28264@subsubheading Synopsis 28265 28266@smallexample 28267 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ] 28268@end smallexample 28269 28270Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments 28271are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If 28272integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the 28273names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure 28274consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may 28275include empty register names. 28276 28277@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28278 28279@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to 28280@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a 28281corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}. 28282 28283@subsubheading Example 28284 28285For the PPC MBX board: 28286@smallexample 28287(gdb) 28288-data-list-register-names 28289^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7", 28290"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18", 28291"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29", 28292"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9", 28293"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20", 28294"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31", 28295"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"] 28296(gdb) 28297-data-list-register-names 1 2 3 28298^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"] 28299(gdb) 28300@end smallexample 28301 28302@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command 28303@findex -data-list-register-values 28304 28305@subsubheading Synopsis 28306 28307@smallexample 28308 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*] 28309@end smallexample 28310 28311Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to 28312which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional 28313list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of 28314numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned. 28315 28316Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are: 28317 28318@table @code 28319@item x 28320Hexadecimal 28321@item o 28322Octal 28323@item t 28324Binary 28325@item d 28326Decimal 28327@item r 28328Raw 28329@item N 28330Natural 28331@end table 28332 28333@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28334 28335The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info 28336all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}. 28337 28338@subsubheading Example 28339 28340For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they 28341don't appear in the actual output): 28342 28343@smallexample 28344(gdb) 28345-data-list-register-values r 64 65 28346^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 28347@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}] 28348(gdb) 28349-data-list-register-values x 28350^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@}, 28351@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 28352@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@}, 28353@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@}, 28354@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@}, 28355@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@}, 28356@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@}, 28357@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@}, 28358@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@}, 28359@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 28360@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@}, 28361@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@}, 28362@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@}, 28363@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@}, 28364@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@}, 28365@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@}, 28366@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@}, 28367@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@}, 28368@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@}, 28369@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@}, 28370@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@}, 28371@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@}, 28372@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@}, 28373@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@}, 28374@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@}, 28375@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@}, 28376@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@}, 28377@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@}, 28378@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@}, 28379@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@}, 28380@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@}, 28381@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@}, 28382@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 28383@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@}, 28384@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@}, 28385@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}] 28386(gdb) 28387@end smallexample 28388 28389 28390@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command 28391@findex -data-read-memory 28392 28393This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead. 28394 28395@subsubheading Synopsis 28396 28397@smallexample 28398 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ] 28399 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size} 28400 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ] 28401@end smallexample 28402 28403@noindent 28404where: 28405 28406@table @samp 28407@item @var{address} 28408An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be 28409read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 28410quoted using the C convention. 28411 28412@item @var{word-format} 28413The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the 28414same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats, 28415,Output Formats}). 28416 28417@item @var{word-size} 28418The size of each memory word in bytes. 28419 28420@item @var{nr-rows} 28421The number of rows in the output table. 28422 28423@item @var{nr-cols} 28424The number of columns in the output table. 28425 28426@item @var{aschar} 28427If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The 28428value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a 28429member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii} 28430characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively). 28431 28432@item @var{byte-offset} 28433An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory. 28434@end table 28435 28436This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by 28437@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total, 28438@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read 28439(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number 28440of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified 28441using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned 28442in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in 28443@samp{addr}. 28444 28445The address of the next/previous row or page is available in 28446@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and 28447@samp{prev-page}. 28448 28449@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28450 28451The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has 28452@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command. 28453 28454@subsubheading Example 28455 28456Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by 28457@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per 28458word. Display each word in hex. 28459 28460@smallexample 28461(gdb) 284629-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2 284639^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6", 28464next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396", 28465prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[ 28466@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@}, 28467@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@}, 28468@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}] 28469(gdb) 28470@end smallexample 28471 28472Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and 28473display as a single word formatted in decimal. 28474 28475@smallexample 28476(gdb) 284775-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1 284785^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2", 28479next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e", 28480next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[ 28481@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}] 28482(gdb) 28483@end smallexample 28484 28485Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format 28486as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x} 28487used as the non-printable character. 28488 28489@smallexample 28490(gdb) 284914-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x 284924^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32", 28493next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c", 28494next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[ 28495@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 28496@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 28497@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 28498@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 28499@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@}, 28500@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@}, 28501@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@}, 28502@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}] 28503(gdb) 28504@end smallexample 28505 28506@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command 28507@findex -data-read-memory-bytes 28508 28509@subsubheading Synopsis 28510 28511@smallexample 28512 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ] 28513 @var{address} @var{count} 28514@end smallexample 28515 28516@noindent 28517where: 28518 28519@table @samp 28520@item @var{address} 28521An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be 28522read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 28523quoted using the C convention. 28524 28525@item @var{count} 28526The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal. 28527 28528@item @var{byte-offset} 28529The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start 28530reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided 28531so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then 28532perform address arithmetics itself. 28533 28534@end table 28535 28536This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the 28537specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory 28538map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region 28539Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining 28540regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors, 28541@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region. 28542 28543In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not, 28544and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at 28545every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will 28546attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end 28547of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works 28548well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region 28549has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end, 28550@value{GDBN} will not read it. 28551 28552The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of 28553the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a 28554list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block 28555and has the following fields: 28556 28557@table @code 28558@item begin 28559The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 28560 28561@item end 28562The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 28563 28564@item offset 28565The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to 28566the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}. 28567 28568@item contents 28569The contents of the memory block, in hex. 28570 28571@end table 28572 28573 28574 28575@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28576 28577The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. 28578 28579@subsubheading Example 28580 28581@smallexample 28582(gdb) 28583-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10 28584^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000", 28585 end="0xbffff15e", 28586 contents="01000000020000000300"@}] 28587(gdb) 28588@end smallexample 28589 28590 28591@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command 28592@findex -data-write-memory-bytes 28593 28594@subsubheading Synopsis 28595 28596@smallexample 28597 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} 28598@end smallexample 28599 28600@noindent 28601where: 28602 28603@table @samp 28604@item @var{address} 28605An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be 28606read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 28607quoted using the C convention. 28608 28609@item @var{contents} 28610The hex-encoded bytes to write. 28611 28612@end table 28613 28614@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28615 28616There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 28617 28618@subsubheading Example 28619 28620@smallexample 28621(gdb) 28622-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 28623^done 28624(gdb) 28625@end smallexample 28626 28627 28628@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28629@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands 28630@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands 28631 28632The commands defined in this section implement MI support for 28633tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}. 28634 28635@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command 28636@findex -trace-find 28637 28638@subsubheading Synopsis 28639 28640@smallexample 28641 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}] 28642@end smallexample 28643 28644Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and 28645@var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible 28646modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}. 28647 28648@table @samp 28649 28650@item none 28651No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames. 28652 28653@item frame-number 28654An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with 28655that index. 28656 28657@item tracepoint-number 28658An integer is required as parameter. Finds next 28659trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number. 28660 28661@item pc 28662An address is required as parameter. Finds 28663next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified 28664address. 28665 28666@item pc-inside-range 28667Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace 28668frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the 28669specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 28670 28671@item pc-outside-range 28672Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds 28673next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside 28674the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 28675 28676@item line 28677Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}. 28678Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at 28679the specified location. 28680 28681@end table 28682 28683If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not 28684have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields: 28685 28686@table @samp 28687@item found 28688This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending 28689on whether a matching tracepoint was found. 28690 28691@item traceframe 28692The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff 28693the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 28694 28695@item tracepoint 28696The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff 28697the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 28698 28699@item frame 28700The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace 28701frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found. 28702@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field. 28703 28704@end table 28705 28706@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28707 28708The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}. 28709 28710@subheading -trace-define-variable 28711@findex -trace-define-variable 28712 28713@subsubheading Synopsis 28714 28715@smallexample 28716 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ] 28717@end smallexample 28718 28719Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If 28720@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified 28721trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start 28722with the @samp{$} character. 28723 28724@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28725 28726The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}. 28727 28728@subheading -trace-list-variables 28729@findex -trace-list-variables 28730 28731@subsubheading Synopsis 28732 28733@smallexample 28734 -trace-list-variables 28735@end smallexample 28736 28737Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the 28738table has the following fields: 28739 28740@table @samp 28741@item name 28742The name of the trace variable. This field is always present. 28743 28744@item initial 28745The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This 28746field is always present. 28747 28748@item current 28749The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit 28750signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is 28751not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is 28752presently running. 28753 28754@end table 28755 28756@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28757 28758The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}. 28759 28760@subsubheading Example 28761 28762@smallexample 28763(gdb) 28764-trace-list-variables 28765^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3", 28766hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}, 28767 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@}, 28768 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}], 28769body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@} 28770 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@} 28771(gdb) 28772@end smallexample 28773 28774@subheading -trace-save 28775@findex -trace-save 28776 28777@subsubheading Synopsis 28778 28779@smallexample 28780 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename} 28781@end smallexample 28782 28783Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the 28784@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved 28785in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked 28786to perform the save. 28787 28788@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28789 28790The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}. 28791 28792 28793@subheading -trace-start 28794@findex -trace-start 28795 28796@subsubheading Synopsis 28797 28798@smallexample 28799 -trace-start 28800@end smallexample 28801 28802Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not 28803have any fields. 28804 28805@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28806 28807The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}. 28808 28809@subheading -trace-status 28810@findex -trace-status 28811 28812@subsubheading Synopsis 28813 28814@smallexample 28815 -trace-status 28816@end smallexample 28817 28818Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include 28819the following fields: 28820 28821@table @samp 28822 28823@item supported 28824May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are 28825supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or 28826@samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining 28827of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be 28828started. This field is always present. 28829 28830@item running 28831May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether 28832tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present 28833if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 28834 28835@item stop-reason 28836Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field 28837may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The 28838value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of 28839the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means 28840the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means 28841tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected. 28842The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a 28843tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint. 28844This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 28845 28846@item stopping-tracepoint 28847The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is 28848present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of 28849@samp{passcount}. 28850 28851@item frames 28852@itemx frames-created 28853The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames 28854in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created 28855during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a 28856circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional. 28857 28858@item buffer-size 28859@itemx buffer-free 28860These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the 28861remaining space. These fields are optional. 28862 28863@item circular 28864The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 28865trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 28866necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 28867and may fill up. 28868 28869@item disconnected 28870The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 28871tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 28872that the trace run will stop. 28873 28874@end table 28875 28876@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28877 28878The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}. 28879 28880@subheading -trace-stop 28881@findex -trace-stop 28882 28883@subsubheading Synopsis 28884 28885@smallexample 28886 -trace-stop 28887@end smallexample 28888 28889Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same 28890fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and 28891@samp{running} fields are not output. 28892 28893@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28894 28895The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}. 28896 28897 28898@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28899@node GDB/MI Symbol Query 28900@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands 28901 28902 28903@ignore 28904@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command 28905@findex -symbol-info-address 28906 28907@subsubheading Synopsis 28908 28909@smallexample 28910 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol} 28911@end smallexample 28912 28913Describe where @var{symbol} is stored. 28914 28915@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28916 28917The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}. 28918 28919@subsubheading Example 28920N.A. 28921 28922 28923@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command 28924@findex -symbol-info-file 28925 28926@subsubheading Synopsis 28927 28928@smallexample 28929 -symbol-info-file 28930@end smallexample 28931 28932Show the file for the symbol. 28933 28934@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28935 28936There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has 28937@samp{gdb_find_file}. 28938 28939@subsubheading Example 28940N.A. 28941 28942 28943@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command 28944@findex -symbol-info-function 28945 28946@subsubheading Synopsis 28947 28948@smallexample 28949 -symbol-info-function 28950@end smallexample 28951 28952Show which function the symbol lives in. 28953 28954@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28955 28956@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}. 28957 28958@subsubheading Example 28959N.A. 28960 28961 28962@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command 28963@findex -symbol-info-line 28964 28965@subsubheading Synopsis 28966 28967@smallexample 28968 -symbol-info-line 28969@end smallexample 28970 28971Show the core addresses of the code for a source line. 28972 28973@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28974 28975The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}. 28976@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands. 28977 28978@subsubheading Example 28979N.A. 28980 28981 28982@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command 28983@findex -symbol-info-symbol 28984 28985@subsubheading Synopsis 28986 28987@smallexample 28988 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr} 28989@end smallexample 28990 28991Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}. 28992 28993@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28994 28995The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}. 28996 28997@subsubheading Example 28998N.A. 28999 29000 29001@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command 29002@findex -symbol-list-functions 29003 29004@subsubheading Synopsis 29005 29006@smallexample 29007 -symbol-list-functions 29008@end smallexample 29009 29010List the functions in the executable. 29011 29012@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29013 29014@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and 29015@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 29016 29017@subsubheading Example 29018N.A. 29019@end ignore 29020 29021 29022@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command 29023@findex -symbol-list-lines 29024 29025@subsubheading Synopsis 29026 29027@smallexample 29028 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename} 29029@end smallexample 29030 29031Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program 29032addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in 29033ascending PC order. 29034 29035@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29036 29037There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 29038 29039@subsubheading Example 29040@smallexample 29041(gdb) 29042-symbol-list-lines basics.c 29043^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}] 29044(gdb) 29045@end smallexample 29046 29047 29048@ignore 29049@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command 29050@findex -symbol-list-types 29051 29052@subsubheading Synopsis 29053 29054@smallexample 29055 -symbol-list-types 29056@end smallexample 29057 29058List all the type names. 29059 29060@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29061 29062The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN}, 29063@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 29064 29065@subsubheading Example 29066N.A. 29067 29068 29069@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command 29070@findex -symbol-list-variables 29071 29072@subsubheading Synopsis 29073 29074@smallexample 29075 -symbol-list-variables 29076@end smallexample 29077 29078List all the global and static variable names. 29079 29080@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29081 29082@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 29083 29084@subsubheading Example 29085N.A. 29086 29087 29088@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command 29089@findex -symbol-locate 29090 29091@subsubheading Synopsis 29092 29093@smallexample 29094 -symbol-locate 29095@end smallexample 29096 29097@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29098 29099@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}. 29100 29101@subsubheading Example 29102N.A. 29103 29104 29105@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command 29106@findex -symbol-type 29107 29108@subsubheading Synopsis 29109 29110@smallexample 29111 -symbol-type @var{variable} 29112@end smallexample 29113 29114Show type of @var{variable}. 29115 29116@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29117 29118The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has 29119@samp{gdb_obj_variable}. 29120 29121@subsubheading Example 29122N.A. 29123@end ignore 29124 29125 29126@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29127@node GDB/MI File Commands 29128@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands 29129 29130This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names 29131and to read in and obtain symbol table information. 29132 29133@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command 29134@findex -file-exec-and-symbols 29135 29136@subsubheading Synopsis 29137 29138@smallexample 29139 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file} 29140@end smallexample 29141 29142Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from 29143which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the 29144command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints 29145are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce 29146error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion 29147notification. 29148 29149@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29150 29151The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}. 29152 29153@subsubheading Example 29154 29155@smallexample 29156(gdb) 29157-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 29158^done 29159(gdb) 29160@end smallexample 29161 29162 29163@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command 29164@findex -file-exec-file 29165 29166@subsubheading Synopsis 29167 29168@smallexample 29169 -file-exec-file @var{file} 29170@end smallexample 29171 29172Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike 29173@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read 29174from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information 29175about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion 29176notification. 29177 29178@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29179 29180The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}. 29181 29182@subsubheading Example 29183 29184@smallexample 29185(gdb) 29186-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 29187^done 29188(gdb) 29189@end smallexample 29190 29191 29192@ignore 29193@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command 29194@findex -file-list-exec-sections 29195 29196@subsubheading Synopsis 29197 29198@smallexample 29199 -file-list-exec-sections 29200@end smallexample 29201 29202List the sections of the current executable file. 29203 29204@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29205 29206The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same 29207information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command 29208@samp{gdb_load_info}. 29209 29210@subsubheading Example 29211N.A. 29212@end ignore 29213 29214 29215@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command 29216@findex -file-list-exec-source-file 29217 29218@subsubheading Synopsis 29219 29220@smallexample 29221 -file-list-exec-source-file 29222@end smallexample 29223 29224List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path 29225to the current source file for the current executable. The macro 29226information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on 29227whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information. 29228 29229@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29230 29231The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source} 29232 29233@subsubheading Example 29234 29235@smallexample 29236(gdb) 29237123-file-list-exec-source-file 29238123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1" 29239(gdb) 29240@end smallexample 29241 29242 29243@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command 29244@findex -file-list-exec-source-files 29245 29246@subsubheading Synopsis 29247 29248@smallexample 29249 -file-list-exec-source-files 29250@end smallexample 29251 29252List the source files for the current executable. 29253 29254It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find 29255the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname. 29256 29257@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29258 29259The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}. 29260@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}. 29261 29262@subsubheading Example 29263@smallexample 29264(gdb) 29265-file-list-exec-source-files 29266^done,files=[ 29267@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@}, 29268@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@}, 29269@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}] 29270(gdb) 29271@end smallexample 29272 29273@ignore 29274@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command 29275@findex -file-list-shared-libraries 29276 29277@subsubheading Synopsis 29278 29279@smallexample 29280 -file-list-shared-libraries 29281@end smallexample 29282 29283List the shared libraries in the program. 29284 29285@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29286 29287The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. 29288 29289@subsubheading Example 29290N.A. 29291 29292 29293@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command 29294@findex -file-list-symbol-files 29295 29296@subsubheading Synopsis 29297 29298@smallexample 29299 -file-list-symbol-files 29300@end smallexample 29301 29302List symbol files. 29303 29304@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29305 29306The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it). 29307 29308@subsubheading Example 29309N.A. 29310@end ignore 29311 29312 29313@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command 29314@findex -file-symbol-file 29315 29316@subsubheading Synopsis 29317 29318@smallexample 29319 -file-symbol-file @var{file} 29320@end smallexample 29321 29322Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When 29323used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is 29324produced, except for a completion notification. 29325 29326@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29327 29328The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}. 29329 29330@subsubheading Example 29331 29332@smallexample 29333(gdb) 29334-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 29335^done 29336(gdb) 29337@end smallexample 29338 29339@ignore 29340@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29341@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands 29342@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands 29343 29344The memory overlay commands are not implemented. 29345 29346@c @subheading -overlay-auto 29347 29348@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state 29349 29350@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays 29351 29352@c @subheading -overlay-map 29353 29354@c @subheading -overlay-off 29355 29356@c @subheading -overlay-on 29357 29358@c @subheading -overlay-unmap 29359 29360@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29361@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands 29362@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands 29363 29364Signal handling commands are not implemented. 29365 29366@c @subheading -signal-handle 29367 29368@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions 29369 29370@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types 29371@end ignore 29372 29373 29374@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29375@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation 29376@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands 29377 29378 29379@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command 29380@findex -target-attach 29381 29382@subsubheading Synopsis 29383 29384@smallexample 29385 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file} 29386@end smallexample 29387 29388Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of 29389@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread 29390group, the id previously returned by 29391@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used. 29392 29393@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29394 29395The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}. 29396 29397@subsubheading Example 29398@smallexample 29399(gdb) 29400-target-attach 34 29401=thread-created,id="1" 29402*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@} 29403^done 29404(gdb) 29405@end smallexample 29406 29407@ignore 29408@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command 29409@findex -target-compare-sections 29410 29411@subsubheading Synopsis 29412 29413@smallexample 29414 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ] 29415@end smallexample 29416 29417Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file. 29418Without the argument, all sections are compared. 29419 29420@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29421 29422The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}. 29423 29424@subsubheading Example 29425N.A. 29426@end ignore 29427 29428 29429@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command 29430@findex -target-detach 29431 29432@subsubheading Synopsis 29433 29434@smallexample 29435 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ] 29436@end smallexample 29437 29438Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution. 29439If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either 29440the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output. 29441 29442@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29443 29444The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}. 29445 29446@subsubheading Example 29447 29448@smallexample 29449(gdb) 29450-target-detach 29451^done 29452(gdb) 29453@end smallexample 29454 29455 29456@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command 29457@findex -target-disconnect 29458 29459@subsubheading Synopsis 29460 29461@smallexample 29462 -target-disconnect 29463@end smallexample 29464 29465Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is 29466generally not resumed. 29467 29468@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29469 29470The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}. 29471 29472@subsubheading Example 29473 29474@smallexample 29475(gdb) 29476-target-disconnect 29477^done 29478(gdb) 29479@end smallexample 29480 29481 29482@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command 29483@findex -target-download 29484 29485@subsubheading Synopsis 29486 29487@smallexample 29488 -target-download 29489@end smallexample 29490 29491Loads the executable onto the remote target. 29492It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields: 29493 29494@table @samp 29495@item section 29496The name of the section. 29497@item section-sent 29498The size of what has been sent so far for that section. 29499@item section-size 29500The size of the section. 29501@item total-sent 29502The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections). 29503@item total-size 29504The size of the overall executable to download. 29505@end table 29506 29507@noindent 29508Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , 29509@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}). 29510 29511In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are 29512downloaded. These messages include the following fields: 29513 29514@table @samp 29515@item section 29516The name of the section. 29517@item section-size 29518The size of the section. 29519@item total-size 29520The size of the overall executable to download. 29521@end table 29522 29523@noindent 29524At the end, a summary is printed. 29525 29526@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29527 29528The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}. 29529 29530@subsubheading Example 29531 29532Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages 29533have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page. 29534 29535@smallexample 29536(gdb) 29537-target-download 29538+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@} 29539+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668", 29540total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@} 29541+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668", 29542total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@} 29543+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668", 29544total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@} 29545+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668", 29546total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@} 29547+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668", 29548total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@} 29549+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668", 29550total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@} 29551+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668", 29552total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@} 29553+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668", 29554total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@} 29555+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668", 29556total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@} 29557+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668", 29558total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@} 29559+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668", 29560total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@} 29561+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668", 29562total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@} 29563+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668", 29564total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@} 29565+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 29566+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 29567+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@} 29568+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156", 29569total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@} 29570+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156", 29571total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@} 29572+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156", 29573total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@} 29574+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156", 29575total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@} 29576+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156", 29577total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@} 29578+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156", 29579total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@} 29580^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586", 29581write-rate="429" 29582(gdb) 29583@end smallexample 29584 29585 29586@ignore 29587@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command 29588@findex -target-exec-status 29589 29590@subsubheading Synopsis 29591 29592@smallexample 29593 -target-exec-status 29594@end smallexample 29595 29596Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or 29597not, for instance). 29598 29599@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29600 29601There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 29602 29603@subsubheading Example 29604N.A. 29605 29606 29607@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command 29608@findex -target-list-available-targets 29609 29610@subsubheading Synopsis 29611 29612@smallexample 29613 -target-list-available-targets 29614@end smallexample 29615 29616List the possible targets to connect to. 29617 29618@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29619 29620The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}. 29621 29622@subsubheading Example 29623N.A. 29624 29625 29626@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command 29627@findex -target-list-current-targets 29628 29629@subsubheading Synopsis 29630 29631@smallexample 29632 -target-list-current-targets 29633@end smallexample 29634 29635Describe the current target. 29636 29637@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29638 29639The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among 29640other things). 29641 29642@subsubheading Example 29643N.A. 29644 29645 29646@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command 29647@findex -target-list-parameters 29648 29649@subsubheading Synopsis 29650 29651@smallexample 29652 -target-list-parameters 29653@end smallexample 29654 29655@c ???? 29656@end ignore 29657 29658@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29659 29660No equivalent. 29661 29662@subsubheading Example 29663N.A. 29664 29665 29666@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command 29667@findex -target-select 29668 29669@subsubheading Synopsis 29670 29671@smallexample 29672 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}} 29673@end smallexample 29674 29675Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args: 29676 29677@table @samp 29678@item @var{type} 29679The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc. 29680@item @var{parameters} 29681Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, , 29682Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details. 29683@end table 29684 29685The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at 29686which the target program is, in the following form: 29687 29688@smallexample 29689^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}", 29690 args=[@var{arg list}] 29691@end smallexample 29692 29693@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29694 29695The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}. 29696 29697@subsubheading Example 29698 29699@smallexample 29700(gdb) 29701-target-select remote /dev/ttya 29702^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[] 29703(gdb) 29704@end smallexample 29705 29706@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29707@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands 29708@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands 29709 29710 29711@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command 29712@findex -target-file-put 29713 29714@subsubheading Synopsis 29715 29716@smallexample 29717 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 29718@end smallexample 29719 29720Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 29721@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 29722 29723@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29724 29725The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}. 29726 29727@subsubheading Example 29728 29729@smallexample 29730(gdb) 29731-target-file-put localfile remotefile 29732^done 29733(gdb) 29734@end smallexample 29735 29736 29737@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command 29738@findex -target-file-get 29739 29740@subsubheading Synopsis 29741 29742@smallexample 29743 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 29744@end smallexample 29745 29746Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 29747on the host system. 29748 29749@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29750 29751The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}. 29752 29753@subsubheading Example 29754 29755@smallexample 29756(gdb) 29757-target-file-get remotefile localfile 29758^done 29759(gdb) 29760@end smallexample 29761 29762 29763@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command 29764@findex -target-file-delete 29765 29766@subsubheading Synopsis 29767 29768@smallexample 29769 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile} 29770@end smallexample 29771 29772Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 29773 29774@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29775 29776The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}. 29777 29778@subsubheading Example 29779 29780@smallexample 29781(gdb) 29782-target-file-delete remotefile 29783^done 29784(gdb) 29785@end smallexample 29786 29787 29788@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29789@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands 29790@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands 29791 29792@c @subheading -gdb-complete 29793 29794@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command 29795@findex -gdb-exit 29796 29797@subsubheading Synopsis 29798 29799@smallexample 29800 -gdb-exit 29801@end smallexample 29802 29803Exit @value{GDBN} immediately. 29804 29805@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29806 29807Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}. 29808 29809@subsubheading Example 29810 29811@smallexample 29812(gdb) 29813-gdb-exit 29814^exit 29815@end smallexample 29816 29817 29818@ignore 29819@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command 29820@findex -exec-abort 29821 29822@subsubheading Synopsis 29823 29824@smallexample 29825 -exec-abort 29826@end smallexample 29827 29828Kill the inferior running program. 29829 29830@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29831 29832The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}. 29833 29834@subsubheading Example 29835N.A. 29836@end ignore 29837 29838 29839@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command 29840@findex -gdb-set 29841 29842@subsubheading Synopsis 29843 29844@smallexample 29845 -gdb-set 29846@end smallexample 29847 29848Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable. 29849@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ????? 29850 29851@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29852 29853The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}. 29854 29855@subsubheading Example 29856 29857@smallexample 29858(gdb) 29859-gdb-set $foo=3 29860^done 29861(gdb) 29862@end smallexample 29863 29864 29865@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command 29866@findex -gdb-show 29867 29868@subsubheading Synopsis 29869 29870@smallexample 29871 -gdb-show 29872@end smallexample 29873 29874Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable. 29875 29876@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29877 29878The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}. 29879 29880@subsubheading Example 29881 29882@smallexample 29883(gdb) 29884-gdb-show annotate 29885^done,value="0" 29886(gdb) 29887@end smallexample 29888 29889@c @subheading -gdb-source 29890 29891 29892@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command 29893@findex -gdb-version 29894 29895@subsubheading Synopsis 29896 29897@smallexample 29898 -gdb-version 29899@end smallexample 29900 29901Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing. 29902 29903@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29904 29905The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by 29906default shows this information when you start an interactive session. 29907 29908@subsubheading Example 29909 29910@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull 29911@c box in TeX. 29912@smallexample 29913(gdb) 29914-gdb-version 29915~GNU gdb 5.2.1 29916~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 29917~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and 29918~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under 29919~ certain conditions. 29920~Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 29921~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for 29922~ details. 29923~This GDB was configured as 29924 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi". 29925^done 29926(gdb) 29927@end smallexample 29928 29929@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command 29930@findex -list-features 29931 29932Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that 29933this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command, 29934or a new field in an output of some command, or even an 29935important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence 29936of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger 29937startup. 29938 29939The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an 29940available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not 29941have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names 29942is given below. 29943 29944Example output: 29945 29946@smallexample 29947(gdb) -list-features 29948^done,result=["feature1","feature2"] 29949@end smallexample 29950 29951The current list of features is: 29952 29953@table @samp 29954@item frozen-varobjs 29955Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well 29956as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output 29957of @code{-varobj-create}. 29958@item pending-breakpoints 29959Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command. 29960@item python 29961Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based 29962pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the 29963@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children} 29964@item thread-info 29965Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command. 29966@item data-read-memory-bytes 29967Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the 29968@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands. 29969 29970@end table 29971 29972@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command 29973@findex -list-target-features 29974 29975Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the 29976target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but 29977unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the 29978features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever 29979a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select}, 29980@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features 29981may change, and the frontend should obtain it again. 29982Example output: 29983 29984@smallexample 29985(gdb) -list-features 29986^done,result=["async"] 29987@end smallexample 29988 29989The current list of features is: 29990 29991@table @samp 29992@item async 29993Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command 29994execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands 29995while the target is running. 29996 29997@item reverse 29998Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution. 29999@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 30000 30001@end table 30002 30003@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command 30004@findex -list-thread-groups 30005 30006@subheading Synopsis 30007 30008@smallexample 30009-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ] 30010@end smallexample 30011 30012Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread 30013group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group. 30014When several thread group are passed, lists information about those 30015thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all 30016top-level thread groups. 30017 30018Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported. 30019With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups 30020available on the target. 30021 30022The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or 30023a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples 30024as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread 30025Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value, 30026each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are 30027requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups 30028are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format 30029of the @samp{group} result is described below. 30030 30031To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups 30032together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option 30033and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is 30034permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group 30035will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or 30036@samp{threads} field. 30037 30038In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with 30039the following caveats: 30040 30041@itemize @bullet 30042@item 30043When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically 30044be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain 30045anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored. 30046 30047@item 30048When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may 30049be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might 30050be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might 30051not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups. 30052The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} 30053is always an expensive operation and cache the results. 30054 30055@end itemize 30056 30057The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may 30058have the following fields: 30059 30060@table @code 30061@item id 30062Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present. 30063The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to 30064convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one. 30065 30066@item type 30067The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a 30068valid type. 30069 30070@item pid 30071The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present 30072for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists. 30073 30074@item num_children 30075The number of children this thread group has. This field may be 30076absent for an available thread group. 30077 30078@item threads 30079This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a 30080thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is 30081specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads. 30082 30083@item cores 30084This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one 30085thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if 30086such information is not available. 30087 30088@item executable 30089The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group. 30090The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process}, 30091and only if there is a corresponding executable file. 30092 30093@end table 30094 30095@subheading Example 30096 30097@smallexample 30098@value{GDBP} 30099-list-thread-groups 30100^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}] 30101-list-thread-groups 17 30102^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 30103 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@}, 30104@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 30105 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 30106 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]] 30107-list-thread-groups --available 30108^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}] 30109-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 30110 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 30111 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 30112 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..] 30113-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18 30114^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 30115 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 30116 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...] 30117@end smallexample 30118 30119 30120@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command 30121@findex -add-inferior 30122 30123@subheading Synopsis 30124 30125@smallexample 30126-add-inferior 30127@end smallexample 30128 30129Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created 30130inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may 30131be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command 30132(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single 30133field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the 30134thread group corresponding to the new inferior. 30135 30136@subheading Example 30137 30138@smallexample 30139@value{GDBP} 30140-add-inferior 30141^done,thread-group="i3" 30142@end smallexample 30143 30144@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command 30145@findex -interpreter-exec 30146 30147@subheading Synopsis 30148 30149@smallexample 30150-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command} 30151@end smallexample 30152@anchor{-interpreter-exec} 30153 30154Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}. 30155 30156@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 30157 30158The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}. 30159 30160@subheading Example 30161 30162@smallexample 30163(gdb) 30164-interpreter-exec console "break main" 30165&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n" 30166&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n" 30167~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n" 30168^done 30169(gdb) 30170@end smallexample 30171 30172@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command 30173@findex -inferior-tty-set 30174 30175@subheading Synopsis 30176 30177@smallexample 30178-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 30179@end smallexample 30180 30181Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged. 30182 30183@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 30184 30185The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1. 30186 30187@subheading Example 30188 30189@smallexample 30190(gdb) 30191-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 30192^done 30193(gdb) 30194@end smallexample 30195 30196@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command 30197@findex -inferior-tty-show 30198 30199@subheading Synopsis 30200 30201@smallexample 30202-inferior-tty-show 30203@end smallexample 30204 30205Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged. 30206 30207@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 30208 30209The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}. 30210 30211@subheading Example 30212 30213@smallexample 30214(gdb) 30215-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 30216^done 30217(gdb) 30218-inferior-tty-show 30219^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1" 30220(gdb) 30221@end smallexample 30222 30223@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command 30224@findex -enable-timings 30225 30226@subheading Synopsis 30227 30228@smallexample 30229-enable-timings [yes | no] 30230@end smallexample 30231 30232Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI 30233command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend 30234developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is 30235equivalent to @samp{yes}. 30236 30237@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 30238 30239No equivalent. 30240 30241@subheading Example 30242 30243@smallexample 30244(gdb) 30245-enable-timings 30246^done 30247(gdb) 30248-break-insert main 30249^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 30250addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c", 30251fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@}, 30252time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@} 30253(gdb) 30254-enable-timings no 30255^done 30256(gdb) 30257-exec-run 30258^running 30259(gdb) 30260*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 30261frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@}, 30262@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c", 30263fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@} 30264(gdb) 30265@end smallexample 30266 30267@node Annotations 30268@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations 30269 30270This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were 30271designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other 30272similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a 30273relatively high level. 30274 30275The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 30276(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 30277 30278@ignore 30279This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}. 30280@end ignore 30281 30282@menu 30283* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax. 30284* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state. 30285* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input. 30286* Errors:: Annotations for error messages. 30287* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid. 30288* Annotations for Running:: 30289 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc. 30290* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code. 30291@end menu 30292 30293@node Annotations Overview 30294@section What is an Annotation? 30295@cindex annotations 30296 30297Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z} 30298characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional 30299information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation 30300is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional 30301information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the 30302additional information, and a newline. The additional information 30303cannot contain newline characters. 30304 30305Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z} 30306characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is 30307no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two 30308@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the 30309annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which 30310means those three characters as output. 30311 30312The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the 30313@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls 30314how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, 30315values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 30316is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a 30317subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable 30318for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have 30319been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation 30320Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). 30321 30322@table @code 30323@kindex set annotate 30324@item set annotate @var{level} 30325The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of 30326annotations to the specified @var{level}. 30327 30328@item show annotate 30329@kindex show annotate 30330Show the current annotation level. 30331@end table 30332 30333This chapter describes level 3 annotations. 30334 30335A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is: 30336 30337@smallexample 30338$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3} 30339GNU gdb 6.0 30340Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 30341GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, 30342and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it 30343under certain conditions. 30344Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 30345There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" 30346for details. 30347This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu" 30348 30349^Z^Zpre-prompt 30350(@value{GDBP}) 30351^Z^Zprompt 30352@kbd{quit} 30353 30354^Z^Zpost-prompt 30355$ 30356@end smallexample 30357 30358Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from 30359@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z} 30360denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is 30361output from @value{GDBN}. 30362 30363@node Server Prefix 30364@section The Server Prefix 30365@cindex server prefix 30366 30367If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect 30368the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which 30369command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This 30370means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in 30371a transparent manner. 30372 30373The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into 30374the value history; to print a value without recording it into the 30375value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the 30376@code{print} command. 30377 30378Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests 30379(@pxref{confirmation requests}). 30380 30381@node Prompting 30382@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input 30383 30384@cindex annotations for prompts 30385When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible 30386to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is 30387over, etc. 30388 30389Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each 30390input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which 30391denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain 30392annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-} 30393annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be 30394associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type 30395features the following annotations: 30396 30397@smallexample 30398^Z^Zpre-prompt 30399^Z^Zprompt 30400^Z^Zpost-prompt 30401@end smallexample 30402 30403The input types are 30404 30405@table @code 30406@findex pre-prompt annotation 30407@findex prompt annotation 30408@findex post-prompt annotation 30409@item prompt 30410When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt). 30411 30412@findex pre-commands annotation 30413@findex commands annotation 30414@findex post-commands annotation 30415@item commands 30416When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands} 30417command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input. 30418 30419@findex pre-overload-choice annotation 30420@findex overload-choice annotation 30421@findex post-overload-choice annotation 30422@item overload-choice 30423When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions. 30424 30425@findex pre-query annotation 30426@findex query annotation 30427@findex post-query annotation 30428@item query 30429When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation. 30430 30431@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation 30432@findex prompt-for-continue annotation 30433@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation 30434@item prompt-for-continue 30435When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't 30436expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable 30437prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the 30438presence of annotations. 30439@end table 30440 30441@node Errors 30442@section Errors 30443@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts 30444 30445@findex quit annotation 30446@smallexample 30447^Z^Zquit 30448@end smallexample 30449 30450This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt. 30451 30452@findex error annotation 30453@smallexample 30454^Z^Zerror 30455@end smallexample 30456 30457This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error. 30458 30459Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was 30460in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a 30461@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one 30462cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One 30463cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation 30464does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way 30465to the top level. 30466 30467@findex error-begin annotation 30468A quit or error annotation may be preceded by 30469 30470@smallexample 30471^Z^Zerror-begin 30472@end smallexample 30473 30474Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error 30475message. 30476 30477Warning messages are not yet annotated. 30478@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(), 30479@c range_error(), and possibly other places. 30480 30481@node Invalidation 30482@section Invalidation Notices 30483 30484@cindex annotations for invalidation messages 30485The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have 30486changed. 30487 30488@table @code 30489@findex frames-invalid annotation 30490@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid 30491 30492The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may 30493have changed. 30494 30495@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation 30496@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid 30497 30498The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or 30499deleted a breakpoint. 30500@end table 30501 30502@node Annotations for Running 30503@section Running the Program 30504@cindex annotations for running programs 30505 30506@findex starting annotation 30507@findex stopping annotation 30508When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as 30509@code{step} or @code{continue}, 30510 30511@smallexample 30512^Z^Zstarting 30513@end smallexample 30514 30515is output. When the program stops, 30516 30517@smallexample 30518^Z^Zstopped 30519@end smallexample 30520 30521is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of 30522annotations describe how the program stopped. 30523 30524@table @code 30525@findex exited annotation 30526@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status} 30527The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for 30528successful exit, otherwise nonzero). 30529 30530@findex signalled annotation 30531@findex signal-name annotation 30532@findex signal-name-end annotation 30533@findex signal-string annotation 30534@findex signal-string-end annotation 30535@item ^Z^Zsignalled 30536The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the 30537annotation continues: 30538 30539@smallexample 30540@var{intro-text} 30541^Z^Zsignal-name 30542@var{name} 30543^Z^Zsignal-name-end 30544@var{middle-text} 30545^Z^Zsignal-string 30546@var{string} 30547^Z^Zsignal-string-end 30548@var{end-text} 30549@end smallexample 30550 30551@noindent 30552where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or 30553@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such 30554as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. 30555@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the 30556user's benefit and have no particular format. 30557 30558@findex signal annotation 30559@item ^Z^Zsignal 30560The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is 30561just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was 30562terminated with it. 30563 30564@findex breakpoint annotation 30565@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number} 30566The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}. 30567 30568@findex watchpoint annotation 30569@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number} 30570The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}. 30571@end table 30572 30573@node Source Annotations 30574@section Displaying Source 30575@cindex annotations for source display 30576 30577@findex source annotation 30578The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code: 30579 30580@smallexample 30581^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr} 30582@end smallexample 30583 30584where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source 30585file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the 30586first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position 30587within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most 30588debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line), 30589@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the 30590line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and 30591@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the 30592source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x} 30593followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not 30594depend on the language). 30595 30596@node JIT Interface 30597@chapter JIT Compilation Interface 30598@cindex just-in-time compilation 30599@cindex JIT compilation interface 30600 30601This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation 30602interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native 30603executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good 30604performance while maintaining platform independence. 30605 30606Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because 30607portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from 30608object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols 30609and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation, 30610@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory 30611symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime. 30612 30613If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then 30614it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If 30615you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest 30616of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the 30617LLVM JIT. 30618 30619Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The 30620JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global 30621variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN} 30622attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to 30623find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find 30624out about additional code. 30625 30626@menu 30627* Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations 30628* Registering Code:: Steps to register code 30629* Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code 30630@end menu 30631 30632@node Declarations 30633@section JIT Declarations 30634 30635These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to 30636implement the interface: 30637 30638@smallexample 30639typedef enum 30640@{ 30641 JIT_NOACTION = 0, 30642 JIT_REGISTER_FN, 30643 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN 30644@} jit_actions_t; 30645 30646struct jit_code_entry 30647@{ 30648 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry; 30649 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry; 30650 const char *symfile_addr; 30651 uint64_t symfile_size; 30652@}; 30653 30654struct jit_descriptor 30655@{ 30656 uint32_t version; 30657 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t 30658 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */ 30659 uint32_t action_flag; 30660 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry; 30661 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry; 30662@}; 30663 30664/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */ 30665void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @}; 30666 30667/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the 30668 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */ 30669struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @}; 30670@end smallexample 30671 30672If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any 30673modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting 30674a global mutex around modifications to these structures. 30675 30676@node Registering Code 30677@section Registering Code 30678 30679To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol: 30680 30681@itemize @bullet 30682@item 30683Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug 30684information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections. 30685 30686@item 30687Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol 30688file. 30689 30690@item 30691Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor. 30692 30693@item 30694Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry. 30695 30696@item 30697Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call 30698@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 30699@end itemize 30700 30701When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the 30702@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for 30703new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow 30704@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files. 30705 30706@node Unregistering Code 30707@section Unregistering Code 30708 30709If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol: 30710 30711@itemize @bullet 30712@item 30713Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list. 30714 30715@item 30716Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry. 30717 30718@item 30719Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call 30720@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 30721@end itemize 30722 30723If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN} 30724and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files. 30725 30726@node GDB Bugs 30727@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN} 30728@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN} 30729@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 30730 30731Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable. 30732 30733Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it 30734may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help 30735the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug 30736reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}. 30737 30738In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the 30739information that enables us to fix the bug. 30740 30741@menu 30742* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug? 30743* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs 30744@end menu 30745 30746@node Bug Criteria 30747@section Have You Found a Bug? 30748@cindex bug criteria 30749 30750If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines: 30751 30752@itemize @bullet 30753@cindex fatal signal 30754@cindex debugger crash 30755@cindex crash of debugger 30756@item 30757If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a 30758@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash. 30759 30760@cindex error on valid input 30761@item 30762If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a 30763bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be 30764somewhere in the connection to the target.) 30765 30766@cindex invalid input 30767@item 30768If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input, 30769that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of 30770``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support 30771for traditional practice''. 30772 30773@item 30774If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions 30775for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case. 30776@end itemize 30777 30778@node Bug Reporting 30779@section How to Report Bugs 30780@cindex bug reports 30781@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting 30782 30783A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products. 30784If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you 30785contact that organization first. 30786 30787You can find contact information for many support companies and 30788individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs 30789distribution. 30790@c should add a web page ref... 30791 30792@ifset BUGURL 30793@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT 30794In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 30795@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using 30796@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web 30797page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can 30798be used. 30799 30800@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to 30801@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do 30802not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive 30803@samp{bug-gdb}. 30804 30805The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which 30806serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly 30807the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the 30808newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one 30809problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail 30810path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information, 30811we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send 30812bug reports to the mailing list. 30813@end ifset 30814@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT 30815In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 30816@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}. 30817@end ifclear 30818@end ifset 30819 30820The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this: 30821@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a 30822fact or leave it out, state it! 30823 30824Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the 30825problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might 30826assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter. 30827Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a 30828stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that 30829name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents 30830of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite 30831the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the 30832easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful. 30833 30834Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the 30835bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither 30836you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and 30837self-contained. 30838 30839Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a 30840bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to 30841@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report 30842bugs properly. 30843 30844To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things: 30845 30846@itemize @bullet 30847@item 30848The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start 30849with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show 30850version}. 30851 30852Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for 30853the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}. 30854 30855@item 30856The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and 30857version number. 30858 30859@item 30860What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@: 30861``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''. 30862 30863@item 30864What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are 30865debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP 30866C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version} 30867to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for 30868those compilers. 30869 30870@item 30871The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and 30872observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee 30873you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the 30874Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient. 30875 30876If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong 30877and then we might not encounter the bug. 30878 30879@item 30880A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will 30881reproduce the bug. 30882 30883@item 30884A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is 30885incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.'' 30886 30887Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we 30888will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might 30889not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us 30890a chance to make a mistake. 30891 30892Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still 30893say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your 30894copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in 30895the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might 30896crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when 30897ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for 30898us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able 30899to draw any conclusion from our observations. 30900 30901@pindex script 30902@cindex recording a session script 30903To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program 30904such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems. 30905Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then 30906include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report. 30907 30908Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN} 30909inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file. 30910 30911@item 30912If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context 30913diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to 30914it by context, not by line number. 30915 30916The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your 30917sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us. 30918 30919@end itemize 30920 30921Here are some things that are not necessary: 30922 30923@itemize @bullet 30924@item 30925A description of the envelope of the bug. 30926 30927Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating 30928which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which 30929changes will not affect it. 30930 30931This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we 30932will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger 30933with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples. 30934We recommend that you save your time for something else. 30935 30936Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead} 30937of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the 30938output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take 30939less time, and so on. 30940 30941However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this, 30942report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used. 30943 30944@item 30945A patch for the bug. 30946 30947A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit 30948the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that 30949a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide 30950to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all. 30951 30952Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to 30953construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path 30954through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able 30955to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed. 30956 30957And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your 30958patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will 30959help us to understand. 30960 30961@item 30962A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on. 30963 30964Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such 30965things without first using the debugger to find the facts. 30966@end itemize 30967 30968@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code 30969@c and consists of the two following files: 30970@c rluser.texinfo 30971@c inc-hist.texinfo 30972@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory, 30973@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX. 30974@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 30975@include rluser.texi 30976@include inc-hist.texinfo 30977@end ifclear 30978 30979@node In Memoriam 30980@appendix In Memoriam 30981 30982The GDB project mourns the loss of the following long-time contributors: 30983 30984@table @code 30985@item Fred Fish 30986Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB (1991-2006), and to Free 30987Software in general. Outside of GDB, he was known in the Amiga world 30988for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project. 30989 30990@item Michael Snyder 30991Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the GDB project, with 30992contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition to 30993his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind 30994adding Reverse Debugging to GDB. 30995@end table 30996 30997Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also 30998enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them. 30999 31000@node Formatting Documentation 31001@appendix Formatting Documentation 31002 31003@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card 31004@cindex reference card 31005The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready 31006for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb} 31007subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In 31008@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN} 31009release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer, 31010you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}. 31011 31012The release also includes the source for the reference card. You 31013can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing: 31014 31015@smallexample 31016make refcard.dvi 31017@end smallexample 31018 31019The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape} 31020mode on US ``letter'' size paper; 31021that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches 31022high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to 31023your @sc{dvi} output program. 31024 31025@cindex documentation 31026 31027All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable 31028distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is 31029a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both 31030on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info 31031formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation 31032and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version. 31033 31034@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info 31035version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info 31036file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to 31037subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If 31038necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor; 31039but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu} 31040Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the 31041@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution. 31042 31043If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the 31044Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or 31045@code{makeinfo}. 31046 31047If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level 31048@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of 31049version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing: 31050 31051@smallexample 31052cd gdb 31053make gdb.info 31054@end smallexample 31055 31056If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{}, 31057a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the 31058Texinfo definitions file. 31059 31060@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but 31061produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset 31062document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system 31063has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise 31064command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another 31065(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may 31066require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension. 31067 31068@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called 31069@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document 31070written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or 31071typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB 31072and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo} 31073directory. 31074 31075If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can 31076typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb} 31077subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to 31078@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type: 31079 31080@smallexample 31081make gdb.dvi 31082@end smallexample 31083 31084Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program. 31085 31086@node Installing GDB 31087@appendix Installing @value{GDBN} 31088@cindex installation 31089 31090@menu 31091* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN} 31092* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script 31093* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory 31094* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets 31095* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure 31096* System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file 31097@end menu 31098 31099@node Requirements 31100@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN} 31101@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for 31102 31103Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available. 31104Other packages will be used only if they are found. 31105 31106@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN} 31107@table @asis 31108@item ISO C90 compiler 31109@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any 31110working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC. 31111 31112@end table 31113 31114@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN} 31115@table @asis 31116@item Expat 31117@anchor{Expat} 31118@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be 31119included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you 31120can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}. 31121The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several 31122standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can 31123use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location. 31124 31125Expat is used for: 31126 31127@itemize @bullet 31128@item 31129Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format}) 31130@item 31131Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) 31132@item 31133Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format}) 31134@item 31135MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries}) 31136@item 31137Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format}) 31138@end itemize 31139 31140@item zlib 31141@cindex compressed debug sections 31142@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read 31143compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable 31144of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN} 31145is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug 31146information in such binaries. 31147 31148The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system 31149distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from 31150@url{http://zlib.net}. 31151 31152@item iconv 31153@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character 31154Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are 31155on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some 31156other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}. 31157 31158On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you 31159have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the 31160@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure. 31161 31162@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will 31163arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears 31164in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and 31165if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv} 31166implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used 31167by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU 31168Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the 31169Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}. 31170@end table 31171 31172@node Running Configure 31173@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script 31174@cindex configuring @value{GDBN} 31175@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process 31176of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to 31177build the @code{gdb} program. 31178@iftex 31179@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with. 31180@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN}, 31181look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the 31182installation procedures since publishing this manual.} 31183@end iftex 31184 31185The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for 31186@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by 31187appending the version number to @samp{gdb}. 31188 31189For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the 31190@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains: 31191 31192@table @code 31193@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)} 31194script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries 31195 31196@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb 31197the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself 31198 31199@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd 31200source for the Binary File Descriptor library 31201 31202@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include 31203@sc{gnu} include files 31204 31205@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty 31206source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library 31207 31208@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes 31209source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers 31210 31211@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline 31212source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface 31213 31214@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob 31215source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine 31216 31217@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc 31218source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package 31219@end table 31220 31221The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure} 31222from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in 31223this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. 31224 31225First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory 31226if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the 31227identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an 31228argument. 31229 31230For example: 31231 31232@smallexample 31233cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 31234./configure @var{host} 31235make 31236@end smallexample 31237 31238@noindent 31239where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or 31240@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run. 31241(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the 31242correct value by examining your system.) 31243 31244Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the 31245@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty} 31246libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the 31247binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories. 31248 31249@need 750 31250@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your 31251system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different 31252shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly: 31253 31254@smallexample 31255sh configure @var{host} 31256@end smallexample 31257 31258If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source 31259directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the 31260@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, 31261@file{configure} 31262creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless 31263you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option). 31264 31265You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the 31266source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run 31267@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only 31268that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular, 31269if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory 31270of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the 31271configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling 31272directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors 31273about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 31274 31275You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths. 31276However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by 31277the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember 31278that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to 31279let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable. 31280 31281@node Separate Objdir 31282@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory 31283 31284If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines, 31285you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of 31286host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by 31287allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory, 31288rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program 31289handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running 31290@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb} 31291program specified there. 31292 31293To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure} 31294with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source. 31295(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure} 31296itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure} 31297would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out 31298the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.) 31299 31300For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a 31301separate directory for a Sun 4 like this: 31302 31303@smallexample 31304@group 31305cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 31306mkdir ../gdb-sun4 31307cd ../gdb-sun4 31308../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4 31309make 31310@end group 31311@end smallexample 31312 31313When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source 31314directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure 31315(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In 31316the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the 31317directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in 31318@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}. 31319 31320Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one 31321instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks 31322like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only 31323one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to 31324build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 31325 31326One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate 31327directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where 31328@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging 31329programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}). 31330You specify a cross-debugging target by 31331giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}. 31332 31333When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run 31334it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you 31335called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories). 31336 31337The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source 31338directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source 31339directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured 31340directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you 31341will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB. 31342 31343When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate 31344directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example, 31345if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere 31346with each other. 31347 31348@node Config Names 31349@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets 31350 31351The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure} 31352script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined 31353aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces 31354of information in the following pattern: 31355 31356@smallexample 31357@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os} 31358@end smallexample 31359 31360For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument, 31361or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}} 31362option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}. 31363 31364The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide 31365any query facility to list all supported host and target names or 31366aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script 31367@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the 31368script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on 31369abbreviations---for example: 31370 31371@smallexample 31372% sh config.sub i386-linux 31373i386-pc-linux-gnu 31374% sh config.sub alpha-linux 31375alpha-unknown-linux-gnu 31376% sh config.sub hp9k700 31377hppa1.1-hp-hpux 31378% sh config.sub sun4 31379sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1 31380% sh config.sub sun3 31381m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1 31382% sh config.sub i986v 31383Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized 31384@end smallexample 31385 31386@noindent 31387@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source 31388directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}). 31389 31390@node Configure Options 31391@section @file{configure} Options 31392 31393Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that 31394are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has 31395several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure 31396Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}. 31397 31398@smallexample 31399configure @r{[}--help@r{]} 31400 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 31401 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 31402 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]} 31403 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]} 31404 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]} 31405 @var{host} 31406@end smallexample 31407 31408@noindent 31409You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than 31410@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use 31411@samp{--}. 31412 31413@table @code 31414@item --help 31415Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}. 31416 31417@item --prefix=@var{dir} 31418Configure the source to install programs and files under directory 31419@file{@var{dir}}. 31420 31421@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir} 31422Configure the source to install programs under directory 31423@file{@var{dir}}. 31424 31425@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation: 31426@need 2000 31427@item --srcdir=@var{dirname} 31428@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another 31429@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@* 31430Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the 31431@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to 31432build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate 31433directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in 31434the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the 31435directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under 31436the working directory in parallel to the source directories below 31437@var{dirname}. 31438 31439@item --norecursion 31440Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not 31441propagate configuration to subdirectories. 31442 31443@item --target=@var{target} 31444Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified 31445@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug 31446programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself. 31447 31448There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets. 31449 31450@item @var{host} @dots{} 31451Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}. 31452 31453There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts. 31454@end table 31455 31456There are many other options available as well, but they are generally 31457needed for special purposes only. 31458 31459@node System-wide configuration 31460@section System-wide configuration and settings 31461@cindex system-wide init file 31462 31463@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file; 31464this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What 31465@value{GDBN} does during startup}). 31466 31467Here is the corresponding configure option: 31468 31469@table @code 31470@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file} 31471Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is 31472@var{file}. 31473@end table 31474 31475If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix}, 31476it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases: 31477 31478@itemize @bullet 31479@item 31480If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix}, 31481it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options 31482are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit}; 31483if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system 31484init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of 31485@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}. 31486 31487@item 31488By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix, 31489it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with 31490@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 31491then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 31492wherever @value{GDBN} is installed. 31493@end itemize 31494 31495@node Maintenance Commands 31496@appendix Maintenance Commands 31497@cindex maintenance commands 31498@cindex internal commands 31499 31500In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN} 31501includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers, 31502that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are 31503provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging 31504messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.) 31505 31506@table @code 31507@kindex maint agent 31508@kindex maint agent-eval 31509@item maint agent @var{expression} 31510@itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression} 31511Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes. 31512This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism 31513(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an 31514expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while 31515@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly 31516to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa + 31517globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each 31518of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding 31519the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the 31520addition and return the sum. 31521 31522@kindex maint info breakpoints 31523@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints 31524Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the 31525breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for 31526internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative 31527breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint 31528is shown: 31529 31530@table @code 31531@item breakpoint 31532Normal, explicitly set breakpoint. 31533 31534@item watchpoint 31535Normal, explicitly set watchpoint. 31536 31537@item longjmp 31538Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through 31539@code{longjmp} calls. 31540 31541@item longjmp resume 31542Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}. 31543 31544@item until 31545Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command. 31546 31547@item finish 31548Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command. 31549 31550@item shlib events 31551Shared library events. 31552 31553@end table 31554 31555@kindex set displaced-stepping 31556@kindex show displaced-stepping 31557@cindex displaced stepping support 31558@cindex out-of-line single-stepping 31559@item set displaced-stepping 31560@itemx show displaced-stepping 31561Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping} 31562if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step 31563over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing 31564an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the 31565breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping. 31566 31567@table @code 31568@item set displaced-stepping on 31569If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use 31570displaced stepping to step over breakpoints. 31571 31572@item set displaced-stepping off 31573@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints, 31574even if such is supported by the target architecture. 31575 31576@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping} 31577@item set displaced-stepping auto 31578This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping 31579only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target 31580architecture supports displaced stepping. 31581@end table 31582 31583@kindex maint check-symtabs 31584@item maint check-symtabs 31585Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs. 31586 31587@kindex maint cplus first_component 31588@item maint cplus first_component @var{name} 31589Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}. 31590 31591@kindex maint cplus namespace 31592@item maint cplus namespace 31593Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces. 31594 31595@kindex maint demangle 31596@item maint demangle @var{name} 31597Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}. 31598 31599@kindex maint deprecate 31600@kindex maint undeprecate 31601@cindex deprecated commands 31602@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]} 31603@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command} 31604Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands 31605cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional 31606argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in 31607favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention 31608the replacement as part of the warning. 31609 31610@kindex maint dump-me 31611@item maint dump-me 31612@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN} 31613Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core. 31614This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program 31615with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal. 31616 31617@kindex maint internal-error 31618@kindex maint internal-warning 31619@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 31620@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 31621Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error} 31622or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error 31623or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the 31624internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to 31625either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current 31626@value{GDBN} session. 31627 31628These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is 31629used as the text of the error or warning message. 31630 31631Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}: 31632 31633@smallexample 31634(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2} 31635@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2 31636A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further 31637debugging may prove unreliable. 31638Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n} 31639Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n} 31640(@value{GDBP}) 31641@end smallexample 31642 31643@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error 31644@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior 31645 31646@kindex maint set internal-error 31647@kindex maint show internal-error 31648@kindex maint set internal-warning 31649@kindex maint show internal-warning 31650@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 31651@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action} 31652@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 31653@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action} 31654When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it 31655gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a 31656core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you 31657override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action}, 31658described in the table below. 31659 31660@table @samp 31661@item quit 31662You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 31663quit. The default is to ask the user what to do. 31664 31665@item corefile 31666You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 31667create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. 31668@end table 31669 31670@kindex maint packet 31671@item maint packet @var{text} 31672If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol, 31673then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and 31674displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial 31675@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the 31676checksum. 31677 31678@kindex maint print architecture 31679@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31680Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument 31681@var{file} names the file where the output goes. 31682 31683@kindex maint print c-tdesc 31684@item maint print c-tdesc 31685Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as 31686a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN} 31687when an XML parser is not available to parse the description. 31688 31689@kindex maint print dummy-frames 31690@item maint print dummy-frames 31691Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack. 31692 31693@smallexample 31694(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add} 31695@dots{} 31696(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)} 31697Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{} 3169858 return (a + b); 31699The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB. 31700@dots{} 31701(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames} 317020x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6 31703 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@} 31704 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001 31705(@value{GDBP}) 31706@end smallexample 31707 31708Takes an optional file parameter. 31709 31710@kindex maint print registers 31711@kindex maint print raw-registers 31712@kindex maint print cooked-registers 31713@kindex maint print register-groups 31714@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31715@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31716@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31717@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31718Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures. 31719 31720The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of 31721the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers} 31722includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which 31723aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the 31724command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each 31725register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, 31726@value{GDBN} Internals}. 31727 31728These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to 31729write the information. 31730 31731@kindex maint print reggroups 31732@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 31733Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The 31734optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the 31735information. 31736 31737The register groups info looks like this: 31738 31739@smallexample 31740(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups} 31741 Group Type 31742 general user 31743 float user 31744 all user 31745 vector user 31746 system user 31747 save internal 31748 restore internal 31749@end smallexample 31750 31751@kindex flushregs 31752@item flushregs 31753This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache. 31754 31755@kindex maint print objfiles 31756@cindex info for known object files 31757@item maint print objfiles 31758Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this 31759command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs 31760and symtabs. 31761 31762@kindex maint print section-scripts 31763@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts 31764@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}] 31765Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section. 31766If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files 31767matching @var{regexp}. 31768For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile, 31769and the full path if known. 31770@xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}. 31771 31772@kindex maint print statistics 31773@cindex bcache statistics 31774@item maint print statistics 31775This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data 31776about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache}) 31777statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number 31778of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types 31779defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables, 31780the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory 31781used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts, 31782sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max, 31783average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and 31784savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain 31785lengths. 31786 31787@kindex maint print target-stack 31788@cindex target stack description 31789@item maint print target-stack 31790A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular 31791kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata}, 31792so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request. 31793In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets 31794until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular 31795address. 31796 31797This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on 31798the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one. 31799 31800@kindex maint print type 31801@cindex type chain of a data type 31802@item maint print type @var{expr} 31803Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument 31804can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of 31805that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is 31806a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s 31807data structures, including its flags and contained types. 31808 31809@kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble 31810@kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble 31811@item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble 31812@item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble 31813Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging 31814information. 31815 31816The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to 31817describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When 31818@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location 31819expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are 31820too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will 31821always see the disassembly form. 31822 31823Here is an example of the resulting disassembly: 31824 31825@smallexample 31826(gdb) info addr argc 31827Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression: 31828 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0 31829@end smallexample 31830 31831For more information on these expressions, see 31832@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}. 31833 31834@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age 31835@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age 31836@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age 31837@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age 31838Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache. 31839 31840@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache 31841In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those 31842produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2 31843reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units. 31844This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the 31845cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached 31846compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total 31847memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will 31848slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption. 31849 31850@kindex maint set profile 31851@kindex maint show profile 31852@cindex profiling GDB 31853@item maint set profile 31854@itemx maint show profile 31855Control profiling of @value{GDBN}. 31856 31857Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile} 31858command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin 31859collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or 31860exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that 31861if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file 31862(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling 31863data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location. 31864 31865Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be 31866compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option. 31867 31868@kindex maint set show-debug-regs 31869@kindex maint show show-debug-regs 31870@cindex hardware debug registers 31871@item maint set show-debug-regs 31872@itemx maint show show-debug-regs 31873Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug 31874registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If 31875enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or 31876removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior 31877triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint. 31878 31879@kindex maint set show-all-tib 31880@kindex maint show show-all-tib 31881@item maint set show-all-tib 31882@itemx maint show show-all-tib 31883Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting 31884at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block} 31885command. 31886 31887@kindex maint space 31888@cindex memory used by commands 31889@item maint space 31890Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a 31891nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command 31892took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested 31893by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line 31894switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 31895 31896@kindex maint time 31897@cindex time of command execution 31898@item maint time 31899Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If 31900set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it 31901took to execute each command, following the command's own output. 31902The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since 31903there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend 31904by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged. 31905it's not possibly currently 31906This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the 31907@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 31908 31909@kindex maint translate-address 31910@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr} 31911Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address 31912@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found, 31913@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from 31914the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to 31915the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this 31916command also allows to find symbols in other sections. 31917 31918If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found 31919is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of 31920executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well. 31921 31922@end table 31923 31924The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of 31925@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite. 31926 31927@table @code 31928@item set watchdog @var{nsec} 31929@kindex set watchdog 31930@cindex watchdog timer 31931@cindex timeout for commands 31932Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the 31933target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN} 31934reports and error and the command is aborted. 31935 31936@item show watchdog 31937Show the current setting of the target wait timeout. 31938@end table 31939 31940@node Remote Protocol 31941@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol 31942 31943@menu 31944* Overview:: 31945* Packets:: 31946* Stop Reply Packets:: 31947* General Query Packets:: 31948* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details:: 31949* Tracepoint Packets:: 31950* Host I/O Packets:: 31951* Interrupts:: 31952* Notification Packets:: 31953* Remote Non-Stop:: 31954* Packet Acknowledgment:: 31955* Examples:: 31956* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension:: 31957* Library List Format:: 31958* Memory Map Format:: 31959* Thread List Format:: 31960* Traceframe Info Format:: 31961@end menu 31962 31963@node Overview 31964@section Overview 31965 31966There may be occasions when you need to know something about the 31967protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target 31968machine, you might want your program to do something special if it 31969recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}. 31970 31971In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate 31972transmitted and received data, respectively. 31973 31974@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial 31975@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote 31976@cindex remote serial protocol 31977All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments 31978and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a 31979@var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character 31980@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character 31981@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}: 31982 31983@smallexample 31984@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 31985@end smallexample 31986@noindent 31987 31988@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote 31989@noindent 31990The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all 31991characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an 31992eight bit unsigned checksum). 31993 31994Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol 31995specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}: 31996 31997@smallexample 31998@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 31999@end smallexample 32000 32001@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote 32002@noindent 32003That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN} 32004has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added 32005since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}. 32006 32007When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first 32008response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 32009the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request 32010retransmission): 32011 32012@smallexample 32013-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 32014<- @code{+} 32015@end smallexample 32016@noindent 32017 32018The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled 32019once a connection is established. 32020@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details. 32021 32022The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the 32023debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In 32024the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent 32025when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all 32026threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode 32027behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop 32028execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details. 32029 32030@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the 32031exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional 32032exceptions). 32033 32034@cindex remote protocol, field separator 32035Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or 32036@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in 32037@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed. 32038 32039Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character 32040@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it 32041would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}). 32042 32043@cindex remote protocol, binary data 32044@anchor{Binary Data} 32045Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal 32046digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote 32047protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean. 32048Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean 32049connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive 32050binary data. 32051 32052The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}) 32053as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape 32054character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}. 32055For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two 32056bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}), 32057@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii} 32058@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub 32059must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it 32060is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence 32061(described next). 32062 32063Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. 32064Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one 32065instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a 32066repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid 32067binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as 32068@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this 32069produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii} 32070code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length 32071encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example, 32072@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character 32073after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 = 320743}} more times. 32075 32076The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value 32077greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or 32078seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only 32079five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as 32080@samp{0*"00}. 32081 32082The error response returned for some packets includes a two character 32083error number. That number is not well defined. 32084 32085@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets 32086For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response 32087(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the 32088protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based 32089on that response. 32090 32091A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M}, 32092@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are 32093optional. 32094 32095@node Packets 32096@section Packets 32097 32098The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined 32099@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}. 32100@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File 32101I/O extension of the remote protocol. 32102 32103Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall 32104syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We 32105include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not 32106part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to 32107separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo 32108@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII 32109bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a 32110@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the 32111@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the 32112@var{baz}. 32113 32114@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol 32115@anchor{thread-id syntax} 32116Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify 32117a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific 32118interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id} 32119can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to 32120pick any thread. 32121 32122In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in 32123which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both 32124process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}. 32125The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the 32126format described above: a positive number with target-specific 32127interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1} 32128to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to 32129indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as 32130@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an 32131error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as 32132@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used 32133for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process 32134ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}. 32135 32136The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both 32137@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess} 32138feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for 32139more information. 32140 32141Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case 32142letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use. 32143 32144Here are the packet descriptions. 32145 32146@table @samp 32147 32148@item ! 32149@cindex @samp{!} packet 32150@anchor{extended mode} 32151Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made 32152persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being 32153debugged. 32154 32155Reply: 32156@table @samp 32157@item OK 32158The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode. 32159@end table 32160 32161@item ? 32162@cindex @samp{?} packet 32163Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for 32164step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the 32165target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}. 32166 32167Reply: 32168@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32169 32170@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{} 32171@cindex @samp{A} packet 32172Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen} 32173specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream 32174@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details. 32175 32176Reply: 32177@table @samp 32178@item OK 32179The arguments were set. 32180@item E @var{NN} 32181An error occurred. 32182@end table 32183 32184@item b @var{baud} 32185@cindex @samp{b} packet 32186(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.) 32187Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. 32188 32189JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's 32190received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are 32191problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.} 32192 32193Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get 32194it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send 32195some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the 32196switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point 32197of view, nothing actually happened.} 32198 32199@item B @var{addr},@var{mode} 32200@cindex @samp{B} packet 32201Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a 32202breakpoint at @var{addr}. 32203 32204Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead 32205(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}). 32206 32207@cindex @samp{bc} packet 32208@anchor{bc} 32209@item bc 32210Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter. 32211@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 32212 32213Reply: 32214@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32215 32216@cindex @samp{bs} packet 32217@anchor{bs} 32218@item bs 32219Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter. 32220@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 32221 32222Reply: 32223@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32224 32225@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 32226@cindex @samp{c} packet 32227Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, 32228resume at current address. 32229 32230Reply: 32231@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32232 32233@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 32234@cindex @samp{C} packet 32235Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If 32236@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address. 32237 32238Reply: 32239@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32240 32241@item d 32242@cindex @samp{d} packet 32243Toggle debug flag. 32244 32245Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet 32246(@pxref{General Query Packets}). 32247 32248@item D 32249@itemx D;@var{pid} 32250@cindex @samp{D} packet 32251The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the 32252remote system. It is sent to the remote target 32253before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command. 32254 32255The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess 32256protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to 32257detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a 32258big-endian hex string. 32259 32260Reply: 32261@table @samp 32262@item OK 32263for success 32264@item E @var{NN} 32265for an error 32266@end table 32267 32268@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX} 32269@cindex @samp{F} packet 32270A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target. 32271This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O 32272Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification. 32273 32274@item g 32275@anchor{read registers packet} 32276@cindex @samp{g} packet 32277Read general registers. 32278 32279Reply: 32280@table @samp 32281@item @var{XX@dots{}} 32282Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes 32283with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of 32284each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are 32285determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions 32286@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The 32287specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below. 32288 32289When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected 32290Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of 32291literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate 32292that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value 32293is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of 322944 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that 32295registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3 32296have been collected, and both have zero value: 32297 32298@smallexample 32299-> @code{g} 32300<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000} 32301@end smallexample 32302 32303@item E @var{NN} 32304for an error. 32305@end table 32306 32307@item G @var{XX@dots{}} 32308@cindex @samp{G} packet 32309Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a 32310description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data. 32311 32312Reply: 32313@table @samp 32314@item OK 32315for success 32316@item E @var{NN} 32317for an error 32318@end table 32319 32320@item H @var{c} @var{thread-id} 32321@cindex @samp{H} packet 32322Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g}, 32323@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it 32324should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other 32325operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and 32326interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 32327 32328Reply: 32329@table @samp 32330@item OK 32331for success 32332@item E @var{NN} 32333for an error 32334@end table 32335 32336@c FIXME: JTC: 32337@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a 32338@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed 32339@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the 32340@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be 32341@c described. For example: 32342@c 32343@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 32344@c selected, returns the register block from that thread; 32345@c otherwise returns current registers. 32346@c 32347@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 32348@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of 32349@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers. 32350 32351@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]} 32352@anchor{cycle step packet} 32353@cindex @samp{i} packet 32354Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is 32355present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle 32356step starting at that address. 32357 32358@item I 32359@cindex @samp{I} packet 32360Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle 32361step packet}. 32362 32363@item k 32364@cindex @samp{k} packet 32365Kill request. 32366 32367FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific 32368thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that 32369thread?)}. 32370 32371@item m @var{addr},@var{length} 32372@cindex @samp{m} packet 32373Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}. 32374Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary. 32375 32376The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering 32377data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned 32378and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to 32379use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be 32380suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices. 32381@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses 32382@cindex size of remote memory accesses 32383@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses 32384 32385Reply: 32386@table @samp 32387@item @var{XX@dots{}} 32388Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal 32389number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the 32390server was able to read only part of the region of memory. 32391@item E @var{NN} 32392@var{NN} is errno 32393@end table 32394 32395@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 32396@cindex @samp{M} packet 32397Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}. 32398@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit 32399hexadecimal number. 32400 32401Reply: 32402@table @samp 32403@item OK 32404for success 32405@item E @var{NN} 32406for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was 32407written). 32408@end table 32409 32410@item p @var{n} 32411@cindex @samp{p} packet 32412Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex. 32413@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned 32414register value is encoded. 32415 32416Reply: 32417@table @samp 32418@item @var{XX@dots{}} 32419the register's value 32420@item E @var{NN} 32421for an error 32422@item 32423Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}. 32424@end table 32425 32426@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}} 32427@anchor{write register packet} 32428@cindex @samp{P} packet 32429Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register 32430number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex 32431digits for each byte in the register (target byte order). 32432 32433Reply: 32434@table @samp 32435@item OK 32436for success 32437@item E @var{NN} 32438for an error 32439@end table 32440 32441@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 32442@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 32443@cindex @samp{q} packet 32444@cindex @samp{Q} packet 32445General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are 32446described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}. 32447 32448@item r 32449@cindex @samp{r} packet 32450Reset the entire system. 32451 32452Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead. 32453 32454@item R @var{XX} 32455@cindex @samp{R} packet 32456Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored. 32457This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 32458 32459The @samp{R} packet has no reply. 32460 32461@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 32462@cindex @samp{s} packet 32463Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If 32464@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address. 32465 32466Reply: 32467@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32468 32469@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 32470@anchor{step with signal packet} 32471@cindex @samp{S} packet 32472Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but 32473requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution. 32474 32475Reply: 32476@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32477 32478@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM} 32479@cindex @samp{t} packet 32480Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern 32481@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes. 32482@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits. 32483 32484@item T @var{thread-id} 32485@cindex @samp{T} packet 32486Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 32487 32488Reply: 32489@table @samp 32490@item OK 32491thread is still alive 32492@item E @var{NN} 32493thread is dead 32494@end table 32495 32496@item v 32497Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name, 32498up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet). 32499 32500@item vAttach;@var{pid} 32501@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet 32502Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}. 32503The process ID is a 32504hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all 32505threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be 32506attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target. 32507 32508@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the 32509@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After 32510@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC. 32511@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the 32512@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you 32513@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not 32514@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either 32515@c stopping or restarting threads. 32516 32517This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 32518 32519Reply: 32520@table @samp 32521@item E @var{nn} 32522for an error 32523@item @r{Any stop packet} 32524for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 32525@item OK 32526for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) 32527@end table 32528 32529@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{} 32530@cindex @samp{vCont} packet 32531Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread. 32532If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any 32533threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is 32534specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and 32535in their current state in non-stop mode. 32536Specifying multiple 32537default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error. 32538Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 32539 32540Currently supported actions are: 32541 32542@table @samp 32543@item c 32544Continue. 32545@item C @var{sig} 32546Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 32547@item s 32548Step. 32549@item S @var{sig} 32550Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 32551@item t 32552Stop. 32553@end table 32554 32555The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the 32556@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is 32557not supported in @samp{vCont}. 32558 32559The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode 32560(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise. 32561A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped. 32562When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action, 32563the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with 32564signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal 32565as an implementation detail. 32566 32567Reply: 32568@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 32569 32570@item vCont? 32571@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet 32572Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet. 32573 32574Reply: 32575@table @samp 32576@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]} 32577The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported 32578command in the @samp{vCont} packet. 32579@item 32580The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported. 32581@end table 32582 32583@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{} 32584@cindex @samp{vFile} packet 32585Perform a file operation on the target system. For details, 32586see @ref{Host I/O Packets}. 32587 32588@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length} 32589@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet 32590Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at 32591@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but 32592its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the 32593flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map 32594Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations 32595together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the 32596stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone} 32597packet is received. 32598 32599The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for 32600multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in 32601this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads 32602in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the 32603@var{thread-id}. 32604 32605Reply: 32606@table @samp 32607@item OK 32608for success 32609@item E @var{NN} 32610for an error 32611@end table 32612 32613@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}} 32614@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet 32615Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data 32616is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X} 32617packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by 32618@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must 32619not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses 32620(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already 32621have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between 32622@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was 32623neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other 32624target-specific method, the results are unpredictable. 32625 32626 32627Reply: 32628@table @samp 32629@item OK 32630for success 32631@item E.memtype 32632for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory 32633@item E @var{NN} 32634for an error 32635@end table 32636 32637@item vFlashDone 32638@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet 32639Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished. 32640The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of 32641@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a 32642@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected 32643regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone} 32644request is completed. 32645 32646@item vKill;@var{pid} 32647@cindex @samp{vKill} packet 32648Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a 32649hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in 32650preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are 32651supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}. 32652 32653Reply: 32654@table @samp 32655@item E @var{nn} 32656for an error 32657@item OK 32658for success 32659@end table 32660 32661@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{} 32662@cindex @samp{vRun} packet 32663Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its 32664command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If 32665@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program 32666(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped 32667state. 32668 32669@c FIXME: What about non-stop mode? 32670 32671This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 32672 32673Reply: 32674@table @samp 32675@item E @var{nn} 32676for an error 32677@item @r{Any stop packet} 32678for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 32679@end table 32680 32681@item vStopped 32682@anchor{vStopped packet} 32683@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet 32684 32685In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop 32686reply and prompt for the stub to report another one. 32687 32688Reply: 32689@table @samp 32690@item @r{Any stop packet} 32691if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 32692@item OK 32693if there are no unreported stop events 32694@end table 32695 32696@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 32697@anchor{X packet} 32698@cindex @samp{X} packet 32699Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary. 32700@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, 32701@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 32702 32703Reply: 32704@table @samp 32705@item OK 32706for success 32707@item E @var{NN} 32708for an error 32709@end table 32710 32711@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 32712@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 32713@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet} 32714@cindex @samp{z} packet 32715@cindex @samp{Z} packets 32716Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or 32717watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}. 32718 32719Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented 32720separately. 32721 32722@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string 32723for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A 32724remote target shall support either both or neither of a given 32725@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To 32726avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should 32727be implemented in an idempotent way.} 32728 32729@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32730@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32731@cindex @samp{z0} packet 32732@cindex @samp{Z0} packet 32733Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address 32734@var{addr} of type @var{kind}. 32735 32736A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at 32737@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The 32738@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of 32739the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} 32740and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some 32741architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}; 32742see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}. 32743 32744@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move 32745code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing 32746overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a 32747target, is not defined.} 32748 32749Reply: 32750@table @samp 32751@item OK 32752success 32753@item 32754not supported 32755@item E @var{NN} 32756for an error 32757@end table 32758 32759@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32760@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32761@cindex @samp{z1} packet 32762@cindex @samp{Z1} packet 32763Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at 32764address @var{addr}. 32765 32766A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not 32767dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind} 32768has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets. 32769 32770@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code 32771movement.} 32772 32773Reply: 32774@table @samp 32775@item OK 32776success 32777@item 32778not supported 32779@item E @var{NN} 32780for an error 32781@end table 32782 32783@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32784@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32785@cindex @samp{z2} packet 32786@cindex @samp{Z2} packet 32787Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}. 32788@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch. 32789 32790Reply: 32791@table @samp 32792@item OK 32793success 32794@item 32795not supported 32796@item E @var{NN} 32797for an error 32798@end table 32799 32800@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32801@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32802@cindex @samp{z3} packet 32803@cindex @samp{Z3} packet 32804Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}. 32805@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch. 32806 32807Reply: 32808@table @samp 32809@item OK 32810success 32811@item 32812not supported 32813@item E @var{NN} 32814for an error 32815@end table 32816 32817@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32818@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 32819@cindex @samp{z4} packet 32820@cindex @samp{Z4} packet 32821Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}. 32822@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch. 32823 32824Reply: 32825@table @samp 32826@item OK 32827success 32828@item 32829not supported 32830@item E @var{NN} 32831for an error 32832@end table 32833 32834@end table 32835 32836@node Stop Reply Packets 32837@section Stop Reply Packets 32838@cindex stop reply packets 32839 32840The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont}, 32841@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can 32842receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?} 32843and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned 32844when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal 32845number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the 32846@value{GDBN} source code. 32847 32848As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the 32849reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's 32850syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its 32851components. 32852 32853@table @samp 32854 32855@item S @var{AA} 32856The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 32857number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no 32858@var{n}:@var{r} pairs. 32859 32860@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{} 32861@cindex @samp{T} packet reply 32862The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 32863number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the 32864@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers 32865and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing 32866round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported 32867this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows: 32868 32869@itemize @bullet 32870@item 32871If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the 32872corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a 32873series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a 32874two-digit hex number. 32875 32876@item 32877If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of 32878the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 32879 32880@item 32881If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of 32882the core on which the stop event was detected. 32883 32884@item 32885If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more 32886specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop 32887reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap 32888signal. At most one stop reason should be present. 32889 32890@item 32891Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair 32892and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the 32893future. 32894@end itemize 32895 32896The currently defined stop reasons are: 32897 32898@table @samp 32899@item watch 32900@itemx rwatch 32901@itemx awatch 32902The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in 32903hex. 32904 32905@cindex shared library events, remote reply 32906@item library 32907The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed. 32908@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new 32909list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored. 32910 32911@cindex replay log events, remote reply 32912@item replaylog 32913The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying 32914logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the 32915beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r} 32916will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution}, 32917for more information. 32918@end table 32919 32920@item W @var{AA} 32921@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 32922The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only 32923applicable to certain targets. 32924 32925The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited 32926process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for 32927multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}. 32928The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string. 32929 32930@item X @var{AA} 32931@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 32932The process terminated with signal @var{AA}. 32933 32934The second form of the response, including the process ID of the 32935terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported 32936support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess 32937extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string. 32938 32939@item O @var{XX}@dots{} 32940@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be 32941written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time 32942while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait 32943for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode. 32944 32945@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{} 32946@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should 32947be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the 32948correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}. 32949@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented 32950system calls. 32951 32952@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for 32953this very system call. 32954 32955The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to 32956call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies 32957with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next 32958reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 32959or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote 32960Protocol Extension}, for more details. 32961 32962@end table 32963 32964@node General Query Packets 32965@section General Query Packets 32966@cindex remote query requests 32967 32968Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets}; 32969packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General 32970query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and 32971sending information to and from the stub. 32972 32973The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name 32974indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example, 32975@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol 32976definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some 32977conventions: 32978 32979@itemize @bullet 32980@item 32981The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons. 32982@item 32983Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case 32984letter. 32985@item 32986The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in 32987lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at 32988the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying 32989foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars). 32990@end itemize 32991 32992The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any 32993parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be 32994separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the 32995full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet, 32996in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin 32997with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL} 32998packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator 32999for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that 33000are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some 33001existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the 33002packet.}. 33003 33004Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here 33005has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an 33006explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the 33007templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No 33008@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components. 33009 33010Here are the currently defined query and set packets: 33011 33012@table @samp 33013 33014@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{} 33015@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet 33016Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the 33017target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value 33018pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg}, 33019@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace}, 33020@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0, 33021indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1, 33022indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its 33023own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to 33024insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.) 33025 33026@item qC 33027@cindex current thread, remote request 33028@cindex @samp{qC} packet 33029Return the current thread ID. 33030 33031Reply: 33032@table @samp 33033@item QC @var{thread-id} 33034Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in 33035@ref{thread-id syntax}. 33036@item @r{(anything else)} 33037Any other reply implies the old thread ID. 33038@end table 33039 33040@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length} 33041@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request 33042@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet 33043Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in 33044IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most 33045significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code 33046@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC. 33047 33048@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug 33049files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate 33050Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating 33051separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least} 33052significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to 33053detect trailing zeros. 33054 33055Reply: 33056@table @samp 33057@item E @var{NN} 33058An error (such as memory fault) 33059@item C @var{crc32} 33060The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}. 33061@end table 33062 33063@item qfThreadInfo 33064@itemx qsThreadInfo 33065@cindex list active threads, remote request 33066@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet 33067@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet 33068Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there 33069may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query 33070works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to 33071obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will 33072be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the 33073sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query. 33074 33075NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below). 33076 33077Reply: 33078@table @samp 33079@item m @var{thread-id} 33080A single thread ID 33081@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{} 33082a comma-separated list of thread IDs 33083@item l 33084(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 33085@end table 33086 33087In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 33088more thread IDs, separated by commas. 33089@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread 33090ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds 33091with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}). 33092Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id} 33093fields. 33094 33095@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm} 33096@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request 33097@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet 33098Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified 33099by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}. 33100 33101@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the 33102thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 33103 33104@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the 33105thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug 33106information associated with the variable.) 33107 33108@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the 33109the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example, 33110a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared 33111object associated with the thread local storage under consideration. 33112Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module 33113differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary. 33114 33115Reply: 33116@table @samp 33117@item @var{XX}@dots{} 33118Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread 33119local storage requested. 33120 33121@item E @var{nn} 33122An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 33123 33124@item 33125An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub. 33126@end table 33127 33128@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id} 33129@cindex get thread information block address 33130@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet 33131Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block. 33132 33133@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread. 33134 33135Reply: 33136@table @samp 33137@item @var{XX}@dots{} 33138Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the 33139thread information block. 33140 33141@item E @var{nn} 33142An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the 33143address could not be retrieved. 33144 33145@item 33146An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub. 33147@end table 33148 33149@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread} 33150Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex 33151digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a 33152subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum 33153number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread} 33154(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is 33155returned in the response as @var{argthread}. 33156 33157Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above). 33158 33159Reply: 33160@table @samp 33161@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{} 33162Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being 33163returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads 33164and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex 33165digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{} 33166is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex 33167digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}. 33168@end table 33169 33170@item qOffsets 33171@cindex section offsets, remote request 33172@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet 33173Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded 33174image. 33175 33176Reply: 33177@table @samp 33178@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]} 33179Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address. 33180Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address. 33181If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf} 33182@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire 33183segments by the supplied offsets. 33184 33185@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response, 33186@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset 33187to the @code{Bss} section.} 33188 33189@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]} 33190Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally 33191contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If 33192@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which 33193conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of 33194@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file 33195does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least 33196as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are 33197kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment. 33198@end table 33199 33200@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id} 33201@cindex thread information, remote request 33202@cindex @samp{qP} packet 33203Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex 33204encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID 33205(@pxref{thread-id syntax}). 33206 33207Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead 33208(see below). 33209 33210Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}. 33211 33212@item QNonStop:1 33213@item QNonStop:0 33214@cindex non-stop mode, remote request 33215@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet 33216@anchor{QNonStop} 33217Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode. 33218@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information. 33219 33220Reply: 33221@table @samp 33222@item OK 33223The request succeeded. 33224 33225@item E @var{nn} 33226An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 33227 33228@item 33229An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by 33230the stub. 33231@end table 33232 33233This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33234by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33235Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command; 33236@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}. 33237 33238@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{} 33239@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request 33240@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet 33241@anchor{QPassSignals} 33242Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process. 33243Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies 33244(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be 33245strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop 33246the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be 33247reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not 33248combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the 33249new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle 33250@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}. 33251 33252Reply: 33253@table @samp 33254@item OK 33255The request succeeded. 33256 33257@item E @var{nn} 33258An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 33259 33260@item 33261An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by 33262the stub. 33263@end table 33264 33265Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals} 33266command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}). 33267This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33268by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33269 33270@item qRcmd,@var{command} 33271@cindex execute remote command, remote request 33272@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet 33273@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for 33274execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output 33275string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond 33276with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output 33277packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a 33278stubs's interpreter may have security implications}. 33279 33280Reply: 33281@table @samp 33282@item OK 33283A command response with no output. 33284@item @var{OUTPUT} 33285A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}. 33286@item E @var{NN} 33287Indicate a badly formed request. 33288@item 33289An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized. 33290@end table 33291 33292(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the 33293command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 33294conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 33295packets.) 33296 33297@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern} 33298@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging 33299@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet 33300@anchor{qSearch memory} 33301Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}. 33302@var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex. 33303@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded. 33304 33305Reply: 33306@table @samp 33307@item 0 33308The pattern was not found. 33309@item 1,address 33310The pattern was found at @var{address}. 33311@item E @var{NN} 33312A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory. 33313@item 33314An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized. 33315@end table 33316 33317@item QStartNoAckMode 33318@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet 33319@anchor{QStartNoAckMode} 33320Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-} 33321protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}). 33322 33323Reply: 33324@table @samp 33325@item OK 33326The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode. 33327@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse, 33328but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further 33329@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection. 33330@item 33331An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode. 33332@end table 33333 33334@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]} 33335@cindex supported packets, remote query 33336@cindex features of the remote protocol 33337@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet 33338@anchor{qSupported} 33339Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and 33340query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows 33341@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others' 33342features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes 33343at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger 33344packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on 33345high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not 33346be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or 33347stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be 33348automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be 33349reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default 33350unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it 33351helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new 33352versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets. 33353 33354Reply: 33355@table @samp 33356@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{} 33357The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature}, 33358depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the 33359possible forms). 33360@item 33361An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized, 33362or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}. 33363@end table 33364 33365The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the 33366@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response) 33367are: 33368 33369@table @samp 33370@item @var{name}=@var{value} 33371The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated 33372with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends 33373on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon. 33374@item @var{name}+ 33375The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not 33376need an associated value. 33377@item @var{name}- 33378The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported. 33379@item @var{name}? 33380The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and 33381@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is 33382needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications, 33383but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses. 33384@end table 33385 33386Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the 33387supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous 33388request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known 33389state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with 33390a different version of @value{GDBN}. 33391 33392The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN}) 33393are defined: 33394 33395@table @samp 33396@item multiprocess 33397This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess 33398extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 33399extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 33400including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 33401@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details. 33402 33403@item xmlRegisters 33404This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target 33405description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target 33406specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register 33407description. 33408 33409@item qRelocInsn 33410This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the 33411@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 33412instruction reply packet}). 33413@end table 33414 33415Stubs should ignore any unknown values for 33416@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported} 33417packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier 33418versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values 33419for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take 33420advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible 33421improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is 33422an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent 33423of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN} 33424describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with 33425all the features it supports. 33426 33427Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature 33428responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms. 33429 33430Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature 33431should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features 33432require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=} 33433form response. 33434 33435Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if 33436@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned 33437in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a 33438stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults. 33439 33440Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing 33441mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal 33442architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information 33443about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in 33444stubs which may be configured for multiple targets. 33445 33446These are the currently defined stub features and their properties: 33447 33448@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2 33449@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require 33450@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem. 33451@item Feature Name 33452@tab Value Required 33453@tab Default 33454@tab Probe Allowed 33455 33456@item @samp{PacketSize} 33457@tab Yes 33458@tab @samp{-} 33459@tab No 33460 33461@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} 33462@tab No 33463@tab @samp{-} 33464@tab Yes 33465 33466@item @samp{qXfer:features:read} 33467@tab No 33468@tab @samp{-} 33469@tab Yes 33470 33471@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 33472@tab No 33473@tab @samp{-} 33474@tab Yes 33475 33476@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 33477@tab No 33478@tab @samp{-} 33479@tab Yes 33480 33481@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} 33482@tab No 33483@tab @samp{-} 33484@tab Yes 33485 33486@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read} 33487@tab No 33488@tab @samp{-} 33489@tab Yes 33490 33491@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write} 33492@tab No 33493@tab @samp{-} 33494@tab Yes 33495 33496@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} 33497@tab No 33498@tab @samp{-} 33499@tab Yes 33500 33501@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} 33502@tab No 33503@tab @samp{-} 33504@tab Yes 33505 33506@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read} 33507@tab No 33508@tab @samp{-} 33509@tab Yes 33510 33511@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 33512@tab No 33513@tab @samp{-} 33514@tab Yes 33515 33516 33517@item @samp{QNonStop} 33518@tab No 33519@tab @samp{-} 33520@tab Yes 33521 33522@item @samp{QPassSignals} 33523@tab No 33524@tab @samp{-} 33525@tab Yes 33526 33527@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode} 33528@tab No 33529@tab @samp{-} 33530@tab Yes 33531 33532@item @samp{multiprocess} 33533@tab No 33534@tab @samp{-} 33535@tab No 33536 33537@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints} 33538@tab No 33539@tab @samp{-} 33540@tab No 33541 33542@item @samp{ReverseContinue} 33543@tab No 33544@tab @samp{-} 33545@tab No 33546 33547@item @samp{ReverseStep} 33548@tab No 33549@tab @samp{-} 33550@tab No 33551 33552@item @samp{TracepointSource} 33553@tab No 33554@tab @samp{-} 33555@tab No 33556 33557@item @samp{QAllow} 33558@tab No 33559@tab @samp{-} 33560@tab No 33561 33562@end multitable 33563 33564These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail: 33565 33566@table @samp 33567@cindex packet size, remote protocol 33568@item PacketSize=@var{bytes} 33569The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in 33570length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk 33571transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the 33572data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum. 33573There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub 33574stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra 33575byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported, 33576@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response. 33577 33578@item qXfer:auxv:read 33579The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet 33580(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}). 33581 33582@item qXfer:features:read 33583The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet 33584(@pxref{qXfer target description read}). 33585 33586@item qXfer:libraries:read 33587The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet 33588(@pxref{qXfer library list read}). 33589 33590@item qXfer:memory-map:read 33591The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet 33592(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}). 33593 33594@item qXfer:sdata:read 33595The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet 33596(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}). 33597 33598@item qXfer:spu:read 33599The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet 33600(@pxref{qXfer spu read}). 33601 33602@item qXfer:spu:write 33603The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet 33604(@pxref{qXfer spu write}). 33605 33606@item qXfer:siginfo:read 33607The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet 33608(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}). 33609 33610@item qXfer:siginfo:write 33611The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet 33612(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}). 33613 33614@item qXfer:threads:read 33615The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 33616(@pxref{qXfer threads read}). 33617 33618@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read 33619The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 33620packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}). 33621 33622@item QNonStop 33623The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet 33624(@pxref{QNonStop}). 33625 33626@item QPassSignals 33627The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet 33628(@pxref{QPassSignals}). 33629 33630@item QStartNoAckMode 33631The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and 33632prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}. 33633 33634@item multiprocess 33635@anchor{multiprocess extensions} 33636@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol 33637The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote 33638protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of 33639thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and 33640add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X} 33641replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the 33642syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports 33643debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use 33644multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also 33645indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request. 33646 33647@item qXfer:osdata:read 33648The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet 33649((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}). 33650 33651@item ConditionalTracepoints 33652The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined 33653for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}). 33654 33655@item ReverseContinue 33656The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet 33657(@pxref{bc}). 33658 33659@item ReverseStep 33660The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet 33661(@pxref{bs}). 33662 33663@item TracepointSource 33664The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies 33665the source form of tracepoint definitions. 33666 33667@item QAllow 33668The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet. 33669 33670@item StaticTracepoint 33671@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol 33672The remote stub supports static tracepoints. 33673 33674@end table 33675 33676@item qSymbol:: 33677@cindex symbol lookup, remote request 33678@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet 33679Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup 33680requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols. 33681 33682Reply: 33683@table @samp 33684@item OK 33685The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 33686@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 33687The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded). 33688@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the 33689@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described 33690below. 33691@end table 33692 33693@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} 33694Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}. 33695 33696@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the 33697target has previously requested. 33698 33699@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If 33700@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field 33701will be empty. 33702 33703Reply: 33704@table @samp 33705@item OK 33706The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 33707@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 33708The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex 33709encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols 33710(if available), until the target ceases to request them. 33711@end table 33712 33713@item qTBuffer 33714@item QTBuffer 33715@item QTDisconnected 33716@itemx QTDP 33717@itemx QTDPsrc 33718@itemx QTDV 33719@itemx qTfP 33720@itemx qTfV 33721@itemx QTFrame 33722@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 33723 33724@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id} 33725@cindex thread attributes info, remote request 33726@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet 33727Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from 33728the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID; 33729see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This 33730string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting 33731for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is 33732displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some 33733examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or 33734@samp{Blocked on Mutex}. 33735 33736Reply: 33737@table @samp 33738@item @var{XX}@dots{} 33739Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, 33740comprising the printable string containing the extra information about 33741the thread's attributes. 33742@end table 33743 33744(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from 33745the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 33746conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 33747packets.) 33748 33749@item QTSave 33750@item qTsP 33751@item qTsV 33752@itemx QTStart 33753@itemx QTStop 33754@itemx QTinit 33755@itemx QTro 33756@itemx qTStatus 33757@itemx qTV 33758@itemx qTfSTM 33759@itemx qTsSTM 33760@itemx qTSTMat 33761@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 33762 33763@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 33764@cindex read special object, remote request 33765@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet 33766@anchor{qXfer read} 33767Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area 33768identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes 33769starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and 33770encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply 33771additional details about what data to access. 33772 33773Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All 33774@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 33775formats, listed below. 33776 33777@table @samp 33778@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33779@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read} 33780Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information, 33781auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty. 33782 33783This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33784by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33785 33786@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 33787@anchor{qXfer target description read} 33788Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The 33789annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is 33790always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex. 33791 33792This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33793by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33794 33795@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 33796@anchor{qXfer library list read} 33797Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}. 33798The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 33799(@pxref{qXfer read}). 33800 33801Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do 33802not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where 33803the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries. 33804 33805This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33806by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33807 33808@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33809@anchor{qXfer memory map read} 33810Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The 33811annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 33812(@pxref{qXfer read}). 33813 33814This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33815by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33816 33817@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33818@anchor{qXfer sdata read} 33819 33820Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker 33821information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must 33822be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint 33823Action Lists}. 33824 33825This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33826by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 33827(@pxref{qSupported}). 33828 33829@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33830@anchor{qXfer siginfo read} 33831Read contents of the extra signal information on the target 33832system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 33833empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 33834 33835This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33836by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 33837(@pxref{qSupported}). 33838 33839@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 33840@anchor{qXfer spu read} 33841Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 33842annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form 33843@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 33844in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 33845in that context to be accessed. 33846 33847This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33848by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 33849(@pxref{qSupported}). 33850 33851@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33852@anchor{qXfer threads read} 33853Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The 33854annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 33855(@pxref{qXfer read}). 33856 33857This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33858by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33859 33860@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33861@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read} 33862 33863Return a description of the current traceframe's contents. 33864@xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic 33865@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 33866 33867This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33868by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33869 33870@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 33871@anchor{qXfer osdata read} 33872Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}. 33873@xref{Operating System Information}. 33874 33875@end table 33876 33877Reply: 33878@table @samp 33879@item m @var{data} 33880Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the 33881target. There may be more data at a higher address (although 33882it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid 33883block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read). 33884@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the 33885request. 33886 33887@item l @var{data} 33888Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target. 33889There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes 33890than the @var{length} in the request. 33891 33892@item l 33893The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data. 33894There is no more data to be read. 33895 33896@item E00 33897The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 33898 33899@item E @var{nn} 33900The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data. 33901@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 33902 33903@item 33904An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by 33905the stub, or that the object does not support reading. 33906@end table 33907 33908@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 33909@cindex write data into object, remote request 33910@anchor{qXfer write} 33911Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area 33912identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes 33913into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data 33914(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex} 33915is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data 33916to access. 33917 33918Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All 33919@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 33920formats, listed below. 33921 33922@table @samp 33923@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 33924@anchor{qXfer siginfo write} 33925Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system. 33926The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 33927empty (@pxref{qXfer write}). 33928 33929This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33930by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 33931(@pxref{qSupported}). 33932 33933@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 33934@anchor{qXfer spu write} 33935Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 33936annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form 33937@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 33938in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 33939in that context to be accessed. 33940 33941This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 33942by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 33943@end table 33944 33945Reply: 33946@table @samp 33947@item @var{nn} 33948@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written. 33949This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request. 33950 33951@item E00 33952The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 33953 33954@item E @var{nn} 33955The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data. 33956@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 33957 33958@item 33959An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not 33960recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing. 33961@end table 33962 33963@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{} 33964Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does 33965not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for 33966@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub 33967must respond with an empty packet. 33968 33969@item qAttached:@var{pid} 33970@cindex query attached, remote request 33971@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet 33972Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an 33973existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess 33974protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), 33975@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target 33976process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and 33977the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}. 33978 33979This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process 33980should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with 33981the @code{quit} command. 33982 33983Reply: 33984@table @samp 33985@item 1 33986The remote server attached to an existing process. 33987@item 0 33988The remote server created a new process. 33989@item E @var{NN} 33990A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 33991@end table 33992 33993@end table 33994 33995@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 33996@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 33997 33998This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific 33999target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for 34000details of XML target descriptions for each architecture. 34001 34002@subsection ARM 34003 34004@subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds 34005 34006These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets. 34007 34008@table @r 34009 34010@item 2 3401116-bit Thumb mode breakpoint. 34012 34013@item 3 3401432-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint. 34015 34016@item 4 3401732-bit ARM mode breakpoint. 34018 34019@end table 34020 34021@subsection MIPS 34022 34023@subsubsection Register Packet Format 34024 34025The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined. 34026In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as 34027sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) 34028to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target 34029byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred 34030most-significant - least-significant. 34031 34032@table @r 34033 34034@item MIPS32 34035 34036All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order: 3403732 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point 34038registers; fsr; fir; fp. 34039 34040@item MIPS64 34041 34042All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including 34043thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same 34044as @code{MIPS32}. 34045 34046@end table 34047 34048@node Tracepoint Packets 34049@section Tracepoint Packets 34050@cindex tracepoint packets 34051@cindex packets, tracepoint 34052 34053Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement 34054tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}). 34055 34056@table @samp 34057 34058@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]} 34059Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena} 34060is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then 34061the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step 34062count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present, 34063then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is 34064the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room 34065for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a 34066tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed 34067by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action 34068encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present, 34069further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's 34070actions. 34071 34072Replies: 34073@table @samp 34074@item OK 34075The packet was understood and carried out. 34076@item qRelocInsn 34077@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 34078@item 34079The packet was not recognized. 34080@end table 34081 34082@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]} 34083Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and 34084@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for 34085this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after 34086another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the 34087trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow, 34088specifying more actions for this tracepoint. 34089 34090In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one 34091can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet 34092is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping'' 34093actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those 34094taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an 34095@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary 34096tracepoint actions. 34097 34098The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of 34099actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the 34100following forms: 34101 34102@table @samp 34103 34104@item R @var{mask} 34105Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is 34106a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number 34107@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered 34108zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may 34109not fit in a 32-bit word. 34110 34111@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len} 34112Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register 34113number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is 34114@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the 34115address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg}, 34116@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal 34117values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case). 34118 34119@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 34120Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as 34121it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in 34122@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a 34123two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes 34124in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the 34125packet). 34126 34127@end table 34128 34129Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP} 34130packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet 34131length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R} 34132action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X} 34133actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions 34134must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The 34135``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a 34136separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.) 34137 34138Replies: 34139@table @samp 34140@item OK 34141The packet was understood and carried out. 34142@item qRelocInsn 34143@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 34144@item 34145The packet was not recognized. 34146@end table 34147 34148@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes} 34149@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet 34150Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}. 34151This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints 34152originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type} 34153is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the 34154tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while 34155@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal. 34156 34157@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source 34158string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string. 34159This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will 34160fit in a single packet. 34161@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated 34162@c tracepoint descriptions section. 34163 34164The available string types are @samp{at} for the location, 34165@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command. 34166@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action 34167list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list. 34168 34169The target does not need to do anything with source strings except 34170report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP} 34171query packets. 34172 34173Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it 34174if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General 34175Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files 34176much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the 34177tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to 34178the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy 34179could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not 34180be found. 34181 34182@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value} 34183@cindex define trace state variable, remote request 34184@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet 34185Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial 34186value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n} 34187and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has 34188the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the 34189target should simply create the trace state variables as they are 34190mentioned in expressions. 34191 34192@item QTFrame:@var{n} 34193Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the 34194register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent 34195request packets from @value{GDBN}. 34196 34197A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the 34198requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated 34199without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has 34200one of the following forms: 34201 34202@table @samp 34203@item F @var{f} 34204The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer; 34205@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there 34206was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet. 34207 34208@item T @var{t} 34209The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t}; 34210@var{t} is a hexadecimal number. 34211 34212@end table 34213 34214@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr} 34215Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 34216currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr}; 34217@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number. 34218 34219@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t} 34220Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 34221currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t} 34222is a hexadecimal number. 34223 34224@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end} 34225Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 34226currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive) 34227and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal 34228numbers. 34229 34230@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end} 34231Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first 34232frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive). 34233 34234@item QTStart 34235Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from 34236tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the 34237@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 34238instruction reply packet}). 34239 34240@item QTStop 34241End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames. 34242 34243@item QTinit 34244Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer. 34245 34246@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{} 34247Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub 34248will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents, 34249if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit. 34250 34251@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those 34252containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should 34253still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so 34254there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents. 34255 34256@item QTDisconnected:@var{value} 34257Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN} 34258disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to 34259continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if 34260@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture. 34261 34262@item qTStatus 34263Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now. 34264 34265The reply has the form: 34266 34267@table @samp 34268 34269@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{} 34270@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently 34271running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated 34272optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status. 34273 34274@end table 34275 34276If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several 34277explanations as one of the optional fields: 34278 34279@table @samp 34280 34281@item tnotrun:0 34282No trace has been run yet. 34283 34284@item tstop:0 34285The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. 34286 34287@item tfull:0 34288The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up. 34289 34290@item tdisconnected:0 34291The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target. 34292 34293@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum} 34294The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count. 34295 34296@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum} 34297The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The 34298string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error 34299(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression). 34300@var{text} is hex encoded. 34301 34302@item tunknown:0 34303The trace stopped for some other reason. 34304 34305@end table 34306 34307Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information. 34308Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring 34309the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these 34310numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped 34311trace. 34312 34313@table @samp 34314 34315@item tframes:@var{n} 34316The number of trace frames in the buffer. 34317 34318@item tcreated:@var{n} 34319The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may 34320be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular. 34321 34322@item tsize:@var{n} 34323The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes. 34324 34325@item tfree:@var{n} 34326The number of bytes still unused in the buffer. 34327 34328@item circular:@var{n} 34329The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 34330trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 34331necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 34332and may fill up. 34333 34334@item disconn:@var{n} 34335The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 34336tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 34337that the trace run will stop. 34338 34339@end table 34340 34341@item qTV:@var{var} 34342@cindex trace state variable value, remote request 34343@cindex @samp{qTV} packet 34344Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}. 34345 34346Replies: 34347@table @samp 34348@item V@var{value} 34349The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current 34350value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a 34351saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the 34352user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in 34353different reply values, such as when requesting values while the 34354program is running. 34355 34356@item U 34357The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example, 34358if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable 34359was not collected. 34360@end table 34361 34362@item qTfP 34363@itemx qTsP 34364These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by 34365the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece 34366of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies 34367to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets 34368that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax) 34369 34370@item qTfV 34371@itemx qTsV 34372These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the 34373target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data, 34374and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to 34375these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define 34376trace state variables. 34377 34378@item qTfSTM 34379@itemx qTsSTM 34380These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist 34381in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the 34382first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional 34383pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form: 34384 34385Reply: 34386@table @samp 34387@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra} 34388A single marker 34389@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{} 34390a comma-separated list of markers 34391@item l 34392(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 34393@item E @var{nn} 34394An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 34395@item 34396An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the 34397stub. 34398@end table 34399 34400@var{address} is encoded in hex. 34401@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex. 34402 34403In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 34404more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each 34405reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the 34406query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for 34407@dfn{last}). 34408 34409@item qTSTMat:@var{address} 34410This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the 34411target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the 34412syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static 34413tracepoint markers. 34414 34415@item QTSave:@var{filename} 34416This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name 34417@var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded 34418as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs 34419absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target. 34420 34421@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len} 34422Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer, 34423starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were 34424a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format. 34425The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver 34426in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for. 34427A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are 34428available. 34429 34430@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value} 34431This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if 34432@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0. 34433 34434@end table 34435 34436@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet 34437When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to 34438relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a 34439different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is 34440enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the 34441return address on the stack, and relative branches or other 34442PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect 34443of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if 34444it had executed in the original location. 34445 34446In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also 34447respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request 34448packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle 34449this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its 34450documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above 34451descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The 34452format of the request is: 34453 34454@table @samp 34455@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to} 34456 34457This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from} 34458to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the 34459instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at 34460@var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target 34461memory starting at @var{to}. 34462@end table 34463 34464Replies: 34465@table @samp 34466@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size} 34467Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is 34468the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence. 34469@item E @var{NN} 34470A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while 34471relocating the instruction. 34472@end table 34473 34474@node Host I/O Packets 34475@section Host I/O Packets 34476@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol 34477@cindex file transfer, remote protocol 34478 34479The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O 34480operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is 34481used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own 34482filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure 34483layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the 34484Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated 34485protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers. 34486Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the 34487target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol 34488Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol. 34489 34490The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with 34491its arguments. They have this format: 34492 34493@table @samp 34494 34495@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{} 34496@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target 34497should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking 34498for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on 34499the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative 34500numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not 34501used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of 34502hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a 34503buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 34504 34505@end table 34506 34507The valid responses to Host I/O packets are: 34508 34509@table @samp 34510 34511@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}] 34512@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually 34513non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured, 34514@var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a 34515value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For 34516operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a 34517binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the 34518normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet 34519documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and 34520@var{attachment}. 34521 34522@item 34523An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized. 34524 34525@end table 34526 34527These are the supported Host I/O operations: 34528 34529@table @samp 34530@item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode} 34531Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or 34532return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string, 34533@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags 34534(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask 34535of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}). 34536@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values. 34537 34538@item vFile:close: @var{fd} 34539Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or 34540-1 if an error occurs. 34541 34542@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset} 34543Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to 34544@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset} 34545relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes; 34546common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file 34547condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be 34548returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if 34549@var{count} was zero. 34550 34551The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success. 34552If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary 34553attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the 34554number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if 34555some characters were escaped. 34556 34557@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data} 34558Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding 34559to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the 34560file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no 34561separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the 34562packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written, 34563which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an 34564error occurred. 34565 34566@item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname} 34567Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0, 34568or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string. 34569 34570@end table 34571 34572@node Interrupts 34573@section Interrupts 34574@cindex interrupts (remote protocol) 34575 34576When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may 34577attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or 34578a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, 34579control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}. 34580 34581The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport 34582mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not 34583currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network 34584interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the 34585@code{telnet} BREAK sequence. 34586 34587@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all 34588transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte 34589@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in 34590the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is 34591transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data 34592and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet 34593(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped 34594@code{0x03} as part of its packet. 34595 34596@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g. 34597When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port, 34598it stops execution and connects to gdb. 34599 34600Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the 34601precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is 34602implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple 34603threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all 34604currently-executing threads and processes. 34605If the stub is successful at interrupting the 34606running program, it should send one of the stop 34607reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result 34608of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply 34609for each stopped thread in non-stop mode. 34610Interrupts received while the 34611program is stopped are discarded. 34612 34613@node Notification Packets 34614@section Notification Packets 34615@cindex notification packets 34616@cindex packets, notification 34617 34618The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications}, 34619packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub 34620may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at 34621present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information 34622without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so 34623are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss 34624is not a problem. 34625 34626A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} # 34627@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification, 34628and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted 34629as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data} 34630never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon 34631receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-} 34632to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption. 34633 34634Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no 34635colon characters, followed by a colon character. 34636 34637Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and 34638notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart 34639timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or 34640not they understand it. 34641 34642Senders should only send the notifications described here when this 34643protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the 34644future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in 34645new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer 34646recipients. 34647 34648(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see 34649the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may 34650transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There 34651are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we 34652assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.) 34653 34654The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are 34655defined: 34656 34657@table @samp 34658@item Stop: @var{reply} 34659Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode. 34660The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as 34661described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, 34662for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by 34663@value{GDBN}. 34664@end table 34665 34666@node Remote Non-Stop 34667@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode 34668 34669@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of 34670multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub 34671supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including 34672@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 34673 34674@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when 34675establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode 34676does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets 34677must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering 34678all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to 34679probe the target state after a mode change. 34680 34681In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that 34682would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the 34683asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to 34684inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads 34685in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop 34686mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is, 34687when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion 34688of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the 34689affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue 34690to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running 34691threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run. 34692 34693Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if 34694additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the 34695previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later 34696synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from 34697@value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable, 34698the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification 34699if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN} 34700ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has 34701finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed 34702sending any queued stop events. 34703 34704Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply 34705notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when 34706@value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when 34707@value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a 34708@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent. 34709Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from 34710the stub so there is no ambiguity. 34711 34712After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall 34713acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet}) 34714as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment 34715is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to 34716send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should 34717process normally. 34718 34719Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued 34720stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a 34721normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another 34722@samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is 34723permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub 34724should process normally. 34725 34726If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no 34727additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} 34728response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall 34729send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the 34730notification, and the process shall be repeated. 34731 34732In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as 34733follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped} 34734sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new 34735sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not 34736it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first 34737stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and 34738subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets 34739using the mechanism described above. The target must not send 34740asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete. 34741If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet, 34742or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond 34743@samp{OK}. 34744 34745@node Packet Acknowledgment 34746@section Packet Acknowledgment 34747 34748@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 34749@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 34750By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet, 34751the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 34752the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission). 34753This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over 34754unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line. 34755 34756In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or 34757TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant. 34758It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication 34759overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the 34760@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}. 34761 34762When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or 34763expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet 34764and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in 34765@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver. 34766 34767If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in 34768no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} 34769by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported}; 34770@pxref{qSupported}. 34771If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been 34772disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command 34773(@pxref{Remote Configuration}), 34774@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub. 34775Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments. 34776@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK} 34777response, which can be safely ignored by the stub. 34778 34779Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation 34780between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made; 34781it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current 34782connection. 34783Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a 34784new connection is established, 34785there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments 34786for the current connection, once disabled. 34787 34788@node Examples 34789@section Examples 34790 34791Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart 34792does not get any direct output: 34793 34794@smallexample 34795-> @code{R00} 34796<- @code{+} 34797@emph{target restarts} 34798-> @code{?} 34799<- @code{+} 34800<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 34801-> @code{+} 34802@end smallexample 34803 34804Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction: 34805 34806@smallexample 34807-> @code{G1445@dots{}} 34808<- @code{+} 34809-> @code{s} 34810<- @code{+} 34811@emph{time passes} 34812<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 34813-> @code{+} 34814-> @code{g} 34815<- @code{+} 34816<- @code{1455@dots{}} 34817-> @code{+} 34818@end smallexample 34819 34820@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 34821@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 34822@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension 34823 34824@menu 34825* File-I/O Overview:: 34826* Protocol Basics:: 34827* The F Request Packet:: 34828* The F Reply Packet:: 34829* The Ctrl-C Message:: 34830* Console I/O:: 34831* List of Supported Calls:: 34832* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes:: 34833* Constants:: 34834* File-I/O Examples:: 34835@end menu 34836 34837@node File-I/O Overview 34838@subsection File-I/O Overview 34839@cindex file-i/o overview 34840 34841The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the 34842target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various 34843system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a 34844remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed 34845actions and returns a response packet to the target system. 34846This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems. 34847 34848The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems. 34849It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both 34850@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for 34851translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal 34852protocol representations when data is transmitted. 34853 34854The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when 34855@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 34856or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call, 34857the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's 34858memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On 34859the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt 34860(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}. 34861 34862The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish 34863the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means, 34864after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the 34865previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step 34866request from @value{GDBN} is required. 34867 34868@smallexample 34869(@value{GDBP}) continue 34870 <- target requests 'system call X' 34871 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call 34872 -> @value{GDBN} returns result 34873 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target 34874 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet 34875@end smallexample 34876 34877The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on 34878the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes, 34879named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host 34880system are not supported by this protocol. 34881 34882File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode. 34883 34884@node Protocol Basics 34885@subsection Protocol Basics 34886@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o 34887 34888The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well 34889as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when 34890@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target, 34891the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result 34892of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet. 34893This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN} 34894to call the appropriate host system call: 34895 34896@itemize @bullet 34897@item 34898A unique identifier for the requested system call. 34899 34900@item 34901All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses 34902in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as 34903pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are. 34904Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation. 34905 34906@end itemize 34907 34908At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions. 34909 34910@itemize @bullet 34911@item 34912If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a 34913system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a 34914standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be 34915expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m} 34916packet. 34917 34918@item 34919@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host 34920representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types. 34921 34922@item 34923@value{GDBN} calls the system call. 34924 34925@item 34926It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation. 34927 34928@item 34929If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified 34930by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the 34931target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected 34932by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X} 34933packet. 34934 34935@end itemize 34936 34937Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all 34938necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains 34939 34940@itemize @bullet 34941@item 34942Return value. 34943 34944@item 34945@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call. 34946 34947@item 34948``Ctrl-C'' flag. 34949 34950@end itemize 34951 34952After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues 34953the latest continue or step action. 34954 34955@node The F Request Packet 34956@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet 34957@cindex file-i/o request packet 34958@cindex @code{F} request packet 34959 34960The @code{F} request packet has the following format: 34961 34962@table @samp 34963@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}} 34964 34965@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called. 34966This is just the name of the function. 34967 34968@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call. 34969Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case 34970of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound 34971datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case 34972of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a 34973comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII 34974string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash. 34975 34976@end table 34977 34978 34979 34980@node The F Reply Packet 34981@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet 34982@cindex file-i/o reply packet 34983@cindex @code{F} reply packet 34984 34985The @code{F} reply packet has the following format: 34986 34987@table @samp 34988 34989@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment} 34990 34991@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value. 34992 34993@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific 34994representation. 34995This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful. 34996 34997@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this 34998case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful. 34999The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}: 35000 35001@smallexample 35002F0,0,C 35003@end smallexample 35004 35005@noindent 35006or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed: 35007 35008@smallexample 35009F-1,4,C 35010@end smallexample 35011 35012@noindent 35013assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}. 35014 35015@end table 35016 35017 35018@node The Ctrl-C Message 35019@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message 35020@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol 35021 35022If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN} 35023reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}), 35024the target should behave as if it had 35025gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call 35026interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop 35027(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02} 35028packet. 35029 35030It's important for the target to know in which 35031state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases: 35032 35033@itemize @bullet 35034@item 35035The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet. 35036 35037@item 35038The system call on the host has been finished. 35039 35040@end itemize 35041 35042These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the 35043returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system 35044call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling 35045on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the 35046system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave 35047as if the break message arrived right after the system call. 35048 35049@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called 35050yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as 35051@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished 35052before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by 35053@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary. 35054The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened 35055or the full action has been completed. 35056 35057@node Console I/O 35058@subsection Console I/O 35059@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o 35060 35061By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file 35062descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output 35063on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation 35064(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled 35065by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor 350660 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following 35067conditions is met: 35068 35069@itemize @bullet 35070@item 35071The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the 35072@code{read} 35073system call is treated as finished. 35074 35075@item 35076The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing 35077newline. 35078 35079@item 35080The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing 35081character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input. 35082 35083@end itemize 35084 35085If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to 35086the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until 35087either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging 35088is stopped at the user's request. 35089 35090 35091@node List of Supported Calls 35092@subsection List of Supported Calls 35093@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls 35094 35095@menu 35096* open:: 35097* close:: 35098* read:: 35099* write:: 35100* lseek:: 35101* rename:: 35102* unlink:: 35103* stat/fstat:: 35104* gettimeofday:: 35105* isatty:: 35106* system:: 35107@end menu 35108 35109@node open 35110@unnumberedsubsubsec open 35111@cindex open, file-i/o system call 35112 35113@table @asis 35114@item Synopsis: 35115@smallexample 35116int open(const char *pathname, int flags); 35117int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode); 35118@end smallexample 35119 35120@item Request: 35121@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}} 35122 35123@noindent 35124@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 35125 35126@table @code 35127@item O_CREAT 35128If the file does not exist it will be created. The host 35129rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps 35130are concerned. 35131 35132@item O_EXCL 35133When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is 35134an error and open() fails. 35135 35136@item O_TRUNC 35137If the file already exists and the open mode allows 35138writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be 35139truncated to zero length. 35140 35141@item O_APPEND 35142The file is opened in append mode. 35143 35144@item O_RDONLY 35145The file is opened for reading only. 35146 35147@item O_WRONLY 35148The file is opened for writing only. 35149 35150@item O_RDWR 35151The file is opened for reading and writing. 35152@end table 35153 35154@noindent 35155Other bits are silently ignored. 35156 35157 35158@noindent 35159@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 35160 35161@table @code 35162@item S_IRUSR 35163User has read permission. 35164 35165@item S_IWUSR 35166User has write permission. 35167 35168@item S_IRGRP 35169Group has read permission. 35170 35171@item S_IWGRP 35172Group has write permission. 35173 35174@item S_IROTH 35175Others have read permission. 35176 35177@item S_IWOTH 35178Others have write permission. 35179@end table 35180 35181@noindent 35182Other bits are silently ignored. 35183 35184 35185@item Return value: 35186@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error 35187occurred. 35188 35189@item Errors: 35190 35191@table @code 35192@item EEXIST 35193@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used. 35194 35195@item EISDIR 35196@var{pathname} refers to a directory. 35197 35198@item EACCES 35199The requested access is not allowed. 35200 35201@item ENAMETOOLONG 35202@var{pathname} was too long. 35203 35204@item ENOENT 35205A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 35206 35207@item ENODEV 35208@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket. 35209 35210@item EROFS 35211@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and 35212write access was requested. 35213 35214@item EFAULT 35215@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value. 35216 35217@item ENOSPC 35218No space on device to create the file. 35219 35220@item EMFILE 35221The process already has the maximum number of files open. 35222 35223@item ENFILE 35224The limit on the total number of files open on the system 35225has been reached. 35226 35227@item EINTR 35228The call was interrupted by the user. 35229@end table 35230 35231@end table 35232 35233@node close 35234@unnumberedsubsubsec close 35235@cindex close, file-i/o system call 35236 35237@table @asis 35238@item Synopsis: 35239@smallexample 35240int close(int fd); 35241@end smallexample 35242 35243@item Request: 35244@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}} 35245 35246@item Return value: 35247@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred. 35248 35249@item Errors: 35250 35251@table @code 35252@item EBADF 35253@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor. 35254 35255@item EINTR 35256The call was interrupted by the user. 35257@end table 35258 35259@end table 35260 35261@node read 35262@unnumberedsubsubsec read 35263@cindex read, file-i/o system call 35264 35265@table @asis 35266@item Synopsis: 35267@smallexample 35268int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count); 35269@end smallexample 35270 35271@item Request: 35272@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 35273 35274@item Return value: 35275On success, the number of bytes read is returned. 35276Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read 35277returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned. 35278 35279@item Errors: 35280 35281@table @code 35282@item EBADF 35283@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 35284reading. 35285 35286@item EFAULT 35287@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 35288 35289@item EINTR 35290The call was interrupted by the user. 35291@end table 35292 35293@end table 35294 35295@node write 35296@unnumberedsubsubsec write 35297@cindex write, file-i/o system call 35298 35299@table @asis 35300@item Synopsis: 35301@smallexample 35302int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count); 35303@end smallexample 35304 35305@item Request: 35306@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 35307 35308@item Return value: 35309On success, the number of bytes written are returned. 35310Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1 35311is returned. 35312 35313@item Errors: 35314 35315@table @code 35316@item EBADF 35317@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 35318writing. 35319 35320@item EFAULT 35321@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 35322 35323@item EFBIG 35324An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the 35325host-specific maximum file size allowed. 35326 35327@item ENOSPC 35328No space on device to write the data. 35329 35330@item EINTR 35331The call was interrupted by the user. 35332@end table 35333 35334@end table 35335 35336@node lseek 35337@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek 35338@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call 35339 35340@table @asis 35341@item Synopsis: 35342@smallexample 35343long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag); 35344@end smallexample 35345 35346@item Request: 35347@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}} 35348 35349@var{flag} is one of: 35350 35351@table @code 35352@item SEEK_SET 35353The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes. 35354 35355@item SEEK_CUR 35356The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset} 35357bytes. 35358 35359@item SEEK_END 35360The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset} 35361bytes. 35362@end table 35363 35364@item Return value: 35365On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from 35366the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a 35367value of -1 is returned. 35368 35369@item Errors: 35370 35371@table @code 35372@item EBADF 35373@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor. 35374 35375@item ESPIPE 35376@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console. 35377 35378@item EINVAL 35379@var{flag} is not a proper value. 35380 35381@item EINTR 35382The call was interrupted by the user. 35383@end table 35384 35385@end table 35386 35387@node rename 35388@unnumberedsubsubsec rename 35389@cindex rename, file-i/o system call 35390 35391@table @asis 35392@item Synopsis: 35393@smallexample 35394int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath); 35395@end smallexample 35396 35397@item Request: 35398@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}} 35399 35400@item Return value: 35401On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 35402 35403@item Errors: 35404 35405@table @code 35406@item EISDIR 35407@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a 35408directory. 35409 35410@item EEXIST 35411@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory. 35412 35413@item EBUSY 35414@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some 35415process. 35416 35417@item EINVAL 35418An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory 35419of itself. 35420 35421@item ENOTDIR 35422A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new 35423path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory 35424and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory. 35425 35426@item EFAULT 35427@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values. 35428 35429@item EACCES 35430No access to the file or the path of the file. 35431 35432@item ENAMETOOLONG 35433 35434@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long. 35435 35436@item ENOENT 35437A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist. 35438 35439@item EROFS 35440The file is on a read-only filesystem. 35441 35442@item ENOSPC 35443The device containing the file has no room for the new 35444directory entry. 35445 35446@item EINTR 35447The call was interrupted by the user. 35448@end table 35449 35450@end table 35451 35452@node unlink 35453@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink 35454@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call 35455 35456@table @asis 35457@item Synopsis: 35458@smallexample 35459int unlink(const char *pathname); 35460@end smallexample 35461 35462@item Request: 35463@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}} 35464 35465@item Return value: 35466On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 35467 35468@item Errors: 35469 35470@table @code 35471@item EACCES 35472No access to the file or the path of the file. 35473 35474@item EPERM 35475The system does not allow unlinking of directories. 35476 35477@item EBUSY 35478The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's 35479being used by another process. 35480 35481@item EFAULT 35482@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 35483 35484@item ENAMETOOLONG 35485@var{pathname} was too long. 35486 35487@item ENOENT 35488A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 35489 35490@item ENOTDIR 35491A component of the path is not a directory. 35492 35493@item EROFS 35494The file is on a read-only filesystem. 35495 35496@item EINTR 35497The call was interrupted by the user. 35498@end table 35499 35500@end table 35501 35502@node stat/fstat 35503@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat 35504@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call 35505@cindex stat, file-i/o system call 35506 35507@table @asis 35508@item Synopsis: 35509@smallexample 35510int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf); 35511int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf); 35512@end smallexample 35513 35514@item Request: 35515@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@* 35516@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}} 35517 35518@item Return value: 35519On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 35520 35521@item Errors: 35522 35523@table @code 35524@item EBADF 35525@var{fd} is not a valid open file. 35526 35527@item ENOENT 35528A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the 35529path is an empty string. 35530 35531@item ENOTDIR 35532A component of the path is not a directory. 35533 35534@item EFAULT 35535@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 35536 35537@item EACCES 35538No access to the file or the path of the file. 35539 35540@item ENAMETOOLONG 35541@var{pathname} was too long. 35542 35543@item EINTR 35544The call was interrupted by the user. 35545@end table 35546 35547@end table 35548 35549@node gettimeofday 35550@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday 35551@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call 35552 35553@table @asis 35554@item Synopsis: 35555@smallexample 35556int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz); 35557@end smallexample 35558 35559@item Request: 35560@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}} 35561 35562@item Return value: 35563On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise. 35564 35565@item Errors: 35566 35567@table @code 35568@item EINVAL 35569@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer. 35570 35571@item EFAULT 35572@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value. 35573@end table 35574 35575@end table 35576 35577@node isatty 35578@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty 35579@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call 35580 35581@table @asis 35582@item Synopsis: 35583@smallexample 35584int isatty(int fd); 35585@end smallexample 35586 35587@item Request: 35588@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}} 35589 35590@item Return value: 35591Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. 35592 35593@item Errors: 35594 35595@table @code 35596@item EINTR 35597The call was interrupted by the user. 35598@end table 35599 35600@end table 35601 35602Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns 356031 to the target if the file descriptor is attached 35604to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls 35605would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than 35606needed. 35607 35608 35609@node system 35610@unnumberedsubsubsec system 35611@cindex system, file-i/o system call 35612 35613@table @asis 35614@item Synopsis: 35615@smallexample 35616int system(const char *command); 35617@end smallexample 35618 35619@item Request: 35620@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}} 35621 35622@item Return value: 35623If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is 35624available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available. 35625For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the 35626return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the 35627command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system} 35628return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case 35629@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned. 35630 35631@item Errors: 35632 35633@table @code 35634@item EINTR 35635The call was interrupted by the user. 35636@end table 35637 35638@end table 35639 35640@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls 35641to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on 35642the host is simplified before it's returned 35643to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process 35644is discarded, and the return value consists 35645entirely of the exit status of the called command. 35646 35647Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused 35648by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the 35649@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command. 35650 35651@table @code 35652@item set remote system-call-allowed 35653@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 35654Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O 35655protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled). 35656 35657@item show remote system-call-allowed 35658@kindex show remote system-call-allowed 35659Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O 35660protocol. 35661@end table 35662 35663@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 35664@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 35665@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 35666 35667@menu 35668* Integral Datatypes:: 35669* Pointer Values:: 35670* Memory Transfer:: 35671* struct stat:: 35672* struct timeval:: 35673@end menu 35674 35675@node Integral Datatypes 35676@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes 35677@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 35678 35679The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int}, 35680@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long}, 35681@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}. 35682 35683@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are 35684implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol. 35685 35686@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types. 35687 35688@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those 35689in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target. 35690 35691@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch. 35692 35693All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a 35694structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian 35695byte order. 35696 35697@node Pointer Values 35698@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values 35699@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol 35700 35701Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception 35702is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't 35703transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings 35704are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@: 35705 35706@smallexample 35707@code{1aaf/12} 35708@end smallexample 35709 35710@noindent 35711which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf. 35712The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including 35713the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"} 35714at address 0x123456 is transmitted as 35715 35716@smallexample 35717@code{123456/d} 35718@end smallexample 35719 35720@node Memory Transfer 35721@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer 35722@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol 35723 35724Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for 35725example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format 35726with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to 35727this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F} 35728packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before 35729it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured 35730data should point to the already-coerced data at any time. 35731 35732 35733@node struct stat 35734@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat 35735@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol 35736 35737The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN} 35738is defined as follows: 35739 35740@smallexample 35741struct stat @{ 35742 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */ 35743 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */ 35744 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */ 35745 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */ 35746 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */ 35747 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */ 35748 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */ 35749 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */ 35750 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */ 35751 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */ 35752 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */ 35753 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */ 35754 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */ 35755@}; 35756@end smallexample 35757 35758The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 35759appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 35760structure is of size 64 bytes. 35761 35762The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or 35763range of values. 35764 35765@table @code 35766 35767@item st_dev 35768A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console. 35769 35770@item st_ino 35771No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 35772 35773@item st_mode 35774Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other 35775bits have currently no meaning for the target. 35776 35777@item st_uid 35778@itemx st_gid 35779@itemx st_rdev 35780No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 35781 35782@item st_atime 35783@itemx st_mtime 35784@itemx st_ctime 35785These values have a host and file system dependent 35786accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not 35787support exact timing values. 35788@end table 35789 35790The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is 35791responsible for coercing it to the target representation before 35792continuing. 35793 35794Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol 35795representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually 35796get truncated on the target. 35797 35798@node struct timeval 35799@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval 35800@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol 35801 35802The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol 35803is defined as follows: 35804 35805@smallexample 35806struct timeval @{ 35807 time_t tv_sec; /* second */ 35808 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */ 35809@}; 35810@end smallexample 35811 35812The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 35813appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 35814structure is of size 8 bytes. 35815 35816@node Constants 35817@subsection Constants 35818@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol 35819 35820The following values are used for the constants inside of the 35821protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these 35822values before and after the call as needed. 35823 35824@menu 35825* Open Flags:: 35826* mode_t Values:: 35827* Errno Values:: 35828* Lseek Flags:: 35829* Limits:: 35830@end menu 35831 35832@node Open Flags 35833@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags 35834@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol 35835 35836All values are given in hexadecimal representation. 35837 35838@smallexample 35839 O_RDONLY 0x0 35840 O_WRONLY 0x1 35841 O_RDWR 0x2 35842 O_APPEND 0x8 35843 O_CREAT 0x200 35844 O_TRUNC 0x400 35845 O_EXCL 0x800 35846@end smallexample 35847 35848@node mode_t Values 35849@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values 35850@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol 35851 35852All values are given in octal representation. 35853 35854@smallexample 35855 S_IFREG 0100000 35856 S_IFDIR 040000 35857 S_IRUSR 0400 35858 S_IWUSR 0200 35859 S_IXUSR 0100 35860 S_IRGRP 040 35861 S_IWGRP 020 35862 S_IXGRP 010 35863 S_IROTH 04 35864 S_IWOTH 02 35865 S_IXOTH 01 35866@end smallexample 35867 35868@node Errno Values 35869@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values 35870@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol 35871 35872All values are given in decimal representation. 35873 35874@smallexample 35875 EPERM 1 35876 ENOENT 2 35877 EINTR 4 35878 EBADF 9 35879 EACCES 13 35880 EFAULT 14 35881 EBUSY 16 35882 EEXIST 17 35883 ENODEV 19 35884 ENOTDIR 20 35885 EISDIR 21 35886 EINVAL 22 35887 ENFILE 23 35888 EMFILE 24 35889 EFBIG 27 35890 ENOSPC 28 35891 ESPIPE 29 35892 EROFS 30 35893 ENAMETOOLONG 91 35894 EUNKNOWN 9999 35895@end smallexample 35896 35897 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns 35898 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers. 35899 35900@node Lseek Flags 35901@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags 35902@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol 35903 35904@smallexample 35905 SEEK_SET 0 35906 SEEK_CUR 1 35907 SEEK_END 2 35908@end smallexample 35909 35910@node Limits 35911@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits 35912@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol 35913 35914All values are given in decimal representation. 35915 35916@smallexample 35917 INT_MIN -2147483648 35918 INT_MAX 2147483647 35919 UINT_MAX 4294967295 35920 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808 35921 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807 35922 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615 35923@end smallexample 35924 35925@node File-I/O Examples 35926@subsection File-I/O Examples 35927@cindex file-i/o examples 35928 35929Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 35930address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written: 35931 35932@smallexample 35933<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6} 35934@emph{request memory read from target} 35935-> @code{m1234,6} 35936<- XXXXXX 35937@emph{return "6 bytes written"} 35938-> @code{F6} 35939@end smallexample 35940 35941Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 35942address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read: 35943 35944@smallexample 35945<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 35946@emph{request memory write to target} 35947-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 35948@emph{return "6 bytes read"} 35949-> @code{F6} 35950@end smallexample 35951 35952Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid 35953file descriptor (@code{EBADF}): 35954 35955@smallexample 35956<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 35957-> @code{F-1,9} 35958@end smallexample 35959 35960Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on 35961host is called: 35962 35963@smallexample 35964<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 35965-> @code{F-1,4,C} 35966<- @code{T02} 35967@end smallexample 35968 35969Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on 35970host is called: 35971 35972@smallexample 35973<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 35974-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 35975<- @code{T02} 35976@end smallexample 35977 35978@node Library List Format 35979@section Library List Format 35980@cindex library list format, remote protocol 35981 35982On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the 35983same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case, 35984@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory 35985operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other 35986platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries. 35987@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries 35988through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 35989packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub 35990queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries 35991are loaded. 35992 35993The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which 35994lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an 35995associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses, 35996which report where the library was loaded in memory. 35997 35998For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the 35999library should have a list of segments. If the target supports 36000dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element 36001should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or 36002section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not 36003depend on the library's link-time base addresses. 36004 36005@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 36006library lists. @xref{Expat}. 36007 36008A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single 36009offset, looks like this: 36010 36011@smallexample 36012<library-list> 36013 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6"> 36014 <segment address="0x10000000"/> 36015 </library> 36016</library-list> 36017@end smallexample 36018 36019Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three 36020allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this: 36021 36022@smallexample 36023<library-list> 36024 <library name="sharedlib.o"> 36025 <section address="0x10000000"/> 36026 <section address="0x20000000"/> 36027 <section address="0x30000000"/> 36028 </library> 36029</library-list> 36030@end smallexample 36031 36032The format of a library list is described by this DTD: 36033 36034@smallexample 36035<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning --> 36036<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*> 36037<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 36038<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)> 36039<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED> 36040<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY> 36041<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED> 36042<!ELEMENT section EMPTY> 36043<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED> 36044@end smallexample 36045 36046In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a 36047single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or 36048section for each library. 36049 36050@node Memory Map Format 36051@section Memory Map Format 36052@cindex memory map format 36053 36054To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a 36055memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the 36056memory map. 36057 36058The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 36059(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that 36060lists memory regions. 36061 36062@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 36063memory maps. @xref{Expat}. 36064 36065The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 36066 36067@smallexample 36068<?xml version="1.0"?> 36069<!DOCTYPE memory-map 36070 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 36071 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd"> 36072<memory-map> 36073 region... 36074</memory-map> 36075@end smallexample 36076 36077Each region can be either: 36078 36079@itemize 36080 36081@item 36082A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length} 36083bytes from there: 36084 36085@smallexample 36086<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 36087@end smallexample 36088 36089 36090@item 36091A region of read-only memory: 36092 36093@smallexample 36094<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 36095@end smallexample 36096 36097 36098@item 36099A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize} 36100bytes in length: 36101 36102@smallexample 36103<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"> 36104 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property> 36105</memory> 36106@end smallexample 36107 36108@end itemize 36109 36110Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered 36111by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X} 36112packets to write to addresses in such ranges. 36113 36114The formal DTD for memory map format is given below: 36115 36116@smallexample 36117<!-- ................................................... --> 36118<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ --> 36119<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. --> 36120<!-- .................................... .............. --> 36121<!-- memory-map.dtd --> 36122<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning --> 36123<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)> 36124<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0"> 36125<!ELEMENT memory (property)> 36126<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region, 36127 and its type, or device. --> 36128<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED 36129 start CDATA #REQUIRED 36130 length CDATA #REQUIRED 36131 device CDATA #IMPLIED> 36132<!-- property: Generic attribute tag --> 36133<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*> 36134<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED> 36135@end smallexample 36136 36137@node Thread List Format 36138@section Thread List Format 36139@cindex thread list format 36140 36141To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes, 36142@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 36143(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with 36144the following structure: 36145 36146@smallexample 36147<?xml version="1.0"?> 36148<threads> 36149 <thread id="id" core="0"> 36150 ... description ... 36151 </thread> 36152</threads> 36153@end smallexample 36154 36155Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that 36156identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The 36157@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core 36158the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread} 36159element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information. 36160 36161@node Traceframe Info Format 36162@section Traceframe Info Format 36163@cindex traceframe info format 36164 36165To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when 36166inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of 36167memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been 36168collected in a traceframe. 36169 36170This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 36171(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document. 36172 36173@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 36174traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}. 36175 36176The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 36177 36178@smallexample 36179<?xml version="1.0"?> 36180<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info 36181 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 36182 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd"> 36183<traceframe-info> 36184 block... 36185</traceframe-info> 36186@end smallexample 36187 36188Each traceframe block can be either: 36189 36190@itemize 36191 36192@item 36193A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for 36194@var{length} bytes from there: 36195 36196@smallexample 36197<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 36198@end smallexample 36199 36200@end itemize 36201 36202The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below: 36203 36204@smallexample 36205<!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* > 36206<!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 36207 36208<!ELEMENT memory EMPTY> 36209<!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED 36210 length CDATA #REQUIRED> 36211@end smallexample 36212 36213@include agentexpr.texi 36214 36215@node Target Descriptions 36216@appendix Target Descriptions 36217@cindex target descriptions 36218 36219@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development, 36220and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases. 36221The format is expected to stabilize in the future. 36222 36223One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems 36224is that there are so many minor variants of each processor 36225architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with 36226a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example --- 36227and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some 36228architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of 36229vendors. This leads to a number of problems: 36230 36231@itemize @bullet 36232@item 36233With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for 36234the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes. 36235@item 36236Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited 36237audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every 36238variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree. 36239@item 36240When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system 36241at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the 36242@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone. 36243@end itemize 36244 36245To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a 36246target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to 36247actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support 36248processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the 36249descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them. 36250 36251@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 36252target descriptions. @xref{Expat}. 36253 36254@menu 36255* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target. 36256* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description. 36257* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target 36258 descriptions. 36259* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about. 36260@end menu 36261 36262@node Retrieving Descriptions 36263@section Retrieving Descriptions 36264 36265Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or 36266specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the 36267description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote 36268protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets, 36269qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be 36270@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an 36271XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description 36272Format}. 36273 36274Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description. 36275If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to 36276specify a file are: 36277 36278@table @code 36279@cindex set tdesc filename 36280@item set tdesc filename @var{path} 36281Read the target description from @var{path}. 36282 36283@cindex unset tdesc filename 36284@item unset tdesc filename 36285Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN} 36286will use the description supplied by the current target. 36287 36288@cindex show tdesc filename 36289@item show tdesc filename 36290Show the filename to read for a target description, if any. 36291@end table 36292 36293 36294@node Target Description Format 36295@section Target Description Format 36296@cindex target descriptions, XML format 36297 36298A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML} 36299document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in 36300the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This 36301means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to 36302check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid. 36303However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for 36304their targets, we also describe the grammar here. 36305 36306Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target 36307and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register 36308sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target. 36309@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your 36310target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target. 36311 36312Here is a simple target description: 36313 36314@smallexample 36315<target version="1.0"> 36316 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture> 36317</target> 36318@end smallexample 36319 36320@noindent 36321This minimal description only says that the target uses 36322the x86-64 architecture. 36323 36324A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking 36325optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements 36326are explained further below. 36327 36328@smallexample 36329<?xml version="1.0"?> 36330<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd"> 36331<target version="1.0"> 36332 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]} 36333 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]} 36334 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]} 36335 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]} 36336</target> 36337@end smallexample 36338 36339@noindent 36340The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line 36341breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version 36342declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted 36343(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be 36344useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for 36345@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend 36346including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible 36347revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report 36348the version mismatch. 36349 36350@subsection Inclusion 36351@cindex target descriptions, inclusion 36352@cindex XInclude 36353@ifnotinfo 36354@cindex <xi:include> 36355@end ifnotinfo 36356 36357It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into 36358several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to 36359share files between different possible target descriptions. You can 36360divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of 36361the target description with an inclusion directive of the form: 36362 36363@smallexample 36364<xi:include href="@var{document}"/> 36365@end smallexample 36366 36367@noindent 36368When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve 36369the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with 36370the contents of that document. If the current description was read 36371using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document; 36372@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the 36373current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for 36374@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the 36375original description. 36376 36377@subsection Architecture 36378@cindex <architecture> 36379 36380An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form: 36381 36382@smallexample 36383 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture> 36384@end smallexample 36385 36386@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 36387@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 36388 36389@subsection OS ABI 36390@cindex @code{<osabi>} 36391 36392This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 36393Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 36394 36395An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form: 36396 36397@smallexample 36398 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi> 36399@end smallexample 36400 36401@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by 36402@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 36403 36404@subsection Compatible Architecture 36405@cindex @code{<compatible>} 36406 36407This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 36408Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 36409 36410A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form: 36411 36412@smallexample 36413 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible> 36414@end smallexample 36415 36416@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 36417@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 36418 36419A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target 36420is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture 36421given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the 36422Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common} 36423or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries 36424in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this 36425capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows: 36426 36427@smallexample 36428 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture> 36429 <compatible>spu</compatible> 36430@end smallexample 36431 36432@subsection Features 36433@cindex <feature> 36434 36435Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target 36436system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU 36437registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element 36438has this form: 36439 36440@smallexample 36441<feature name="@var{name}"> 36442 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]} 36443 @var{reg}@dots{} 36444</feature> 36445@end smallexample 36446 36447@noindent 36448Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name 36449of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special 36450knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature 36451should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}. 36452 36453@subsection Types 36454 36455Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must 36456interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer, 36457but other types can be requested by name in the register description. 36458Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined 36459Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types. 36460 36461Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives 36462a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type. 36463Types must be defined before they are used. 36464 36465@cindex <vector> 36466Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays 36467of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements, 36468specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements, 36469@var{count}: 36470 36471@smallexample 36472<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/> 36473@end smallexample 36474 36475@cindex <union> 36476If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it 36477with a union type containing the useful representations. The 36478@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements, 36479each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}: 36480 36481@smallexample 36482<union id="@var{id}"> 36483 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 36484 @dots{} 36485</union> 36486@end smallexample 36487 36488@cindex <struct> 36489If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define 36490it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>} 36491element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields 36492or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields, 36493its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an 36494explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an 36495integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or 36496equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit. 36497 36498@smallexample 36499<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 36500 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/> 36501 @dots{} 36502</struct> 36503@end smallexample 36504 36505If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an 36506explicit type, and no implicit padding is added. 36507 36508@smallexample 36509<struct id="@var{id}"> 36510 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 36511 @dots{} 36512</struct> 36513@end smallexample 36514 36515@cindex <flags> 36516If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with 36517a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size} 36518and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a 36519@var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags 36520are supported. 36521 36522@smallexample 36523<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 36524 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/> 36525 @dots{} 36526</flags> 36527@end smallexample 36528 36529@subsection Registers 36530@cindex <reg> 36531 36532Each register is represented as an element with this form: 36533 36534@smallexample 36535<reg name="@var{name}" 36536 bitsize="@var{size}" 36537 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]} 36538 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]} 36539 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]} 36540 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/> 36541@end smallexample 36542 36543@noindent 36544The components are as follows: 36545 36546@table @var 36547 36548@item name 36549The register's name; it must be unique within the target description. 36550 36551@item bitsize 36552The register's size, in bits. 36553 36554@item regnum 36555The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater 36556than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in 36557a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description 36558defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write 36559the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P} 36560packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets 36561in order of increasing register number. 36562 36563@item save-restore 36564Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function 36565calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is 36566@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for 36567some system control registers; this is not related to the target's 36568ABI. 36569 36570@item type 36571The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type 36572defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int} 36573and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size 36574for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the 36575architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for 36576@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}. 36577 36578@item group 36579The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must 36580be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no 36581@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register 36582in @code{info registers}. 36583 36584@end table 36585 36586@node Predefined Target Types 36587@section Predefined Target Types 36588@cindex target descriptions, predefined types 36589 36590Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types 36591from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead, 36592standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental 36593types. The currently supported types are: 36594 36595@table @code 36596 36597@item int8 36598@itemx int16 36599@itemx int32 36600@itemx int64 36601@itemx int128 36602Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits. 36603 36604@item uint8 36605@itemx uint16 36606@itemx uint32 36607@itemx uint64 36608@itemx uint128 36609Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits. 36610 36611@item code_ptr 36612@itemx data_ptr 36613Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and 36614any dedicated return address register may be marked as code 36615pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic 36616address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers 36617may be marked as data pointers. 36618 36619@item ieee_single 36620Single precision IEEE floating point. 36621 36622@item ieee_double 36623Double precision IEEE floating point. 36624 36625@item arm_fpa_ext 36626The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers. 36627 36628@item i387_ext 36629The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers. 36630 36631@item i386_eflags 3663232bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86. 36633 36634@item i386_mxcsr 3663532bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86. 36636 36637@end table 36638 36639@node Standard Target Features 36640@section Standard Target Features 36641@cindex target descriptions, standard features 36642 36643A target description must contain either no registers or all the 36644target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then 36645@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on 36646the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the 36647default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be 36648described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN} 36649can recognize them. 36650 36651This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements 36652which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features 36653with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers; 36654if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required 36655feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target 36656description. You can add additional registers to any of the 36657standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if 36658they were added to an unrecognized feature. 36659 36660This section lists the known features and their expected contents. 36661Sample XML documents for these features are included in the 36662@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}. 36663 36664Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the 36665company or organization which selected the name, and the overall 36666architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature 36667containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}. 36668 36669The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose 36670of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display 36671registers using the capitalization used in the description. 36672 36673@menu 36674* ARM Features:: 36675* i386 Features:: 36676* MIPS Features:: 36677* M68K Features:: 36678* PowerPC Features:: 36679@end menu 36680 36681 36682@node ARM Features 36683@subsection ARM Features 36684@cindex target descriptions, ARM features 36685 36686The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile 36687ARM targets. 36688It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, 36689@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}. 36690 36691For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} 36692feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain 36693registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, 36694and @samp{xpsr}. 36695 36696The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it 36697should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}. 36698 36699The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present, 36700it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and 36701@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon}, 36702@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional. 36703 36704The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it 36705should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If 36706they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included. 36707@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from 36708halves of the double-precision registers. 36709 36710The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not 36711need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the 36712VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the 36713quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers. 36714If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also 36715be present and include 32 double-precision registers. 36716 36717@node i386 Features 36718@subsection i386 Features 36719@cindex target descriptions, i386 features 36720 36721The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64 36722targets. It should describe the following registers: 36723 36724@itemize @minus 36725@item 36726@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386 36727@item 36728@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64 36729@item 36730@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es}, 36731@samp{fs}, @samp{gs} 36732@item 36733@samp{st0} through @samp{st7} 36734@item 36735@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff}, 36736@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop} 36737@end itemize 36738 36739The register sets may be different, depending on the target. 36740 36741The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should 36742describe registers: 36743 36744@itemize @minus 36745@item 36746@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386 36747@item 36748@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64 36749@item 36750@samp{mxcsr} 36751@end itemize 36752 36753The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the 36754@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should 36755describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers: 36756 36757@itemize @minus 36758@item 36759@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386 36760@item 36761@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64 36762@end itemize 36763 36764The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should 36765describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}. 36766 36767@node MIPS Features 36768@subsection MIPS Features 36769@cindex target descriptions, MIPS features 36770 36771The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets. 36772It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo}, 36773@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending 36774on the target. 36775 36776The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should 36777contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause} 36778registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 36779 36780The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though 36781it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should 36782contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and 36783@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 36784 36785The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should 36786contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the 36787Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls. 36788 36789@node M68K Features 36790@subsection M68K Features 36791@cindex target descriptions, M68K features 36792 36793@table @code 36794@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core} 36795@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core} 36796@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core} 36797One of those features must be always present. 36798The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is 36799used. The feature that is present should contain registers 36800@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp}, 36801@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}. 36802 36803@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp} 36804This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers 36805@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and 36806@samp{fpiaddr}. 36807@end table 36808 36809@node PowerPC Features 36810@subsection PowerPC Features 36811@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features 36812 36813The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC 36814targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, 36815@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and 36816@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 36817 36818The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should 36819contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}. 36820 36821The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should 36822contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, 36823and @samp{vrsave}. 36824 36825The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should 36826contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} 36827will combine these registers with the floating point registers 36828(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} 36829through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} 36830through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7. 36831 36832The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should 36833contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and 36834@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in 36835@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in 36836@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine 36837these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the 36838user. 36839 36840@node Operating System Information 36841@appendix Operating System Information 36842@cindex operating system information 36843 36844@menu 36845* Process list:: 36846@end menu 36847 36848Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of 36849the operating system running on the target---for example the list of 36850processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the 36851mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the 36852target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses 36853on a different aspect of target. 36854 36855Operating system information is retrived from the target via the 36856remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata 36857read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and 36858the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched. 36859 36860@node Process list 36861@appendixsection Process list 36862@cindex operating system information, process list 36863 36864When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the 36865@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is 36866an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in 36867@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}. 36868 36869An example document is: 36870 36871@smallexample 36872<?xml version="1.0"?> 36873<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd"> 36874<osdata type="processes"> 36875 <item> 36876 <column name="pid">1</column> 36877 <column name="user">root</column> 36878 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column> 36879 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column> 36880 </item> 36881</osdata> 36882@end smallexample 36883 36884Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value 36885of that column should identify the process on the target. The 36886@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be 36887displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present, 36888should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process 36889is running on. Target may provide additional columns, 36890which @value{GDBN} currently ignores. 36891 36892@node Trace File Format 36893@appendix Trace File Format 36894@cindex trace file format 36895 36896The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description 36897section, and a trace frame section with binary data. 36898 36899The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is 36900@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data, 36901while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values 36902in the future. 36903 36904The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text 36905separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a 36906variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such 36907as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will 36908ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end 36909of this section. 36910 36911@c FIXME add some specific types of data 36912 36913The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames. 36914Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a 36915four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in 36916the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a 36917character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace 36918state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a 36919hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's 36920endianness. 36921 36922@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section 36923 36924@table @code 36925@item R @var{bytes} 36926Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a 36927@code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the 36928actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a 36929hexadecimal encoding. 36930 36931@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}... 36932Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte 36933address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by 36934@var{length} bytes. 36935 36936@item V @var{number} @var{value} 36937Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value 36938@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}. 36939 36940@end table 36941 36942Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types 36943of blocks. 36944 36945@include gpl.texi 36946 36947@node GNU Free Documentation License 36948@appendix GNU Free Documentation License 36949@include fdl.texi 36950 36951@node Index 36952@unnumbered Index 36953 36954@printindex cp 36955 36956@tex 36957% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the 36958% meantime: 36959\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill 36960\centerline{The body of this manual is set in} 36961\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,} 36962\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}} 36963\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.} 36964\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},} 36965\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and} 36966\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}} 36967\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill} 36968\page\colophon 36969% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991. 36970@end tex 36971 36972@bye 36973